0% found this document useful (0 votes)
220 views516 pages

Bulletin 857 Protection System For Feeder and Motor Protection, Series A

Uploaded by

Razvan Mares
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
0% found this document useful (0 votes)
220 views516 pages

Bulletin 857 Protection System For Feeder and Motor Protection, Series A

Uploaded by

Razvan Mares
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
You are on page 1/ 516

User Manual

Original Instructions

Bulletin 857 Protection System for Feeder and


Motor Protection, Series A
Catalog Number 857
Important User Information
Read this document and the documents listed in the additional resources section about installation, configuration, and
operation of this equipment before you install, configure, operate, or maintain this product. Users are required to
familiarize themselves with installation and wiring instructions in addition to requirements of all applicable codes, laws,
and standards.

Activities including installation, adjustments, putting into service, use, assembly, disassembly, and maintenance are
required to be carried out by suitably trained personnel in accordance with applicable code of practice.

If this equipment is used in a manner not specified by the manufacturer, the protection provided by the equipment may
be impaired.

In no event will Rockwell Automation, Inc. be responsible or liable for indirect or consequential damages resulting from
the use or application of this equipment.

The examples and diagrams in this manual are included solely for illustrative purposes. Because of the many variables and
requirements associated with any particular installation, Rockwell Automation, Inc. cannot assume responsibility or
liability for actual use based on the examples and diagrams.

No patent liability is assumed by Rockwell Automation, Inc. with respect to use of information, circuits, equipment, or
software described in this manual.

Reproduction of the contents of this manual, in whole or in part, without written permission of Rockwell Automation,
Inc., is prohibited

Throughout this manual, when necessary, we use notes to make you aware of safety considerations.

WARNING: Identifies information about practices or circumstances that can cause an explosion in a hazardous
environment, which may lead to personal injury or death, property damage, or economic loss.

ATTENTION: Identifies information about practices or circumstances that can lead to personal injury or death, property
damage, or economic loss. Attentions help you identify a hazard, avoid a hazard, and recognize the consequence.

IMPORTANT Identifies information that is critical for successful application and understanding of the product.

Labels may also be on or inside the equipment to provide specific precautions.

SHOCK HAZARD: Labels may be on or inside the equipment, for example, a drive or motor, to alert people that dangerous
voltage may be present.

BURN HAZARD: Labels may be on or inside the equipment, for example, a drive or motor, to alert people that surfaces may
reach dangerous temperatures.

ARC FLASH HAZARD: Labels may be on or inside the equipment, for example, a motor control center, to alert people to
potential Arc Flash. Arc Flash will cause severe injury or death. Wear proper Personal Protective Equipment (PPE). Follow ALL
Regulatory requirements for safe work practices and for Personal Protective Equipment (PPE).
Table of Contents

Summary of Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13

Preface
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Additional Resources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18

Chapter 1
Overview 857 Relay Protection System Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
SetPointPS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
User Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Setting File and Firmware Compliance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Operating Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
EU Directive Compliance and Other Standard Compliance . . 23
Catalog Number Explanation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Available Replacement Option Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25

Chapter 2
Local Panel User Interface 857 Protection System Front Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Backlight Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Keypad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Menu Navigation and Pointers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Operation Status Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Resetting Latched Indicators and Output Protection
Elements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Adjusting the Display Contrast . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Local Panel Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Navigating in Menus. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Main Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Menu Structure of Protection Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Setting Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Fault Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Operating Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
To Gain Access. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Password Management. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Restoring a Lost Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Operating Measures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Control Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Measured Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Reading the Event Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Signal Forcing Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Configuration and Parameter Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Parameter Setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 3


Table of Contents

Setting Range Limits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49


Disturbance Recorder Menu DR. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Configuring the Digital Inputs DI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Configuring the Digital Outputs DO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Protection Menu (Prot) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Configuration Menu (CONF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Protocol Menu (Bus) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
SetPointPS Personal Computer Software. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Single-line Diagram Editing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Blocking and Interlocking Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Webset Through Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Server . . . 60
Enable the HTTP Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Connect to the 857 Protection System with a Web Browser. . . 61
Configure the 857 Protection System Through Webset
HTTP Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Using the Webset HTTP Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Caption View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Menu/Group List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Content/Group View. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63

Chapter 3
Protection Functions Maximum Number of Protection Stages in One Application. . . . . . 67
Protection Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
General Features of Protection Stages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Setting Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Start and Trip Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Output Matrix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Blocking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Retardation Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Reset Time (Release Time) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Hysteresis or Deadband . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Function Dependencies. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Application Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Current Protection Function Dependencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Overcurrent Stage I> (50/51) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Three Independent Stages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Inverse Operation Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Inverse Time Limitation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Cold Load and Inrush Current Handling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Setting Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Missing Recorded Value. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Remote Controlled Overcurrent Scaling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Directional Overcurrent Protection Iφ> (67) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Four Independent Stages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Inverse Operation Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Inverse Time Limitation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81

4 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Table of Contents

Cold Load and Inrush Current Handling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82


Setting Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Current Unbalance Stage I2> (46) in Feeder Protection Mode . . . . 85
Setting Parameters of Current Unbalance Stage I2> (46) . . . . . . . . . 86
Measured and Recorded Values of Current Unbalance
Stage I2> (46). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Current Unbalance Protection I2> (46) in Motor Protection
Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Inverse Delay. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
More Stages (DT Delay Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Setting Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Incorrect Phase Sequence Protection I2>> (47). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Stall Protection Ist> (48) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Motor Status. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Soft Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Normal Starting Sequence. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Frequent Start Protection N> (66) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Undercurrent Protection I< (37) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Directional Earth-fault Protection I0φ> (67N) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Polarization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Modes for Different Network Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Input Signal Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Intermittent Earth-fault Detection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Two Independent Stages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Inverse Operation Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Inverse Time Limitation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Setting Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Earth-fault Phase Detection Algorithm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
On an Ideal Grounded Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Implementation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Earth-fault-protection I0> (50N/51N),(50G/51G),
(50GS/51GS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Input Signal Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Intermittent Earth-fault Detection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Four or Six Independent Undirectional Earth-fault
Overcurrent Stages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Inverse Operation Time (I0> Stage only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Inverse Time Limitation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Setting Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Directional Transient Intermittent Earth-fault-protection I0int>
(67NI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Direction Algorithm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 5


Table of Contents

I0 Pick-up Sensitivity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112


Co-ordination with U0> Backup Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Co-ordination with the Normal Directional Earth-fault-
protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Auto Reclosing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Intermittent Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Peak Amount Counter, Operation Time, and Intermittent
Time Coordination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Setting Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Capacitor Bank Unbalance Protection (50NC/51NC). . . . . . . . . . 117
Compensation Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Compensation and Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Zero Sequence Voltage Protection U0>, U0>>(59N) . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Measure Residual Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Two Independent Stages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Setting Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Thermal Overload Protection T> (49) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Thermal Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Time Constant for Cooling Situation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Heat Capacitance, Service Factor, and Ambient
Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Example of a Behavior of the Thermal Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Initial Temperature Rise After Restart. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Alarm Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Overvoltage Protection U> (59). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Three Independent Stages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Configurable Release Delay. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Configurable Hysteresis. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Setting Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Undervoltage Protection U< (27) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Blocking During VT/PT Fuse Failure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Self-blocking at Very Low Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Three Independent Stages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Setting Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Reverse Power and Underpower Protection P<, P<<(32). . . . . . . . 134
Overfrequency and Underfrequency Protection
f><, f>><< (81), (81H/81L) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Protection Mode for f>< and f>><< Stages. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Undervoltage Self-blocking of Underfrequency Stages . . . . . . . 135
Initial Self-blocking of Underfrequency Stages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Four Independent Frequency Stages. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Setting Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137

6 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Table of Contents

Rate of Change of Frequency (ROCOF) Protection df/dt (81R) . 137


Frequency Behavior During Load Switching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Settings Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
ROCOF Implementation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
ROCOF and Frequency Over and Under Stages . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Definite Operation-time Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Inverse Operation-time Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Synchrocheck Protection (25) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Magnetizing Inrush Second Harmonic O/C Stage If2>(68F2) . . . 149
Fifth Harmonic O/C Stage If5> (68F5). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
Circuit Breaker Failure Protection CBFP (50BF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
Programmable Stages (99) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
Eight Independent Stages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Setting Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
Arc Fault Protection (50ARC/50NARC) (Optional) . . . . . . . . . . . 154
Three Stages for Arc Faults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
Light Channel Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Binary Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Binary Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Delayed Light Indication Signal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Pick-up Scaling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Inverse Time Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Stage Specific Inverse Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Operation Modes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Local Panel Graph . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Inverse Time Setting Error Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Limitation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Standard Inverse Delays IEC, IEEE, IEEE2, RI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
IEC Inverse-time Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
IEEE/ANSI Inverse-time Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
IEEE2 Inverse-time Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
RI and RXIDG type Inverse-time Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Free Parameter Settings with IEC, IEEE, and IEEE2
Equations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Inverse-time Setting Error Signal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Limitations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Programmable Inverse-time Curves . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Inverse-time Setting Error Signal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Limitations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
86 Lockout Functionality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172

Chapter 4
Support Functions Event Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Event Enabling/Masking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 7


Table of Contents

Event Buffer Overflow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174


Disturbance Recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Triggering the Recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Reading the Recordings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Number of Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Virtual COMTRADE Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Cold Load Pick-up and Inrush Current Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Cold Load Pick-up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Application for Cold Load Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Inrush Current Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Application for Inrush Current Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Voltage Sags and Swells . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Current Transformer Supervision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Voltage Transformer Supervision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Circuit Breaker Condition Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Breaker Curve and Its Approximation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
Setting Alarm Points. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
Clear “Operations Left” Counters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
Operation Counters to Monitor the Wearing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Logarithmic Interpolation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Example of the Logarithmic Interpolation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Example of Operation Counter Decrementing When the
Circuit Breaker Is Breaking a Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Energy Pulse Outputs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Scaling Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
System Clock and Synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Time Zone Offsets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Daylight Savings Time (DST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Adapt Auto Adjust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Time Drift Correction without External Sync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
Synchronization Using a Digital Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198
Synchronization Correction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Sync Source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Sync Source: IRIG-B003 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Deviation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Auto-Lag/Lead . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
The Running Hour Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Timers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
Combined Overcurrent Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Self-supervision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Incomer Short Circuit Fault Locator (Feeder Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
Order of Algorithmic Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
Feeder Fault Locator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
Earth-fault Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
Algorithm Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213

8 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Table of Contents

Chapter 5
Measurement Functions Measurement Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
UA, UB, UC Voltage Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
RMS Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
RMS Currents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
RMS Voltages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Harmonics and Total Harmonic Distortion (THD) . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Demand Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Minimum and Maximum Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Maximum Values of the Last 31 Days and 12 Months . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Voltage Measurement Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Power Calculations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
Line-to-Line Voltages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
Line-to-Neutral Voltages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
Direction of Power and Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
Symmetric Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
Primary, Secondary, and Per Unit Scaling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Current Scaling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
Voltage Scaling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
Per Unit [pu] Scaling of Line-to-Line Voltages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230

Chapter 6
Control Functions Output Relays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
Digital Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Virtual Inputs and Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
Output Matrix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
Block Matrix. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Controllable Objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Object States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Basic Settings for Controllable Objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Output Signals of Controllable Objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Settings for Read-only Objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Controlling with DI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Local/Remote Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Auto-reclose Function (79) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
Terminology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
Manual Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Manual Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Reclaim Time Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Support for Two Circuit Breakers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Blocking of AR Shots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Starting AR Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
The Starting Sequence at Shot 2…5 and Skipping of AR
Shots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Critical AR Request . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 9


Table of Contents

Shot Active Matrix Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244


AR Running Matrix Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
Final Trip Matrix Signals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
Digital Input to Block AR Setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
AR Info for Mimic Display Setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
Logic Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249

Chapter 7
Communications Communication Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Local Port. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
Remote Port X9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
Extension Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Ethernet Port (Optional). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Communication Protocols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Personal Computer Communication. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Modbus TCP and Modbus RTU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Configure the Modbus Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Modbus RTU Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
Configuration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
Modbus TCP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
Testing Modbus with Simple Tester. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
PROFIBUS DP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
SPA-Bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
IEC 60870-5-103. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
DNP 3.0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
IEC 60870-5-101. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
External I/O (Modbus RTU Master) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
IEC 61850 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
EtherNet/IP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
File Transfer Protocol (FTP) Server. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
Connect to the FTP Server Using Windows DOS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
Using the FTP Client in Windows by Command Line. . . . . . . 287
Using the FTP Client in Windows Through Windows
Explorer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
EtherNet/IP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Network Design . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Determine Network Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
Set the Network IP Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
Assign Network Parameters with the BOOTP/ DHCP
Utility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
Electronic Data Sheet (EDS) File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
Upload the EDS File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
EDS Add On Profile Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
Predefined Static Ethernet Input and Output Assemblies . . . . . . . . 296

10 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Table of Contents

Chapter 8
Applications Substation Feeder Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309
Industrial Feeder Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310
Parallel Line Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311
Ring Network Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
Trip Circuit Supervision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
Internal Parallel Digital Inputs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313
Trip Circuit Supervision with One Digital Input. . . . . . . . . . . . 313
Non-dry Digital Inputs DI1…DI6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
Trip Circuit Supervision with Two Digital Inputs. . . . . . . . . . . 320

Chapter 9
Connections Rear Panel View. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323
Details of Terminal Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326
Auxiliary Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
Serial Communication Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
Pin Assignments of Communication Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334
Front Panel Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337
Optional Two-channel Arc Protection Card. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337
Optional Digital I/O Card (DI19/DI20) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
External Input/Output Modules. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
Block Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
Block Diagrams of Option Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342
Optional Arc Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342
Connection Examples. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 343

Chapter 10
Specifications Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347
Tests and Environmental Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
Protection Stages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353
Non-directional Current Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353
Directional Current Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357
Frequent Start Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359
Voltage Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359
Frequency Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360
Power Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362
Synchrocheck Function ∆f, ∆U, ∆φ (25) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362
Circuit-breaker Failure Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363
Magnetizing Inrush If2 > (68F2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363
Transformer Over Excitation If5> (68F5) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363
Arc Fault-protection Stages (Option) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364
Supporting Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 365
Disturbance Recorder (DR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 365
Transformer Supervision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 366
Voltage Sag and Swell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 367
Voltage Interruptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 367

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 11


Table of Contents

Chapter 11
Installation Mounting Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369

Appendix A
Parameter List Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 371

Appendix B
Modbus Parameter List Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 459

Appendix C
Configuring the 857 Relay in Typical Hardware Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471
Studio 5000 Configuring an I/O Profile Using an EDS AOP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 472
Select a Static Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 472
Download the EDS File from the 857 Relay. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 473
Register the EDS-based Device into Studio 5000 . . . . . . . . . . . . 474
Configure Device Properties in Studio 5000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 477
Configuring the 857 I/O Profile Using the Ethernet /IP Bridge . . 479
Set Connection Parameters in RSLogix 5000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 479
Configuring the 857 for EtherNet/IP Using the Front Panel . 482
Configuring the 857 for Ethernet/IP Using SetpointPS. . . . . . 484
Configure Produced/Consumed (CIP I/O) Image . . . . . . . . . . 487
Produced and Consuming Assemblies (CIP I/O) Data Table
Alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 488

Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 491

Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 503

12 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Summary of Changes

This manual contains new and updated information as indicated in the


following table.
Topic Page
Added Protection Functions 50NC/51INC, 68F2, and 68F5 21
Added Catalog Number Explanation 24
Added Webset via Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Server section 60
Updated Start and Trip Signals section to account for condition configuration 70
Added Remote Controlled Overcurrent Scaling section 78
Recorded values of the latest eight faults 78
Current unbalance stage I2> (46) in feeder protection mode 85
Current unbalance stage I2> (46) in motor protection mode 86
Updated Stall protection Ist> (48) section 89
Inserted Motor Status shown in SetPointPS graphic 92
Inserted Motor Status in the Output and Block Matrix graphic 92
Inserted Impact of a Soft Starting Profile graphic 92
Inserted Normal Start Sequence graphic 93
Updated Application using the N> stage, Breaker Control 94
Updated Application using the N> stage, Contactor Control 95
Inserted U0 signal in tip table 97
Added Directional phase overcurrent Iφ> (67) 102
Added Parameters of the directional overcurrent stages Iφ>>>, Iφ>>>> (67) 103
Added Earth-fault Phase Detection Algorithm 105 … 107
Inserted second Intermittent Earth-Fault Detection paragraph 108
Inserted SetGrp value descriptions110 111
Added Operation Time section and three graphics 114
Inserted Magnetizing Inrush Second Harmonic O/C Stage If2>(68F2) section 149
Inserted Fifth harmonic O/C stage If5> (68F5) section 150
Replaced IEC Very Inverse Delay figure 162
Inserted Inverse Delay of type RI graph 169
Inserted Inverse Delay of type RXIDG graph 169
Added Disturbance Recorder Waveforms table 175
Inserted Running virtual COMTRADE files with the 857 Protection System section 179
Added Important table to Inrush Current Detection section 181
Added Important table to Application for Inrush Current Detection section 181
Added Time Zone Offsets section 195
Added Daylight Savings Time (DST) section 196
Inserted Incomer Short Circuit Fault Locator 206
Inserted Feeder Fault Locator section 210
Added Squelch Limit table 215
Updated Measuring range for Voltage Inputs UA, UB, UC 216
Updated Voltage Measurement Mode section 219

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 13


Summary of Changes

Topic Page
Added Polarity footnote 233
Added AC Mode information to Digital Inputs section 234
Added Digital Input Threshold Voltages table footnote 235
Updated Output Matrix graphic title 236
Updated Manual Closing section 243
Updated Reclaim Time Settings table 243
Added AR3/AR4, START3/START4, Discr1/Discr2 under Shot Settings 245
Updated Logic Functions section 249
Replaced Communication Ports and Connectors graphic 253
Added I, M, and N rows 255
Updated Ethernet Port section (added text, tables, and images) 257
Added Configuring the Modbus Protocol section 261
Added File Transfer Protocol (FTP) Server section 285
Added Connect to the FTP server using Windows DOS Commands section 287
Replaced Example Connection of Allen-Bradley 857 311
Updated Trip Circuit Supervision section 312
Expanded Trip Circuit Supervision with One Digital Input section 313
Added “Using any of the non-dry digital inputs DI1…DI6” section 317
Added Tip to Trip Circuit Supervision with Two Digital Inputs section 320
Replaced Trip Circuit Supervision with Two Dry Digital Inputs graphic 321
Inserted Trip Supervision with Two Dry Digital Inputs graphic 321
Added three images and content to Trip Circuit Supervision section 322
Inserted Rear Panel Connections of an 857-3C7 graphic 324
Inserted Rear Panel Connections of an 857-3C8 graphic 325
Added Terminal X8 model 857-3C7 table and graphic 329
Added Terminal X8 model 857-3C8 table and graphic 330
Added Terminal X6 with DI19/DI20 option table and graphic 331
Added Optional Built-in Ethernet/61850 Interfaces table and graphic 334
Inserted 857-VCMRTD row 334
Updated Type column in 32 mm-high Modules table 335
Corrected graphic title to 857-VCM485-4 336
Updated External Input/Output Modules and deleted outdated content 338
Replaced Block Diagram of Allen-Bradley 857-3C6 339
Inserted Block Diagram of Allen-Bradley 857-3C7 340
Inserted Block Diagram of Allen-Bradley 857-3C8 341
Inserted Block Diagram of Optional D10/D20 Module with One Arc Channel 342
Updated graphic title to reflect image 343
Updated Measuring Circuitry table and added footnotes 347
Added “(selected by Catalog Number)” 348
Added Start Up Peak section to Auxiliary Voltage table 348

14 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Summary of Changes

Topic Page
Inserted Ethernet Connection table 350
Updated Operating Temperature in Environmental Conditions table 352
Updated Weight, Dimensions, and IP rating information in Casing table 352
Updated Start time in Overcurrent stage I>(50/51) 353
Updated Start time in Overcurrent stage I>> and I>>>(50/51) 353
Added Delay type, Motor Stop Limit, Motor Running Limit rows 354
Updated all Inverse time characteristic information 354
Added Unbalance Stage I2> (46) table footnote 355
Updated table title to Current unbalance I2> (46) in feeder mode 355
Inserted Pickup Current section 358
Inserted Reset Angle and Updated Inaccuracy section 358
Added Intermittent to table head 358
Added Operating Time 360
Added Low Voltage blocking range 360
Added 2nd Harmonic overcurrent protection stage If2> (68F2) table 360
Added Magnetizing Inrush If2> (68F2) section 363
Added Transformer Over Excitation If5> (68F5) section 363
Added 5th Harmonic stage If5> (68F5) table 364
Added Operating time (delayed Arc L> for Arcl>(50AR) 364
Added Operating time (delayed Arc L> for Arcl01>(50NARC) 364
Added Operating time (delayed Arc L> for Arcl02>(50NARC) 365
Updated Cold Load/Inrush current detection (68) table 365
Added IMAX > and IMIN < settings 366
Added full parameter list to Appendix 371
Added Modbus parameter list to Appendix B 459
Added Appendix C, Connecting to an 857 Protection System with EtherNet/IP in 471
RSLogix 5000®

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 15


Summary of Changes

Notes:

16 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Preface

Introduction The Allen-Bradley® 857 motor and feeder protection system includes the
essential protection functions for feeders and motors in distribution networks
of utilities, heavy industry, power plants, and offshore applications. The device
includes many programmable functions, such as arc protection (option),
thermal, trip circuit supervision, and circuit breaker protection and
communication protocols for various protection and communication
situations.

This user manual contains the following:


• A general description of the functions of the protection system.
• Instructions for the following:
– Installation
– Operation
– Parameterization
– Configuration
– Change of settings
• Detailed protection function descriptions.
• Application examples.
• Technical data sheets.

This manual is representative of the latest version of 857 Protection System


firmware (12.001 and higher). Some features are not available in all previous
version of firmware. Contact your Rockwell Automation representative for
further details.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 17


Preface

Additional Resources These documents contain additional information concerning related products
from Rockwell Automation®.
Resource Description
SetPointPS Configuration Software Programming Manual, publication Provides information on configuring,
857-PM001 setting up, troubleshooting, and using
the SetPointPS communication
software
857 Protection System for Feeder and Motor Protection Quick Start, Provides information on mounting,
publication 857-QS001 wiring, and installation of the 857 relay
857 Protection System Specification Guide, publication 857-SR001 Provides specifications on protective
features, measuring and monitoring,
arc flash protection, and cold load
pickup monitoring
857-RAA/857-RAD RTD Scanner User Manual, publication 857-UM002 Provides information on layout, wiring,
installation, configurations, mounting
and I/O
857-VPA3CG PROFIBUS DP Option Module, publication 857-UM003 Provides information on the PROFIBUS
option modules, including installation,
commissioning, dimensions, and
specifications
Industrial Automation Wiring and Grounding Guidelines, publication Provides general guidelines for
1770-4.1 installing a Rockwell Automation
industrial system.
Product Certifications website, http //www.rockwellautomation.com/ Provides declarations of conformity,
global/certification/overview.page certificates, and other certification
details.

You can view or download publications at


http://www.rockwellautomation.com/global/literature-library/overview.page.
To order paper copies of technical documentation, contact your local
Allen-Bradley distributor or Rockwell Automation sales representative.

18 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Chapter 1

Overview

857 Relay Protection System The major features of the 857 Protection System are shown in the following
list.
Features
• Digital signal is handled with a 16-bit microprocessor, and 16-bit A/D
conversion technique to measure accuracy on all setting ranges.
• Wide setting ranges for the protection functions to a sensitivity of 0.5%.
• Integrated fault location for short circuit faults.
• The Protection System can match the requirements of the application by
disabling unneeded functions.
• Flexible control and digital signal control inputs (DI) and outputs (DO)
for signal blocking.
• Flexible signal-grouping matrix in the device makes it adaptable to
various control and alarm systems.
• Ability to control up to six objects locally (for example circuit-breakers,
disconnectors).
• Status of eight objects (for example circuit breakers, disconnectors,
switches).
• Configurable display with six selectable measurement values.
• Configurable schemes the are interlocking with basic logic functions.
• An event register record of events and fault values that can be read
through the keypad, local HMI, or SetPointPS (a free PC-based
configuration software).
• All settings, events, and indications are stored in nonvolatile memory.
• Configuration, parameterization, and reading of information through
local HMI, or with SetPointPS software interface.
• Connection to any automation system through several available
communication protocols. These protocols include Modbus RTU,
ModbusTCP, PROFIBUS DP, IEC 60870-5-103, IEC 60870-5-101,
IEC 61850, SPA-Bus, EtherNet/IP, or DNP 3.0.
• Universal power supply handles any source within the range from
40…265V DC or V AC. An optional alternative power-supply for
18…36V DC is available.
• Built-in high-resolution disturbance recorder for evaluating analog and
digital signals.
• Arc protection is also provided as an optional feature.
• Two different optional 12-channel RTD scanners available.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 19


Chapter 1 Overview

SetPointPS

SetPointPS is a software configuration tool for Rockwell Automation® Bulletin


857 and 865 Protection Systems. All configurations are made with a user-
friendly graphical interface and the created documents can be printed and
saved. User knowledge of the Rockwell Automation® 857 Protection System
model or hardware is not required. SetPointPS can read all information
directly from the device and configures itself. It can be obtained free of charge
at www.rockwellautomation.com.

It is possible to read and evaluate disturbance recordings from Rockwell


Automation® 857 and 865 Protection System. The built-in evaluator uses
standard COMTRADE files for saving the records. See publication 857-
PM001.

User Interface

The 857 Protection System is controlled in the following three ways:

• Locally with the push button on the 857 Protection System front panel,
see 857 Protection System Front Panel on page 27).

• Locally by using a personal computer that is connected to the serial port


on the front panel or on the rear panel of the Protection System. Both
cannot be used simultaneously.

• By remote control over the remote control port on the Protection


System rear panel.

20 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Overview Chapter 1

Setting File and Firmware Compliance

The Settings files from all major revisions of firmware are not upward or
downward compatible between major versions. This statement is true of
products with firmware revision 10, 12, and higher firmware revisions.

IMPORTANT Do not load a Settings file between 857 Protection Systems of one version
into an 857 Protection System with another firmware revision.

Operating Safety

ATTENTION: The terminals on the rear panel of the 857 Protection System
can carry dangerous voltages, even if the auxiliary voltage is switched off. Do
not place a live current transformer secondary-circuit in an open circuit
condition. The disconnection of a live circuit can cause dangerous voltages!
Any operational measures must be conducted according to national and local
directives and instructions

IMPORTANT Read the operation instructions before performing any operational


measures.

The comprehensive protection functions of the 857 Protection System


(Table 1) make it ideal for utility, industrial, marine, and offshore power
distribution applications. Because the protection system is designed for global
applications, it includes both ANSI IEEE and IEC protective function
numbers and symbology.
Table 1 - List of Protection Functions
IEEE/ ANSI IEC Symbol Function Name Note
Code
25 df/dv Synchrocheck
27 U< Undervoltage protection
U<<
U<<<
32 P< Reverse power protection
P<<
37 I< Undercurrent/Load Loss protection
46R I2> Current unbalance protection - Feeder Only available when
protective mode application mode is feeder
protection
46 I2> Current unbalance protection - Motor Only available when
protective mode application mode is motor
protection
47 I2>> Phase reversal / incorrect phase sequence Only available when
protection application mode is motor
protection

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 21


Chapter 1 Overview

Table 1 - List of Protection Functions (Continued)


IEEE/ ANSI IEC Symbol Function Name Note
Code
48 Ist> Stall protection Only available when
application mode is motor
protection
49 T> Thermal overload protection
50ARC ArcI> Optional arc fault-protection
50BF CBFP Circuit-breaker failure protection
50N/51N I0> Earth-fault protection External connection method
50G/51G I0>> and protective settings define
50GS/51GS I0>>> protection type.
I0>>>>
50NARC ArcI01> Optional earth-fault protection
ArcI02>
50NC/51INC I0CAP Capacitor-bank unbalance protection
50/51 I> Overcurrent protection
I>>
I>>>
59 U> Overvoltage protection
U>>
U>>>
59N U0> Residual voltage protection
U0>>
66 N> Frequent start protection Only available when
application mode is motor
protection
67 Iφ> Directional overcurrent protection
Iφ>>
Iφ>>>
Iφ>>>>
67N I0φ> Directional earth-fault protection
I0φ>>
67NI IOint> Directional transient intermittent earth-
fault protection
68F2 Uf2> Magnetizing In Rush
68F5 Uf5> Transformer overexcitation, 2nd harmonic
79 AR Auto-Reclose
81 f>< Frequency protection, 5th harmonic
f>><<
81L f< Underfrequency protection
f<<
81R df/dt Rate of change of frequency (ROCOF)
protection
86 Lockout Selection All protective elements can be
set for lockout control
99 Prg1…8 Programmable stages

22 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Overview Chapter 1

EU Directive Compliance and Other Standard Compliance


EMC Compliance 2014/30/EU Compliance with the European Commission's EMC Directive.
Product Specific Standards were used to establish conformity:
EN 60255-26: 2013
Product Safety 2014/35/EU Compliance with the European Commission's Low Voltage
Directive. Compliance is demonstrated by reference to generic
safety standards: EN60255-27:2014
Complies With c-UL-us Listed Industrial Australian Declaration of Conformity (formerly C-Tick)
Controls E334349,UL 508.

Figure 1 - Application of the Feeder and Motor Protection Device


400 kV/200 kV
Transmission
110 kV Network Remote
Network
Control
Transmission
Substations

Power Plants

Distribution
Substation
Remote Control
Interface

Protection
System

i
i i

Protection Protection I/O


System System

20 kV Overhead Line

20-kV Cable
Network
Secondary Distribution
Substation Transformer
(Distribution 230/240V
Transformer) 230/240V

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 23


Chapter 1 Overview

Catalog Number Explanation


Position
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
857 – 3 C 6 A A A –__
a b c d e f g

a e
Nom Phase Current (A) / Nom DI7-28 Activation Voltage Optional Hardware (Communication port 1)

3 1 A / 5 A / 24V Code Description

6 1 A / 5 A / 110V A TTL/RS-232 (VCM TTL)

7 1 A / 5 A / 220V B Plastic/Plastic serial fiber interface (VCM FIBRE PP)


C N/A
b
D RS-485 interface (4-wire, VCM 485-4)
Nom Earth-fault Current I/O1 and I/O2 [A]
Glass/Glass dual serial fiber interface for 857-RAD (857-VCMFIBRE
E
C 1 A and 5 A GG)(1)
D 0.2 A and 1 A F Rx Plastic/Tx Glass serial fiber interface (VCM FIBRE PG)

c G Rx Glass/Tx Plastic serial fiber interface (VCM FIBRE GP)

Additional I/O (X8 Terminal) I RJ45 connection (RS-232, VCM 232)

6 None M ST 100-Mbps Ethernet dual fiber interface including IEC 61850

8 Ten outputs N RTD glass fiber interface for 857-RAA (857-VCMRTD)(2)

9 Eight standard inputs and four outputs(1) (1) Required for connection to 857-RAD Enhanced RTD Scanner. Only available in this location.
(2) Required for connection to the 857-RAA scanner only.
(1) Some options not UL Listed. Check with your Rockwell Automation® representative.
f
d Optional Hardware (Communication port 2)
Supply Voltage [V] A None
A 40…265V AC/DC C RJ45 connection (RS-232, 857-VCM232)
B 18…36V DC D RS-485 interface (2-wire, 857-VCM485-2)
C 40…265V AC/DC, arc protection option L Built-in RJ45 10-Mbps Ethernet interface(1)
D 18…36V DC, arc protection option M Built in RJ45 10-Mbps interface inc. IEC 61850(1)
E 40…265V AC/DC, DI19, DI20, arc channel, optional N RTD interface for 857-RAA (Glass fiber, 857-VCMRTD)(2)
F 18…36V DC+ DI19, DI20, arc channel, optional (1) Cannot order in combination with the following optional Communication PORT 1:
(M) ST 100-Mbps EtherNet/IP fiber interface with IEC 61850
(2) Required for connection to the 857-RAA scanner only.

g
Ingress Protection Rating
IP 30 (standard)
I IP 54 with conformal coating (optional)
C IP 30 with conformal coating (optional)

24 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Overview Chapter 1

Accessories Catalogue Number Description


857-RAA 12-channel external RTD scanner (857 must have VCMRTD fiber interface) (1)
857-RAD Enhance external 12-channel RTD scanner, with analog I/O (857 must have VCMFIBER
fiber interface) (1)
857-VEA3CG External EtherNet/IP (external module, requires 857-VX-004-M3 cable) (2)
857-VPA3CG External PROFIBUS I/P (requires 857-VX-007-F cable) (2)
857-VSE001 External dual fiber-optic interface (requires 857-VX022 cable) (2)
857-VSE002 External RS485 I/F module (requires 857-VX022 cable) (2)
857-VSE006 External module IEC 103 to 61850 converter (RJ45 –)
857-VSE010 External single optic interface module via 857-VCM232 (2)
857-VX003-3 857/SetPointPS programming cable, 3m serial to serial cable
857-VX004-M3 RS-232 converter cable-connects to PLC or 857-VEA3CG
857-VX007-F3 RS-232 converter cable-connects to 857-VPA3CG
857-VX022 RS-232 cable to 857-VSE modules (D9-sub connector at relay end)
857-VX049 RS-232 cable to 857-VSE modules (RJ45 connector at relay end)
857-VPA3CG PROFIBUS converter module (external module, requires 857-VX007-F cable)
857-VA1DA-6 Arc sensor - 6 meter lead wire (3)
857-VA1DA-02 Arc sensor- 20 meter lead wire (3)
857-VYX076 Raising collar - 40 mm (4)
857-VYX077 Raising collar - 60 mm (4)
857-VX080 RS-232 cable to 857-VPA3CG (RJ45 connector at relay end)
857-VYX233 Raising collar - 100 mm (4)
9300-USBS USB to serial converter and cable (required if programming computer does not have a
serial port)
(1) Interconnection to 857 via 62.5 micrometer fiber-optic cables that use ST style of connectors at each end.
(2) Some configurations can require an 857-VX049 cable, check with the factory.
(3) Maximum two per relay. Relay must have arc flash option, see Catalog Number Explanation on page 24.
(4) See Chapter 11 for further details.

Available Replacement Repair/replacement parts only.


Option Modules Catalog Number Description
857-VCM485-4 RS-485 interface (4-wire)
857-VCM485-2 RS-485 interface (2 wire)
857-VCMFIBRE Dual Serial fiber interface (Glass/Glass) – dual-fiber
interface to 857-RAD RTD scanner
857-VCMRTD RTD interface (Glass fiber) – single-fiber interface to
857-RAA RTD scanner
857-VCMTTL TTL/RS-232 interface
857-VCM 232RS RS-232 with RJ45 connector

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 25


Chapter 1 Overview

Notes:

26 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Chapter 2

Local Panel User Interface

857 Protection System Front Figure 2 shows the front panel of the 857 Protection System and the location
of the user interface elements that are used for local control.
Panel
Figure 2 - Front Panel of 857 Protection System

857

1. LCD dot-matrix display.


2. Keypad.
3. Status indicators.
4. RS-232 serial communication port for connection to a personal
computer.

Display

The backlit 128 x 64 LCD dot-matrix display can show 21 characters per row
and eight rows simultaneously. The display shows the following:
• The single-line diagram of the 857 Protection System with the object
status, measurement values, identification, and so forth (Figure 3).
• The configuration and parameterization values of the 857 Protection
System (Figure 4).

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 27


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

Figure 3 - Sections of the LCD Matrix Display

1 Freely configurable single-line diagram.


2 Five controllable objects.
3 Six object statuses.
4 Location identification.
5 Local/Remote selection.
6 Auto-reclose on/off selection (if applicable).
7 Freely selectable measurement values (max. six values).

Figure 4 - Sections of the LCD Matrix Display

8 Main menu column.


9 The heading of the active menu.
10 The cursor of the main menu.
11 Possible navigation directions.
12 Measured/setting parameter.
13 Measured/set value.

28 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Local Panel User Interface Chapter 2

Backlight Control

To turn on the backlight, press any key on the front HMI of the 857 Protection
System. The Display backlight can also be switched on with any digital input
and virtual input or output by using SetPointPS software. Go to the
“LOCALPANEL CONF/Display backlight ctrl” setting, which is used for
selecting the trigger input for backlight control. When the selected input
activates, the display backlight activated for 60 minutes.

Keypad

The keypad is used to control objects and switches on the single-line diagram
display. To navigate in the menu, and set the required parameter values, use the
keypad and the guidance that is given in the display.

Figure 5 - Keys on the Keypad

The keypad has the following keys and functions:


1 Enter and confirmation key (enter)
2 Cancel key (cancel)
3 Up/Down [Increase/Decrease] arrow keys (up/down)
4 Keys to select submenus [select a digit in a numerical value] (left/right)
5 Additional information key (info)

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 29


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

Menu Navigation and Pointers

Use the arrow keys up and down to move up and down in the main menu (see
Keypad on page 29). The active main menu option is indicated with a cursor.
The main menu option items are abbreviations, for example Evnt = events.

Figure 6 - Active Menu Options

After any selection, the The name of the active submenu and a
arrow symbols show the possible ANSI code of the selected function.
possible navigating
directions.

The measured and set The measured and


parameters. set values.

Operation Status Indicators

The 857 Protection System has eight status indicators (Figure 7) that are listed
in Table 2.

Figure 7 - Operation Status Indicators of the 857 Protection System

30 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Local Panel User Interface Chapter 2

Table 2 - Operation Status Indicators


Status Indicator Meaning Remarks
Power The auxiliary power is switched on. Normal operational state
Error Internal fault, operates in parallel with the The Protection System attempts to restart. If
self-supervision output 857 Protection the error indicator remains lit, call for service.
System.
Com The serial bus is in use and is transferring Normal operational state
information.
Alarm One or several signals of the output The indicator is switched off when the signal
Protection System matrix are activated and is that caused output Al to activate in the
assigned to output AL. One of the signals Output Matrix, for example the START signal,
activates the output. is reset. The resetting depends on the type of
For more information about output matrix, configuration, which is connected or latched.
see Configuring the Digital Outputs DO on
page 52.
Trip One or several signals of the output The indicator is switched off when the signal
Protection System matrix have been assigned that caused output Tr to activate, for example
to output Tr. One of the signals activates the the TRIP signal, is reset. The resetting
output. For more information about output depends on the type of configuration, which
Protection System configuration, see is connected or latched.
Configuring the Digital Outputs DO on
page 52.
A,B,C (LA, LB, LC) Application-related indicators. Configurable

Resetting Latched Indicators and Output Protection Elements

All indicators and output protection elements can be given a latching


function (86) in the configuration.

The following are ways to reset latched indicators and protection elements:
• From the alarm list, press and hold the Cancel button for approximately
3 seconds. To reset the latched indicators and output protection
elements press enter.
• To acknowledge each event, press the Enter button the equivalent
number of times. To reset the latched indicators and output protection
elements, press the Enter button in the initial display.
• Reset the latched indicators and output protection elements through a
remote communication or through a digital input that is configured for
that purpose.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 31


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

Adjusting the Display Contrast

The readability of the LCD varies with the brightness and the temperature of
the environment. To adjust the contrast with a personal computer, use the
SetPointPS software GUI. To adjust the contrast from the front of the 857
Protection System complete this procedure.

1. Press info then press enter.


2. Enter the configurator password (default password=0002). Use the up,
down, and right arrow keys.
3. Press enter.
4. Press info.
5. To adjust the display level, use the up and down keys.

Local Panel Operations The front panel can be used to control objects, change the local/remote status,
read the measured values, set parameters, and to configure 857 Protection
System functions. A personal computer, which is connected to a local
communication port, can set some parameters.

Navigating in Menus

All menu functions are based on the main menu/submenu structure. To


navigate the structure, complete this procedure.

1. Use the arrow keys (up and down) to move up and down in the main
menu.
2. Move to a submenu by repeatedly pressing the right key until the
required submenu is shown. To return to the main menu, press the left
key.
3. Press enter to confirm the submenu selection.
If there are more than six items in the selected submenu, a black line
appears to the right side of the display (Figure 8). It is then possible to
scroll down in the submenu.

Figure 8 - Example of Scroll Indication

4. Cancel the selection by pressing cancel.

32 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Local Panel User Interface Chapter 2

5. Press up or down in any position of a submenu, when it is not selected,


to go one step up or down in the main menu.

The active main menu selection is indicated with black background color. The
possible navigating directions in the menu are shown in the upper-left corner
with black triangular symbols.

Figure 9 - Principles of the Menu Structure and Navigation in the Menus


MAIN MENU SUB-MENUS

6. Obtain additional information about any menu item by pressing info.


7. Revert to the normal display by pressing cancel.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 33


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

Main Menu

The general menu structure is shown in Figure 9. The menu is dependent on


the user configuration and the options according to the order code. For
example, only the enabled protection stages appear in the menu.
Table 3 - List of the Local Main Menu
Main Number of Description ANSI Code Note
Menu Menus
(1)
1 Interactive mimic display
5 Double size measurements that are user-defined 1(1)
1 Title screen with device name, time, and firmware revision.
P 14 Power measurements
E 4 Energy measurements
I 13 Current measurements
U 15 Voltage measurements
Dema 15 Demand values
Umax 5 Time stamped Minimum and Maximum of voltages
Imax 9 Time stamped Minimum and Maximum of currents
Pmax 5 Time stamped Minimum and Maximum of power and frequency
Mont 21 Maximum values of the last 31 days and the last 12 months
Evnt 2 Events
(2)
DR 2 Disturbance recorder
Runh 2 Hours run. Active time (hours) of a selected digital input and Time
Stamps of the latest start and stop.
TIMR 6 Day and week timers
DI 5 Digital inputs including virtual inputs
(3)
DO 4 Digital outputs (Protection Systems) and output matrix
(4)
ExtAI 3 External analog inputs
(3)
ExtAO 3 External analog outputs
(4)
ExDI 3 External digital inputs
(4)
ExDO 3 External digital outputs
Prot 27 Protection counters, combined overcurrent status, protection
status, protection enabling, cold load, and inrush detection If2>
and block matrix
(5)
I> 5 First overcurrent stage 50/51
(5)
I>> 3 Second overcurrent stage 50/51
(5)
I>>> 3 Third overcurrent stage 50/51
(5)
Iϕ> 6 First directional-overcurrent stage 67
(5)
Iϕ>> 6 Second directional-overcurrent stage 67
(5)
Iϕ>>> 4 Third directional-overcurrent stage 67
(5)
Iϕ>>>> 4 Fourth directional-overcurrent stage 67
(5)
I< 3 Undercurrent stage 37
(5)
I2> 3 Current unbalance stage 46
(5)
T> 3 Thermal overload stage 49
(5)
Io> 5 First earth-fault stage 50N/51N
50G/51G

34 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Local Panel User Interface Chapter 2

Table 3 - List of the Local Main Menu (Continued)


Main Number of Description ANSI Code Note
Menu Menus
Io>> 3 Second earth-fault stage 50N/51N (5)

50G/51G
(5)
Io>>> 3 Third earth-fault stage 50N/51N
50G/51G
(5)
Io>>>> 3 Fourth earth-fault stage 50N/51N
50G/51G
(5)
Ioϕ> 6 First directional earth-fault stage 67N
(5)
Ioϕ>> 6 Second directional earth-fault stage 67N
(5)
Ioint> 4 Transient intermittent E/F 67NI
(5)
U> 4 First overvoltage stage 59
(5)
U>> 3 Second overvoltage stage 59
(5)
U>>> 3 Third overvoltage stage 59
(5)
U< 4 First Undervoltage stage 27
(5)
U<< 3 Second Undervoltage stage 27
(5)
U<<< 3 Third Undervoltage stage 27
(5)
Uo> 3 First residual-overvoltage stage 59N
(5)
Uo>> 3 Second residual overvoltage stage 59N
(5)
P< 3 First reverse and underpower stage 32
(5)
P<< 3 Second reverse and underpower stage 32
(5)
f>< 4 First over/under-frequency stage 81
(5)
f>><< 4 Second over/under-frequency stage 81
(5)
f< 4 First underfrequency stage 81L
(5)
f<< 4 Second underfrequency stage 81L
(5)
dfdt 3 Rate of change of frequency (ROCOF) stage 81R
(5)
Prg1 3 First programmable stage
(5)
Prg2 3 Second programmable stage
(5)
Prg3 3 Third programmable stage
(5)
Prg4 3 Fourth programmable stage
(5)
Prg5 3 Fifth programmable stage
(5)
Prg6 3 Sixth programmable stage
(5)
Prg7 3 Seventh programmable stage
(5)
Prg8 3 Eighth programmable stage
(5)
If2> 3 Second harmonic O/C stage 68F2
(5)
If5> 3 Fifth harmonic O/C stage 68F5
(5)
CBFP 3 Circuit breaker failure-protection 50BF
(5)
CBWE 4 Circuit breaker wearing-supervision
AR 15 Auto-reclose 79
(5)
CTSV 1 CT supervisor
VTSV 1 VT supervisor (5)

ArcI> 4 Optional arc protection stage for phase-to-phase faults and 50ARC (5)
delayed light signal.
ArcIo1> 3 Optional arc protection stage for earth-faults. Current input = I01 50NARC (5)

ArcIo2> 3 Optional arc protection stage for earth-faults. Current input = I02 50NARC (5)

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 35


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

Table 3 - List of the Local Main Menu (Continued)


Main Number of Description ANSI Code Note
Menu Menus
(6)
OBJ 11 Object definitions
(1)
Lgic 2 Status and counters of the user logic
(7)
CONF 12 Device setup, scaling, and so forth.
(8)
Bus 13 Serial port and protocol configuration
Diag 6 Device self-diagnosis
(1) Configure with SetPointPS.
(2) Read recorded files with SetPointPS.
(3) Configure for N.O. or N.C.
(4) The menu is visible only if protocol “External I/O” is selected for one of the serial ports. Serial ports are configured in menu “Bus”.
(5) The menu is visible only if the stage is enabled.
(6) Objects are circuit breakers, disconnects, and so forth. Their position or status can be displayed and controlled in the interactive
mimic display.
(7) There are two extra menus, which are visible only if the access level “operator” or “configurator” has been opened with the
corresponding password.
(8) Detailed protocol configuration is done with SetPointPS.

Menu Structure of Protection Functions

The general structure of all protection function menus is similar, but the details
differ from stage to stage. For example, the details of the second overcurrent
stage I>> menus are shown in Figure 10.

FIRST MENU OF I>> 50/51 STAGE


Figure 10 - First Menu of I>>50/51 Stage

The status, start, trip counter, and setting group menu content, as shown in
Figure 10, is explained in the following list:
• Status – The stage is not detecting any fault at the moment. If the
operating level is “Configurator” and the Force flag is set to On, the
stage can be forced to pick up or trip. See Operating Levels on page 40
for more details.
• SCntr 5 – The stage has picked-up a fault five times since the last reset of
restart. This value can be cleared if the operating level is at least Setting
Groups on page 68“Operator”.
• TCntr 1 – The stage has tripped twice since the last reset of restart. This
value can be cleared if the operating level is at least “Operator”.

36 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Local Panel User Interface Chapter 2

• SetGrp 1 – The active setting group is one. This value can be edited if
the operating level is at least “Operator”. How to set groups is explained
in Setting Groups on page 68.
• SGrpDI – A digital input does not control this setting group. This value
can be edited if the operating level is at least “Configurator”.
• Force Off – The forcing function for status forcing and output
Protection System forcing are disabled. This force flag status can be set
to “On” or back to “Off ” if the operating level is at least “Configurator”.
If a front panel key is not pressed within 5 minutes, and there is no
SetPointPS communication, the force flag is set to “Off ” position. The
forcing is explained in Signal Forcing Control on page 46.

SECOND MENU OF I>> 50/51 STAGE


Figure 11 - Second Menu (Next to the Right) of I>>50/51 Stage

The content of the main setting menu shown in Figure 11 is explained in the
following list:

• Stage setting group 1 – The group 1 setting values. To view the other
setting group, press enter and then right or left. How to set groups is
explained in Setting Groups on page 68.

• Ilmax 403A – The maximum of the three measured phase currents is at


the moment 403 A. The value that the stage is supervising.

• Status – The status of the stage. A copy of the status value in the first
menu.

• I>> 1013A – The pick-up limit is 1013 A in primary value.

• I>> 2.50 x In – The pick-up limit is 2.50 times the rated current of the
protected object. This value can be edited if the operating level is at least
“Operator”. The operating levels are explained in Operating Levels on
page 40.

• t>> 0.60s – The total operation delay is set to 600 Ms. This value can be
edited if the operating level is at least “Operator”.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 37


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

THIRD MENU OF I>> 50/51 STAGE


Figure 12 - Third and Last Menu (Next to the Right) of I>>50/51 Stage

This menu is for registered values by the I>> stage. Fault logs are explained in
Fault Log on page 40.

• FAULT LOG 1 – The latest of the eight available logs. Press enter and
right or left to move between logs.

• 2012-09-14 – Date of the log.

• 12:25:10.288 – Time of the log.

• Type 1-2 – The overcurrent fault has been detected in phases L1 and L2
(A and B, red and yellow, R and S, u and v).

• Flt 2.86 x In – The fault current has been 2.86 per units.

• Load 0.99 x In – The average load current before the fault has been
0.99 pu.

• EDly 81% – The elapsed operation delay has been 81% of the setting
0.60 s = 0.49 s. Any registered elapsed delay less than 100% means that
the stage has not tripped, because the fault duration has been shorter
than the delay setting.

• SetGrp 1 – The setting group has been 1. To reach this line, press enter
and then down several times.

38 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Local Panel User Interface Chapter 2

Setting Groups

Most of the protection functions have four setting groups (SetGrp1, SetGrp2,
SetGrp3, and SetGrp4). These groups are useful, for example, when the
network topology is changed frequently. To change the active group, use a
digital input, through remote communication or locally by using the local
panel.

The active setting group of each protection function can be selected separately.
Figure 13 shows an example where the changing of the I> setting group is
handled with digital input one (SGrpDI). If the digital input is TRUE, the
active setting group is group two. If the digital input is FALSE, the active group
is group one. If no digital input is selected (SGrpDI = -), the active group can
be selected by changing the value of the parameter SetGrp.

Figure 13 - Example of Protection Submenu with Setting Group

Scroll to the desired submenu and press enter to select the submenu. The
selected setting group is in the lower left corner (Figure 14). Set1 is setting
group one, Set2 is setting group two, Set3 is setting group three, and Set4 is
setting group four. Press left or right to select another group. Left is used when
the active setting group is 2 and right is used when the active setting group is 1.

Figure 14 - Example of I> Setting Submenu

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 39


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

Fault Log

All protection functions include fault logs that can register up to eight
different faults with time stamp information and fault values. The fault logs are
stored in nonvolatile memory, and are not cleared when the power is switched
off. To clear all logs use SetPointPS. Each function has its own logs (see
Figure 15).

Figure 15 - Example of Fault Log

To see the values of log two, press enter to select the current log (log one). The
current log number is then indicated in the lower left corner of the display (see
Figure 16, Log2 = log two). Press the right once to select Log two.

Figure 16 - Example of Selected Fault Log

Operating Levels
The 857 Protection System has three access levels User, Operator, and
Configurator. The access levels mitigate accidental change of protection system
configurations, parameters, or settings.
USER Level OPERATOR Level CONFIGURATION Level
Use To read parameter values, Control objects and to Needed during the
measurements, and events. change the settings of the commissioning of the Protection
protection stages. System. The scaling of the voltage
and current transformers can be
set by using this level and all
other parameters can be
changed.
Password No; levels permanently Yes; default configuration Yes; default configuration
Protected? open. password is 0001. password is 0002.
Setting State Press enter Press enter
Logout Closing that is not required. Automatically closes after Automatically closes after 10-
10-minutes idle time. To minutes idle time. To close enter
close enter password 9999. password 9999.

40 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Local Panel User Interface Chapter 2

To Gain Access

1. Press info and enter on the front panel.

Figure 17 - Opening the Access Level

2. Enter the password that is needed for the desired level.


The password can contain four digits. Digits are supplied, one by one.
3. Move to the position of the digit by using the right key.
4. Set the desired digit value by using the up key.
5. Press enter.

Password Management

The passwords can only be changed using SetPointPS software that is


connected to the local RS-232 port on the 857 Protection System with an 857-
VX003-3 cable.

Restoring a Lost Password

To restore a lost or forgotten password, a special 857 Protection System-script


program is needed and only done by Rockwell Automation service personnel.
Default serial-port settings are 38400 bps, eight data bits, no parity, and one
stop bit. The serial bit rate is configurable by using the front panel of the
Protection System.

Command Description
get pwd_break Get the break code (Example: 6569403)
get serno Get the serial number of the 857 Protection System
(Example: 12345)

Send both the numbers to Rockwell Automation and ask for a password break.
A device-specific break code is sent back. The code is valid for two weeks for
the specific device.
Command Description
set pwd_break=4435876 Restore the default configuration passwords (“4435876”
is just an example; the actual code must be requested
from the Rockwell Automation support team.

Now the passwords are restored to the default values (see Operating Levels on
page 40).

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 41


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

Operating Measures Control Functions

The default display on the local panel is a single-line (MIMIC) diagram. It


includes the 857 Protection System identification, Local/Remote indication,
Auto-reclose on/off selection, and user-selectable analog measurement values.

The operator password must be active to control the objects, see To Gain
Access on page 41.

Toggling Local/Remote Control

1. Press enter. The previously activated object starts to blink.


2. To select the Local/Remote object (“L” or “R” squared), use the arrow
keys.
3. Press enter.
The L/R dialog appears.
4. Select “REMOTE” to enable remote control and disable local control.
Select “LOCAL” to enable local control and disable remote control.
5. Press enter. The Local/Remote state changes.

Object Control

1. Press enter. The previously activated object starts to blink.


2. To select the object to control, use the arrow keys. Only controllable
objects can be selected,
3. Press enter.
A control dialog appears.
4. To select the “Open” or “Close” commands, use the up and down arrow
keys.
5. Press enter to confirm the operation. The state of the object changes.

Toggling Virtual Inputs

1. Press enter, the previously activated object starts to blink.


2. Select the virtual input object (empty or black square)
The dialog appears.
3. Select “VIon” to activate the virtual input or select “VIoff ” to deactivate
the virtual input.

42 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Local Panel User Interface Chapter 2

Measured Data

The measured values can be read from the main menus and their submenus.
Any measurement value in this table can be displayed on the main view next to
the single-line diagram. Up to six selectable measurements can be shown on the
default main display and 30 more on addition measurement screens.
Table 4 - Measured Values
Value Menu/Submenu Description
P P/POWER Active power [kW]
Q P/POWER Reactive power [kVAR]
S P/POWER Apparent power [kVA]
? P/POWER Active power angle [?]
P.F. P/POWER Power factor [ ]
f P/POWER Frequency [Hz]
Pda P/15 MIN POWER Active power [kW]
Qda P/15 MIN POWER Reactive power [kVAR]
Sda P/15 MIN POWER Apparent power [kVA]
Pfda P/15 MIN POWER Power factor [ ]
fda P/15 MIN POWER Frequency [Hz]
PL1 P/POWER/PHASE 1 Active power of phase 1 [kW]
PL2 P/POWER/PHASE 1 Active power of phase 2 [kW]
PL3 P/POWER/PHASE 1 Active power of phase 3 [kW]
QL1 P/POWER/PHASE 1 Reactive power of phase 1 [kVAR]
QL2 P/POWER/PHASE 1 Reactive power of phase 2 [kVAR]
QL3 P/POWER/PHASE 1 Reactive power of phase 3 [kVAR]
SL1 P/POWER/PHASE 2 Apparent power of phase 1 [kVA]
SL2 P/POWER/PHASE 2 Apparent power of phase 2 [kVA]
SL3 P/POWER/PHASE 2 Apparent power of phase 3 [kVA]
PF_L1 P/POWER/PHASE 2 Power factor of phase 1 [ ]
PF_L2 P/POWER/PHASE 2 Power factor of phase 2 [ ]
PF_L3 P/POWER/PHASE 2 Power factor of phase 3 [ ]
cos P/COS and TAN Cosine phi [ ]
tan P/COS and TAN Tangent phi [ ]
cosL1 P/COS and TAN Cosine phi of phase L1 [ ]
cosL2 P/COS and TAN Cosine phi of phase L2 [ ]
cosL3 P/COS and TAN Cosine phi of phase L3 [ ]
Iseq P/PHASE SEQUENCIES Actual, current phase sequence [OK; Reverse;?? ]
Useq P/PHASE SEQUENCIES Actual, voltage phase sequence [OK; Reverse;?? ]
Io1ϕ P/PHASE SEQUENCIES I/O/Uo angle [o]
Io2ϕ P/PHASE SEQUENCIES I/O2/Uo angle [o]
fAdop P/PHASE SEQUENCIES Adopted frequency [Hz]
E+ E/ENERGY Exported energy [MWh]

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 43


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

Table 4 - Measured Values (Continued)


Value Menu/Submenu Description
Eq+ E/ENERGY Exported reactive energy [Mvar]
E- E/ENERGY Imported energy [MWh]
Eq- E/ENERGY Imported reactive energy [Mvar]
E+.nn E/DECIMAL COUNT Decimals of exported energy [ ]
Eq.nn E/DECIMAL COUNT Decimals of reactive energy [ ]
E-.nn E/DECIMAL COUNT Decimals of imported energy [ ]
Ewrap E/DECIMAL COUNT Energy control
E+ E/E-PULSE SIZES Pulse size of exported energy [kWh]
Eq+ E/E-PULSE SIZES Pulse size of exported reactive energy [kVAR]
E- E/E-PULSE SIZES Pulse size of imported energy [kWh]
Eq- E/E-PULSE SIZES Pulse duration of imported reactive energy [ms]
E+ E/E-PULSE DURATION Pulse duration of exported energy [ms]
Eq+ E/E-PULSE DURATION Pulse duration of exported reactive energy [ms]
E- E/E-PULSE DURATION Pulse duration of imported energy [ms]
Eq- E/E-PULSE DURATION Pulse duration of imported reactive energy [ms]
E+ E/E-pulse TEST Test the exported energy pulse [ ]
Eq+ E/E-pulse TEST Test the exported reactive energy [ ]
E- E/E-pulse TEST Test the imported energy [ ]
Eq- E/E-pulse TEST Test the imported reactive energy [ ]
IL1 I/PHASE CURRENTS Phase current IL1 [A]
IL2 I/PHASE CURRENTS Phase current IL2 [A]
IL3 I/PHASE CURRENTS Phase current IL3 [A]
IL1da I/PHASE CURRENTS 15-min average for IL1 [A]
IL2da I/PHASE CURRENTS 15-min average for IL2 [A]
IL3da I/PHASE CURRENTS 15-min average for IL3 [A]
Io1 I/SYMMETRIC CURRENTS Primary value of zero sequence/ residual current I/O [A]
Io2 I/SYMMETRIC CURRENTS Primary value of zero-sequence/residual current I/O2 [A]
IoCalc I/SYMMETRIC CURRENTS Calculated ground (earth) current [A]
I1 I/SYMMETRIC CURRENTS Positive sequence current [A]
I2 I/SYMMETRIC CURRENTS Negative sequence current [A]
I2/I1 I/SYMMETRIC CURRENTS Negative sequence current that is related to positive
sequence current (for unbalance protection) [%]
THDIL I/HARM. DISTORTION Total harmonic distortion of the mean value of phase
currents [%]
THDIL1 I/HARM. DISTORTION Total harmonic distortion of phase current IL1 [%]
THDIL2 I/HARM. DISTORTION Total harmonic distortion of phase current IL2 [%]
THDIL3 I/HARM. DISTORTION Total harmonic distortion of phase current IL3 [%]
Diagram I/HARMONICS of IL1 Harmonics of phase current IL1 [%] (See Figure 18)
Diagram I/HARMONICS of IL2 Harmonics of phase current IL2 [%] (See Figure 18)
Diagram I/HARMONICS of IL3 Harmonics of phase current IL3 [%] (See Figure 18)

44 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Local Panel User Interface Chapter 2

Table 4 - Measured Values (Continued)


Value Menu/Submenu Description
Uline U/LINE VOLTAGES Average value for the three line voltages [V]
U12 U/LINE VOLTAGES Phase-to-phase voltage U12 [V]
U23 U/LINE VOLTAGES Phase-to-phase voltage U23 [V]
U31 U/LINE VOLTAGES Phase-to-phase voltage U31 [V]
UL U(PHASE VOLTAGES Average for the three phase voltages [V]
UL1 U/PHASE VOLTAGES Phase-to-earth voltage UL1 [V]
UL2 U/PHASE VOLTAGES Phase-to-earth voltage UL2 [V]
UL3 U/PHASE VOLTAGES Phase-to-earth voltage UL3 [V]
Uo U/SYMMETRIC VOLTAGES Residual voltage Uo [%]
U1 U/SYMMETRIC VOLTAGES Positive sequence voltage [%]
U2 U/SYMMETRIC VOLTAGES Negative sequence voltage [%]
U2/U1 U/SYMMETRIC VOLTAGES Negative sequence voltage that is related to positive
sequence voltage [%]
THDU U/HARM. DISTORTION Total harmonic distortion of the mean value of voltages
[%]
THDUa U/HARM. DISTORTION Total harmonic distortion of the voltage input a [%]
THDUb U/HARM. DISTORTION Total harmonic distortion of the voltage input b [%]
THDUc U/HARM. DISTORTION Total harmonic distortion of the voltage input c [%]
Diagram U/HARMONICS of Ua Harmonics of voltage input Ua [%] (See Figure 18)
Diagram U/HARMONICS of Ub Harmonics of voltage input Ub [%] (See Figure 18)
Diagram U/HARMONICS of Uc Harmonics of voltage input Uc [%] (See Figure 18)
Count U/VOLT. INTERRupTS Voltage interrupts counter [ ]
Prev U/VOLT. INTERRupTS Previous interruption [ ]
Total U/VOLT. INTERRupTS Total duration of voltage interruptions [days, hours]
Prev U/VOLT. INTERRupTS Duration of previous interruption [s]
Status U/VOLT. INTERRupTS Voltage status [LOW; NORMAL]

Figure 18 - Example of Harmonics Bar Display

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 45


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

Reading the Event Register

The event register can be read from the Event submenu by using the following
steps.

1. Press the right arrow once.


The EVENT LIST appears. The display contains a list of events that are
configured to be included in the event register.

2. Press up and down to scroll through the event list.


3. Press left to exit the even list.

To set the order in which the events are sorted, set the “Order” parameter to
“New-Old”. In the EVENT LIST, the first event is the most recent event.

Signal Forcing Control

In some menus, it is possible to switch a function on and off by using a force


function. This feature can be used, for instance, for testing a certain function.
The force function can be activated by using these steps:

1. Open the CONFIGURATION access level.


2. Move to the setting state of the desired function, for example DO (see
Configuration and Parameter Setting on page 47).
3. Select the Force function (the background color of the force text is
black).

4. Press enter.
5. Press up or down to change from “OFF” to “ON”, to activate the Force
function.

46 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Local Panel User Interface Chapter 2

6. Press enter to return to the selection list. Choose the signal that Force
controls with the up and down keys, for instance the T1 signal.
7. Press enter to confirm the selection. Force now controls Signal T1.
8. Press up or down to change the selection from “0” (not alert) to “1”
(alert) or vice versa.
9. Press enter to execute the forced control operation of the selected
function. For example, when making the output Protection System of
T1 pickup.
10. Repeat steps 7 and 8 to alternate between the on and off state of the
function.
11. Repeat steps 1…4 to exit the Force function.
12. Return to the main menu by pressing cancel.

ATTENTION: All interlockings and blockings are bypassed when the force
control is used. Use ONLY in an off-line test condition.

Configuration and Parameter Setting

The minimum procedure to configure an 857 Protection System is as follows.

1. Open the access level “Configurator”. The default password for


configurator access level is 0002.
2. Set the rated values in menu [CONF] including at least current
transformers and a potential (voltage) transformer rating and motor
data if applicable. The date and time settings are in this same main
menu.
3. Enable the needed protection functions and disable the rest of the
protection functions in main menu [Prot].
4. Set the setting parameter of the enable protection stages according to the
application.
5. Connect the output Protection Systems to the start and trip signals of
the enabled protection stages with the output matrix. This connection
can be done in main menu [DO], although the SetPointPS program is
recommended for output matrix editing.
6. Configure the needed digital inputs in main menu [DI].
7. Configure blocking and interlockings for protection stages with the
block matrix. This configuration can be done in main menu [Prot],
although SetPointPS is recommended for block matrix editing.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 47


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

Some of the parameters can only be changed through the RS-232 serial port
with the SetPointPS software. These parameters (for example passwords,
blockings, and mimic configuration) are normally set only during the
commission process.

Some of the parameters require the restarting of the Protection System, which
is automatic. If a parameter change requires the restarting, of the Protection
System the display shows as Figure 19. A similar warning is displayed when
using SetPointPS.

Figure 19 - Example of Auto-reset Display

To return to the setting view, press CANCEL. If a parameter must be changed,


press enter again. The parameter can now be set. When the parameter change is
confirmed by pressing enter, [RESTART]- text appears to the top-right corner
of the display to indicate that auto-resetting is pending. If no key is pressed, the
auto-reset is executed within seconds.

WARNING: Do not cycle control power to the 857 Protection System; the
Protection System automatically restarts.

Parameter Setting

SetPointPS software is recommended to change parameters (see SetPointPS


Personal Computer Software on page 59). It is a more efficient method than
using the front panel controls only.

These instructions use the front panel controls.

1. Press enter to move to the setting state of the desired menu (for example,
CONF/CURRENT SCALING). The Pick text appears in the upper-
left part of the display.
2. Press info. Enter the password that is associated with the configuration
level by pressing the arrow keys (default value is 0002). Press enter.
For more information about the access levels, see Operating Levels on
page 40.
3. Press up and down to scroll through the parameters. A parameter can be
set when the background color of the line is black. If the parameter
cannot be set, the parameter is framed.

48 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Local Panel User Interface Chapter 2

4. Press enter to select the desired parameter (for example Inom).


5. Press up and down to change a parameter value. If the value contains
multiple digits, press left and right to shift from digit to digit, and up
and down to change the digits.
6. Press enter to accept a new value. To leave the parameter value
unchanged, exit the edit state by pressing cancel.

Figure 20 - Changing the Parameters

Setting Range Limits

If the given parameter setting values are out-of-range values, a fault message is
shown when the setting is confirmed with the enter key. Adjust the setting so it
is within the allowed range.

Figure 21 - Example of a Fault Message

The allowed setting range is shown in the display in the setting mode. To view
the range, press info. To return to the setting mode press CANCEL.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 49


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

Figure 22 - Allowed Setting Ranges Shown in the Display

Disturbance Recorder Menu DR

Through the sub menus of the disturbance recorder menu, these functions and
features can be read and set.

1. Disturbance Settings
2. Manual trigger (ManTrg)
3. Status (Status)
4. Clear oldest record (Clear)
5. Clear all records (ClrAll)
6. Recording completion (Stored)
7. Count of ready records (ReadyRec)

50 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Local Panel User Interface Chapter 2

Sub Menu Functions/Features


Disturbance recorder Maximum time (MaxLen)
Sample rate (Rate)
Record time (Time)
Pre trig time (PreTrig)
Manual trigger (MnlTrig)
Count of ready records (ReadyRe)
Rec. Coupling Add a link to the recorder (AddLink)
Clear all links (ClrLnks)
Available signal links DO, DI
Uline, Uphase
IL
U2/U1, U2, U1
I2/In, I2/I1, I2, I1, IoCalc
Cosphi
PF, S, Q, P, f
Uo
UL3, UL2, UL1
U31, U23, U12
Io2, Io1
IL3, IL2, IL1
Prms, Qrms, Srms
Tan phi
THDIL1, THDIL2, THDIL3
THDUa, THDUb, THDUc
IL1RMS, IL2RMS, IL3RMS
ILmin, ILmax, ULLmin, ULLmax, ULNmin, ULNmax
U12y, U12z, fy, fz

Configuring the Digital Inputs DI

These functions can be read and set through the submenus of the digital inputs
menu.
• The status of digital inputs (DIGITAL INPUTS 1-20/24/32).
• Operation counters (DI COUNTERS).
• Operation delay (DELAYs for DigIn).
• The polarity of the input signal (INPUT POLARITY). Normally open
(NO) or normally closed (NC) circuit.
• To enable Event, EVENT MASK1.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 51


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

Configuring the Digital Outputs DO

These functions can be read and set through the submenus of the digital
outputs menu.
• The status of the output protection systems relays (RELAY OUTPUTS
1, 2, 3, and 4).
• The forcing of the output protection systems relays (RELAY
OUTPUTS 1, 2, 3, and 4) (only if Force = ON):
– Forced control (0 or 1) of the Trip relays.
– Forced control (0 or 1) of the Alarm relays.
– Forced control (0 or 1) of the S relay.
• The configuration of the output signals to the output relays. The
configuration of the status indicators Alarm and Trip and application-
specific alarm status indicators A, B, and C (the output relay matrix).

TIP The quantity of Trip and Alarm relays depends on the Protection System
type and optional hardware.

Protection Menu (Prot)

These functions can be read and set through the submenus of the Prot menu.
• Reset all counters (PROTECTION SET/ClAll).
• Read the status of all protection functions (PROTECT STATUS 1-x).
• Enable and disable protection functions (ENABLED STAGES 1-x).
• Define the interlockings between signals (only with SetPointPS).

Each stage of the protection functions can be disabled or enabled individually


in the Prot menu. When a stage is enabled, it is in operation immediately
without a need to reset the relay.

The Protection System includes several protection functions. The number of


functions that can be active simultaneously is limited by the processor capacity.

52 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Local Panel User Interface Chapter 2

Configuration Menu (CONF)

The Configuration Menu contains functions and features that can be read and
set through the submenus of the configuration menu, from the front of the 857
Protection System.

Device Setup
• Set the bit rate for the command-line interface in ports X4 and the front
panel. The front panel uses this setting. If SPA-Bus is selected for the
rear-panel local port X4, the bit rate is according to SPA-Bus settings.
• Displays the access level [Acc]
• Personal computer access level [PCAcc]

Language

A list of available languages in the 857 Protection System.

Current Scaling
• Rated phase CT primary current (Inom).
• Rated phase CT secondary current (Isec).
• Rated input of the relay [Iinput]. 5 A or 1 A, as specified in the order
code of the device.
• Rated value of I01 CT primary current (Ionom).
• Rated value of I01 CT secondary current (Iosec).
• Rated I01 input of the Protection System [Ioinp]. 5 A or 1 A, as specified
in the order code of the device.
• Rated value of I02 CT primary current (Io2nom).
• Rated value of I02 CT secondary current (Io2sec).
• Rated I02 input of the Protection System [Io2inp]. 5A, 1 A or 0.2, as
specified in the order code of the device.

The rated input values are equal to the rated secondary value of the CT.

The rated CT secondary can be greater than the rated input, but the
continuous current must be less than four times the rated input. In
compensated, high impedance that is earthed, and isolated networks with a
cable transformer to measure residual current I0, a relay used. The relay has 1 A
or 0.2 A input, and the CT is 5 A or 1 A, which increases the measurement
accuracy.

The rated CT secondary can also be less than the rated input, but the
measurement accuracy near zero current decreases.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 53


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

Motor Currents

Displayed ONLY if the Protection System is in Motor protective mode.


• Rated current of the motor (Imot).

Voltage Scaling
• Rated VT primary voltage (Uprim).
• Rated VT secondary voltage (Usec).
• Rated U0 VT secondary voltage (Uosec).
• Voltage measuring-mode (Umode).

Frequency Adaption
• Mode (Auto, Fixed, Manual).
• Adapted Frequency (fAdop).

Units For Mimic Display


• Unit for voltages. The choices are V (Volt) or kV (kilovolt).
• Scaling for active, reactive, and apparent power [Power]. The choices are
k (for kW, kVAR, and kVA) or M (for MW, Mvar, and MVA).

Fundemantal/RMS
• Energy (Fundamental, RMS).
• Display Fundamental (On/Off ).
• Display RMS (On/Off ).

Device info
• Protection System type (857).
• Serial number (SerN).
• Software version (PrgVer).
• Bootcode version (BootVer).

Date/Time Setup
• Day, month, and year (Date).
• Time of day (Time).
• Date format (yyyy-mm-dd, dd.mm.yyyy, or mm/dd/yyyy).

Clock Synchronization
• Digital input for minute sync pulse (SyncDI). If any digital input is not
used for synchronization, select “-”.
• Daylight Savings Time for NTP synchronization (DST).
• Detected source of synchronization (SyScr).
• Synchronization message counter (MsgCnt).
• Latest synchronization deviation (Dev).

54 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Local Panel User Interface Chapter 2

These parameters are visible only when the access level is higher than “User”.
• Offset, that is constant error, of the synchronization source (SyOS).
• Auto adjust interval (AAIntv).
• Average drift direction (AvDrft): “Lead” or “lag”.
• Average synchronization deviation (FilDev).

Software Options
• Application Mode (Feeder, Motor).
• Dist. Earth-fault (On/Off ).
• MIMIC (On/Off ).

Protocol Menu (Bus)

There are multiple communication ports on the rear panel. Protocol


availability depends on the communication options ordered. In addition, there
is a connector in the front panel. This connector takes control when the
857-VX003-3 cable is attached, which overrules the local port in the rear panel.

Remote Port
• Communication protocol for remote port X5 [Protocol].
• Message counter [Msg#]. Can be used to verify that the device is
receiving messages.
• Communication error counter [Errors].
• Communication time-out error counter [Tout].
• Information of bit rate/data bits/parity/stop bits.
This value is not directly editable. An edit is done in the protocol setting
menus. The counters are useful when testing the communication.

Local Port
This port is disabled if the 857-VX003-3 cable is connected to the front panel
connector.
• Communication protocol for the local port X4 [Protocol]. For
SetPointPS use “None”.
• Message counter [Msg#]. Can be used to verify that the device is
receiving messages.
• Communication error counter [Errors].
• Communication time-out error counter [Tout].
• Information of bit rate/data bits/parity/stop bits.
This value is not directly editable. An edit is done in the protocol setting
menus. For SetPointPS and protocol “None”, the setting is done in
Protection System menu CONF/DEVICE SETup.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 55


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

Personal Computer (LOCAL/SPA-Bus)


A second menu for local port X4. The SetPointPS communication status is
shown.
• Bytes/size of the transmitter buffer [Tx].
• Message counter [Msg#]. Can be used to verify that the device is
receiving messages.
• Communication error counter [Errors].
• Communication time-out error counter [Tout].
• Same information as in the previous menu.

Extension Port(1)
• Communication protocol for extension port X4 [Protocol]. For
connection to the 857-RAD enhanced RTD scanner, select External
I/O. See publication 857-UM002 for complete details.
• Message counter [Msg#]. Used to verify that the device is receiving
messages.
• Communication error counter [Errors].
• Communication time-out error counter [Tout].
• Information of bit rate/data bits/parity/stop bits.
• This value is not directly editable. An edit is done in the protocol setting
menus.

Ethernet Port
These parameters are used by the Ethernet interface. For changing the
nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn Ethernet port settings, SetPointPS is recommended.
• Ethernet port protocol [Protoc].
• IP Port for protocol [Port].
• IP address [IpAddr].
• Net mask [NetMsk].
• Gateway [Gatew].
• Name server [NameSw].
• Network time protocol (NTP) server [NTPSvr].
• IP Port for SetPointPS [VS Port].
• TCP Keep alive interval [KeepAlive]
• Media access control address [MAC]
• Message counter [Msg#].
• Error counter [Errors].
• Timeout counter [Tout].

(1) Used with 857-RAD enhanced RTD scanner.

56 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Local Panel User Interface Chapter 2

Modbus
• TCP Keep alive interval [Keepalive].
• Modbus address for this slave device [Addr]. This address must be
unique within the system.
• Modbus bit rate [bit/s]. Default is “9600”.
• Parity [Parity]. Default is “Even”.

See Chapter 7 for details.

External I/O Protocol


External I/O is a set of protocols that are used with the extension I/O modules
that are connected to the extension port. Only one instance of this protocol is
possible. The selectable protocols are:
• Modbus: is a selectable protocol.
– Bit rate [bit/s]. Default is “9600”.
– Parity [Parity]. Default is “Even”.
• RTD Input: This protocol is used together with the 857-RAA scanner.
– Bit rate [bit/s]. Default is “9600”.
– Parity [Parity]. Default is “Even”.

See publication 857-UM002 for details.

SPA-Bus

Several instances of this protocol are possible.


• SPA-Bus address for this device [Addr]. This address must be unique
within the system.
• Bit rate [bit/s]. Default is “9600”.
• Event number style [Emode]. Default is “Channel”.

See Chapter 7 for details.

IEC 60870-5-103

Only one instance of this protocol is possible.


• Address for this device [Addr]. This address must be unique within the
system.
• Bit rate [bit/s]. Default is “9600”.
• Minimum measurement response-interval [MeasInt].
• ASDU6 response time mode [SyncRe].

See Chapter 7 for details.

IEC 103 Disturbance Recordings

See Chapter 7 for details.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 57


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

PROFIBUS

Only one instance of this protocol is possible.


• [Mode]
• Bit rate [bit/s] must be 2400 bps. This parameter is the bit rate between
the main CPU and the PROFIBUS ASIC. The PROFIBUS master sets
the PROFIBUS bit rate and can be up to 12 Mbit/s.
• Event number style [Emode].
• Size of the PROFIBUS Tx buffer [InBuf ].
• Size of the PROFIBUS Rx buffer [OutBuf ].
• When configuring the PROFIBUS master system, the lengths of these
buffers are needed. The size of both buffers is set indirectly when
configuring the data items for PROFIBUS.
• Address for this slave device [Addr]. This address must be unique within
the system.
• PROFIBUS converter type [Conv]. If the shown type is a dash “-”:
PROFIBUS protocol has not been selected. Or the device has not
restarted after protocol change. Or there is a communication problem
between the main CPU and the PROFIBUS ASIC.

See PROFIBUS DP on page 277 and Rockwell Automation® publication


857-UM003 for GSD file content and additional details.

DNP 3.0

Only one instance of this protocol is possible.


• Bit rate [bit/s]. Default is “9600”.
• [Parity].
• Address for this device [SlvAddr]. This address must be unique within
the system.
• Master address [MstrAddr].

See Chapter 7 for details.

IEC 60870-5-101
• Bit rate [bit/s]. Default is “9600”.
• [Parity].
• Link layer address for this device [LLAddr].
• ASDU address [ALAddr].

See Chapter 7 for details.

58 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Local Panel User Interface Chapter 2

SetPointPS Personal SetPointPS is a free personal computer program available for configuration and
setting of Allen-Bradley® 857 and 865 protection systems. Obtain the latest
Computer Software SetPointPS software from www.ab.com. See 857-PM001 for more
information.

The personal computer user-interface can be used for the following tasks:
• Do the on-site parameter settings of the protection system.
• Load protection system software from a computer.
• Read measured values, registered values, and events to a computer.
• Do a continuous monitoring of all values and events.
• Inject digital voltage and current signals for protection validation and
troubleshooting.

Two RS-232 serial ports can be available for connecting a local personal
computer with SetPointPS to the protection system. One on the front panel
(standard) and one on the rear panel of the protection system (optional).
These two serial ports are connected in parallel. If the connection cables are
connected to both ports, only the port on the front panel is active. To connect
a personal computer to a serial port, use a connection cable Bulletin 857-
VX003-3.

The SetPointPS program can also use an Ethernet TCP/IP LAN connection.
An optional Ethernet communication-port is required.

Single-line Diagram Editing

The single-line diagram is drawn with the SetPointPS software. For more
information, see the SetPointPS manual, publication 857-PM001.

Figure 23 - Single-line Diagram

Blocking and Interlocking Configuration

The configuration of the blockings and interlockings is done with the


SetPointPS software. Any start or trip signal can be used for blocking the
operation of any protection stage. The interlocking between objects can be
configured in the same blocking matrix of the SetPointPS software. For more
information, see publication 857-PM001.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 59


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

Webset Through Hypertext The Webset HTTP configuration interface can configure the device with a
web browser (Explorer, Mozilla Firefox, or Google Chrome). The feature is
Transfer Protocol (HTTP) available on 857 protection systems that are equipped with a built-in or
Server optional Ethernet card and firmware revision 12.001 or newer installed.
Webset provides a subset of features that are provided by SetPointPS, the
configuration software. The same group lists and group views are available
except for the LOGIC and the MIMIC groups, which are configurable only
through SetPointPS.

For web access to the 857 protection system, configure the protection system
to enable HTTP services.

Enable the HTTP Server

The HTTP server can be enabled(1) within the 857 protection system by using
these methods:

1. With SetPointPS – By checking the box to Enable HTTP server in the


PROTOCOL CONFIGURATION group view as seen in Figure 24.
2. With the 857 HMI – By navigating to Bus > ETHERNET PORT >
HTTP srvr and setting the value to On.

Figure 24 - Configuration Field for Enabling/disabling the HTTP Server in SetPointPS

(1) Configurator access level is required to enable the HTTP server. The 857 Protection System requires a restart before this feature is
enabled.

60 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Local Panel User Interface Chapter 2

Connect to the 857 Protection System with a Web Browser

If the Ethernet port connection of the protection system is properly


configured, the protection system connects to a personal computer.

1. Open a web browser window.


2. In the browser type, the IP address of the protection system. See
Figure 24 for location of the IP address.
3. Press Enter.
A prompt is displayed (Figure 25).

Figure 25 - Authorization Prompts in Various Browser Types

1. In the User Name field type one of the following:


a. For configurator access level, type conf.
b. For operator access level, type operator.
c. For user access level, type user.
2. Enter the password in the password field:
• By default, the password for Configurator Access Level is 2 or 0002,
and for Operator Access Level is 1 or 0001.
• The User Access Level does not require a password.
• These passwords can be changed using the SetPointPS software. See
857-PM001.
3. Press OK or Login. The main page loads in the browser.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 61


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

Configure the 857 Protection System Through Webset HTTP Server

Once connected, an interactive interface similar to that of SetPointPS is


displayed (Figure 26). It features the ability to interrogate and revise the
program settings of the 857 Protection System. It also provides the graphical
abilities to monitor metering and energy-related data.

ATTENTION: Unlike the SetPointPS interface, interaction with the web


interface is directly on-line to the857 Protection System. Any changes are
immediately sent to the protection system. It is highly recommended the
process/load being protected by the Protection System is not operating or
being protected when changes are made through Webset.

Figure 26 - Main Page and the Functional Areas of the Configurator Mode on a Bulletin 857

Using the Webset HTTP Server

There are several interactive controls that are included with the Webset
configurator. See Figure 26 for the functional areas within the Webset
interface.

Fields that are styled with a light green color and bold font are editable. The
exception is that matrices are shown in this style.

62 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Local Panel User Interface Chapter 2

Caption View

The Caption View in Webset features a row of menu buttons (see Figure 26).
The basic interaction and use of these buttons is as follows(1):
• Auto-Refresh: a toggle-button for enabling/disabling automatic
periodic content refresh from a menu item from the 857 Protection
System. The button changes to a dark green when enabled. If another
menu selection is made, the Auto Refresh is automatically disengaged.
The refresh interval depends on the size of the current page being
displayed. Its use is recommended mostly for monitoring the metering
values, such as those in the MEASUREMENTS group.
• Refresh Menu: refreshes the current Group View one time.
• Refresh Content: refreshes the Group View menu-item contents, one
time.
• Restart Device: issues a restart command to the 857 Protection System,
after clicking OK in the popup prompt. The Cancel command can be
used from this popup prompt.(2)
• Log out: logs the user out of the web-based session.

Menu/Group List
The menu/group list functionality mimics the functions available by using
SetPointPS programming software (see publication 857-PM001). The list is
generated based on the options that are available in the device connected. To
scroll down the list, use the slider bar on the right side of this portion of the
control window.

Content/Group View

To edit the settings, click the element name in the Content/Group View area.
See Figure 27.

(1) The web interface is an online real-time interaction service. Any changes that are made are sent to the Protection System
immediately. Some pages could take up to 10 seconds to load in some browsers version. Subsecond response is typical.
(2) Configurator access level is required. The 857 Protection System key restarts once the command is initiated which could result in
a change of state of all output 857 Protection Systems.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 63


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

Figure 27 - View of Measurements Item

To change a parameter, follow these steps.

1. Select the desired main parameter item popup to change.


2. Select the variable within the setting parameter or protection elements.
These areas are shown in light green. A popup window appears which
permits the changing of that given parameter.
3. Shown in figure Figure 28 is the selection of the primary ratio of the
main current transformers. Enter the desired value into the appropriate
area of the editor prompt.
4. Click Submit.
5. The valid range for the specific element being changed is in the area
below the entry box within the window.

Figure 28 - Editing the Parameters

64 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Local Panel User Interface Chapter 2

If a change is made to a given parameter, which affects other values on the page,
these other values do not automatically update. Refresh the content or enable
the Auto-refresh function. This aspect depends on type of change being made.
Updating the page with the browser refresh function is also an option, but can
provide a slower response time than the Webset refresh functionality.

For some parameter changes, the editing of a value requires the 857 Protection
System to restart. In this case, the edited field will turn yellow after the submit
button has been clicked to indicate that a restart is required. The Protection
System protective mode has been changed to Feeder Protection Mode from
Motor Protection Mode. The yellow color (Figure 29) signifies that a restart of
the Protection System is required to initialize this change.

Figure 29 - Parameter Change Requiring Restart

To restart the protection system follow these steps.

1. Click the Restart Device button on the Webset page


2. Click OK.
3. Refresh to make sure that the views are updated.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 65


Chapter 2 Local Panel User Interface

Notes:

66 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Chapter 3

Protection Functions

Each protection stage can independently be enabled or disabled according to


the requirements of the intended application.

Maximum Number of The device limits the maximum number of enabled stages to about 30,
depending on the type of the stages. For more information, see Configuration
Protection Stages in One and Parameter Setting on page 47.
Application

Protection Functions Table 5 - List of Protection Functions


IEEE/ANSI Code IEC Symbol Function Name Page
25 df/dv Synchrocheck 141
14 U< Speed switch input 131
U<<
27 Undervoltage protection
U<<<
32 P< Reverse and underpower protection 134
P<<
37 I< Undercurrent protection 96
38 I2 > RTDs 85, 86
46(1) Current unbalance protection
47(1) I2>> Phase reversal / incorrect phase sequence protection 89
48(1) Ist> Stall protection 89
49 T> Thermal overload protection 124
50/51 I> Overcurrent protection 74
I>>
I>>>
50ARC ArcI> Optional arc overcurrent protection 154
50BF CBFP Circuit-breaker failure protection 150
50N/51N I0 > Earth-fault protection 107
50G/51G I0>>
50GS/51GS I0>>>
I0>>>>
50NARC ArcI01> Optional earth-fault protection 154
ArcI02>
50NC/51NC Capacitor-bank unbalance protection 117
55PF Power Factor Relay

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 67


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Table 5 - List of Protection Functions (Continued)


IEEE/ANSI Code IEC Symbol Function Name Page
59N U0> Zero sequence voltage protection 121
U0>>
59 U> Overvoltage protection 128
U>>
U>>>
66(1) N> Frequent start protection 94
67 Iφ> Directional overcurrent protection 79
Iφ>>
Iφ>>>
Iφ>>>>
67N I0φ> Directional earth-fault protection 96
I0φ>>
67NI I0int Directional transient intermittent earth-fault 112
protection
68F2 If2> Second harmonic overcurrent protection 149
68F5
81, 81H, 81L f>< Frequency protection 135
f>><<
79 AR Reclose 135
81L f< Underfrequency protection
f<<
81R df/dt Rate of change of frequency (ROCOF) protection 137
86 Selective lockout
99 Prg1…8 Programmable stages 151
1) Some stages vary between feeder or motor protective modes.

General Features of Setting Groups


Protection Stages
The setting groups are controlled by using digital inputs or other assigned
inputs. Up to four setting groups can be available depending on the version of
the Protection System firmware. When none of the assigned input/inputs is/
are not active, the parameter ‘SetGrp no control state’ defines the active setting
group. When controlled input activates, the corresponding setting group is
activated as well. If multiple inputs are active simultaneously, ‘SetGrp priority’
defines the active setting group. By using virtual I/O, the active setting group
can be controlled. Also by using the local panel display, any communication
protocol, or the built-in programmable logic functions. The status of a
protection stage can be any of the following list:
OK = ‘–’ Stage is not detecting any fault.
Blocked Stage is detecting a fault but is blocked for some reason.
Start (Alarm) Stage has begun counting the operation delay and is an Alarm state.
Trip Stage has tripped and the fault is still active.

68 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

IMPORTANT Since the 857 relay is designed to be applied in any global location, the term
‘Start’ is used universally throughout the product to indicate that protective
element or condition is in an alarm state or condition. This term is used
throughout the product and this document.

The status of a protective stage can show Blocked. The block can be due to an
active signal through the block matrix from other stages, the programmable
logic, or any digital input. Some stages also have built-in logic for blocking. For
example, an under frequency stage is blocked if the voltage is too low. For more
details about block matrix, see Measurement Functions on page 215.

Forcing a Start or Trip Condition for Testing

The “Force flag” parameter forces the status of any protection stage to be
“start” or “trip” for a half second. By using the parameter, no current or voltage
injection to the Protection System is required check the following:
• The output matrix configuration.
• The wiring from the output relays to the circuit breaker or contactor.
• The communication protocols are correctly transferring event
information to a remote system.

After testing, the force flag automatically resets 5 minutes after the last local
panel push button activity.

The force flag also enables the forcing of the output relays and the forcing of
the optional mA outputs. Force Flag is found in the Relays menu.

Figure 30 - Force Flag

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 69


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Start and Trip Signals

Every protection stage has two internal binary-output signals, start and trip.
The start signal is issued when a fault is detected (Alarm condition). The trip
signal is issued after the configured operation delay, unless the fault disappears
before the end of the delay time. These conditions can be configured to Trip or
Alarm relays or virtual outputs.

Output Matrix

The output matrix is used to connect the internal start and trip signals to the
output relays and indicators, see Control Functions on page 233.

Blocking

Any protection function, except arc protection, can be blocked with internal
and external signals when the block matrix is used. See Measurement Functions
on page 215). For example, internal signals are logic outputs and start and trip
signals from other stages and external signals are digital and virtual inputs.

Some protection stages have the blocking functions built-in. For example,
under-frequency protection has the blocking for undervoltage built-in to avoid
tripping when the voltage is off.

When a protection stage is blocked, it does not pick up if a fault condition is


detected. If the blocking is activated during the operation delay, the delay
counting is frozen until the blocking goes off or the pick-up reason. If the stage
is tripping, the blocking has no effect.

Retardation Time

Retardation time is a protection the Protection System requires to notice that a


fault has been cleared during the operation time delay. This parameter is
important when grading the operation time-delay settings between Protection
Systems. If the delay setting was slightly shorter, an unselective trip can occur
(the dash line pulse).

70 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Figure 31 - Retardation Time

tFAULT
tRET ≤ 50 ms

DELAY SETTING ≥tFAULT + tRET

TRIP CONTACTS

For example, when there is a large fault in an outgoing feeder, it can start (that
is pick-up both the incoming and outgoing feeder Protection System). Clear
the fault by the outgoing feeder relay. The incoming feeder relay must not trip.
Set the operating delay of the incoming feeder so that it is greater than at the
outgoing feeder. The incoming feeder can still trip if the operation time
difference is inadequate. The difference must be more than the retardation
time of the incoming feeder relay, plus the operating time of the outgoing
feeder circuit breaker.

Figure 31 shows an overcurrent fault as seen by the incoming feeder, when the
outgoing feeder does clear the fault. An unselective trip can happen (the
dashed 40-ms pulse in the figure) if either the following occurs:
• The operation delay setting is slightly shorter.
• The fault duration is slightly longer than in the figure.

The 857 Protection System retardation time is less than 50 ms.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 71


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Reset Time (Release Time)

Figure 32 shows an example of reset time (release delay) when the Protection
System is clearing an overcurrent fault. When the protection system trip
contacts are closed, the circuit breaker (CB) starts to open. After the CB
contacts are open, the fault current still flows through an arc between the
opened contacts. The current is finally cut when the arc extinguishes at the
next zero -crossing of the current (the start moment of the reset delay). After
the reset delay, the trip contacts and start contact are opened unless the latching
is configured. The reset time varies from fault to fault depending on the fault
size. After a significant fault, the time is longer. The reset time also depends on
the specific protection stage. The maximum reset time for each stage is
specified in Chapter 10. For most stages, it is less than 95 ms.

Figure 32 - Reset Time

tSET
tCB
tRESET

TRIP CONTACTS

Hysteresis or Deadband

When comparing a measured value against a pick-up value, some amount of


hysteresis is required to avoid oscillation near any equilibrium situation. With
zero hysteresis, any noise in the measured signal or any noise in the
measurement itself would cause unwanted oscillation between a fault-on and
fault-off situation.

72 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Figure 33 - Behavior of a Greater Than Comparator


In overcurrent and overvoltage
stages, the hysteresis (deadband)
acts according to this figure

Hysteresis
PICK up LEVEL

>PICK up

Figure 34 - Behavior of a Less Than Comparator


In undercurrent and under
frequency stages, the
hysteresis (deadband) acts
according to this figure
Hysteresis

PICK up LEVEL

>PICK up

Function Dependencies Application Modes

There are two application modes available within the protection system the
feeder protective mode and the motor protective mode. In feeder protective
mode, all current-dependent protection functions are relative to nominal
current In derived by CT ratios. The motor protection functions are
unavailable in the feeder protective mode. In the motor protective mode, all
current-dependent protection functions are relative to the nominal current
Imot of the motor. The motor protective mode enables motor protection
functions. All functions that are available in the feeder protective mode are also
available in the motor protective mode.

The application mode can be changed with the SetPointPS software or from
CONF menu in the device. To change the application mode, it requires the
configurator password, and a restart of the protection system.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 73


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Current Protection Function Dependencies

The current based protection functions are relative to IMODE, which is


dependent on the application mode. In motor protective mode, all current
based functions are relative to IMOT, and in the feeder protective mode to In,
with the following exceptions.

I2> (46), I2>> (47), Ist> (48), and N> (66) are dependent on IMOT and are
only available when the application mode is motor protection.

Overcurrent Stage I> (50/51) Overcurrent protection is used against short circuit faults and heavy overloads.

The overcurrent function measures the fundamental frequency component of


the phase currents. The protection is sensitive for the highest of the three phase
currents. Whenever this value exceeds the pick-up setting of a particular stage,
this stage picks up and a start signal is issued. If the fault situation remains
longer than the operation delay setting, a trip signal is issued.

IMPORTANT When the 857 is used for control and protection of fuse and contactor based
configuration (E2), 50/51 protection elements should only be used for
alternative functions or used to block the tripping of the switching device for
currents greater than the switching device's interrupting rating.

Three Independent Stages

There are three adjustable overcurrent stages I>, I>>, and I>>>. The first stage
I> can be configured for definite time (DT) or inverse time operation
characteristic (IDMT). The stages I>> and I>>> have DT operation
characteristic. By using the definite delay type and setting the delay to its
minimum, an instantaneous (ANSI 50) operation is obtained.

Figure 35 shows a functional block diagram of the I> overcurrent stage with
DT and inverse time operation time. Figure 36 shows a functional block
diagram of the I>> and I>>> overcurrent stages with DT operation delay.

Inverse Operation Time


Inverse delay means that the operation time depends on the amount the
measured current exceeds the pick-up setting. The bigger the fault current, the
faster the operation. Accomplished inverse delays are available for the I> stage.
The inverse delay types are described in Inverse Time Operation on page 157.
The device shows the currently used inverse delay curve-graph on the local
panel display.

74 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Inverse Time Limitation

The maximum measured secondary current is 50 x IN, which limits the scope
of inverse curves with high pick-up settings. See Inverse Time Operation on
page 157.

Cold Load and Inrush Current Handling


See Cold Load Pick-up and Inrush Current Detection on page 180.

Setting Groups

There are four settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs,
virtual inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to
switch between setting groups.

Figure 35 - Block Diagram of the Three-phase Overcurrent Stage I> and I’>

Im1
Im2 Max Start
Im3 ts tr
Register
Block Event

Trip

Register
Event

Setting I>s Delay Definite/ Multiplier Enable


Inverse Inverse Time Events
Time Characteristics

Figure 36 - Block Diagram of the Three-phase Overcurrent Stage I>> and I>>>

Im1
Im2 Start
Max
Im3 ts tr
Register
Block Event

Trip

Register
Event

Setting I>>s Delay Enable Events

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 75


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Table 6 - Parameters of the Overcurrent Stage I> (50/51)


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Status - Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F(1)
Trip F(1)
TripTime s Estimated time to trip
SCntr Cumulative start counter C(2)
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C(2)
SetGrp 1 …4 Active setting group Set(3)
SGrpDI Digital signal to select the active setting group:
- None
DIx Digital input
VIx Virtual input Set(3)
LEDx Status indicator signal
VOx Virtual output
Force Off Force flag for status, forcing for test purposes. A common flag Set(3)
On for all stages and output relays, too. This flag is automatically
reset 5 minutes after the front panel button are last used.
ILmax A The supervised value. Max. of IL1, IL2, and IL3
I> A Pick-up value that is scaled to primary value
I> xImode Pick-up setting Set(3)
Curve Delay curve family
DT Definite time
IEC Inverse time. See Inverse Time Operation on page 157.
IEEE Set(3)
IEEE2 Pre 1996
RI
PrgN
Type Delay type Set(3)
DT Definite time
NI Inverse time. See Inverse Time Operation on page 157.
VI Inverse
EI Inverse
LTI Long Time Inverse
Parameters
t> s Definite operation time (for Definite Time only) Set(3)
k> Inverse delay multiplier (for inverse time only) Set(3)
Dly20x s Delay at 20xIset
Dly4x s Delay at 4xIset
Dly2x s Delay at 2xIset
Dly1x s Delay at 1xIset
IncHarm On / Off Include Harmonics
Delay curves Graphic delay curve picture (only local display)
A, B, C, D, E User constants for standard equations. Set(3)
Type = parameters. See Inverse Time Operation on page 157.
(1) F = Editable when force flag is on
(2) C = Can be cleared to zero.
(3) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

76 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Missing Recorded Value


Table 7 - Recorded Values
LOG1 Date and time of trip
Type Fault type
Flt xIMODE Fault current
Load xIMODE Pre-fault current
Edly % Elapsed delay time
SetGrp Active set group during default

Table 8 - Parameters of the Overcurrent Stages I>>, I>>> (50/51)

For details on setting ranges, see Protection Stages on page 353.


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Status - Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F(1)
Trip F(1)
SCntr Cumulative start counter C(2)
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C(2)
SetGrp 1 …4 Active setting group Set(3)
SGrpDI Digital signal to select the active setting group Set(3)
- None
DIx Digital input
VIx Virtual input
LEDx Status indicator signal
VOx Virtual output
Force Off Force flag for status, forcing for test purposes. A common Set(3)
On flag for all stages and output relays, too. Automatically reset
by a 5-minute timeout.
ILmax A The supervised value. Max. of IL1, IL2, and IL3
I>> A Pick-up value that is scaled to primary value
I>>>
I>> xImode Pick-up setting Set(3)
I>>>
t>> s Definite operation time Set(3)
t>>>
IncHarm On Include harmonics Set
Off
(1) F = Editable when force flag is on.
(2) C = Can be cleared to zero.
(3) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 77


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults

Detailed information is available on the eight latest faults: Time stamp, fault
type, fault current, load current before the fault, elapsed delay, and setting
group.

Table 9 - Recorded Values of Overcurrent Stages (Eight Latest Faults) I>, I>>, I>>> (50/51)
Parameter Value Unit Description
yyyy-mm-dd Time stamp of the recording, date
hh : mm: ss: ms Time stamp, time of day
Type Fault type:
1-N Ground fault
2-N Ground fault
3-N Ground fault
1-2 Two-phase fault
2-3 Two-phase fault
3-1 Two-phase fault
1,2,3 Three-phase fault
Flt xImode Maximum fault current
Load xImode 1-s average phase currents before the fault
EDly % Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% = trip
SetGrp 1 …4 Active setting group during fault

Remote Controlled Overcurrent Scaling

Pick-up setting of the three overcurrent stages can also be controlled remotely.
In this case, only two coefficients for scaling are possible100% (the scaling is
inactive) and any configured value between 10…200% (the scaling is active).
When scaling is enabled, all settings of group one are copied to group two. But
the pick-up value of group two is changed, according to the given value
(10…200%).
• This feature is enabled/disabled through SetPointPS or by using the
local panel. When using SetPointPS, the scaling can be activated and
adjusted in the “protection stage status 2” –menu. The local panel has
similar settings that are found in the “prot” -menu.
• It is also possible to change the scaling factor remotely by using the
Modbus TCP –protocol. When changing the scaling factor remotely,
the value of 1% is equal to 1. Check the correct Modbus address for this
application from the SetPointPS or from the communication parameter
list.

78 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Figure 37 - Example of Remote Scaling

Figure 37 shows the effect of remote scaling. After enabling, group is changed
from group one to group two and all settings from group one are copied to
group two. The difference is that group two uses scaled pick-up settings.

IMPORTANT When the remote scaling function is used, all settings of group 2, 3, and 4
are placed. This function cannot be used simultaneously with normal group
changes.

Directional Overcurrent The directional overcurrent protection can be used for directional short circuit
protection. Typical applications are the following:
Protection Iφ> (67)
• Short circuit protection of two parallel cables or overhead lines in a
radial network.

• Short circuit protection of a looped network with one feeding point.

• Short circuit protection of a two-way feeder, which usually supplies


loads but is used in special cases as an incoming feeder.

• Directional earth-fault protection in low impedance earthed networks.


In this case, the device must be connected to line-to-neutral voltages
instead of line-to-line voltages. The voltage measurement mode must be
“3LN” (see Voltage Measurement Mode on page 219).

The stages are sensitive to the amplitude of the highest fundamental frequency
current of the three measured phase currents. The phase angle is based on the
phase angle of the three-phase power phasor. For details of power direction, see
Direction of Power and Current on page 222. A typical characteristic is shown
in Figure 38. The base angle setting is –30°. The stage picks up, if the tip of the
three-phase current phasor gets into the gray area.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 79


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

TIP To connect for the right direction for earth-faults:


If the maximum earth-fault current is greater than the most sensitive
directional overcurrent setting, connect the device to the line to neutral
voltages.
For networks having the maximum possible earth-fault current less than
the overcurrent setting, use 67N, the directional earth-fault stages.

Figure 38 - Example of Protection Area of the Directional Overcurrent Function


+90°
-inductive +capacitive

Set Value
-res. 0° +res.
ILOAD
Trip Area

Base Angle = -30°


IFAULT

-Capacitive +Inductive
-90°

Three modes are available: directional, ,non-directional and directional +


back-up Figure 39. In the non-directional mode, the stage is acting just like an
ordinary overcurrent 50/51 stage.

Directional+back-up mode works the same way as directional mode but it has
undirectional back-up protection in case a close-up fault forces all voltages to
about zero. After the angle memory hold time, the direction would be lost.
Basically the directional+backup mode is required when operation time is set
longer than voltage memory setting and no other undirectional back-up
protection is in use.

Figure 39 - Difference Between Directional Mode and Non-directional Mode


90° 90°
-Inductive +Capacitive -inductive +Capacitive

Directional Directional

Set Value 0° Set Value 0°


-res. -res.
+res. +res.
Base Angle = 0°

Trip Area Trip Area

-Capacitive +Inductive -Capacitive +Inductive


-90° -90°

80 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

An example of bi-directional operation characteristic is shown in Figure 40.


The right side stage in this example is the stage Iφ> and the left side is Iφ>>.
The base angle setting of the Iφ> is 0° and the base angle of Iφ>> is set to –180°.

Figure 40 - Bi-directional Application with Two Stages Iφ> and Iφ>>


+90°
-Inductive. +Capacitive

IDIR>>Trip Area

Set Value Set Value



-res. +res.
Base Angle=0°
Base Angle=-180°
IDIR>>Trip Area

-Capacitive +Inductive.
-90°

The stage picks up and issues a start signal when any of the three phase
currents:
• Exceeds the setting value.
• Is in directional mode and has a phase angle including the base angle
within the active ± 88° wide sector.

If this fault situation remains on longer than the delay setting, a trip signal is
issued.

Four Independent Stages

There are four separately adjustable stages available: Iφ>, Iφ>>, Iφ>>>, and
Iφ>>>>.

Inverse Operation Time


Stages Iφ> and Iφ>> are configured for Definite Time (DT) or inverse time
characteristic. See Inverse Time Operation on page 157 for available inverse
delays. Stages Iφ>>> and Iφ>>>> have DT operation delay. The device shows a
scalable graph of the configured delay on the local panel display.

Inverse Time Limitation

The maximum measured secondary current is 50 x IN. This maximum limits


the scope of inverse curves with high pick-up settings. See Inverse Time
Operation on page 157.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 81


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Cold Load and Inrush Current Handling

See Cold Load Pick-up and Inrush Current Detection on page 180.

Setting Groups
There are four settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs,
virtual inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to
switch between setting groups. For details on setting ranges, seeProtection
Stages on page 353.

Figure 41 shows the functional block of the Iφ> stage.

Figure 41 - Block Diagram of the Three-phase Overcurrent Stage Iφ>

Im1
Im2 Start
Max ts tr
Im3 Register
Block Event

IL1 Trip
IL3 P
U12 Phase
U23 Angle Register
Event

Setting Definite/ Multiplier Enable Events


Dir/ Base Delay
Not-dir Angle Idir>s Inverse Time Inverse Time
Characteristics

Table 10 - Parameters of the Directional Overcurrent Stages Iφ>, Iφ>> (67)

Parameter Value Unit Description Note


Status - Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F(1)
Trip F(1)
Trip Time S Estimated time to trip
SCntr Cumulative start counter C(2)
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C(2)
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group Set(3)
SGrpDI Digital signal to select the active setting group: Set(3)
- None
DIx Digital input
VIx Virtual input
LEDx Status indicator signal
VOx Virtual output
Force Off Force flag for status forcing for test purposes. A common Set(3)
On flag for all stages and output relays, too. Automatically
reset by a 5-minute timeout.
ILmax A The supervised value. Max. of IL1, IL2, and IL3
Iφ> A Pick-up value that is scaled to primary value
Iφ>>

82 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Table 10 - Parameters of the Directional Overcurrent Stages Iφ>, Iφ>> (67) (Continued)

Parameter Value Unit Description Note


Iφ> xImode Pick-up setting Set(3)
Iφ>>
Curve Delay curve family: Set (3)
DT Definite time
IEC Inverse time. See Inverse Time Operation on page 157.
IEEE
IEEE2
RI
PrgN
Type Delay type: Set(3)
DT Definite time
NI Inverse time
VI Very Inverse
EI Extremely Inverse
LTI Long Time Inverse
Parameter
s
t> s Definite operation time (for Definite Time only) Set(3)
k> Inverse delay multiplier (for inverse time only) Set(3)
Dly20x s Delay at 20 IMODE
Dly4x s Delay at 4 Imode
Dly2x s Delay at 2 IMODE
Dly1x s Delay at 1xIMODE
Mode Dir Directional mode (67) Set(3)
Undir Undirectional (50/51)
Offset ? Angle offset in degrees Set(3)
φ ? Measured power angle
U1 %Un Measured positive sequence voltage
A, B, C, D, E User constants for standard equations. Type = Set(3)
Parameters. See Inverse Time Operation on page 157.
(1) F = Editable when force flag is on
(2) C = Can be cleared to zero
(3) Set = An editable parameter (password required)

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 83


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Table 11 - Parameters of the Directional Overcurrent Stages Iφ>>>, Iφ>>>> (67)

Parameter Value Unit Description Note


Status - Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F(1)
Trip F(1)
SCntr Cumulative start counter C(2)
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C(2)
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group Set(3)
SGrpDI Digital signal to select the active setting group: Set(3)
- None
DIx Digital input
VIx Virtual input
LEDx Status indicator signal
VOx Virtual output
Force Off Force flag for status forcing for test purposes. Force is a common Set(3)
On flag for all stages and output relays. Automatically reset by a 5-
minute timeout.
ILmax A The supervised value. Max. of IL1, IL2, and IL3
Iφ>>> A Pick-up value that is scaled to primary value
Iφ>>>>
Iφ>>> xImode Pick-up setting Set(3)
Iφ>>>>
t>>> s Definite operation time (for Definite Time only) Set(3)
t>>>>
Mode Dir Directional mode (67) Set(3)
Undir Undirectional (50/51)
Offset ? Angle offset in degrees Set(3)
φ ? Measured power angle
U1 %Un Measured positive sequence voltage
(1) F = Editable when force flag is on.
(2) C = Can be cleared to zero.
(3) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

For details on setting ranges, see Protection Stages on page 353.

84 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults

Detailed information is available on the eight latest faults: Time stamp, fault
type, fault current, load current before the fault, which is elapsed delay, and
setting group.

Table 12 - Recorded Values of the Directional Overcurrent Stages (8 Latest Faults)


Iφ>, Iφ>>, Iφ>>>, Iφ>>>> (67)

Parameter Value Unit Description


yyyy-mm-dd Time stamp of the recording, date
hh:mm:ss:ms Time stamp, time of day
Type Fault type:
1-N Ground fault
2-N Ground fault
3-N Ground fault
1-2 Two-phase fault
2-3 Two-phase fault
3-1 Two-phase fault
1-2-3 Three-phase fault
Flt xIn Maximum fault current
Load xIn 1-s average phase currents before the fault
EDly % Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% = trip
Angle ? Fault angle in degrees
U1 xUn Positive sequence voltage during fault
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group during fault

Current Unbalance Stage I2> The unbalance stage detects unbalanced load conditions. For example, a
broken conductor or a heavy loaded overhead line if there is no earth-fault.
(46) in Feeder Protection
Mode The operation of the unbalanced load function is based on the negative-phase-
sequence component I2 related to the positive-phase sequence component I1.
This function is calculated from the phase currents with the method of
symmetrical components. The function requires that the measuring inputs are
connected correctly so that the rotation directions of the phase currents are as
in Chapter 9. The unbalance protection has DT operation characteristic.

I
K2 = ---2- , where
I1

I1 = IL1 + aIL2 + a2IL3


I2 = IL1 + a2IL2 + aIL3

3
a = 1 ∠120° = – 1--- + j ------- , a phasor rotating constant.
2 2

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 85


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Setting Parameters of Table 13 - Parameter Value Unit-default Description


Current Unbalance Parameter Value Unit Default Description
Stage I2> (46) I2/I1 2…70 % 20 Setting value, I2/I1
t> 1.0…600.0 s 10.0 Definite Operating
Time
Type DT — DT The selection of time
INV characteristics

S_On Enabled/Disabled — Enabled Start on event


S_Off Enabled/Disabled — Enabled Start off event
T_On Enabled/Disabled — Enabled Trip on event
T_Off Enabled/Disabled — Enabled Trip off event

Measured and Recorded Table 14 - Parameter Value Unit-default Description


Values of Current Unbalance Parameter Value Unit Description
Stage I2> (46) Measured Value I2/I1 % Relative negative-
sequence component
Recorded Values SCntr Cumulative start
counter
TCntr Cumulative start
counter
Flt % Maximum I2/I1 fault
component
EDly % Elapsed time as
compared to the set
operating time,
100% = tripping

Current Unbalance Current unbalance in a motor causes double frequency currents in the rotor.
This unbalance warms up the surface of the rotor. The available thermal
Protection I2> (46) in Motor capacity of the rotor is much less than the thermal capacity of the whole motor.
Protection Mode An rms only current based overload protection (see Thermal Overload
Protection T> (49) on page 124) cannot prevent a motor from a current
unbalance.

The current unbalance protection is based on the negative sequence of the base
frequency phase-currents. Both definite and inverse time characteristics are
available. Incorrect current phase sequencing to the 857 can result in abnormal
and extreme unbalanced values.

86 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Inverse Delay
Equation 3.1

The inverse delay is based on this equation.

K1 -
T = --------------------------
2 , where
 --------
I 2 -
– K2
2

 I MOT

T = Operation time (in seconds).


K1 = Delay multiplier.
I2 = Measured and calculated negative sequence phase current of
fundamental frequency.
IMOT = Nominal current of the motor.
K2 = Pick-up setting I2> in pu. The maximum allowed degree of
unbalance.
Example:
K1 = 15 s
I2 = 22.9% = 0.229 x IMOT
K2 = 5% = 0.05 x IMOT
15 - = 300.4 seconds
t = --------------------------------------
2
 0.229 
------------- – 0.05 2
 1 

The operation time in this example is 5 minutes.

More Stages (DT Delay Only)

If multiple DT delay stages are needed for current unbalance protection, the
freely programmable stages (99) can be used (see Programmable Stages (99) on
page 151).

Setting Groups

There are four settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs,
virtual inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to
switch between setting groups.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 87


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Figure 42 - Inverse Operation Delay of Current Unbalance Stage I2>


The longest delay is 2000
limited to 1000 seconds
(16 Min 40s). 1000

500 K 2= 2 % K 2= 40 % K 2= 70 %

200

Operation Time 100 K 1= 50 s

50

K 2= 2 % K 2= 40 % K 2= 70 %
20
10

5
K 1= 1 s
2
1
0 20 40 60 80 100
Negative Sequence current2 I (%)

Table 15 - Parameters of the Current Unbalance Stage I2> (46)

For details on setting ranges, see Protection Stages on page 353.


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Status - Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F(1)
Trip F(1)
SCntr Cumulative start counter C(2)
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C(2)
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group Set(3)
SGrpDI Digital signal to select the active setting group: Set(3)
- None
DIx Digital input
VIx Virtual input
LEDx Status indicator signal
VOx Virtual output
Force Off Force flag for status forcing for test purposes. A common flag for Set(3)
On all stages and output relays, too. Automatically reset by a 5-
minute timeout.
I2/Imot %Imot The supervised value.
I2> %Imot Pick-up setting Set(3)
t> s Definite operation time (Type=DT) Set(3)
Type DT Definite time Set(3)
INV Inverse time (See Equation 3.1 )
K1 s Delay multiplier (Type =INV) Set(3)
(1) F = Editable when force flag is on.
(2) C = Can be cleared to zero.
(3) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

88 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults

Detailed information is available on the eight latest faults: Time stamp,


unbalance current, elapsed delay, and setting group.
Table 16 - Recorded Values of the Current Unbalance Stage (8 Latest Faults) I2> (46) in Motor
Protection Mode
Parameter Value Unit Description
yyyy-mm-dd Time stamp of the recording, date
hh:mm:ss:ms Time stamp, time of day
Flt %Imot Maximum unbalance current
EDly % Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% = trip
SetGrp 12 Active setting group during the fault

Incorrect Phase Sequence The phase sequence stage helps prevent the motor from running in the wrong
direction. When the ratio between negative and positive sequence current
Protection I2>> (47) exceeds 80%, the phase sequence stage starts and trips after 100 ms. Visual
indication of correct voltage and current phase sequencing is provided through
the relay measurement functions.
Table 17 - Parameters of the Incorrect Phase Sequence Stage: I2>> (47)

Parameter Value/unit Description


Measured I2/I1 % Negative phase sequence current/positive phase sequence
value current
Recorded SCntr Start counter (Start) reading
values
TCntr Trip counter (Trip) reading
Flt % Max. value of fault current
EDly % Elapsed time as compared to the set operate time, 100% =
tripping

Stall Protection Ist> (48) The stall protection (unit Ist>) measures the fundamental frequency
component of the phase currents.

Protection (stage Ist>) can be configured for definite time or inverse time
operation characteristic.

The stall protection stage helps protect the motor against prolonged full voltage
starts caused by a stalled rotor. The pickup setting Ist> is the current detection
level for a motor start, too high of load inertia, or too low of system voltage. This
protection stage is sensitive to the fundamental frequency component of the
phase currents. The Ist> stage can be configured for definite operation time or
inverse-time operation characteristics. For a weak power system voltage, the
inverse characteristic is useful. This characteristic allows more start time when the
voltage drop decreases the starting current, and increases the starting time.
Figure 43 shows an example of the inverse characteristics.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 89


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

If the measured current is less than the specified start current (ISTART ), the
operation time is longer than the specified start time (TSTART ) and vice versa.
While the current has been under 10% of IMOT, and IStart is exceeded by
200 milliseconds. The stall protection stage starts to count the operation time
TSTART according to Equation 3.2 . The equation is also drawn in Figure 43.
When current drops below 120% x IMOT, the stall protection stage releases. Stall
protection is active only during the start of the motor.

Equation 3.2

T =  ----------
I START 2
- T , where
 I MEAS  START

T = Operation time in seconds


ISTART = Start current of the motor. Default 6.00 x IMOT
IMEAS = Measured current during start
TSTART = Maximum allowed start time for the motor

Figure 43 - Operation Time Delay of the Stall Protection Stage Ist>

TIME

TSTART

IstartMin ISTART CURRENT

If the measured current is less than the specified start current ISTART, the
operation time is longer than the specified start time TSTART and vice versa.

90 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Figure 44 - Block Diagram of the Stall Protection Stage Ist>


Im1
&
Im2
Im3
Max > ts tr
Start
Register
& Event
Block
Trip

Register
& Event

Motor Nom. Delay Definite/ Inverse Delay Enable Events


Start Inverse
Current Time

Table 18 - Parameters of the Stall Protection Stage: Ist> (48)

Parameter Value/unit Description


Setting ImotSt xImot Nom motor starting current
values
Ist> %Imot Motor start detection current. Must be less than initial motor
starting current.
Type DT Operation characteristic /definite time
Inv Operation characteristic/ inverse time
tDT> s Operation time [s]
tInv> s Time multiplier at inverse time
Recorded SCntr Start counter (Start) reading
values
TCntr Trip counter (Trip) reading
Flt xImot Max. value of fault.
EDly % Elapsed time as compared to the set operate time, 100% = tripping

Motor Status Motor status is defined internally as Stopped, Starting, or Running.


Motor Stopped The average current for the motor is less than 10% of the Nom current, IMOT.
Motor Starting To achieve this status condition, the motor must be in the Motor Stopped status for at least
500 ms before starting. The motor average current must increase above the setting for start
detection current within 200 ms. This status continues to be reported until the conditions for
the running state are reached.
Motor Running The running status is achieved from the stop or start condition. The low limit for Motor
Running is 20% of the motor nominal current, IMOT. The high limit for Motor Running is 120%
of the motor nominal current, IMOT.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 91


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Figure 45 - Motor Status in SetPointPS Displayed on the Local Panel of the Protection System

The status of the motor can be viewed through the SetPointPS software or by
the MSTAT status display on the Protection System. These motor status
conditions are also found in the Output and Block Matrix. These status signals
can be used for tripping, indication, or for purpose of protection blocking.

Figure 46 - Motor Status in the Output and Block Matrix

Soft Starting

Frequency converter drives and voltage-based soft starters do not initiate the
Motor Starting status due to the lower currents during the starting of the
motor. The motor status changes directly from the Motor Stopped to Motor
Running position when the current increases to a certain level.

Figure 47 - Impact of a Soft Starting Profile

Motor Nominal Current (100%)

RUN

Motor Running Limit (20%)

Motor Stopped Speed Limit (10%)


STOP STOP
Motor Current IL1+IL2+IL3/3

92 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Normal Starting Sequence

The default value for Start Detection is a value of six times the motor Nom
current (6 x IMOT ).

Figure 48 - Normal Start Sequence


Starting

Motor Start Detection (Setting Value)

Motor Running Limit (120%)


Motor Nom Current (100%) Running

Motor Stopped Limit (10%)


STOP
Motor Current IL1+IL2+IL3 / 3

Must be less than 200 ms

The problem with various soft starting methods is the impact to the traditional
full voltage motor starting current profile. This will generally cause the 857 not
to engage the Motor Starting status indication.

As well, the protection settings tend to be done related to a full voltage start
and a normal running level of protection. Thus, an alternative signal is required
to accomplish the blocking during starting.

The most straightforward way is to provide an externally wetted (120…240V


sourced) contact to one of the digital inputs (DI7 through DI18). An Up to
Speed or bypass contactor status contact must be fed to a digital input on the
857. This can be used augment the motor start detection characteristics within
the 857.

In most cases, the soft starters and adjustable speed drives are already providing
good levels of start protection that is based on specific protection algorithms in
their control firmware. In most of these types of applications, the 857 is
providing a level of redundant start protection. However, the 857 can
accommodate these types of applications in several different ways. Many of the
857 protection elements can be adjusted to have multiple programmed
protective conditions if the customer so desires. The user can select from
Group 1 (default) through Group 4 setting by using any one of the digital
inputs as a switching command.

The most effective method is to use one or more control signals to Block select
protection elements during a given condition or state. In this case, a reduce
voltage or variable frequency start.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 93


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

This is accomplished by using the Block Matrix feature. Any protection


function, except arc protection elements, can be blocked with internal control
and/or status signals or via external control signals. Internal and external
elements, conditions or status from items like logic outputs, protective
elements, start and trip signals and external digital and virtual inputs are
constantly monitored by the 857.

Frequent Start Protection The most common way to start an asynchronous motor is to switch the stator
windings to the supply voltages. Each start heats up the motor considerably
N> (66) because the initial currents are higher than the rated current.

If the motor manufacturer defines the maximum number of starts within 1


hour and/or the minimum time between two consecutive starts, this stage
helps prevent frequent starts.

When the motor current has been less than 10% of IMOT and then exceeds
IST>, the situation is recognized as a Start. When the current is less than
10% x IMOT, the motor is regarded as stopped. See Motor Status on page 91
for additional details.

This stage produces a signal when the second last start has been completed. A
trip signal is normally activated and released when there are no starts left.
Figure 49 shows an application.

Figure 49 - Application to Prevent Frequent Starts, Using N> Stage - Breaker Control
The A1 relay has been configured to + +
Normally Closed (NC) and controlled by − −
STOP START
the N> motor start inhibit signal. Open Close
Whenever N> motor start becomes Coil Coil
activated, it stops the circuit breaker from
closing.

M
+

857 Protection System


Output Matrix
T1 A1

I> start
I> trip

N>alarm
N> motor start inhibit

94 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

The Frequent Start Protection must be adapted for use with electrically held
breakers or contactors. This adaption is due to the initiation or trigger point
that is used within the firmware. See Figure 50.

Figure 50 - Application to Prevent Frequent Starts, Using the N> Stage - Contactor Control

120 Vac 0 Vac

857 857
T1 STOP START
A1
CR

CR

The A1 contact, which is shown in Figure 50, is used to block subsequent starts
after the last programmed available start. The A1 contact is mapped to the
“N>motor start inhibition” status signal in the output matrix.

Table 19 - Parameters of the Frequent Start Protection: N> (66)


Parameter Value/unit Description
Measured Mot strs Motor starts in last hour
value
T Min Elapsed time from motor start
Setting values Sts/h Max. starts in 1 hour
Interval Min Min. interval between two consecutive starts
Recorded SCntr Start counter (Start) reading
values
TCntr Trip counter (Trip) reading
Descr 1StartLeft One start that is left, activates the N> start signal
MaxStarts Max. start trip, activates the N> trip signal
Interval Min. interval between two consecutive starts has not yet been
elapsed, activates the N> trip signal
Tot Mot Strs Number of total motor starts
Mot Strs/h Number of motor starts in last hour
El. Time Min Elapsed time from the last motor start
from mot
Strt

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 95


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Undercurrent Protection The undercurrent unit measures the fundamental frequency component of the
phase currents.
I< (37)
The stage I< can be configured for DT characteristic.

The undercurrent stage helps protect the motor driven device, for example a
submersible pump, rather than the motor itself.

Table 20 - Parameters of the Undercurrent Stage: I< (37)


Parameter Value/unit Description
Measured value ILmin A Min. value of phase currents IL1…IL3 in primary value
Setting values I< xImode Setting value as per times Imot
t< S Operation time [s]
Recorded values SCntr Start counter (Start) reading
TCntr Trip counter (Trip) reading
Type 1-N Fault type/single-phase fault, for example, 1-N = fault on
2-N phase L1
3-N
1-2 Fault type/two-phase fault, for example: 2-3 = fault between
2-3 L2 and L3
1-3
1-2-3 Fault type/three-phase fault
Flt % Min. value of fault current as per times Imot
Load % 1s is the mean value of pre-fault currents IL1—IL3
EDly % Elapsed time as compared to the set operate time, 100% =
tripping

Directional Earth-fault The directional earth-fault-protection is used for earth-faults. This protection
is used in networks or motors where a selective and sensitive earth-fault-
Protection I0φ> (67N) protection is needed in applications with network structures and lengths that
vary.

The device consists of versatile protection functions for earth-fault-protection


in various network types.

The function is sensitive to the fundamental frequency component of the


residual current and zero sequence voltage, and the phase angle between them.
The attenuation of the third harmonic is more than 60 dB. When the I0 and
U0 size and the phase angle between I0 and –U0 fulfills the pick-up criteria: the
stage picks up and a start signal is issued. If the fault situation remains on
longer than the setting for operation time delay, a trip signal is issued.

96 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Polarization

The negative zero sequence voltage –U0 is used for polarization, which is the
angle reference for I0. The–U0 voltage can be measured in two ways, by the
energizing input U0 or calculated from the phase voltages internally. The
measurement mode depends on the selected voltage measurement mode (see
Voltage Measurement Mode on page 219):

• LN: the zero sequence voltage is calculated from the phase voltages so
separate zero sequence voltage transformers are not needed. The setting
values are relative to the configured voltage transformer (VT) voltage/
√3.

• LL+U0: The zero sequence voltage is measured with voltage


transformer, for example, fault-protection that uses a broken (open)
delta connection. The setting values are relative to the VT0 secondary
voltage that is defined in the configuration settings.

TIP The U0 signal (X1-17 and X1-18) must be connected according to the
connection diagram (Figure 186 on page 343) to get a correct polarization.
The negative U0, –U0, is connected to the device.

Modes for Different Network Types

The available modes are the following:


• ResCap
This mode consists of two sub modes, Res and Cap. A digital signal can
be used to switch dynamically between these two sub modes. This
feature can be used with compensated networks, when the use of a
Petersen coil or other system is temporarily switched off.
– Res
The stage is sensitive to the resistive component of the selected I0
signal. This mode is used with compensated networks (resonant
grounding) and networks that are earthed with a high resistance. In
this context, “high resistance” means that the earth-fault current is
limited to be less than the rated phase current. Compensation is done
with a Petersen coil or grounded resistor between the neutral point of
the main transformer and earth. The trip area is a half plane as shown
in Figure 52. The base angle is set to zero degrees.
– Cap
The stage is sensitive to the capacitive component of the selected I0
signal. This mode is used with unearthed/ungrounded networks.
The trip area is a half plane as shown in Figure 52. The base angle is
set to zero degrees.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 97


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

• Sector
This mode is used with networks that are earthed with a small/low
resistance. In this context “small” means that the earth-fault current can
be more than the rated phase currents. The trip area has a shape of a
sector as shown in Figure 53. The base angle is set to zero degrees or
slightly on the lagging inductive side (that is negative angle).
• Undir
This mode makes the stage equal to the undirectional stage I0>. The
phase angle and U0 amplitude setting are discarded. Only the amplitude
of the selected I0 input is supervised.

Input Signal Selection

Each stage can be connected to supervise any of these inputs and signals:
• Input I01 for all networks other than rigidly earthed.
• Input I02 for all networks other than rigidly earthed.
• Calculated signal I0Calc for rigidly and low impedance earthed
networks. I0Calc = IL1 + IL2 + IL3 = 3I0.

Intermittent Earth-fault Detection

Intermittent earth-faults make the protection to “start” (to pick up), but does
not cause a trip. Here an intermittent fault means one cycle or more. For
shorter than 1-ms transient type of intermittent earth-faults in compensated
networks, there is a dedicated stage I0int> 67NI. When starting happens with
enough frequency, such intermittent faults can be cleared using the
intermittent time setting. When a new “start” happens within the set
intermittent time, the operation delay counter is not cleared between adjacent
faults and finally the stage trips.

Two Independent Stages

There are two separately adjustable stages: Iφ> and Iφ>>. Both the stages can be
configured for definite time (DT) delay or inverse time delay operation.

Inverse Operation Time

Inverse delay means that the operation time depends on the amount the
measured current exceeds the pick-up setting. The bigger the fault current is
the faster the operation. Accomplished inverse delays are available for both
stages I0φ> and I0φ>>. The inverse delay types are described in Inverse Time
Operation on page 157. The device shows a scalable graph of the configured
delay on the local panel display.

98 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Inverse Time Limitation

The maximum measured secondary residual current is 10 x I0N and maximum


measured phase current is 50 x IN. This setting limits the scope of inverse
curves with high pick-up settings. See Inverse Time Operation on page 157 for
more information.

Setting Groups

There are two settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs, virtual
inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to switch
between setting groups.

Figure 51 - Block Diagram of the Directional Earth-fault Stages I0φ> and I0φ>>

Io Isinφ
Start
Icosφ
Register
Block Event

Uo Trip
t

Register
Event

Choice Setting Setting Delay Enable Events


Icosφ(res)/ Iφ>s I/O>s
Isinφ(Cap)

Figure 52 - Operation Characteristic of the Directional Earth-fault-protection in Res or Cap


Mode
Res mode can be used with
compensated networks
and Cap mode is used with
ungrounded networks.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 99


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Figure 53 - Examples of Operation Characteristics of the Directional Earth-fault Stages in


Sector Mode

TIP The drawn I0 phasor in both figures is inside the trip area.
The angle offset and half sector size are parameters that are user-defined.

Table 21 - Parameters of the Directional Earth-fault Stages I0φ>, I0φ>> (67N)

Parameter Value Unit Description Note


Status - Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F(1)
Trip F(1)
TripTime s Estimated time to trip
SCntr Cumulative start counter C(2)
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C(2)
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group Set(3)
SGrpDI Digital signal to select the active setting group: Set(3)
- None
DIx Digital input
VIx Virtual input
LEDx Status indicator signal
VOx Virtual output
Force Off Force flag for status forcing for test purposes. A common Set(3)
On flag for all stages and output relays, too. Automatically
reset by a 5-minute timeout.
Io pu The supervised value according to the parameter “Input”.
Io2
IoCalc
IoPeak (I0φ> only)
Io2Peak (I0φ> only)
IoRes pu Resistive part of I0 (only when “InUse”=Res)
IoCap pu Capacitive part of I0 (only when “InUse”=Cap)
I0φ> A Pick-up value that is scaled to primary value
I0φ> pu Pick-up setting relative to the parameter “Input” and the Set(3)
corresponding CT value
Uo> % Pick-up setting for U0 Set(3)
Uo % Measured U0

100 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Table 21 - Parameters of the Directional Earth-fault Stages I0φ>, I0φ>> (67N) (Continued)

Parameter Value Unit Description Note


Curve Delay curve family: Set (3)
DT Definite time
IEC Inverse time. See Inverse Time Operation on page 157.
IEEE
IEEE2
RI
PrgN
Type Delay type: Set(3)
DT Definite time
NI Inverse time. See Inverse Time Operation on page 157.
VI
EI
LTI
Parameters
t> s Definite operation time (for Definite Time only) Set(3)
k> Inverse delay multiplier (for inverse time only) Set(3)
Mode ResCap High impedance earthed nets Set(3)
Sector Low impedance earthed nets
Undir Undirectional mode
Offset ? Angle offset (MTA) for RecCap and Sector modes Set(3)
Sector Default = 88 ±° Half sector size of the trip area on both sides of the offset Set(3)
angle
ChCtrl Res/Cap control in mode ResCap: Set(3)
Res Fixed to Resistive characteristic
Cap Fixed to Capacitive characteristic
DI1…32 Controlled by digital input
VI1…4 Controlled by virtual input
InUse Selected submode in mode ResCap:
- Mode is not ResCap
Res Submode = resistive
Cap Submode = capacitive
Input Io1 X6-7, 8, 9.X1-7 and 8. See Applications on page 309. Set(3)
Io2 X6-10, 11, 12
IoCalc IL1 + IL2 + IL3
Io1Peak X6-7, 8, 9 peak mode (I0ϕ> only)
Io2Peak X6-10, 11, 12 peak mode (I0φ> only)
Intrmt s Intermittent time Set(3)
Dly20x s Delay at 20xIoset
Dly4x s Delay at 4xIoset
Dly2x s Delay at 2xIoset
Dly1x s Delay at 1xIoset
A, B, C, D, E User-defined constants for standard equations. Type = Set(3)
parameters. See Inverse Time Operation on page 157.
(1) F = Editable when force flag is on.
(2) C = Can be cleared to zero.
(3) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

For details on setting ranges, see Protection Stages on page 353.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 101


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults

There is detailed information available of the eight latest earth-faults: Time


stamp, fault current, elapsed delay, and setting group.

Table 22 - Recorded Values of Directional Earth-fault Stages (Eight Latest Faults)


I0φ>, I0φ>> (67N)

Parameter Value Unit Description


yyyy-mm-dd Time stamp of the recording, date
hh:mm:ss:ms Time stamp, time of day
Flt pu Maximum earth-fault current
EDly % Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% = trip
Angle ? Fault angle of I0. –U0 = 0°
Uo % Max. U0 voltage during the fault
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group during fault

Table 23 - Directional Phase Overcurrent Iφ> (67)


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Iφ>, Iφ>> xImode Pick-up value that is scaled to primary value
Iφ>, Iφ>> Pick-up setting Set(1)
Curve Delay curve family: Set(1)
DT Definite time
IEC, IEEE, Inverse time. See Inverse Time Operation on page 157.
IEEE2, RI,
PrgN
Type Delay type Set(1)
DT Definite time
NI, VI, EI, Inverse time. See Inverse Time Operation on page 157.
LTI,
Parameters
t> k> s Definite operation time (for Definite Time only) Set(1)
Dly20x Inverse delay multiplier (for inverse time only) Set(1)
Dly4x s Delay at 20xImode
Dly2x s Delay at 4xImode
Dly1x s Delay at 2xImode
Mode s Delay at 1xImode
Dir Directional mode (67) Set(1)
Undir Undirectional (50/51)
Dir+back- Directional and undirectional back-up
up
Offset Angle offset in degrees
U/I angle Measured U1/I1 angle
U1 Measured positive sequence voltage
A, B, C, D, E User-defined constants for standard equations. Set(1)
Type=Parameters. See Inverse Time Operation on
page 157.
(1) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

102 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Table 24 - Parameters of the Directional Overcurrent Stages Iφ>>>, Iφ>>>> (67)

Parameter Value Unit Description Note


Status Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F(1)
Trip F(1)
SCntr Cumulative start counter C(2)
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C(2)
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group Set(3)
SgrpDI Digital signal to select the active setting group Set(3)
-Dix None
Vix Digital input
LEDx Virtual input
Vox Status Indicator indicator signal
Off Virtual output
Force On Force flag for status forcing for test purposes. A common Set(3)
flag for all stages and output relays, too.
Automatically reset by a 5-minute timeout.
ILmax A The supervised value. Max. of IL1, IL2, and IL3
Iφ>>>> A Pick-up value that is scaled to primary value
Iφ>>>>
Iφ>>>> xlmode Pick-up setting Set(3)
Iφ>>>>
t>>> s Definite operation time (for Definite Time only Set(3)
t>>> Dir
Mode Directional (67) Set(3)
Undir Undirectional (50/51)
Dir+back- Directional and undirectional back-up
up
Offset ° Angle offset in degrees Set(3)
U/I angle ° Measured U1/I1 angle
U1 % Un Measured positive sequence voltage
(1) F = Editable when force flag is on. For details of setting ranges, see Chapter 12.3 Protection functions.
(2) C = Can be cleared to zero.
(3) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 103


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults

There is detailed information available of the eight latest faults: Time stamp,
fault type, fault current, load current before the fault, elapsed delay, and setting
group.

Table 25 - Recorded Values of the Directional Overcurrent Stages (8 Latest Faults)


Iφ>, Iφ>>, Iφ>>>, Iφ>>>> (67)

Parameter Value Unit Description


yyyy-mm-dd Time stamp of the recording, date
hh:mm:ss:ms Time stamp, time of day
Type Fault type
1-N Ground fault
2-N Ground fault
3-N Ground fault
1-2 Two-phase fault
2-3 Two-phase fault
3-1 Two-phase fault
1-2-3 Three-phase fault
1-2-N Two-phase fault with earth contact
2-3-N Two-phase fault with earth contact
3-1-N Two-phase fault with earth contact
1-2-3-N Three-phase fault with earth contact
Flt xln Maximum fault current
Load xln 1-s average phase currents before the fault
EDly % Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% = trip
Angle ° Fault angle in degrees
U1 xUn Positive sequence voltage during fault
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group during fault
Direction Dir, undir, and dir+back-up
mode

104 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Earth-fault Phase Detection A faulty phase is initially recognized when a zero sequence overcurrent is
detected. The faulted phase or phases are detected in a two stage system:
Algorithm
1. Algorithm is using delta principle to detect the faulty phase/phases.
2. Algorithm confirms the faulty phase with neutral current angle
comparison to the suspected faulted phase.

On an Ideal Grounded Network

If there is a forward earth-fault in phase L1, its current increases to create calculated
or measured zero sequence current at phase angle of 0°. If there is reverse earth-
fault in phase L1, its current decreases to create calculated or measured zero
sequence current at a phase angle of 180°.

If there is forward earth-fault in phase L2, its current increases to create calculated
or measured zero sequence current at phase angle of -120°. If there is reverse
earth-fault in phase L2, its current decreases to create calculated or measured zero
sequence current at a phase angle of 60°.

If there is a forward earth-fault in phase L3, its current increases to create


calculated or measured zero sequence current. In phase current decreases to
create calculated or measured zero sequence current at a phase angle of -60°.

Implementation

When a faulty phase is recognized, it is recorded in the 50-N protection element


fault log (also in event list and alarm screen). To enable or disable the faulted
phase and the direction record function, use the Io>>, Io>>>, and Io>>>>
protection stage settings.

For compensated ground networks, the results of this algorithm are not
accurate or reliable. The algorithm depends on the network compensation
degree. For compensated networks, turn off this feature to avoid confusion or
false indications.

For high impedance earthed networks, the protection element includes a pull-
down menu in both setting groups. To permit the selection of grounding
network between RES or CAP. The RES selection is default selection and it is
for earthed networks. When the CAP selection is used, the I/O angle will be
corrected to the inductive direction of 90°. After that, the faulty phase detection is
made.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 105


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

The possible detection, identification, and associated details for each condition
are listed in Table 26.
Table 26 - Earth-fault Phase Conditions
Condition Identification and Associated Details
FWD L1 Phase L1 increases above the set limit and two other phases remain inside the set (delta)
limit. The I/O current angle is +/- 60° from L1 phase angle.
FDW L2 Phase L2 increases above the set limit and two other phases remain inside the set (delta)
limit. The I/O current angle is +/- 60° from L2 phase angle.
FDW L3 Phase L3 increases above the set limit and two other phases remain inside the set (delta)
limit. The I/O current angle is +/- 60° from L3 phase angle.
FWD L1-L2 Phase L1 and L2 increase above the set limit and phase L3 remains inside the set (delta)
limit. The I/O current angle is between L1 and L2 phase angles.
FWD L2-L3 Phase L2 and L3 increase above the set limit and phase L1 remains inside the set (delta)
limit. The I/O current angle is between L2 and L3 phase angles.
FWD L3-L1 Phase L3 and L1 increase above the set limit and phase L2 remains inside the set (delta)
limit. The I/O current angle is between L3 and L3 phase angles.
FWD L1-L2-L3 All three phase currents increase above the set delta limit.
REV 1 (any one phase) One phase decreases below the set delta limit and other two phases remain inside the
delta limit.
REV 2 (any two phases) Two phases decrease below the set delta limit and third phase remains inside the delta
limit.
REV 3 (all three phases) All three phase currents decrease below the set delta limit.

Figure 54 … Figure 56 illustrates three simulated fault scenarios.

Figure 54 - Phase L1 Forward

Figure 55 - Phase L2 Forward

Figure 56 - Phase L3 Forward

106 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Earth-fault-protection I0> Undirectional earth-fault-protection is used to detect earth-faults in low


impedance earthed networks. In high impedance earthed networks,
(50N/51N),(50G/51G), compensated networks, and isolated networks, undirectional earth-fault can be
(50GS/51GS) used as back-up protection.

The undirectional earth-fault function is sensitive to the fundamental


frequency component of the residual current 3I0. The attenuation of the third
harmonic is more than 60 dB. Whenever this fundamental value exceeds the
pick-up setting of a particular stage, this stage picks up and a start signal is
issued. If the fault situation remains longer than the operation time-delay
setting, a trip signal is issued.

Figure 57 - Block Diagram of the Earth-fault Stage I0>

Start
Io
ts tr Register
Block Event

Trip

Register
Event

Setting Io>s Delay Definite/ Multiplier Enable Events


Inverse
Time Inverse
Time
Characteristics

Figure 58 - Block Diagram of the Earth-fault Stages I0>>, I0>>>, and I0>>>>

Start
Io
ts tr
Register
Block Event

Trip

Register
Event

Setting Io>>s Delay Enable Events

Figure 57 shows a functional block diagram of the I0> earth overcurrent stage
with definite and inverse time operation. Figure 58 shows a functional block
diagram of the I0>>, I0>>>, and I0>>>> earth-fault stages with Definite
Time operation delay. This element can be configured to provide 50/51 G, GS
and N protection, depending on configuration.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 107


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Input Signal Selection

Each stage can be connected to supervise any of these inputs and signals:
• Input I01 for all networks other than rigidly earthed.
• Input I02 for all networks other than rigidly earthed.
• Calculated signal I0Calc for rigidly and low impedance earthed networks
I0Calc = IL1 + IL2 + IL3.

Intermittent Earth-fault Detection

Intermittent earth-faults cause protection to start, but does not cause a trip.
Here, a short fault means one cycle or more. For transient types of intermittent
earth-faults (shorter than 1 ms) in compensated networks, use a dedicated
stage Iot> 67NT. When engagement happens enough times, such intermittent
faults can be cleared using the intermittent time setting. When a new
engagement happens within the set intermittent time, the operation delay
counter is not cleared between adjacent faults and finally the stage trips.

By using I01 peak OR I02 peak, a 1-ms current peak is enough to start the stage
and increase the delay counter by 20 ms. For example, if the operating time is
120 ms. And the time between two peaks does not exceed the intermittent
time setting, the six peaks would initiate a trip.

Four or Six Independent Undirectional Earth-fault Overcurrent


Stages
There are four separately adjustable earth-fault stages: I0>, I0>>, I0>>>, and
I0>>>>. The first stage I0> can be configured for Definite Time (DT) or
inverse-time operation characteristic (IDMT). The other stages have DT
operation characteristic. By using the definite delay type and setting the delay
to its minimum, an instantaneous (ANSI 50) operation is obtained.

When using the directional earth-fault stages (Chapter 10) in undirectional


mode, two or more stages with inverse-time operation delay are available for
undirectional earth-fault-protection.

Inverse Operation Time (I0> Stage only)

Inverse delay means that the operation time depends on the amount the
measured current exceeds the pick-up setting. The bigger the fault current is,
the faster the operation. Accomplished inverse delays are available for the I0>
stage. The inverse delay types are described under Inverse Time Operation on
page 157. The Protection System shows a scalable graph of the configured
delay on the local panel display.

108 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Inverse Time Limitation

The scope of inverse curves with high pick-up settings is limited by:
• The maximum the measured secondary residual current 10 x I0N, and
• The maximum measured phase current 50 x IN

See Inverse Time Operation on page 157 for more information.

Setting Groups

There are two settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs, virtual
inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to switch
between setting groups.
Table 27 - Parameters of the Undirectional Earth-fault Stage I0> (50N/51N)(1)

Parameter Value Unit Description Note


Status - Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F(2)
Trip F(2)
TripTime s Estimated time to trip
SCntr Cumulative start counter C(3)
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C(3)
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group Set(4)
Set
SGrpDI Digital signal to select the active setting group: Set(4)
- None
DIx Digital input
VIx Virtual input
LEDx Status indicator signal
VOx Virtual output
Force Off Force flag for status for test purposes. A common flag for all Set(4)
On stages and output relays. Automatically reset by a 5-minute
timeout.
Io pu The supervised value according to the parameter “Input”.
Io2
IoCalc
IoPeak
Io2Peak
I’oCalc
Io> A Pick-up value that is scaled to primary value
Io> pu Pick-up setting relative to the parameter “Input” and the Set(4)
corresponding CT value

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 109


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Table 27 - Parameters of the Undirectional Earth-fault Stage I0> (50N/51N)(1) (Continued)

Parameter Value Unit Description Note


Curve Delay curve family: Set (4)
DT Definite time
IEC Inverse time. See Local Panel User Interface on page 27.
IEEE
IEEE2
RI
PrgN
Type Delay type: Set(4)
DT Definite time
NI Inverse time. See Local Panel User Interface on page 27.
VI
EI
LTI
Paramete
rs
t> s Definite operation time (for Definite Time only) Set(4)
k> Inverse delay multiplier (for inverse time only) Set(4)
Input Io1 X1-7 and 8. See Applications on page 309. Set(4)
Io2 X1-9 and 10
IoCalc IL1 + IL2 + IL3
Io1Peak X1-7 and 8 peak mode
Io2Peak X1-9 and 10 peak mode
I’oCalc I’L1 + I’L2 + I’L3
Intrmt s Intermittent time Set(4)
Dly20x s Delay at 20xIset
Dly4x s Delay at 4xIset
Dly2x s Delay at 2xIset
Dly1x s Delay at 1xIset
A, B, C, D, E User-defined constants for standard equations. Type = Set(4)
parameters.
See Local Panel User Interface on page 27.
(1) Provides 50/51 G, GS, and N protection depending on configuration
(2) F = Editable when force flag is on
(3) C = Can be cleared to zero.
(4) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

For details on setting ranges, see Connections on page 323.


Table 28 - Parameters of the Undirectional Earth-fault Stage I0>>, I0>>>, I0>>>>
(50N/51N)(1)
Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Status - Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F(2)
Trip F(2)
TripTime s Estimated time to trip
SCntr Cumulative start counter C(3)
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C(3)

110 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Table 28 - Parameters of the Undirectional Earth-fault Stage I0>>, I0>>>, I0>>>>


(50N/51N)(1) (Continued)
Parameter Value Unit Description Note
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group Set(4)
Set
SGrpDI Digital signal to select the active setting group: Set(3)
- None
DIx Digital input
VIx Virtual input
LEDx Status indicator signal
VOx Virtual output
Force Off Force flag for status forcing for test purposes. A common flag for Set(3)
On all stages and output relays, too. Automatically reset by a 5-
minute timeout.
Io pu The supervised value according to the parameter “Input”.
Io2
IoCalc
Io>> A Pick-up value that is scaled to primary value
Io>>>
Io>>>>
Io>> pu Pick-up setting relative to the parameter “Input” and the Set(3)
Io>>> corresponding CT value
Io>>>>
t> s Definite operation time (for Definite Time only) Set(3)
Input Io1 X1-7 and 8. See Connections on page 323. Set (3)
Io2 X1-9 and 10
IoCalc IL1 + IL2 + IL3
I’oCalc I’L1 + I’L2 + I’L3
(1) Provides 50/51 G, GS, and N protection depending on configuration
(2) F = Editable when force flag is on
(3) C = Can be cleared to zero.
(4) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

For details on setting ranges, see Protection Stages on page 353.

Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults

Detailed information is available on the eight latest earth-faults: Time stamp,


fault current, elapsed delay, and setting group.

Table 29 - Parameters of the Undirectional Earth-fault Stages (Eight Latest Faults)


I0>, I0>>, I0>>>, I0>>>> (50N/51N)

Parameter Value Unit Description


yyyy-mm-dd Time stamp of the recording, date
hh:mm:ss:ms Time stamp, time of day
Flt pu Maximum earth-fault current
EDly % Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% = trip
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group during the fault

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 111


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Directional Transient
Intermittent Earth-fault- TIP This function is available only in voltage measurement modes. The modes
include direct -U0 measurement, for example, 2ULL+U0, but not, for
protection I0int> (67NI) example, in mode 3ULN. See Voltage Measurement Mode on
page 219.

The directional intermittent transient earth-fault-protection is used to detect


short intermittent transient faults in compensated cable networks. The
transient faults are self-extinguished at some zero crossing of the transient part
of the fault current IFault. The fault duration is typically only 0.1…1 ms.
Normal directional earth-fault function, by using only the fundamental
frequency components of I0 and U0, cannot recognize such short duration
faults.

Although a transient fault usually self-extinguishes within less than 1 ms, in


most cases a new fault happens when the phase-to-earth voltage of the faulty
phase has recovered (Figure 59).

Figure 59 - Typical Phase to Earth Voltages


Residual current of the
faulty feeder and the zero
sequence voltage U0 during
two transient earth-faults in
phase L1. In this case, the
network is compensated.

Time (ms)

Direction Algorithm

The function is sensitive to the instantaneous sampled values of the residual


current and residual voltage. The selected voltage measurement mode must
include a direct –U0 measurement.

I0 Pick-up Sensitivity

The sampling time interval of the relay is 625 µs at 50 Hz/520 µs at 60 Hz


(32 samples/cycle). The I0 current spikes can be short compared to this
sampling interval. Fortunately, the current spikes in cable networks are high.

112 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

While the anti-alias filter of the relay attenuates the amplitude, the filter also
makes the pulses wider. When the current pulses are high enough, it is possible
to detect pulses, which have duration of >20% of the sampling interval.
Although the measured amplitude can be only a fraction of the actual peak
amplitude. It does not disturb the direction detection. The algorithm is more
sensitive to the sign and the timing of the I0 transient than sensitive to the
absolute amplitude of the transient. Thus a fixed value is used as a pickup level
for the I0.

Co-ordination with U0> Backup Protection

In a fully compensated situation, the zero sequence voltage back up protection


stage U0> for the bus cannot release between consecutive faults. The U0> can
do an unselective trip if the intermittent transient stage I0INT> doesn’t operate
fast enough. The actual operation time of the I0INT> stage is dependent on the
behavior of the fault and the intermittent time setting. The co-ordination
between U0> and I0INT> is simple. The start signal of the transient stage
I0INT> in an outgoing feeder can be used to block the U0> backup protection.

Co-ordination with the Normal Directional Earth-fault-protection


Based on Fundamental Frequency Signals, the intermittent transient earth-
fault-protection stage I0INT> must be used together with the normal
directional earth-fault-protection stages Iφ>, Iφ>>. The transient stage
I0INT> can (in worst case) detect the start of a steady earth-fault in the wrong
direction, but will not trip. The peak value of a steady state sine-wave I0 signal
must also exceed the corresponding base frequency component peak-value to
make the I0INT> trip.

The operation time of the transient stage I0INT> must be lower than the
settings of any directional earth-fault-stage. This setting avoids any unnecessary
trip from the Iφ>, Iφ>> stages. The start signals from the I0INT> stage can also
be used to block Iφ>, Iφ>> stages of parallel functions.

Auto Reclosing

The start signal of any Iφ> stage initiating auto-reclosing (AR) can be used to
block the I0INT> stage. This AR avoids the I0INT> stage with a long
intermittent setting, from interfering with the AR cycle in the middle of
discrimination time.

Usually the I0INT> stage itself is not used to initiate any AR. For transient
faults, the AR does not help because the fault phenomenon includes repeated
self-extinguishing.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 113


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Intermittent Time

Single transient-faults make the protection pick up, but does not cause a trip if
the stage has time to release between to successive faults. When starting
happens enough times, such intermittent faults can be cleared using the
intermittent time setting.

When a new fault happens within the set intermittent time, the operation
delay counter is not cleared between adjacent faults and finally the stage trips.
One transient fault is enough to start the stage and increase the delay counter
by 20 ms. For example, if operating time is 140 ms. And the intermittent time
setting between two peaks is not exceeded, then the seventh peak (in a 50-Hz
system) causes a trip (Figure 63).

Peak Amount Counter, Operation Time, and Intermittent Time


Coordination

Algorithm has three independently settable parameters: operation delay,


required amount of peaks and intermittent time. All requirements must be
satisfied before the stage issues a trip signal. There is a settable reset delay that
makes sure the stage does not release before the circuit breaker has operated.
The setting range for the required number of peaks is 1…20 and for operational
delay is 0.04…300 s. Reset delay setting range is 0.06…300 s. Intermittent time
setting is 0.00…300 s.

If the setting for the following has the:


• Peak is set to 2.
• Operation delay is set to 160 ms.
• Intermittent time is set to 200 ms.

The function starts operation delay calculation from the first peak. After the
second peak, in 80 ms the peak amount criteria is satisfied. At 160 ms, full-
operation time criteria is satisfied and the stage issues trip (Figure 60).

If the second peak does not come before the operational delay becomes full, the
stage is released after intermittent time has come full. But if the second peak
comes after operation time has come full but still inside intermittent time then
a trip is issued instantly (Figure 61).

If intermittent time comes full before operation delay comes full, the stage is
released (Figure 62). There are limitations to avoid incorrect settings. The
Algorithm assumes that peaks cannot come more often than 10 ms. If peak
amount is set to 10, then operation delay does not accept value less than
100 ms. If operational delay is set to 40 ms, it is not possible to set a higher peak
amount setting than 4. This setting prohibits the usage of settings that can
never be satisfied.

114 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Figure 60 - Stage Issues a Trip.

Intermittent Time: 0.2 s

Operation Time = 0.16 s Reset Delay = 0.1 s


TRIP
Setting for Minimum Number of Peaks = 2
Time

Figure 61 - Stage Issues Instant Trip

Intermittent Time: 0.2 s


Intermittent Time

Operation time = 0.16 s Reset Delay = 0.1 s


TRIP Setting for Minimum Number of Peaks = 3

Time

Figure 62 - Stage Is Released

Intermittent Time: 0.2 s


Intermittent Time
Operation Time = 0.16 s
TRIP Setting for Minimum Number of Peaks = 2 NO TRIP

Time

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 115


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Setting Groups

There are two settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs, virtual
inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to switch
between setting groups.

Figure 63 - Block Diagram of the Directional Intermittent Transient Earth-fault Stage I0int>

I0 samples
I0 Start
I0 peak
TRANSIENT
ALGORITHM Register
Event
I0 fundamental DIV
freq. amplitude
U0 samples COUNTER
U0 Trip
CLEAR
U0 fundamental
Register
freq. amplitude Event
TOP
Block

Setting, Setting, Enable


Setting, Delay Intermittent Events
Uo pickup n - delay/20 ms Time

Table 30 - Parameters of Directional Intermittent Transient Earth Fault Stage I0int> (67NI)

Parameter Value Unit Description Note


Status - Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F(1)
Trip F(1)
SCntr Cumulative start counter C(2)
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C(2)
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group Set(3)
SGrpDI Digital signal to select the active setting group: Set(3)
- None
DIx Digital input
VIx Virtual input
LEDx Status indicator signal
VOx Virtual output
Force Off Force flag for status forcing for test purposes. A common flag Set(3)
On for all stages and output relays, too. Automatically reset after a
5-minute timeout.
Io1 pu The detected I0 value according to the parameter “Input”.
Io2
Uo % The measured U0 value. U0N = 100%
Uo> % U0 pickup level. U0N = 100% Set(3)

116 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Table 30 - Parameters of Directional Intermittent Transient Earth Fault Stage I0int> (67NI)

Parameter Value Unit Description Note


t> s Operation time. Actually the number of cycles including faults x Set(3)
20 ms. When the time between faults exceeds 20 ms, the
actual operation time is longer.
Io input Io1Peak I01 Connectors X1-7 and 8 Set(3)
Io2Peak I02 Connectors X1-9 and 10
Intrmt s Intermittent time. When the next fault occurs within this time, Set(3)
the delay counting continues from the previous value.
(1) F = Editable when force flag is on.
(2) C = Can be cleared to zero.
(3) Set =An editable parameter (password required).

For details on setting ranges, see Protection Stages on page 353.

Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults

There is detailed information available of the eight latest detected faults: Time
stamp, U0 voltage, elapsed delay, and setting group.

Table 31 - Recorded Values of the Directional Intermittent Transient Earth-fault Stage


(Eight Latest Faults) I0int> (67NI)

Parameter Value Unit Description


yyyy-mm-dd Time stamp of the recording, date
hh:mm:ss:ms Time stamp, time of day
Flt pu Maximum detected earth-fault current
EDly % Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% = trip
Uo % Max. U0 voltage during the fault
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group during fault

Capacitor Bank Unbalance The versatile capacitor, filter, and reactor bank protection can be enabled with
five current measurement inputs. The fifth input is useful for unbalance
Protection (50NC/51NC) current measurement of a double wye connected unearthed bank. The
unbalance protection is highly sensitive to internal faults of a bank because of
the natural unbalance compensation. The location method gives the
protection a new dimension and enables easy maintenance monitoring for a
bank.

This protection scheme is used in double wye connected capacitor banks. The
unbalance current is measured with a dedicated current transformer (could be
like 5A/5A) between two startpoints of the bank. System unbalance does not
affect the unbalance current. However, due to manufactured tolerances, some
amount of natural unbalance current exists between the startpoints. This
natural unbalance current affects the settings, so the setting must be increased.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 117


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Figure 64 - Typical, Capacitor Bank Protection Application with the 857 Protection System
L1

L2

L3

X1:1
857
X1:2 IL1 T1
X1:3
X1:4 IL2
X1:5
X1:6 IL3
X1:7
X1:8 I01

X1:9
I02
X1:10

VAMP 255

118 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Compensation Method

The method for unbalance protection is to compensate the natural unbalance


current. The compensation is triggered manually when commissioning. The
phasors of the unbalance current and one phase current are recorded, because
one polarizing measurement is needed. When the phasor of the unbalance
current is related to IL1, the frequency changes or deviations have no effect on
the protection.

After recording, the measured unbalance current corresponds the zero-level so


the setting of the stage can be sensitive.

Compensation and Location


The most sophisticated method is to use the same compensation method as
previously mentioned. The add-on feature is to locate the branch of each
broken fuse.

This feature is implemented to the stage I0>>>>, while the other stage I0>>>
can still function as a normal unbalance protection-stage with compensation
method. Normally, the I0>>>> could be set as an alarming stage while stage
I0>>> trips the circuit-breaker.

Set the stage I0>>>> based on the calculated unbalance current change of one
faulty element. The calculated setting must be approximately 10% smaller than
the calculated value. There are tolerances in the primary equipment and in the
Protection System measurement circuit. The time setting of I0>>>> is not
used for tripping. The time setting specifies, how long the device must wait
until it is certain that there is a faulty element in the bank. After this time has
elapsed, the stage I0>>>> makes a new compensation automatically, and the
measured unbalance current for this stage is now zero.

IMPORTANT The automatic compensation does not effect on the measured unbalance
current of stage I0>>>.

When an element failure in the bank occurs, the algorithm checks the phase
angle of the unbalance current. This check is related to the phase angle of the
phase current IL1. Based on this angle, the algorithm can increase the
corresponding faulty elements counter (there are six counters).

Set for the stage I0>>>> to the allowed number of faulty elements. For
example if set to three elements, the fourth fault element issues the trip signal.

The fault location is used with internal fused capacitor and filter banks. There
is no need to use it with fuseless or external fused capacitor and filter banks,
nor with the reactor banks.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 119


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Table 32 - Setting Parameters of Capacitor Bank Unbalance Protection:


I0>>>, I0>>>> (50N/51N)

Parameter Value Unit Default Description


Input Io1 - Io2 Current measurement input.
Io2 Do not use the calculated value, which is only for
IoCalc earth-fault-protection purposes

Io>>> 0.01…8.00 0.10 (Io>>>) Setting value


(Input Io1, Io2)
Io>>>> 0.01…20.0 pu 0.20
(Input IoCalc) (Io>>>>)

t> 0.08…300.00 s 0.50 (Io>>>) Definite operating time


1.00
(Io>>>>)
CMode Off; On (Io>>>) - Off Compensation selection
Off; Normal
Location
(Io>>>>)
SaveBa - - - Trig the phasor recording
Get
SetBal 0.010…3.000 pu 0.050 Compensation level
S_On On - On Start on event
Off
S_Off On - On Start off event
Off
T_On On - On Trip on event
Off
T_Off On - On Trip off event
Off
DIoSav On - Off Recording triggered event
Off
DIoSav On - Off Recording ended event
Off

Table 33 - Measured and Recorded Values of Capacitor Bank Unbalance Protection:


I02>, I02>> (50N/51N)
Parameter Value Unit Default Description
Measured Io Pu Unbalance current (including the natural
values unbalance current)
dIo A Compensated unbalance current
Display Io>>> A Setting value
Io>>>>
Recorded values SCntr - Cumulative start counter
TCntr - Cumulative trip counter
Flt pu The max. fault value
EDly % Elapsed time as compared to the set operating
time; 100% = tripping
Isaved A Recorded natural unbalance current
SavedA deg Recorded phase angle of natural unbalance
current

120 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Table 33 - Measured and Recorded Values of Capacitor Bank Unbalance Protection:


I02>, I02>> (50N/51N) (Continued)
Parameter Value Unit Default Description
Recorded values Faults (Io>>>> - Allowed number of element failures
only)
Total (Io>>>> - Actual number of element failures in the bank
only)

Clear (Io>>>> - - Clear the element counters


only) Clear
L1-B1 (Io>>>> - Number of element failures in phase L1 in
only) branch 1 (left side)
L1-B2 (Io>>>> - Number of element failures in phase L1 in
only) branch 2 (right side)
L2-B1 (Io>>>> - Number of element failures in phase L2 in
only) branch 1 (left side)
L2-B2 (Io>>>> - Number of element failures in phase L2 in
only) branch 2 (right side)
L3-B1 (Io>>>> - Number of element failures in phase L3 in
only) branch 1 (left side)
L3-B2 (Io>>>> - Number of element failures in phase L3 in
only) branch 2 (right side)
Locat (Io>>>> - Changed unbalance current (after automatic
only) compensation)
LocAng - Changed phase angle of the unbalance current
(Io>>>> only) (after automatic compensation)

Zero Sequence Voltage The zero sequence voltage protection is used as unselective backup for earth-
faults. And for selective earth-fault-protections for motors having a unit
Protection U0>, U0>>(59N) transformer between the motor and the busbar.

This function is sensitive to the fundamental frequency component of the zero


sequence voltage. The attenuation of the third harmonic is more than 60 dB.
3n harmonics exist between the neutral point and earth also when there is no
earth-fault.

When the measured value exceeds the pick-up setting of a particular stage, this
stage picks up and a start signal is issued. If the fault situation remains on
longer than the setting for the operation time delay, a trip signal is issued.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 121


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Measure Residual Voltage

The zero sequence voltage can be measured with three voltage transformers,
one voltage transformer between the neutral point of the motor and earth. Or
calculated from the measured phase-to-neutral voltages according to the
selected voltage measurement mode (see Voltage Measurement Mode on
page 219):
• Phase: the zero sequence voltage is calculated from the phase voltages a
separate zero sequence voltage transformer is not needed. The setting
values are relative to the configured voltage transformer (VT) voltage/
√3.
• Line + U0: The zero sequence voltage is measured with voltage
transformer, for example with a broken delta connection. The setting
values are relative to the VT0 secondary voltage defined in
configuration.

TIP The U0 signal must be connected according to the connection diagram


(Figure 186 on page 343) to get a correct polarization. Connect –U0 to the
device.

Two Independent Stages

There are two separately adjustable stages: U0> and U0>>. Both stages can be
configured for Definite Time operation characteristic. The zero sequence
voltage function comprises two separately adjustable zero sequence voltage
stages (stage U0> and U0>>).

Setting Groups

Each stage has four settings groups. Use digital and virtual inputs (mimic
display, communication, logic), and manual control to switch between setting
groups.

Figure 65 - Block Diagram of the Zero Sequence Voltage Stages U0> and U0>>

Start
Uo
ts tr
Register
Blocking Event

Trip

Register
Event

Setting Uo>s Release Delay Delay Enable Events

122 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Table 34 - Parameters of the Residual Overvoltage Stages U0>, U0>> (59N)

Parameter Value Unit Description Note


Status - Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F(1)
Trip F(1)
SCntr Cumulative start counter C(2)
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C(2)
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group Set(3)
SGrpDI Digital signal to select the active setting group: Set(3)
- None
DIx Digital input
VIx Virtual input
LEDx Status indicator signal
VOx Virtual output
Force Off Force flag for status forcing for test purposes. A common flag Set(3)
On for all stages and output relays. Automatically reset by a 5-
minute timeout.
Uo % The supervised value relative to Un/√ 3
Uo> % Pick-up value relative to Un/√ 3 Set(3)
Uo>>
t> s Definite operation time Set(3)
t>>
(1) F = Editable when force flag is on.
(2) C = Can be cleared to zero.
(3) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

For details on setting ranges, see Protection Stages on page 353.

Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults

Detailed information is available on the eight latest faults: Time stamp, fault
voltage, elapsed delay, and setting group.

Table 35 - Recorded Values of the Residual Overvoltage Stages U0>, U0>> (59N)

Parameter Value Unit Description


yyyy-mm-dd Time stamp of the recording, date
hh:mm:ss:ms Time stamp, time of day
Flt % Fault voltage relative to Un/√ 3
EDly % Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% = trip

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 123


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Thermal Overload Protection The thermal overload function helps protects the motor in the motor mode or
cables in the feeder mode against excessive heating.
T> (49)

Thermal Model

The temperature is calculated using rms values of phase currents and a thermal
model according to IEC 60255-8. The rms value is calculated using harmonic
components up to the 15th.

2 2
I – IP
Trip time: t = τ • 1 n ----------------
2 2
-
I –a

Alarm: a = k • k Θ • I mode • alarm (Alarm 60% = 0.6)

Trip: a = k • kΘ • I mode

2
 IP 
Release time: t = τ • C τ •  1n --------------
-
 a 2 – I 2

Trip release: a = 0.95 • k Θ • I mode

Start release: a = 0.95 • k Θ • I mode • alarm (Alarm 60% = 0.6)

T = Operation time.
τ = Thermal time constant tau (setting value).
ln = Natural logarithm function.
I = Measured rms phase current (max. value of three phase
currents).
Ip = Preload current, I P = θ • k Θ • I n (If temperature rise is
120% θ=1.2). This parameter is the memory of the
algorithm and corresponds to the actual temperature rise.
k = Overload factor (Maximum continuous current), which is
service factor (setting value).
kΘ = Ambient temperature factor (permitted current due to
tamb). See Figure 49.
IMODE = The rated current (IN or IMOT ).
Cτ = Protection System constant for time to cool
(constant = Cτ x ). τ

124 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Time Constant for Cooling Situation

If the fan motor is stopped, the cooling is slower than with an active fan.
Therefore there is a coefficient Cτ for thermal constant available. The
coefficient to be used as a cooling time constant, when current is less than 0.3 x
IMOT.

Heat Capacitance, Service Factor, and Ambient Temperature


The maximum allowed continuous current IMAX determines the trip level. The
trip level corresponds to the 100% temperature rise ΘTRIP that is the heat
capacitance of the transformer. IMAX depends on the given service factor k and
ambient temperature ΘAMB and settings IMAX40 and IMAX70 according to the
equation:

I MAX = k • k θ • I MODE

The value of the ambient temperature compensation-factor kΘ depends on the


ambient temperature ΘAMB and settings IMAX40 and IMAX70 (Figure 66).
Ambient temperature is not in use when kΘ = 1. This factor is true when:

• IMAX40 is 1.0.

• Samb is “N/A” (no ambient temperature sensor used).

• TAMB is 40 °C (104 °F).

Figure 66 - Ambient Temperature Correction of the Overload Stage T>

k
1.2

IMAX40
1.0

0.8 IMAX70

0.6

10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80

AMB (°C)

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 125


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Example of a Behavior of the Thermal Model

Figure 67 shows an example of the thermal model behavior. In this example


τ = 30 minutes, k = 1.06, and kΘ = 1. The current has been zero for a long
time and thus the initial temperature rise is 0%. At time = 50 minutes, the
current changes to 0.85xIMODE. The temperature rise starts to approach value
(0.85/1.06)2 = 64% according to the time constant. At time = 300 min., the
temperature is stable, and the current increases to 5% over the maximum. The
rated current and the service factor k define the maximum. The temperature
rise starts to approach value 110%. At about 340 minutes, the temperature rise
is 100% and a trip follows.

Initial Temperature Rise After Restart

When the Protection System is switched on, an initial temperature rise of 70%
is used. Depending on the actual current, the calculated temperature rise then
starts to approach the final value.

Alarm Function

The thermal overload stage contains a separately settable alarm function.


When the alarm limit is reached, the stage activates its start signal.

126 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Figure 67 - Example of the Thermal Model Behavior


Temperature Rise

Θoverload
Θmax
Θalarm
Reset ratio = 95%

Θp

Settings:
τ = 30 min.
k = 1.06
Θalarm = 90%

Alarm
Trip

I/IN
IMAX = k*IN IOVERLOAD = 1.05*IMAX

IP = 0.85*IN

Time
100 Min 200 Min 300 Min 400 Min 500 Min

Table 36 - Parameters of the Thermal Overload Stage T> (49)


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Status - Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F(1)
Trip F(1)
Time Hour (hh) Estimated time to trip
Minute
(mm)
Second (SS)
SCntr Cumulative start counter C(2)
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C(2)
Force Off Force flag for status forcing for test purposes. A common Set(3)
On flag for all stages and output relays, too. Automatically
reset by a 5-minute timeout.
T % Calculated temperature rise. Trip limit is 100%. F(1)
MaxRMS A rms Measured current. Highest of the three phases.
Imax A kxIgn. Current corresponding to the 100% temperature rise.
k> xIn Allowed overload (service factor) Set(3)
Alarm % Alarm level Set(3)
tau min Thermal time constant Set(3)
ctau xtau Coefficient for the cooling time constant. Default = 1.0 Set(3)

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 127


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Table 36 - Parameters of the Thermal Overload Stage T> (49) (Continued)


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
kTamb xIn Ambient temperature corrected max. allowed continuous
current
Imax40 %In Allowed load at Tamb 40°C. Default = 100%. Set(3)
Imax70 %In Allowed load at Tamb 70°C. Set(3)
Tamb °C Ambient temperature. Editable Samb=n/a. Default = 40°C Set(3)
Samb Sensor for ambient temperature: Set(3)
n/a No sensor in use for Tamb
ExtAI1…16 External analog input 1…16
(1) F = Editable when force flag is on.
(2) C = Can be cleared to zero.
(3) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

For details on setting ranges, see Protection Stages on page 353.

Overvoltage Protection The overvoltage function measures the fundamental frequency component of
the line-to-line voltages regardless of the voltage measurement mode (see
U> (59) Voltage Measurement Mode on page 219). By using line-to-line voltages, any
phase-to-ground overvoltages during earth-faults have no effect (the earth-
fault-protection functions take care of earth-faults). Whenever any of these
three line-to-line voltages exceeds the pick-up setting of a particular stage, this
stage picks up and a start signal is issued. If the fault situation remains on
longer than the operation-time delay setting, a trip signal is issued.

In solidly earthed 4-wire networks, with loads between phase and neutral,
overvoltage protection can be needed for phase-to-ground voltages, too. In
these applications, the programmable stages can be used. See Programmable
Stages (99) on page 151.

Three Independent Stages

There are three separately adjustable stages: U>, U>>, and U>>>. All stages
can be configured for Definite Time operation characteristic.

Configurable Release Delay

The U> stage has a settable release delay that enables the detection of
intermittent faults. The time counter of the protection function does not reset
immediately after the fault is cleared, but resets after the release delay has
elapsed. If the fault appears again before the release delay time has elapsed, the
delay counter continues from the previous value. The function trips if faults
occur frequently.

128 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Configurable Hysteresis

The deadband is 3% by default. An overvoltage fault is regarded as a fault until


the voltage drops below 97% of the pickup setting. In a sensitive alarm
application, a smaller hysteresis is needed. If the pickup setting is about only 2%
above the normal voltage level, hysteresis must be less than 2%. Otherwise the
stage will not release after fault.

Setting Groups

There are two settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs, virtual
inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to switch
between setting groups.

Figure 68 shows the functional block diagram of the overvoltage function


stages U>, U>> and U>>>.

Figure 68 - Block Diagram of the Three-phase Overvoltage Stages U>, U>>, and U>>>

Im1 MAX
Im2 Start
Im3 ts tr
Register
Block Event

Trip

Register
Event

Setting Hysteresis Release Enable Events


U>s Delay
Delay

Table 37 - Parameters of the Overvoltage Stages U>, U>>, U>>> (59)


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Status - Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F(1)
Trip F(1)
SCntr Cumulative start counter C(2)
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C(2)
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group Set(3)
SGrpDI Digital signal to select the active setting group: Set(3)
- None
DIx Digital input
VIx Virtual input
LEDx Status indicator signal
VOx Virtual output
Force Off Force flag for status forcing for test purposes. A common flag Set(3)
On for all stages and output relays, too. Automatically reset by a 5-
minute timeout.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 129


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Table 37 - Parameters of the Overvoltage Stages U>, U>>, U>>> (59) (Continued)
Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Umax V The supervised value. Max. of U12, U23, and U31
U> V Pick-up value that is scaled to primary value
U>>
U>>>
U> %Un Pick-up setting relative to UN Set(3)
U>>
U>>>
t> s Definite operation time Set(3)
t>>
t>>>
RlsDly s Release delay (U> stage only) Set(3)
Hyster 3 % Deadband size that is hysteresis Set(3)
(default)
(1) F = Editable when force flag is on.
(2) C = Can be cleared to zero.
(3) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

For details on setting ranges, see Protection Stages on page 353.

Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults

Detailed information is available on the eight latest faults: Time stamp, fault
voltage, elapsed delay, and setting group.

Table 38 - Recorded Values of the Overvoltage Stages (8 Latest Faults) U>, U>>, U>>> (59)
Parameter Value Unit Description
yyyy-mm-dd Time stamp of the recording, date
hh:mm:ss:ms Time stamp, time of day
Flt %Un Maximum fault voltage
EDly % Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% = trip
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group during fault

130 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Undervoltage Protection A basic undervoltage protection. The function measures the three line-to-line
voltages. Whenever the smallest of them drops below the pick-up setting of a
U< (27) particular stage, this stage picks up and a start signal is issued. If the fault
situation remains on longer than the operation-time delay setting, a trip signal
is issued.

Blocking During VT/PT Fuse Failure

As with all protection stages, the undervoltage function can be blocked with
any internal or external signal by using the block matrix. For example, if the
secondary voltage of one of the measuring transformers disappears because of a
fuse failure (see Voltage Transformer Supervision on page 185). The blocking
signal can also be a signal from the user logic (see Logic Functions on
page 249).

Self-blocking at Very Low Voltage

The stages can be blocked with a separate, low limit setting. With this setting,
the particular stage is blocked when the biggest of the three line-to-line
voltages drop below the given limit. The idea is to avoid tripping when the
voltage is switched off. If the operating time is less than 0.08 s, set the blocking
level to exceed 15% for the blocking action to be fast enough. The self-blocking
can be disabled by setting the low-voltage block limit equal to zero.

Figure 69 shows an example of low voltage self-blocking.

(A) The maximum of the three line-to-line voltages ULLmax is below the
block limit. Not regarded as an under voltage situation.
(B) The voltage ULLmin is above the block limit but below the pick-up level.
An undervoltage situation.
(C) Voltage is OK, because it is above the pick-up limit.
(D) An under voltage situation.
(E) Voltage is OK.
(F) An under voltage situation.
(G) The voltage ULLmin is under block limit and is not regarded as an under
voltage situation.
(H) An under voltage situation.
(I) Voltage is OK.
( J) Same as G.
(K) Voltage is OK.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 131


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Figure 69 - Undervoltage State and Block Limit


ULLmax = Max(U12, U23, U31)

E I K
C
Deadband
U< setting

H
D
B F

Block limit
J
A G
time

U< Undervoltage state

Three Independent Stages

There are three separately adjustable stages: U<, U<<, and U<<<. They can be
configured for Definite Time (DT) operation characteristic.

Setting Groups

There are two settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs, virtual
inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to switch
between setting groups.

Table 39 - Parameters of the Undervoltage Stages U<, U<<, U<<< (27)


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Status - Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F(1)
Trip F(1)
SCntr Cumulative start counter C(2)
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C(2)
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group Set(3)
SGrpDI Digital signal to select the active setting group: Set(3)
- None
DIx Digital input
VIx Virtual input
LEDx Status indicator signal
VOx Virtual output

132 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Table 39 - Parameters of the Undervoltage Stages U<, U<<, U<<< (27) (Continued)
Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Force Off Force flag for status forcing for test purposes. A common flag for Set(3)
On all stages and output relays, too. Automatically reset by a 5-
minute timeout.
MinU V The supervised minimum of line-to-line voltages in primary volts
U< V Pick-up value that is scaled to primary value
U<<
U<<<
U< %Un Pick-up setting Set(3)
U<<
U<<<
t< S Definite operation time Set(3)
t<<
t<<<
LVBlk %Un Low limit for self-blocking Set(3)
RlsDly S Release delay (U< stage only) Set(3)
Hyster Default % Deadband setting Set(3)
3.0%
(1) F = Editable when force flag is on.
(2) C = Can be cleared to zero.
(3) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

For details on setting ranges, see Protection Stages on page 353.

Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults

Detailed information is available on the eight latest faults for each of the stages:
Time stamp, fault voltage, elapsed delay, voltage before the fault and setting
group.

Table 40 - Recorded Values of the Undervoltage Stages (8 Latest Faults) U<, U<<, U<<< (27)
Parameter Value Unit Description
yyyy-mm-dd Time stamp of the recording, date
hh:mm:ss:ms Time stamp, time of day
Flt %Un Minimum fault voltage
EDly % Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% = trip
PreFlt %Un Supervised value before fault, 1-s average value.
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group during fault

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 133


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Reverse Power and Reverse power function can disconnect a motor if the supply voltage is lost and
helps prevent power generation by the motor. Underpower function can detect
Underpower Protection the loss of load of a motor.
P<, P<<(32)
Reverse power and underpower function is sensitive to active power. For
reverse power function, the pick-up value is negative. For underpower
function, a positive pick-up value is used. Whenever the active power goes
under the pick-up value, the stage picks up and issues a start signal. If the fault
situation stays on longer than the delay setting, a trip signal is issued.

The pick-up setting range is from -200…200% of the Nom apparent power Sn.
The configured voltage and current transformer values determine the Nom
apparent power.

Equation 3.3

S n = ( VT RatedPrimary • CT RatedPrimary ) • 3

There are two identical stages available with independent setting parameters.

Table 41 - Setting Parameters of P< and P<< Stages


Parameter Value Unit Default Description
P< -200.0…200.0 %Sn -4.0 (P<) P<,P<< pick-up setting
P<< -20.0(P<<)
T< 0.3…300.0 S 1.0 P<, P<< operational delay
S_On Enabled - Enabled Start on event
Disabled
S_Off Enabled - Enabled Start off event
Disabled
T_On Enabled - Enabled Trip on event
Disabled
T_Off Enabled - Enabled Trip off event
Disabled

Table 42 - Measured and Recorded Values of P< and P<< Stages


Parameter Value Unit Description
Measured P kW Active power
value
Recorded SCntr - Start counter (Start) reading
values
TCntr - Trip counter (Trip) reading
Flt %Sn Maximum value of fault
EDly % Elapsed time as compared to the set operating time, 100% =
tripping

134 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Overfrequency and Frequency protection is used for load sharing, loss of mains detection, and as a
backup protection for over-speeding.
Underfrequency Protection
f><, f>><< (81), (81H/81L) The frequency function measures the frequency from the two first voltage
inputs. At least one of these two inputs must have a voltage that is connected to
be able to measure the frequency. Whenever the frequency crosses the pick-up
setting of a particular stage, this stage picks up and a start signal is issued. If the
fault situation remains on longer than the operation delay setting, a trip signal
is issued. For situations where no voltage is present, an adapted frequency is
used.

Protection Mode for f>< and f>><< Stages


These two stages can be configured for overfrequency or underfrequency.

Undervoltage Self-blocking of Underfrequency Stages

The underfrequency stages are blocked when biggest of the three line-to-line
voltages are below the low-voltage block limit setting. With this common
setting (LVBlk), all stages in underfrequency mode are blocked when the
voltage drops below the given limit. The idea is to avoid purposeless alarms
when the voltage is off.

Initial Self-blocking of Underfrequency Stages

When the biggest of the three line-to-line voltages have been below the block
limit, the underfrequency stages are blocked until the pick-up setting is
reached.

Four Independent Frequency Stages

There are four separately adjustable frequency stages: f><, f><><, f<, f<<. The
two first stages can be configured for overfrequency or underfrequency usage.
So totally four underfrequency stages can be in use simultaneously. The use of
programmable stages even more can be implemented (see Programmable
Stages (99) on page 151). All stages have definite operation-time delay (DT).

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 135


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Setting Groups

There are four settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs,
virtual inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to
switch between setting groups.
Table 43 - Parameters of the Over and Underfrequency Stages
f><, f><><, f<, f<< (81H/81L)
Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Status - Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F(1)
Trip F(1)
SCntr Cumulative start counter C(2)
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C(2)
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group Set(3)
SGrpDI Digital signal to select the active setting group: Set(3)
- None
DIx Digital input
VIx Virtual input
LEDx Status indicator signal
VOx Virtual output
Force Off Force flag for status forcing for test purposes. A common flag Set(3)
On for all stages and output relays, too. Automatically reset by a 5-
minute timeout.
f Hz The supervised value.
Hz Pick-up value: Set(3)
fx Over/under stage f><. See Mode.
fXX Over/under stage f><><
f< Under stage f<
f<< Under stage f<<
s Definite operation time: Set(3)
tX f>< stage
tXX f><>< stage
t< f< stage
t<< f<< stage
Mode Operation mode. (only for f>< and f><><): Set(3)
> Overfrequency mode
< Underfrequency mode
LVblck %Un Low limit for self-blocking. A common setting for all four Set(3)
stages.
(1) F = Editable when force flag is on.
(2) C = Can be cleared to zero.
(3) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

For details on setting ranges, see Protection Stages on page 353.

136 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults

Detailed information is available on the eight latest faults: Time stamp,


frequency during fault, elapsed delay, and setting group.

Table 44 - Recorded Values of the Over and Under Frequency Stages (Eight Latest Faults)
f><, f><><, f<, f<< (81H/81L)
Parameter Value Unit Description
yyyy-mm-dd Time stamp of the recording, date
hh:mm:ss:ms Time stamp, time of day
Flt Hz Faulty frequency
EDly % Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% = trip
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group during fault

Rate of Change of Frequency Rate of change of frequency (ROCOF or df/dt) function is for fast Load-
shedding. The function is used to speed up operation time in over- and under-
(ROCOF) Protection df/dt frequency situations and to detect loss of grid. For example, a centralized
(81R) dedicated relay to shed load can be omitted and replaced with distributed
Load-shedding, if all outgoing feeders are equipped with 857 Protection
Systems.

A special application for ROCOF is to detect loss of grid (loss of mains,


islanding). The more the remaining load differs from the load before the loss of
grid, the better the ROCOF function detects the situation.

Frequency Behavior During Load Switching

Load switching and fault situations can generate a change in frequency. A load
drop can increase the frequency and increase in load can decrease the
frequency, for a while. The frequency can also oscillate after the initial change.
Over time, the control system of any local generator can drive the frequency
back to the original value. If there is a heavy short circuit fault or in case the
new load exceeds the generating capacity, the average frequency decreases.

In Figure 70, is an example. At 0.6 s, which is the programmed delay setting,


the average slope exceeds the 0.5 Hz/s setting and a trip signal would be
generated.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 137


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Figure 70 - Example of Definite Time df/dt Operation Time


At 0.6 s, which is the FREQUENCY (Hz)
delay setting, the
average slope exceeds
the setting 0.5 Hz/s and a Settings:
trip signal is generated df/dt = 0.5 Hz/s
t = 0.60 s
tMin =0.60 s

TIME

START

TRIP

Settings Groups

There are four settings available and can be switched by using a digital input, a
virtual input, or manually.

ROCOF Implementation

The ROCOF function is sensitive to the absolute average value of the time
derivate of the measured frequency |df/dt|. Whenever the measured frequency
slope |df/dt| exceeds the setting value for 80-ms time a start signal is issued. The
ROCOF stage picks up and issues the start signal only after an additional 60-ms
delay. If the average |df/dt|, since the pick-up moment, still exceeds the setting,
when the operation delay time has elapsed, a trip signal is issued. In this Definite
Time mode, the second delay parameter “minimum delay, tMin” must be equal to
the operation delay parameter “t”.

If the frequency is stable for about 80 ms without a trip, the stage releases.

ROCOF and Frequency Over and Under Stages

One difference between over-/under-frequency and df/dt function is the


speed. In many cases, a df/dt function can predict an overfrequency or
underfrequency situation and is thus faster than a simple overfrequency or
underfrequency function. In most cases, standard overfrequency and
underfrequency stages must be used together with ROCOF. This association
makes sure that there is tripping in case the frequency drift is slower than the
slope setting of ROCOF.

138 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Definite Operation-time Characteristics

Figure 70 shows an example where the df/dt pick-up value is 0.5 Hz/s and the
delay settings are t=0.60 s and tMin=0.60 s. Equal times t = tMin gives DT delay
characteristics. Although the frequency slope fluctuates, the stage does not
release but continues to calculate the average slope since the initial pick-up. At
the defined operation time, t = 0.6 s, the average slope is 0.75 Hz/s. This value
exceeds the setting, and the stage trips.

At slope settings less than 0.7 Hz/s, the fastest possible operation time is
limited (Figure 71).

Figure 71 - At Very Sensitive Slope Settings, the Fastest Possible Operation Time Is Limited
The fastest possible
operation time is limited
according to this figure.
Fastest possible operation time settings

Slope Setting df/dt (Hz/s)

Inverse Operation-time Characteristics

By setting the second delay parameter tMin smaller than the operational delay t,
an inverse type of operation time characteristics is achieved (Figure 72).

Figure 73 shows an example, where the frequency behavior is the same as in the
first figure. But the tMin setting is 0.15 s instead of being equal with t. The
operation time depends on the measured average slope according to this
equation.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 139


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

s SET • t SET
- where,
t TRIP = --------------------------
s

tTRIP = The resulting operation times.


sSET = df/dt that is slope setting (Hz/s).
tSET = Operation time setting t (s).
s = Measured average frequency slope (hz/s).

The minimum operation time is limited by the setting parameter tMin. In the
example of the fastest operation time, 0.15 s, is achieved when the slope is
2 Hz/s or more. The leftmost curve in Figure 72 shows the inverse
characteristics with the same settings as in Figure 73.

Figure 72 - Three Examples of Possible Inverse df/dt Operation Time Characteristics


The slope and operation delay
settings define the knee points to Slope and delay settings
the left. A common setting for tMin
has been used in these three
examples. The minimum delay
parameter defines the knee point
positions on the right.
Operation times

Setting for minimum delay


tMin = 0.15 s

Measured slope |df/dt| (Hz/s)

Figure 73 - Example of Inverse df/dt Operation Time


The time to trip is 0.3.s, FREQUENCY (Hz)
although the setting is
0.6 s. Because the average Settings:
slope 1 Hz/s is steeper than 60.0 df/dt = 0.5 Hz/s
the setting value 0.5 Hz/s. t = 0.60 s
tMin = 0.15 s
1.

0.5
0

Hz/
Hz

s
/s

0.7
2.0

5H
z/s
Hz/

49.7 TIME
s

0.00 0.15 0.30 0.45 0.60

START
TRIP

140 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Table 45 - Setting Parameters of df/dt Stage


Parameter Value Unit Default Description
df/dt 0.2…10.0 Hz/s 5.0 df/dt pick-up setting
t> 0.14…10.0 s 0.50 df/dt operational delay
tMin> 0.14…10.0 s 0.50 df/dt minimum delay
S_On Enabled - Enabled Start on event
Disabled
S_Off Enabled - Enabled Start off event
Disabled
T_On Enabled - Enabled Trip on event
Disabled
T_Off Enabled - Enabled Trip off event
Disabled

Table 46 - Measured and Recorded Values of df/dt Stage


Parameter Valu Unit Description
e
Measured f Hz Frequency
value
df/dt Hz/s Frequency rate of change
Recorded SCntr - Start counter (Start) reading
values
TCntr - Trip counter (Trip) reading
Flt %Hz/s Maximum rate of change fault value
EDly % Elapsed time as compared to the set operating time, 100% =
tripping

Synchrocheck Protection (25) A function that checks synchronism when the circuit-breaker or contactor is
closed. The function monitors voltage amplitude, frequency, and phase angle
difference between two voltages. Since there are two stages available, it is
possible to monitor three voltages. The voltages can be busbar and line or
busbar and busbar (bus coupler).

The Synchrocheck protection element disqualifies the use of the normal


measuring modes. Therefore, “2LL/LLy”, “1LL+U0/LLy” or “LL/LLy/LLz”
voltage-measuring mode must be selected to enable Synchrocheck function. If
“2LL/LLy”- or “1LL+U0/LLy”-mode is selected, one stage is available. The
“LL/LLy/LLz”-mode enables the use of two stages.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 141


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

The voltage that is used to Synchrocheck is phase-to-phase voltage U12. The


Synchrocheck stage 1 compares U12 with U12y. The compared voltages for the
stage 2 can be selected.
Table 47 - Setting Parameters of Synchrocheck Stages SyC1, SyC2 (25)
Parameter Values Unit Default Description
Side U12/U12y - U12/ Voltage selection. The stage 1 has fixed voltages U12/
U12/U12z U12z U12y.
U12y/U12z
CBObj Obj1…6 - Obj1 The selected object for CB control. The Synchrocheck
closing command uses the closing command of the
selected object.
The stage 1 uses the object 1. The stage 2 can use
objects 2…6.
SMode Async - Sync Synchrocheck mode.
Sync Off = only voltage check
Off Async = the function checks dU, df and dangle. The
frequency slip, df, determines the remaining time for
closing. This time must be longer than “CB time”.
Sync mode = Synchronization is tried to make exactly
when angle difference is zero. In this mode, the
Measured frequency difference (df) setting must be
enough small (<0.3 Hz).
UMode - - - Voltage check mode:
DD The first letter refers to the reference voltage and the
DL second letter refers to the comparison voltage.
LD D means that the side must be “dead” when closing
DD/DL (dead = The voltage below the dead-voltage limit
setting)
DD/LD
L means that the side must be “live” when closing (live
DL/LD = The voltage higher than the live voltage limit
DD/DL/LD setting).
Example: DL mode for stage 1: The U12 side must be
“dead” and the U12y side must be “live”.
CBtime 0.04…0.6 s 0.1 Typical closing-time of the circuit-breaker.
DIbypass Digital - - Bypass input. If the input is active, the function is
inputs bypassed.
Bypass 0 - 0 The bypass status. “1” means that the function is
1 bypassed. This parameter can also be used for manual
bypass.
CBCtrl Open - - Circuit-breaker control.
Close
ShowInfo Off - On Additional information display about the Synchrocheck
On status to the mimic.

SGrpDI Digital - - The input for changing the setting group.


inputs
SetGrp 1…4 - 1 The active setting group.

142 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Table 48 - Measured and Recorded Values of Synchrocheck Stages SyC1, SyC2 (25)
Parameter Values Unit Description
Measured df - Hz Measured frequency difference
Values
dU - % Un / Measured voltage amplitude and phase angle difference
deg
UState - - Voltage status (for example DD)
SState - - Synchrocheck status
ReqTime - - Request time status
f (1) - Hz Measured frequency (reference side)
(1)
fy - Hz Measured frequency (comparison side)
(1)
U12 - % Un Measured voltage (reference side)
U12y(1) - % Un Measured voltage (comparison side)
Recorded ReqCntr - - Request counter
Values
SyncCntr - - Synchronizing counter
FailCntr - - Fail counter
f (1) - Hz Recorded frequency (reference side)
fy (1) - Hz Recorded frequency (comparison side)
U12 (1) - % Un Recorded voltage (reference side)
U12y (1) - % Un Recorded voltage (comparison side)
dAng - Deg Recorded phase angle difference, when close command is
given from the function
dAngC - Deg Recorded phase angle difference, when the circuit-breaker
actually closes.
EDly - % The elapsed time that is compared to the set request
timeout setting, 100% = timeout
(1) The labels (parameter names) change according to the voltage selection.

The signals of both the stages are available in the output matrix and the logic:
“Request”, “OK” and “Fail”. The “request” signal is active when a request has
received but the breaker is not yet closed. The “OK” signal is active when the
synchronizing conditions are met or the voltage check criterion is met. The
“fail”-signal is activated if the function fails to close the breaker or contactor
within the request timeout setting (Figure 74).

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 143


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Figure 74 - Principle of the Synchrocheck Function


Object Close Command given (mimic or Requests go down when ‘real’
bus) makes only sync request object close is requested

Sync Request

Sync OK

Object Close Command

Time Synchronization, if timeout


happens Sync_Fail signal activates Normal object
Timeout that is defined in close operation
Synchrocheck

IMPORTANT The control pulse of the selected object must be long enough. For example,
if the voltages are in opposite direction, the synchronizing conditions are
met after several seconds.

Figure 75 - Block Diagram of the Synchrocheck and the Controlling Object

Object Closed Command Synchrocheck Object CB

Sync_Fail signal if sync Object_Fail signal if


timeout happens ‘real’ object control fails

Time Settings:
Synchrocheck: Max Synchronize Time (~seconds)
Object: Max Object Control Pulse len (~200 ms)

144 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

The wiring of the secondary circuits of voltage transformers to the device


terminal depends on the selected voltage-measuring mode.

Table 49 - Voltage Measurement Modes for Synchrocheck Function


Voltage Input Terminals Signals in Mode Signals in Mode Signals in Mode
“1LL+U0/LLy” “2LL/LLy” “LL/LLy/LLz”
Ua X1:11, 12 U12 U12 U12
Ub X1:13, 14 U12y U23 U12y
Uc X1:17, 18 U0 U12y U23z
Number of Synchrocheck Stages 1 1 2
Availability of U0 and directional I0 stages Yes No No
Power Measurement 1-phase power, 3-phase power, 1-phase power,
symmetrical loads unsymmetrical symmetrical loads
loads

The application examples show the correct connection of the voltage inputs. In
Figure 76 and Figure 77, the applications require only one stage (voltage-
measuring modes are “1LL+U0/LLy” and “2LL/LLy”). Two stages are needed
for the application that is presented in Figure 78 (voltage-measuring mode is
“LL/LLy/LLz”).

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 145


146
Chapter 3

1 -

- 0
+ U0 U12 1 -
Protection Functions

+
+

+ - 0

X3:17 Front
~
Communication
X3:18 option 1
Local port
X1:1 Remote port X9
U12y Extension port
X1:2 I L1 Communication
X1:3 option 2
X1:4 I L2 X10
X1:5
X1:6 I L3
X1:7 T1 X3:14
X1:8 I 01
X1:9 X3:15 +
X1:10 I 02 T2 X3:12
X1:11
X1:12 Ua X3:13 +

X1:13 T3 X7:17
+
X1:14 Ub
X1:17 X7:18 +
X1:18 Uc
T4 X7:15
Option Block
X6: 1 X7:16 +
X6: 2 X8:19
X6: 3 T5
X6: 4
X6: 5 X8:20
X6: 6 X8:17
T6
X6: 7
X8:18
X3: 1 +48V
DI 1 DI T7 X8:15
X3: 2
X3: 3 DI2
X3: 4 DI3 X8:16
857-3C7xxx

X3: 5 DI4
T8 X8:13

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


X3: 6 DI5
X3: 7 DI 6
X8:14
X7: 1 DI7 A1 X3:9
DI
X7: 2 DI 8 X3:11
X7: 3 DI9
X7: 4 DI10 X3:10
X7: 5 DI 11 A2 X2: 7
X7: 6 DI12
X7: 7 X2:8
A3 X2:5
X7: 8 DI13
DI
X7: 9 DI14
X7:10 DI15 X2:6
X7: 11 DI16 A4 X2:3
X7:12 DI17
X7:13 DI18
X2:4
Figure 76 - One Synchrocheck Stage Is Needed with “1LL+Uo/LLy”-mode

X7:14 Comm
A5 X2:1
X8: 1 DI21
DI22 DI
X8: 2 X2:2
X8: 3 Comm
IF X2:9
X8: 4 DI23
X8: 5 DI24 X2:10
X8: 6 Comm X2:11
X8: 7 DI25
X8: 8 DI26
X8: 9 Comm
X8:10 DI27
X8:11 DI28
X8:12 Comm
+ U 23 U12
1 -

+
- 0

X3:17 Front
~
X3:18 Communication
Local port option1
X1:1 Remote port X9
IL1 Extension port
X1:2 Communication
X1:3 option2
X1:4 IL2 X10
X1:5
X1:6 IL3
X1:7 T1 X3:14
X1:8 I01
X1:9 X3:15+
X1:10 I02 T2 X3:12
U12y X1:11
X1:12 Ua X3:13+
X1:13 T3 X7:17
X1:14 Ub
X1:17 Uc X7:18+
X1:18 T4 X7:15
Option Block
X6:1 X7:16+
X6:2 X8:19
X6:3 T5
X6:4
X6:5 X8:20
X6:6 T6 X8:17
+ X6:7
X8:18
X3:1 +48V
DI1 DI T7 X8:15
X3:2
X3:3 DI2
X3:4 DI3 X8:16
X3:5 DI4
DI5 T8 X8:13
X3:6
857-3C7xxx

X3:7 DI6
X8:14
X7:1 DI7 A1 X3:9

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


X7:2 DI8 DI
X7:3 DI9 X3:11
X7:4 DI10 X3:10
X7:5 DI11 A2 X2:7
X7:6 DI12
X7:7 Comm X2:8
A3 X2:5
X7:8 DI13
X7:9 DI14 DI
X7:10 DI15 X2:6
X7:1 1 DI16 A4 X2:3
X7:12 DI17
Figure 77 - One Synchrocheck Stage Is Needed with “2L/LLy”-mode

X7:13 DI18
X7:14 Comm X2:4
A5 X2:1
X8:1 DI21 DI
X8:2 DI22 X2:2
X8:3 Comm X2:9
X8:4 DI23 IF
X8:5 DI24 X2:10
X8:6 Comm X2:11
X8:7 DI25
Protection Functions

X8:8 DI26
X8:9 Comm
X8:10 DI27
X8:11 DI28
X8:12 Comm

147
Chapter 3
148
1 -
Chapter 3

- 0

Infeed 1
Protection Functions

+
U12y

M
X3:17 Front
~
X3:18 Communication
Localport option 1
X1: 1 Remote port X9
IL1 Extension port
X1: 2 Communication
X1: 3 option 2
X1: 4 IL2 X10
X1: 5
X1: 6 IL3
X1: 7 T1 X3:14
I01
+

X1: 8 X3:15
X1: 9
X1:10
I02 T2 X3:12

M
+

X1: 11 U 12 X3:13
X1:12
X1:13 T3 X7:17
X1:14 U12Y
+

X1:17 U12Z X7:18


X1:18 T4 X7:15
Option Block
+

X6: 1 X7:16
X6: 2 T5 X8:19
X6: 3
X6: 4
X6: 5 X8:20
X6: 6 T6 X8:17
X6: 7

U12
X8:18
X3: 1 +48V
DI1 DI T7 X8:15
X3: 2 DI2
X3: 3 DI3
X3: 4 X8:16
X3: 5 DI4 T8
DI5 X8:13
X3: 6

M
X3: 7 DI6
X8:14
857-3C7xxx

X7: 1 DI7 A1 X3: 9


DI
X7: 2 DI8
DI9 X3:11
X7: 3 DI10 X3:10
X7: 4 DI11
X7: 5 DI12 A2 X2: 7
X7: 6 Comm
X7: 7 X2: 8
A3 X2: 5
X7: 8 DI13 DI
X7: 9 DI14 X2: 6
X7:10 DI15
X7: 11 DI16 A4 X2: 3
X7:12 DI17
DI18
X7:13 X2: 4
+

X7:14 Comm X2: 1


A5
X8: 1 DI21
X8: 2 DI22 DI X2: 2
X8: 3 Comm X2: 9
DI23 IF

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


M
X8: 4 DI24 X2:10
X8: 5 Comm
X8: 6 X2:11
X8: 7 DI25
X8: 8 DI26
X8: 9 Comm
X8:10 DI27
X8: 11 DI28
X8:12 Comm
U12z
Figure 78 - Two Synchrocheck Stages Are Needed with “LL/LLy/LLz”-mode

Infeed 2

1 -

- 0
Protection Functions Chapter 3

Magnetizing Inrush Second This stage is used to block other stages. The ratio between the second
harmonic component and the fundamental frequency component is measured
Harmonic O/C Stage on all phase currents. When the ratio in any phase exceeds the setting value, the
If2>(68F2) stage gives a start signal. After a settable delay, the stage gives a trip signal.

The start and trip signals can be used for blocking the other stages. The trip
delay is irrelevant if only the start signal is used for blocking. The trip delay of
the stages to be blocked must be more than 60 ms to make sure of a proper
block.

Figure 79 - Block Diagram of the Second Harmonic Stage

Im1
&
Im2
Im3 Max > ts tr
Start
Register
& Event
Block

t
Trip

Register
& Event

Setting Delay Enable Events


2.Harm

Table 50 - Setting Parameters of Second Harmonic Blocking If2> (68F2)

Parameter Value Unit Default Description


lf2> 10…100 % 10 Setting value If5/Ifund
t_f2 0.03…300.0 s 2.00 Definite operating time
S_On Enabled; Disabled — Enabled Start on event
S_Off Enabled; Disabled — Enabled Start off event
T_On Enabled; Disabled — Enabled Trip on event
T_Off Enabled; Disabled — Enabled Trip off event

Table 51 - Measured and Recorded Values of Second Harmonic Blocking If2> (68F2)

Parameter Value Unit Description


Measured Values IL1H2 % 2. Harmonic of IL1, proportional to the fundamental
value of IL1
IL2H2 % 2. Harmonic of IL2
IL3H2 % 2. Harmonic of IL3
Recorded Values Flt % The max. fault value
EDly % Elapsed time as compared to the set operating time;
100% = tripping

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 149


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Fifth Harmonic O/C Stage Overexcitation of a transformer creates odd harmonics. This fifth harmonic
overcurrent stage can detect overexcitation and block some other stages.
If5> (68F5)
The ratio between the fifth harmonic component and the fundamental
frequency component is measured on all phase currents. When the ratio in any
phase exceeds the setting value, the stage gives a start signal. After a settable
delay, the stage gives a trip signal.

The trip delay of the stages to be blocked must be more than 60 ms to make
sure of proper block.

Table 52 - Setting Parameters of Second Harmonic Blocking If5> (68F5)

Parameter Value Unit Default Description


lf5> 10…100 % 10 Setting value If2/Ifund
t_f5 0.03…300.0 s 0.03home? Definite operating time
S_On Enabled; Disabled — Enabled Start on event

S_Off Enabled; Disabled — Enabled Start off event

T_On Enabled; Disabled — Enabled Trip on event

T_Off Enabled; Disabled — Enabled Trip off event

Circuit Breaker Failure The (CBFP) feature is used to trip any upstream circuit breaker (CB). The trip
occurs if the fault does not disappear within a given time after the initial trip
Protection CBFP (50BF) command. Another output contact from the relay must be used for this backup
trip.

The operation of the CBFP is based on two criteria. The supervision of the
signal to the selected trip relay and the time the fault remains on after the trip
command.

If this time is longer than the operating time of the CBFP stage, the CBFP
stage activates another output relay. This output relay remains activated until
the primary trip relay is reset.

The CBFP stage is supervising all protection stages with the same selected trip
relay, since it supervises the control signal of this relay. See Output Matrix on
page 236 for details about the Output Matrix and the trip relays.
Table 53 - Parameters of the Circuit Breaker Failure Stage (50BF)
Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Status - Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F(2)
Trip F(2)
SCntr Cumulative start counter C(3)
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C(3)

150 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Table 53 - Parameters of the Circuit Breaker Failure Stage (50BF) (Continued)


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Force Off Force flag for status forcing for test purposes. A common Set(4)
On flag for all stages and output relays, too. Automatically
reset by a 5-minute timeout.
CBrelay 1...14 The supervised output relay(1) Set(4)
Relay T1 – T14 (depending on the ordering code)
t> s Definite operation time Set(4)
(1) This setting is also used for circuit breaker condition monitoring. See Circuit Breaker Condition Monitoring on page 185.
(2) #F = Editable when force flag is on.
(3) #C = Can be cleared to zero.
(4) #Set = An editable parameter (password required).

For details on setting ranges, see Protection Stages on page 353.

Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults


Detailed information is available on the eight latest faults: Time stamp and
elapsed delay.

Table 54 - Recorded Values of the Circuit Breaker Failure Stage (Eight Latest Faults) CBFP
(50BF)
Parameter Value Unit Description
yyyy-mm-dd Time stamp of the recording, date
hh:mm:ss:ms Time stamp, time of day
EDly % Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% = trip

Programmable Stages (99) For special applications, customized protection stages can be built by selecting
the supervised signal and the comparison mode.

These parameters are available:


• Priority: for operation times under 1 second but greater than 60 ms,
20 ms is recommended. If operation times less than 60 ms are needed,
select 10 ms. For longer operation times and THD signals, 100 ms is
recommended.
• Coupling A: the name of the supervised signal in “>” and “<” modes
(see Table 55). Also the name of the supervised signal 1 in “Diff ” and
“AbsDiff ” modes.
• Coupling B: the name of the supervised signal 2 in “Diff ” and
“AbsDiff ” modes.
• Link: The name of the supervised signal (see Table 55).
• Compare Condition: Compare mode. ‘>’ for over or ‘<’ for under
comparison. “Diff ” and “AbsDiff ” for Coupling A and Coupling B
comparison.
• Pick-up: Limit of the stage. The available setting range and the unit
depend on the selected signal.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 151


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

• Operation Delay: Definite time operation delay.


• Hysteresis: Deadband (hysteresis).
• No Compare Limit for <: Only used with compare mode under (‘<’) as
the limit to start the comparison. Signal values under NoCmp are not
regarded as fault.
Table 55 - Available Signals Supervised by the Programmable Stages
IL1, IL2, IL3 Phase currents
Io1 Residual current input I01
Io2 Residual current input I02
U12, U23, U31 Line-to-line voltages
UL1, UL2, UL3 Phase-to-ground voltages
Uo Zero-sequence voltage
f Frequency
P Active power
Q Reactive power
S Apparent power
Cos Phi Cosine φ
IoCalc Phasor sum IL1 + IL2 + IL3
I1 Positive sequence current
I2 Negative sequence current
I2/I1 Relative negative sequence current
I2/In Negative sequence current in pu
U1 Positive sequence voltage
U2 Negative sequence voltage
U2/U1 Relative negative sequence voltage
IL Average (IL1 + IL2 + IL3)/3
Uphase (ULN) Average (UL1 + UL2 + UL3)/3
Uline (ULL) Average (U12 + U23 + U31)/3
TanFii Tangent φ [=tan(arccos φ)]
Prms Active power rms value
Qrms Reactive power rms value
Srms Apparent power rms value
THDIL1 Total harmonic distortion of IL1
THDIL2 Total harmonic distortion of IL2
THDIL3 Total harmonic distortion of IL3
THDUa Total harmonic distortion of input Ua
THDUb Total harmonic distortion of input Ub
THDUc Total harmonic distortion of input Uc
fy Frequency behind circuit breaker
fz Frequency behind second circuit breaker
IL1rms IL1 rms for average sampling

152 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Table 55 - Available Signals Supervised by the Programmable Stages (Continued)


IL2rms IL2 rms for average sampling
IL3rms IL3 rms for average sampling
U12y Voltage behind circuit breaker
U12z Voltage behind second circuit breaker
ILmin, ILmax Minimum and maximum of phase currents
ULLmin, ULLmax Minimum and maximum of line voltages
ULNmin, ULNmax Minimum and maximum of phase voltages

Eight Independent Stages

The Protection System has eight independent programmable stages. Each


programmable stage can be enabled or disabled to fit the intended application.

Setting Groups

There are four settings groups available for each stage. Use digital inputs,
virtual inputs (mimic display, communication, logic), and manual control to
switch between setting groups.

There are two identical stages available with independent setting parameters.
Table 56 - Parameters of the Programmable Stages PrgN (99)
Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Status - Status of the stage
Blocked
Start F
Trip F
SCntr Cumulative start counter C
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group Set
SGrpDI Digital signal to select the active setting group: Set
- None
DIx Digital input
VIx Virtual input
LEDx Status indicator signal
VOx Virtual output
Force Off Force flag for status, forcing for test purposes. A common Set
On flag for all stages and output relays, too. Automatically
reset by a 5-minute timeout.
Link (See Table •) Name for the supervised signal Set
(See Table •) Value of the supervised signal
Cmp Mode of comparison: Set
> Over protection
< Under protection
Pickup Pick up value is scaled to primary level
Pickup pu Pick up setting in pu Set

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 153


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Table 56 - Parameters of the Programmable Stages PrgN (99) (Continued)


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
t s Definite operation time Set
Hyster % Deadband setting Set
NoCmp pu Minimum value to start under comparison. (Mode=’<‘) Set

Set = An editable parameter (password required).


C = Can be cleared to zero.
F = Editable when force flag is on.

Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults

Time stamp, fault value, and elapsed delay information for the eight latest
faults.

Table 57 - Recorded Values of the Programmable Stages PrgN (99)


Parameter Value Unit Description
yyyy-mm-dd Time stamp of the recording, date
hh:mm:ss:ms Time stamp, time of day
Flt pu Fault value
EDly % Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% = trip
SetGrp 1…4 Active setting group during fault

Arc Fault Protection (50ARC/ TIP This protection function needs optional hardware in slot X6. See Optional
50NARC) (Optional) Two-channel Arc Protection Card on page 337 (Chapter 9) and Arc Fault-
protection Stages (Option) on page 364 (Chapter 10).

Arc protection is for fast arc protection and elimination that is based on
simultaneous light and current measurement. Special arc sensors measure the
light of an arc.

Three Stages for Arc Faults

There are three separate stages for the various current inputs:
• ArcI> For phase-to-phase arc faults. Current inputs IL1, IL2,
IL3 are used.
• ArcI01> For phase-to-earth arc faults. Current input I01 is used.
• ArcI02> For phase-to-earth arc faults. Current input I02 is used.

154 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Light Channel Selection

The light information source to the stages can be selected from this list.
• – No sensor is selected. The stage does not work.
• S1 Light sensor S1.
• S2 Light sensor S2.
• S1/S2 One of the light sensors S1 or S2.
• BI Binary input of the arc card. 48 Vdc.
• S1/BI Light sensor S1 or the binary input.
• S2/BI Light sensor S2 or the binary input.
• S1/S2/BI Light sensor S1 or S2 or the binary input.

Binary Input

The binary input (BI) on the arc option card can be used to get the light
indication from another Protection System to build selective arc protection
systems. See Optional Two-channel Arc Protection Card on page 337 for more
information.

The BI signal can also be connected to any of the output relays, BO, indicators,
and so on, offered by the output matrix (see Output Matrix on page 236). BI is
a dry input for 48-Vdc signal from binary outputs of other 857 Protection
Systems or dedicated compatible arc protection devices that are supplied by
Allen-Bradley®.

Binary Output

The binary output (BO) on the arc option card is used to give the light
indication signal or any other signal to another Protection System binary input.
The signal is used to build selective arc protection systems. See Optional Two-
channel Arc Protection Card on page 337 and Optional Digital I/O Card
(DI19/DI20) on page 338 (Chapter 9) for more details.

Selection of the BO connected signal is done with the output matrix (see
Measurement Functions on page 215). BO is an internally wetted 48V DC
signal for BI to other 857 Protection Systems or compatible dedicated arc
protection devices that are supplied by Allen-Bradley®.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 155


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Delayed Light Indication Signal

The relay output matrix has a delayed light indication output signal (Delayed
ArcL>) available for building selective arc protection systems. Any light source
combination and a programmed delay can be configured starting from
0.01…0.15 s. The resulting signal is available in the output matrix to be
connected to any BO, output relays, and so on.

Pick-up Scaling

The per unit (pu) values for pickup setting are based on the current
transformer values.
• ArcI>: 1 pu = 1 x IN = rated phase current CT value
• ArcI01>: 1 pu = 1 x I01N = rated residual current CT value for input
I01
• ArcI02>: 1 pu = 1 x I02N = rated residual current CT value for input
I02
Table 58 - Parameters of Arc Protection Stages Arcl>, Arcl01>, Arcl02> (50 ARC / 50N ARC)
Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Status – Status of the stage
Start Light is detected according to ArcIn F
Trip Light and overcurrent is detected F
LCntr Cumulative light indications counter. S1, S2, or BI. C
SCntr Cumulative light indication counter for the selected inputs C
according to parameter ArcIn
TCntr Cumulative trip counter C
Force Off Force flag for status, forcing for test purposes. A common flag Set
On for all stages and output relays, too. Automatically reset by a 5-
minute timeout.
Value of the supervised signal:
ILmax Stage ArcI>
Io1 Stage ArcI01>
Io2 Stage ArcI02>
ArcI> pu Pick up setting xIN Set
ArcIo1> pu Pick up setting xI01N
ArcIo2> pu Pick up setting xI02N
ArcIn Light indication source selection: Set
– No sensor that is selected
S1 Sensor 1 at terminals X6:4…5
S2 Sensor 2 at terminals X6:6…7
S1/S2
BI Terminals X6:1…3
S1/BI
S2/BI
S1/S2/BI

156 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Table 58 - Parameters of Arc Protection Stages Arcl>, Arcl01>, Arcl02> (50 ARC / 50N ARC)
Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Delayed light signal output
Ldly s Delay for delayed light output signal Set
LdlyCn Light indication source selection: Set
– No sensor that is selected
S1 Sensor 1 at terminals X6:4…5
S2 Sensor 2 at terminals X6:6…7
S1/S2
BI Terminals X6:1…3
S1/BI
S2/BI
S1/S2/BI

For details on setting ranges, see Protection Stages on page 353.


Set = An editable parameter (password required).
C = Can be cleared to zero.
F = Editable when force flag is on.

Recorded Values of the Latest Eight Faults


Detailed information is available on the eight latest faults: Time stamp, fault
type, fault value, load current before the fault and elapsed delay.

Table 59 - Recorded Values of the Arc Protection Stages Arcl>, Arcl01>, Arcl02> (50 ARC / 50N ARC)

Parameter Value Unit Description


yyyy-mm-dd Time stamp of the recording, date
hh:mm:ss:ms Time stamp, time of day
Type pu Fault type value. Only for ArcI> stage.
Flt pu Fault value
Load pu Pre fault current. Only for ArcI> stage.
EDly % Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% = trip

Inverse Time Operation The inverse-time operation, inverse delay minimum-time (IDMT), is available
for several protection functions. The common principle, formula, and graphic
representations of the available inverse delay types are described in this section.

Inverse delay means that the operation time depends on the measured real-time
process values during a fault. For example, with an overcurrent stage that uses
inverse delay a bigger fault current gives faster operation. The alternative to
inverse delay is definite delay. With definite delay, a preset time is used and the
operation time does not depend on the size of a fault.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 157


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Stage Specific Inverse Delay

Some protection functions have their own specific type of inverse delay. Details
of these dedicated inverse delays are described with the protection function.

Operation Modes

There are three operation modes to use the inverse time characteristics.
Standards delays Use standard delay characteristics by selecting a curve family (IEC, IEEE, IEEE2, RI)
and a delay type (Normal Inverse, Very Inverse, and so on).
Standard delay formula Select a curve family (IEC, IEEE, IEEE2) and define your own parameters for the
with free parameters selected delay formula. This mode is activated by setting delay type to
‘Parameters’, and change the delay function parameters from A to E. See Free
Parameter Settings with IEC, IEEE, and IEEE2 Equations on page 170.
Fully programmable Build the characteristics by setting 16 [current, time] points. The Protection
inverse delay System interpolates the values between given points with second degree
characteristics polynomials. This mode is activated by setting curve family to “PrgN”. There are a
maximum of three different programmable curves available simultaneously.
Each programmed curve is used by any number of protection stages.
See Programmable Inverse-time Curves on page 171.

Local Panel Graph

The Protection System shows a graph of the currently used inverse delay on the
local panel display. Up and down keys can be used for zooming. Also the delays
at 20xISET, 4xISET, and 2xISET are shown.

Inverse Time Setting Error Signal

If there are any errors in the inverse delay configuration, the protection stage
uses DT delay.

There is a signal “Setting Error” available in output matrix, which indicates


three different situations:
• Settings are currently changed with SetPointPS or the local panel and
there is temporarily an illegal combination of curve/delay/points. For
example, if curve family settings are IEC/NI and then changed to IEEE.
The setting error is active, because there is no NI type available for IEEE
curves. After changing the valid delay type for IEEE mode (for example
MI), the “Setting Error” signal will release.

• There are errors in formula parameters A to E, and the device cannot


build the delay curve.

• There are errors in the programmable curve configuration and the


device cannot interpolate values between the given points.

158 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Limitation

The maximum measured phase current is 50xIN and the maximum directly
measured earth-fault current is 5xI0N. The full scope of inverse delay curves
goes up to 20 times the setting. At high setting, the maximum measurement
capability limits the scope of inverse curves according to Table 60.

Table 60 - Maximum Secondary Current


Current Input Maximum Measured Maximum Secondary Scaled
Secondary Current Setting Enabling Inverse-delay
Times up to Full 20x Setting
IL1, IL2, IL3, and I0Calc 250 A 12.5 A
(1)
I0N = 5 A 50 A 2.5 A
I0N = 1 A (1) 10 A 0.5 A
I0N = 0.2 A(1) 2A 0.1 A
(1) The available I0N values depend on the order code. The Allen-Bradley® 857-3C6XXX has 1A and 5 A I0 inputs while the Allen-
Bradley® 857-3D6XXX has 0.2 A and 1 A I0 inputs.

Example 1 of Limitations:

Application mode is Feeder.

CT = 750/5.
CT0= 100/1 (cable CT is used for residual current).

The cable CT is connected to the 1 A terminal of the available I0 inputs.

For overcurrent stage I>, Table 60 gives 12.5 A. The maximum setting for I>
stage that gives full inverse-delay range is 12.5 A /
5 A = 2.5 x IN = 1875 APrimary.

For earth-fault stage I0>, Table 60 gives 0.5 A. The maximum setting for I0>
stage that gives full inverse-delay range is 0.5 A / 1 A = 0.5 x I0N = 50 APrimary.

Example 2 of Limitations:

Application mode is Motor.

CT = 750/5.

Rated current of the motor = 600 A.

I0Calc (= IL1 +IL2 +IL3) is used for residual current.

At the secondary level, the rated motor current is 600 / 750 * 5 = 4 A.

For overcurrent stage I>, Table 60 gives 12.5 A. The maximum setting that
gives full inverse delay range, is 12.5 A / 4 A = 3.13 xIMOT = 1875 APrimary.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 159


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

For earth-fault stage I0>, Table 60 gives 12.5 A. Thus the maximum setting for
I0> the stage that gives the full inverse delay range is 12.5 A /
5 A = 2.5 xI0N = 1875 APrimary.

Standard Inverse Delays IEC, IEEE, IEEE2, RI

The available standard inverse delays are divided in four categories IEC, IEEE,
IEEE2, and RI called delay curve families. Each category of family contains a
set of different delay types according to Table 61.

Inverse -time Setting Error Signal

The inverse-time setting error signal is activated, if the delay category is


changed and the old delay type does not exist in the new category. See Table 61
for more details.

Limitations

The minimum, DT delay start is the latest when the measured value is 20 times
the setting. There are limitations at high setting values due to the measurement
range. See Table 61 for more details.

Table 61 - Available Standard Delay Families and Types


Delay Type Curve Family
DT IEC IEEE IEEE2 RI
DT Definite time X
NI1 Normal inverse X X
VI Very inverse X X X
EI Extremely inverse X X X
LTI Long time inverse X X
LTEI Long time extremely inverse X
LTVI Long time very inverse X
MI Moderately inverse X X
STI Short time inverse X
STEI Short time extremely inverse X
RI Old ASEA type X
RXIDG Old ASEA type X

160 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

IEC Inverse-time Operation

The operation time depends on the measured value and other parameters
according to Equation 3.4 . This equation can only be used to draw graphs or
when the measured value I is constant during the fault. A modified version is
implemented in the Protection System for real-time usage.

Equation 3.4

kA
t = --------------------------------
-
 ---------------
I B
–1
 I pickup

t = Operation delay in seconds.


k = User multiplier.
I = Measured value.
Ipickup = User pickup setting.
A, B = Constants parameters according to Table 62.

There are three different delay types of according to IEC 60255-3, Normal
Inverse (NI), Extremely Inverse (EI), Very Inverse (VI), and a VI extension.
Additionally there is a Long Time Inverse (LTI).

Table 62 - Constants for IEC Inverse Delay Equation


Delay Type Parameter
A B
NI Normal inverse 0.14 0.02
EI Extremely inverse 80 2
VI Very inverse 13.5 1
LTI Long time inverse 120 1

Example for Delay Type “Normal Inverse (NI)”:

k = 0.50
I = 4 pu (constant current)
Ipickup = 2 pu
A = 0.14
B = 0.02

• 0.14 = 5.0
t = 0.50
--------------------------
0.02
 4--- –1
 2

The operation time in this example is 5 seconds. The same result can be read
from Figure 80.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 161


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Figure 80 - IEC Normal Inverse Delay Figure 82 - IEC Extremely Inverse Delay

Figure 81 - IEC Very Inverse Delay Figure 83 - IEC Long Time Inverse Delay

162 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

IEEE/ANSI Inverse-time Operation

There are three different delay types according to IEEE Std C37.112-1996
(MI, VI, EI) and many variations of these versions according to Table 63. The
IEEE standard defines inverse delay for both trip and release operations.
However, in the 857 Protection System, only the trip time is inverse according
to the standard but the release time is constant.

The operation delay depends on the measured value and other parameters
according to Equation 3.5 . This equation can only be used to draw graphs or
when the measured value I is constant during the fault. A modified version is
implemented in the Protection System for real-time usage.

Equation 3.5

A
t = k --------------------------------
-+B
 ---------------
I C
–1
 I pickup

t = Operation delay in seconds.


k = User multiplier.
I = Measured value.
Ipickup = User pickup setting.
A,B,C = Constant parameter according to Table 63.

Table 63 - Constants for IEEE/ANSI Inverse Delay Equation


Delay Type Parameter
A B C
LTI Long time inverse 0.086 0.185 0.02
LTVI Long time very inverse 28.55 0.712 2
LTEI Long time extremely inverse 64.07 0.250 2
MI Moderately inverse 0.0515 0.1140 0.02
VI Very inverse 19.61 0.491 2
EI Extremely inverse 28.2 0.1217 2
STI Short time inverse 0.16758 0.11858 0.02
STEI Short time extremely 1.281 0.005 2
inverse

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 163


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Example for Delay Type “Moderately Inverse (MI)”:

k = 0.50
I = 4 pu
Ipickup = 2 pu
A = 0.0515
B = 0.114
C = 0.02

0.0515 + 0.1140 = 1.9


t = 0.50 -------------------------
0.02
 4--- –1
 2

The operation time in this example is 1.9 seconds. The same result can be read
from Figure 87.

Figure 84 - ANSI/IEEE Long Time Figure 85 - ANSI/IEEE Long Time


Inverse Delay Very Inverse Delay

164 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Figure 86 - ANSI/IEEE Long Time Extremely Figure 88 - ANSI/IEEE Moderately


Inverse Delay Inverse Delay

Figure 87 - ANSI/IEEE Short Time Figure 89 - ANSI/IEEE Short Time Extremely


Inverse Delay Inverse Delay

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 165


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

IEEE2 Inverse-time Operation

Before 1996 and the release of ANSI standard C37.112, microprocessor relays
were using equations that approximated the behavior of various induction disc
types of relays. An approximation that is shown in Equation 8, which in the
protection system is called IEEE2. Another common name is IAC, from older
General Electric IAC relays that were modeled using the same equation.

There are four different delay types according toTable 64. The older
electromechanical induction disc relays have inverse delay for both trip and
release operations. However, in the 857Protection System, only the trip time is
inverse with the release time being constant.

The operation delay depends on the measured value and other parameters
according to Equation 3.6 . This equation can only be used to draw graphs or
when the measured value It is constant during the fault. A modified version is
implemented in the Protection System for real-time usage.

Equation 3.6

B D E
t = k A + ------------------------------
- + ---------------------------------
- + ---------------------------------
-
 ---------------
I
– C   ---------------
I – C 2
 ---------------
I
– C  3
I  I  I
pickup pickup pickup

t = Operation delay in seconds.


k = User multiplier.
I = Measured value.
Ipickup = User pickup setting.
A,B,C,D = Constant parameter according to Table 64.

Table 64 - Constants for IEEE2 Inverse Delay Equation


Delay Type Parameter
A B C D E
MI Moderately inverse 0.1735 0.6791 0.8 -0.08 0.1271
NI Normally inverse 0.0274 2.2614 0.3 -0.1899 9.1272
VI Very inverse 0.0615 0.7989 0.34 -0.284 4.0505
EI Extremely inverse 0.0399 0.2294 0.5 3.0094 0.7222

Example for Delay Type “Moderately Inverse (MI)”:

k = 0.50
I = 4 pu
Ipickup = 2 pu
A = 0.1735
B = 0.6791
C = 0.8
D = -0.08
E = 0.127

166 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

0.6791 - + -----------------------
– 0.08 - + -----------------------
0.127 - = 0.38
t = 0.5 0.1735 + ---------------------
2 3
 4--- – 0.8  4--- – 0.8  4--- – 0.8
2  2  2 

The operation time in this example is 0.38 seconds. The same result can be read
from Figure 90.

Figure 90 - IEEE2 Moderately Inverse Delay Figure 91 - IEEE2 Normal Inverse Delay

Figure 92 - IEEE2 Very Inverse Delay Figure 93 - IEEE2 Extremely Inverse Delay

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 167


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

RI and RXIDG type Inverse-time Operation

These two inverse delay types have their origin in older ASEA (now ABB)
earth-fault Protection Systems.

The operation delay of types RI and RXIDG depends on the measured value
and other parameters according to Equation 3.7 - RI and Equation 3.8–
RXIDG . Actually these equations can only be used to draw graphs or when the
measured value I is constant during the fault. Modified versions are
implemented in the Protection System for real-time usage.

Equation 3.7 - RI

k
t RI = ----------------------------------------
-
0.236
0.339 – ---------------------
 ---------------
I 
 I pickup

Equation 3.8– RXIDG

I
t RXIDG = 5.8 – 1.351n -------------------
kI pickup

t = Operation delay in seconds.


k = The User multiplier.
I = Measured value.
Ipickup = The User pickup setting.

Example for Delay Type RI:

k = 0.50
I = 4 pu
Ipickup = 2 pu

0.5
t RI = --------------------------------- = 2.3
0.339 – 0.236 -------------
 4--- 
2

168 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

The operation time in this example is 2.3 seconds. The same result can be read
from Figure 94.
Figure 94 - Inverse Delay of Type RI Figure 95 - Inverse Delay of Type RXIDG

Example for Delay Type RXIDG:

k = 0.50.
I = 4 pu.
Ipickup = 2 pu.

4
t RXIDG = 5.8 – 1.351n ---------------- = 3.9
0.5 • 2

The operation time in this example is 3.9 seconds. The same result can be read
from Figure 95.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 169


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

Free Parameter Settings with IEC, IEEE, and IEEE2 Equations

This mode is activated by setting delay type to “Parameters”. Edit the delay
function constants, parameters A to E. Use the standard equations with
constants instead of the standardized constants as in the previous chapter.

Example for GE-IAC51 Delay Type Inverse:

k = 0.50
I = 4 pu
Ipickup = 2 pu
A = 0.2078
B = 0.8630
C = 0.8000
D = –0.4180
E = 0.1947

0.8630 - + -----------------------
– 0.4180 - + -----------------------
0.1947 -
t = 0.5 0.2078 + --------------------- = 0.37
2 3
 4--- – 0.8  4--- – 0.8  4--- – 0.8
2  2  2 

The operation time in this example is 0.37 seconds. The resulting time/current
characteristic of this example matches with the characteristic of the old
electromechanical IAC51 induction disc relay.

Inverse-time Setting Error Signal


The inverse-time setting error signal becomes active, if interpolation with the
given parameters is not possible. See Inverse Time Operation on page 157.

Limitations

The minimum, DT delay start, is when the measured value is 20 times the
setting. However, there are limitations at high setting values due to the
measurement range. See Inverse Time Operation on page 157 for more details.

170 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Protection Functions Chapter 3

Programmable Inverse-time Curves

The [current, time] curve points are programmed by using the SetPointPS
software. The rules for defining the curve points are the following:
• The configuration must begin from the topmost line.
• The row order must be: the smallest current (longest operation time) on
the top. The largest current (shortest operation time) on the bottom.
• Fill all unused rows (on the bottom) with 1.00 in the Current I/I pickup
cells and 0.00 in the Operational delay cells.

Table 65 is an example configuration of curve points.

Table 65 - Curve Point Configurations


Point Current I/Ipickup Operation Delay
1 1.00 10.00 s
2 2.00 6.50 s
3 5.00 4.00 s
4 10.00 3.00 s
5 20.00 2.00 s
6 40.00 1.00 s
7 1.00 0.00 s
8 1.00 0.00 s
9 1.00 0.00 s
10 1.00 0.00 s
11 1.00 0.00 s
12 1.00 0.00 s
13 1.00 0.00 s
14 1.00 0.00 s
15 1.00 0.00 s
16 1.00 0.00 s

Inverse-time Setting Error Signal

The inverse-time setting error signal is activated, if interpolation with the given
points fails. See Inverse Time Operation on page 157.

Limitations

The minimum DT delay start is the latest when the measured value is 20 times
the setting. However, there are limitations at high setting values due to the
measurement range. See Inverse Time Operation on page 157.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 171


Chapter 3 Protection Functions

86 Lockout Functionality

The 86 lockout functionality is provided for all protective elements trip and
status conditions and all output devices. It can be activated through the
latching functionality that is provided in the Output Matrix. When the
lockout functionality for an output relay or protective or control function is
activated, it must be manually or remotely reset. Determine the reason for the
for lockout condition before resetting the latched or lockout condition. Do not
automatically reset a lockout function without following proper safety
practices.

WARNING: When any latched condition is reset, it can result in an automatic


restart of the application. Extra care and a good understanding of the
application are required when applying any lockout functionality to the
control circuit.
To reset the lockout function, press the appropriate keys on the front panel of
the 857 or initiate a remote reset command remotely through a separate
communication parameter. ‘

172 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Chapter 4

Support Functions

Event Log Event log is a buffer of event codes and time stamps, including date and time.
For example, each start-on, start-off, trip-on, or trip-off of any protection stage
has a unique event-number code. The code and the corresponding time stamp
are called an event.

As an example of information that is included with a typical event, an


overvoltage trip event of the first 59 stage U> is shown in Table 66.

Table 66 - Overvoltage Trip Event (Typical)


Event Description Local Panel Available Over
Communication Protocols
Code: IE2 Channel 30, event 2 Yes Yes
I> trip on Event text Yes No
2.7 x In Fault value Yes No
2007-01-31 Date Yes Yes
08:35:13.413 Time Yes Yes
Type: U12,23,31 Fault type Yes No

Event log can also be scanned using the front panel or by using SetPointPS.
With SetPointPS, the events can be stored to a file if the relay is not connected
to any system. Some of the data is also available through the associated
communication interface.

Only the latest event can be read when using communication protocols or
SetPointPS. Every reading increments the internal read pointer to the event
buffer. If a communication error occurs, the latest event can be read any
number of times by using another parameter. On the local panel, the event
buffer can be scanned back and forth.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 173


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Event Enabling/Masking

An uninteresting event can be masked, which keeps the particular event from
being written in the event buffer.

The default setting allows for the 200 latest events in the event buffer. The
oldest one is overwritten, when a new event does occur (first in, first out). The
event buffer size can be modified to hold between 50…2000 events. The event
buffer size can be modified using the SetPointPS software, in the ALocal Panel
Conf menu. The Alarm screen can also be enabled in this same menu location
within the SetPointPS program. The shown resolution of a time stamp is 1
millisecond, but the actual resolution depends on the particular function that
creates the event. For example, most protection stages create events with 10 ms
or 20-ms resolution. The absolute accuracy of all time stamps depends on the
time synchronization of the relay. See System Clock and Synchronization on
page 195.

Event Buffer Overflow

The normal procedure is to poll events from the device every time. If not done,
the event buffer eventually overflows. On the local screen, overflow is indicated
with string “OVF” after the event code.

Table 67 - Setting Parameters for Events


Parameter Value Description Note
Count Number of events
ClrEn – Clear event buffer Set
Clear
Order Old-New Order of the event buffer Set
New-Old for local display

FVSca Scaling of event fault Set


PU value:
Pri Per unit scaling
Primary scaling
Display Alarms On Alarm popup display is Set
enabled
Off No alarm display

FORMAT OF EVENTS ON THE LOCAL DISPLAY


Code: CHENN CH = event channel, NN = event code
Event description Event channel and code in plain text
yyyy-mm-dd Date (for available date formats. See System Clock and
Synchronization on page 195)
hh:mm:ss:ms Time

174 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

Disturbance Recorder The 12 channel disturbance recorder can be used to record all measured
signals. Such as, currents, voltages, and the status information of digital inputs
(DI) and digital outputs (DO). The digital inputs include the arc protection
signals S1, S2, BI, and BO, if the optional arc protection is available. It can be
useful for troubleshooting applications and controls during commissioning or
abnormal events.

Triggering the Recorder

Any start or trip signal from any protection stage, or by a digital input, triggers
the recorder. The triggering signal is selected in the output matrix (vertical
signal DR). The recording can also be triggered manually. All disturbance
recordings have a time stamp.

Reading the Recordings

The recordings can be uploaded, viewed, and analyzed with the SetPointPS
program. The disturbance recordings are in COMTRADE format. Other
programs can be used to view and analyze the recordings that are made by the
relay.

For more details, see publication 857-PM001.

Number of Channels

There can be a maximum of 12 recordings. The maximum selection of


channels in one recording is 12 (limited in waveform recording). The digital
inputs reserve one channel (includes all inputs). Also the digital outputs
reserve one channel (includes all outputs). If digital inputs and outputs are
recorded, there are still 10 channels that are left for analog waveforms.
Table 68 - Disturbance Recorder Waveforms
Channel Description Available for Waveform
Voltage Measurement Mode
2LL+Uo 3LN 1LL+Uo/LLy 2LL/LLy LL/LLy/LLz
IL, IL2, IL3 Phase Current Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Io1, Io2 Measured Residual Current Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
U12 Line-to-line Voltage Yes — Yes Yes Yes
U23 Line-to-line Voltage Yes — — Yes —
U31 Line-to-line Voltage — — — — —
UL1, UL2, UL3 Phase-to-neutral Voltage — Yes — — —
Uo Zero Sequence Voltage Yes — Yes — —
f Frequency — — — — —
P, Q, S Active, reactive, apparent power — — — — —

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 175


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Table 68 - Disturbance Recorder Waveforms (Continued)


Channel Description Available for Waveform
Voltage Measurement Mode
2LL+Uo 3LN 1LL+Uo/LLy 2LL/LLy LL/LLy/LLz
P.F. Power Factor — — — — —
CosPhi cosφ — — — — —
IoCalc Phasor sum I/O = (IL1+IL2+IL3)/ — — — — —
3
I1 Positive Sequence Current — — — — —
I2 Negative Sequence Current — — — — —
I2/I1 Relative Current Unbalance — — — — —
I2/Imode Current Unbalance [xlmode] — — — — —
U1 Positive Sequence Current — — — — —
U2 Negative Sequence Current — — — — —
U2/U1 Relative Current Unbalance — — — — —
IL Average (IL1+IL2+IL3)/3 — — — — —
Uphase Average (UL1+UL2+UL3)/3 — — — — —
Uline Average (U12+U23+U31)/3 — — — — —
DO Digital Outputs Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
DI Digital Inputs Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
TanPhi tanφ — — — — —
THDIL1 Total Harmonic Distortion of IL1 — — — — —
THDIL2 Total Harmonic Distortion of IL2 — — — — —
THDIL3 Total Harmonic Distortion of IL3 — — — — —
THDUa Total Harmonic Distortion of Ua — — — — —
THDUb Total Harmonic Distortion of Ub — — — — —
THDUc Total Harmonic Distortion of Uc — — — — —
DI_2 Digital Inputs 21…32 Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Prms Active Power rms value — — — — —
Qrms Reactive Power rms value — — — — —
Srms Apparent Power rms value — — — — —
fy Frequency behind Circuit Breaker — — — — —
fz Frequency behind second Circuit — — — — —
Breaker
U12y Voltage behind Circuit Breaker — — Yes Yes Yes
U12z Voltage behind second Circuit — — — — —
Breaker
IL1RMS IL1 RMS for Average Sampling — — — — —
IL2RMS IL2 RMS for Average Sampling — — — — —
IL3RMS IL3 RMS for Average Sampling — — — — —

176 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

Table 69 - Disturbance Recorder Parameters


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Mode Saturated Behavior in memory full situation: No more recordings are Set
Overflow accepted The oldest recorder is overwritten (F1F0)
SR Sample rate: Set
32/cycle Waveform
16/cycle Waveform
8/cycle Waveform
1/10 ms One cycle value (1)
1/20 ms One cycle value (2)
1/200 ms Average
1/1 s Average
1/5 s Average
1/10 s Average
1/15 s Average
1/30 s Average
1/1 min Average
Time s The recording length Set
PreTrig % Amount of recording data before the trigger moment Set
MaxLen s Maximum time setting. This value depends on sample rate,
number and type of the selected channels, and the
configured recording length.
Status Status of recording:
– Not active
Run Waiting for a triggering
Trig Recording
FULL Memory is full in saturated mode
ManTrig – Manual triggering Set
Trig
ReadyRec n Available recordings = n
m Maximum number of recordings= m
The value of “m” depends on sample rate, number and type
of the selected channels, and the configured recording
length.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 177


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Table 69 - Disturbance Recorder Parameters (Continued)


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
AddCh Add one channel. Maximum simultaneous number of Set(3)
channels is 12.
IL1, IL2, IL3 Phase current
Io1, Io2 Measured residual current
U12, U23, U31 Line-to-line voltage
UL1, UL2, UL3 Phase-to-neutral voltage
Uo Zero sequence voltage
f Frequency
P, Q, S Active, reactive, apparent power
P.F. Power factor
CosPhi cosφ
IoCalc Phasor sum I/O = (IL1+IL2+IL3)/3
I1 Positive sequence current
I2 Negative sequence current
I2/I1 Relative current unbalance
I2/In Current unbalance [xIGN]
U1 Positive sequence voltage
U2 Negative sequence voltage
U2/U1 Relative voltage unbalance
IL Average (IL1 + IL2 + IL3)/3
Uphase Average (UL1 + UL2 + UL3)/3
Uline Average (U12 + U23 + U31)/3
DO Digital outputs
DI Digital inputs
TanPhi tanφ
THDIL1 Total harmonic distortion of IL1
THDIL2 Total harmonic distortion of IL2
THDIL3 Total harmonic distortion of IL3
THDUa Total harmonic distortion of input Ua
THDUb Total harmonic distortion of input Ub
THDUc Total harmonic distortion of input Uc
DI_2 Digital inputs 21 …32
Prms Active power rms value
Qrms Reactive power rms value
Srms Apparent power rms value
fy Frequency behind circuit breaker
fz Frequency behind second circuit breaker
U12y Voltage behind circuit breaker
U12z Voltage behind second circuit breaker
IL1RMS IL1 RMS for average sampling
IL2RMS IL2 RMS for average sampling
IL3RMS IL3 RMS for average sampling
ClrCh – Remove all channels Set(3)
Clear
(Ch) List of selected channels
(1) The fundamental frequency rms value of one cycle COMTRADE update is every 10 ms.
(2) The fundamental frequency rms value of one cycle I/O self-diagnostic update is every 20 ms.
(3) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

178 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

Figure 96 - Typical Disturbance Recording

Virtual COMTRADE Files Virtual COMTRADE files can be run with the 857 Protection Systems. Relay
behavior can be analyzed by replaying the recorder data repeatedly in the relay
memory.

IMPORTANT Not applicable to the Arc Flash protection functions.

Use the SetPointPS programming tool to open the file. See SetPointPS
software publication 857-PM001 for details.

1. Connect to a relay SetPoint PS.


2. In SetPointPS, click the Disturbance Recorder Icon and select Open.

3. Select the COMTRADE file from the hard disk or other source
location.
SetPointPS is now ready to read the recording.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 179


Chapter 4 Support Functions

4. Check “Enable Virtual Measurement”.

5. Click the Refresh icon to send record data to the relay, which takes a few
seconds.
6. Click the Go icon to initiate playback of the file.

The “Change to control mode” button takes you back to the virtual
measurement.

TIP The sample rate of the COMTRADE file must be 32/cycle (625φs when 50 Hz
is used). The channel names have to correspond to the channel names in the
857 Protection System: IL1, IL2, IL3, Io1, Io2, U12, U23, UL1, UL2, UL3, and Uo.

Cold Load Pick-up and Inrush Cold Load Pick-up


Current Detection
The signal for cold load detection is activated for a given time when:
• The three phase currents are less than a given idle value.
• At least one of the currents exceeds a given pick-up level within 80 ms.

This signal is available for use within the output matrix and the blocking
matrix. Virtual outputs of the output matrix of the group control setting can be
used.

Application for Cold Load Detection

Right after closing a circuit breaker or contactor a given amount of overload


can be allowed for a limited time. This overload is to take care of concurrent
thermostat-controlled loads. For example, the cold load pick-up function
selects a coarser setting group for overcurrent stages. It is also possible to use the
signal for cold load detection to block any set of protection stages for a given
time.

180 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

Inrush Current Detection

Inrush current detection is similar to the cold load detection. It includes a


condition for second harmonic relative content of the currents. The inrush
detection signal is activated when:
• All phase currents are less than a given idle value.
• At least one-phase current exceeds a given pick-up level, within
80 ms.
• The ratio second harmonic ratio to fundamental frequency, If2/If1, of
at least one phase exceeds the given setting.

This signal is available for both the output and the blocking matrix. Use of
virtual outputs of the output matrix for the setting group control is possible.

By setting the Pickupf2 parameter for If2/If1 to zero, the inrush signal behaves
equally with the cold load pick-up signal.

IMPORTANT Inrush detection is based on an FFT calculation, which requires a full cycle of
data for analyzing the harmonic content.

Application for Inrush Current Detection

The inrush current of transformers usually exceeds the pick-up setting of


sensitive overcurrent stages and contains many even harmonics. After closing a
circuit breaker or contactor, the pick-up and trip of sensitive overcurrent stages
can be avoided. Select a coarser setting group for the overcurrent stage with
inrush detect signal. It is also possible to use the detection signal to block any
set of protection stages for a given time.

IMPORTANT Inrush detection is based on FFT (Fast Fourier Transform) calculation, which
requires full cycle of data for analyzing the harmonic content.
When using the inrush function for blocking and the current rise is noticed,
use the start conditions for cold load pick-up to activate the inrush blocking.
After the Cold load pick-up rgw c=blocking is continued if:
• A second harmonic component is in the signal
And
• The inrush current detection six Supporting functions first cycle.
Otherwise the second harmonic based blocking signal is released.
Inrush blocking is recommended in time delayed overcurrent stages, while
non-blocked instant overcurrent stage is set to 20% higher than expected
inrush current. By this scheme, fast reaction time (in short circuit faults
during the energization) can be achieved while the inrush function blocks
the time delayed stages.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 181


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Figure 97 - Functionality of Cold Load and Inrush Current Feature


1 3 4
Pick-up

Idle

Cold load

1. No activation because the current has not been under the set Idle current.
2. Current dropped under the Idle current level but now it stays between
the Idle current and the pick-up current for over 80 ms.
3. No activation because the phase two lasted longer than 80 ms.
A cold load activation exists, which lasts as long as the operation time
was set. Or as long as the current stays above the pick-up setting.

Table 70 - Parameters of the Cold Load and Inrush Detection Function


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
ColdLd - Status of cold load detection:
Start Cold load situation is active
Trip Timeout
Inrush - Status of inrush detection:
Start Inrush is detected
Trip Timeout
ILmax A The supervised value. Max. of IL1, IL2, and IL3
Pickup A Primary scaled pick-up value
Idle A Primary scaled upper limit for idle current
MaxTime s Set(1)
Idle xImode Current limit setting for idle situation Set(1)
Pickup xImode Pick up setting for minimum start current Set(1)
80 ms Maximum transition time for start recognition
Pickupf2 % Pick up value for relative amount of second harmonic, Set(1)
If2/If1
(1) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

182 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

Voltage Sags and Swells One of the most important power quality functions are voltage sag and swell
monitoring. The power quality of electrical networks and the sophisticated
loads (for example computers) requires an uninterruptible supply of “clean”
electricity. The 857 Protection System provides many power quality functions
that can evaluate, monitor, and alarm that is based on the power quality.

The protection system provides separate logs to monitor sags and swells. The
voltage log is triggered if any voltage input goes under the sag limit (U<) or
exceeds the swell limit (U>). There are four registers for both sags and swells in
the fault log. Each register has start time, phase information, duration,
minimum, average, maximum voltage values of each sag and swells event. There
is total number of sags and swells counters, and total timers for sags and swells.

The voltage power quality functions are located under the submenu “U”.

Table 71 - Setting Parameters of Sags and Swells Monitoring


Parameter Value Unit Default Description
U> 20…150 % 110 Setting value of swell limit
U< 10…120 % 90 Setting value of sag limit
Delay 0.06…1.00 s 0.06 Delay for sag and swell detection
Low voltage 0...50 % 1.0 Percentage of Un (Low voltage blocking is checking the
blocking maximum of line to line voltages.)
SagOn On - On Sag on event
Off
SagOff On - On Sag off event
Off
SwelOn On - On Swell on event
Off
SwelOf On - On Swell off event
Off

Table 72 - Recorded Values of Sags and Swells Monitoring


Parameter Value Unit Description
Recorded Count - Cumulative sag counter
values Total - Cumulative sag-time counter
Count - Cumulative swell counter
Total - Cumulative swell-time counter
Sag/ swell Date - Date of the sag/swell
logs 1–4 Time - Time stamp of the sag/swell
Type - Voltage inputs that had the sag/swell
Time s Duration of the sag/swell
Min1 %Un Minimum voltage value during the sag/swell in the input 1
Min2 %Un Minimum voltage value during the sag/swell in the input 2
Min3 %Un Minimum voltage value during the sag/swell in the input 3
Ave1 %Un Average voltage value during the sag/swell in the input 1
Ave2 %Un Average voltage value during the sag/swell in the input 2
Ave3 %Un Average voltage value during the sag/swell in the input 3
Max1 %Un Maximum voltage value during the sag/swell in the input 1
Max2 %Un Maximum voltage value during the sag/swell in the input 2
Max3 %Un Maximum voltage value during the sag/swell in the input 3

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 183


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Current Transformer The 857 Protection System can supervise the external wiring between the
protection system terminals and current transformers (CT) and the CT
Supervision themselves. Also is a safety function, as an open secondary on a CT can cause
dangerous voltages.

The CT supervisor function measures phase currents. The function issues an


alarm after the operation delay has elapsed if:

One of the three phase currents drops below Imin< setting, while, another
phase current is exceeding the Imax> setting.

Table 73 - Setting Parameters of CT Supervisor: CTSV ( )


Parameter Value Unit Default Description
Imax> 0.0…10.0 xIn 2.0 Upper setting for CT supervisor
Imin< 0.0…10.0 xIn 0.2 Lower setting for CT supervisor
t> 0.02…600. s 0.10 Operation delay
0
CT on On - On CT supervisor on event
Off
CT off On - On CT supervisor off event
Off

Table 74 - Measured and Recorded Values of CT Supervisor: CTSV ( )


Parameter Value Unit Description
Measured ILmax A Maximum of phase currents
value
ILmin A Minimum of phase currents
Display Imax> A Setting values as primary values
Imin<
Recorded Date - Date of CT supervision alarm
Values
Time - Time of CT supervision alarm
Imax A Maximum phase current
Imin A Minimum phase current

184 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

Voltage Transformer The 857 Protection System supervises the VTs and VT wiring between the
relay terminals and the VTs. If there is a blown fuse in the voltage transformer
Supervision circuitry, the prevented or distorted voltage measurement could issue an alarm.
In some applications, protection functions that use voltage signals are blocked
to avoid a spurious trip.

The VT supervisor function measures the three phase voltages and currents.
The negative sequence voltage U2 and the negative sequence current I2 are
calculated. The function issues an alarm after the operation delay has elapsed
if:
• U2 exceeds the U2> setting and simultaneously;
• I2 is less than the I2< setting.

Table 75 - Setting Parameters of VT Supervisor: VTSV ( )


Parameter Value Unit Default Description
U2> 0.0…200.0 %Un 34.6 Upper setting for VT supervisor
I2< 0.0…200.0 %In 100.0 Lower setting for VT supervisor
t> 0.02…600. s 0.10 Operation delay
0
VT on On - On VT supervisor on event
Off
VT off On - On VT supervisor off event
Off

Table 76 - Measured and Recorded Values of VT Supervisor: VTSV ( )


Parameter Value Unit Description
Measured U2 %Un Measured negative sequence voltage
Values
I2 %In Measured negative sequence current
Recorded Date - Date of VT supervision alarm
Values
Time - Time of VT supervision alarm
U2 %Un Recorded negative sequence voltage
I2 %In Recorded negative sequence current

Circuit Breaker Condition The 857 Protection System has a monitoring function for conditions that
supervises the wearing of the circuit-breaker. The condition monitoring can
Monitoring give alarms for the need of CB maintenance well before the CB condition is
critical.

The CB wear function measures the breaking current of each CB pole


separately. The function then estimates the wearing of the CB according to the
permissible cycle diagram. The breaking current is registered when the trip
relay supervised by the circuit breaker failure protection (CBFP) is activated.
(See Circuit Breaker Failure Protection CBFP (50BF) on page 150 and the
setting parameter “CBrelay” in Table 53).

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 185


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Breaker Curve and Its Approximation

The permissible cycle diagram is available in the documentation that is


provided by the circuit breaker manufacturer (Figure 98). The diagram
specifies the permissible number of cycles for every level of the breaking
current. This diagram is parameterized to the function for condition
monitoring with maximum eight [current, cycles] points. (Table 77). If fewer
than eight points are needed, the unused points are set to [IBIG, 1], where IBIG
is more than the maximum breaking capacity.

If the wearing characteristics of the CB, or part of it, is a straight line on a log/
log graph. The two endpoints are enough to define that part of the
characteristics. The device uses logarithmic interpolation for any current values
that fall in between the given current points 2–8.

The points 4–8 are not needed for the CB in Figure 98. They are set to 100 kA
and the algorithm discards one operation.

Figure 98 - Example of a Circuit Breaker Wearing Characteristic Graph

100000

10000
Number of Permitted Operations

1000

100
50

20
10
100 200 500 1000 10000 100000
Current (A)

TIP The values in Table 77are taken from Figure 98. The table is edited with
SETPOINTPS under menu “BREAKER CURVE”.

186 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

Table 77 - Example of Circuit-breaker Wearing Characteristics in Tabular Format

Table format in SetPointPS. Example values from Figure 98.


Point Interrupted Current (kA) Number of Permitted Operations
1 0 (mechanical age) 10000
2 1.25 (rated current) 10000
3 31.0 (maximum breaking current) 80
4 100 1
5 100 1
6 100 1
7 100 1
8 100 1

Setting Alarm Points

There are two alarm points available, each having two setting parameters each.

• Current
The first alarm can be set, for example, to nominal current of the CB or
any application typical current. The second alarm can be set, for
example, according to a typical fault current.

• Operations left alarm limit


An alarm is activated when there are fewer operations that are left, at the
defined current level, than this limit.

Any actual interrupted currents are logarithmically weighted for the two given
alarm current levels. The number of operations that are left at the alarm points
is decreased accordingly. When the “operations left” goes under the given
alarm limit, an alarm signal is issued to the output matrix. An event is
generated depending on the event enabling.

Clear “Operations Left” Counters


To clear the Operations Left counter, the breaker curve table must be filled and
the alarm currents defined. The wearing function is initialized by clearing the
decreasing operation counters with parameter “Clear” (Clear oper. left cntrs).
After clearing, the device shows the maximum allowed operations for the
defined alarm current levels.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 187


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Operation Counters to Monitor the Wearing

The operations that are left can be read from the counters “Al1Ln” (Alarm 1)
and “Al2Ln” (Alarm 2). There are three values for both alarms, one for each
phase. The two alarm functions supervise the smallest of the three values.

Logarithmic Interpolation

The permitted number of operations for currents in between the defined


points are logarithmically interpolated using these equations:

Equation 4.1

a-
C = ---
n , where
I

C = Permitted operations
I = Interrupted current
a = Constant according to Equation 4.2
n = Constant according to

Equation 4.2

Ck
1n -------------
Ck + 1
n = -------------------
-
Ik + 1
1n -----------
Ik

Equation 4.3

a = C k I k2

1n = Natural logarithm function


Ck = Permitted operations, k = row 2–7 in Table 77
Ik = The corresponding current, k = row 2–7 in Table 77
Ck+1 = Permitted operations, k = row 2–7 in Table 77
Ik+1 = The corresponding current, k = row 2–7 in Table 77

188 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

Example of the Logarithmic Interpolation

Alarm 2 current is set to 6 kA. What is the maximum number of operations


according to Table 77.

The current 6 kA lies between points 2 and 3 in the table. That gives value for
the index k. Using:

k = 2
Ck = 10000
Ck+1 = 80
Ik+1 = 31 kA
Ik = 1.25 kA

And the Equation 4.2 and Equation 4.3, the device calculates
10000
1n ---------------
80 = 1.5038
n = ---------------------
31000
1n ---------------
1250
1.5038 6
a = 10000 • 1250 = 454 • 10

Using Equation 4.1, the device gets the number of permitted operations for
current 6 kA.
6
454 • 10 - = 945
C = -----------------------
1.5038
6000

Thus the maximum number of current breaking at 6 kA is 945. This number


can be verified with the original breaker curve in Figure 98. The figure shows
that at 6 kA the operation count is between 900…1000. A useful alarm level for
operation-left, could be in this case, for example, 50, being about five per cent
of the maximum.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 189


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Example of Operation Counter Decrementing When the Circuit


Breaker Is Breaking a Current
Alarm 2 is set to 6 kA. CBFP is supervising trip relay T1 and trip signal of an
overcurrent stage detects a two-phase fault is connected to this trip relay T1.
The interrupted phase currents are 12.5 kA, 12.5 kA, and 1.5 kA.

How Alarm 2 Counters Are Decremented

If the Equation 4.1 and values n and a (from the previous example) are used,
the device gets the number of permitted operations at 10 kA.

6
454 • 10 - = 313
C 10kA = --------------------------
1.5038
12500

At alarm level 2, 6 kA, the corresponding number of operations is calculated


according to Equation 4.4.

Equation 4.4

C AlarmMax
∆ = -------------------------
C

945
∆ L1 = ∆ L2 = --------- = 3
313

The decrement of Alarm 2 counters is 3 for phases L1 and L2. In phase L1, the
currents are less than the alarm limit current 6 kA. For such currents, the
decrement is one.

∆ L3 = 1

190 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

Table 78 - Local Panel Parameters of CBWEAR Function

The breaker curve table is edited with SETPOINTPS.


Parameter Value Unit Description Set
CBWEAR STATUS
Operations that are left for:
Al1L1 - Alarm 1, phase L1
Al1L2 - Alarm 1, phase L2
Al1L3 - Alarm 1, phase L3
Al2L1 - Alarm 2, phase L1
Al2L2 - Alarm 2, phase L2
Al2L3 - Alarm 2, phase L3
Latest trip
Date Time stamp of the latest trip operation
Time
IL1 A Broken current of phase L1
IL2 A Broken current of phase L2
IL3 A Broken current of phase L3
CBWEAR SET
Alarm1
Current 0.00…100.00 kA Alarm1 current level Set (1)
Cycles 100000…1 Alarm1 limit for operations left Set (1)
Alarm2
Current 0.00…100.00 kA Alarm2 current level Set (1)
Cycles 100000…1 Alarm2 limit for operations left Set (1)
CBWEAR SET2
Al1On On “Alarm1 on” event enabling Set (1)
Off
Al1Off On “Alarm1 off” event enabling Set (1)
Off
Al2On On “Alarm2 on” event enabling Set (1)
Off
Al2Off On “Alarm2 off” event enabling Set (1)
Off
Clear – Clearing of cycle counters Set (1)
Clear
(1) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 191


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Energy Pulse Outputs The 857 Protection System can be configured to send a pulse whenever certain
amount of energy is imported or exported. The principle is presented in
Figure 99. Each time the energy level reaches the pulse size, an output relay is
activated. The output relay stays active as long as defined by a pulse duration
setting.

Figure 99 - Principle of Energy Pulses

Configurable:
100…5000 ms

Configurable:
10…10000 kWh
kvarh

The device has four energy pulse outputs. The output channels are:
• Active exported energy.
• Reactive exported energy.
• Active imported energy.
• Reactive imported energy.

Each channel can be connected to any combination of the output relays with
output matrix. The parameters for the energy pulses can be found in the E
menu under the submenus E-PULSE SIZES and E-PULSE DURATION.

Table 79 - Energy Pulse Output Parameters


Parameter Value Unit Description
E-PULSE E+ 10…10,000 kWh Pulse size of active exported energy
SIZES
Eq+ 10…10,000 kVARh Pulse size of reactive exported energy
E- 10…10,000 kWh Pulse size of active imported energy
Eq- 10…10,000 kVARh Pulse size of reactive imported energy
E-PULSE E+ 100…5000 ms Pulse length of active exported energy
DURATION
Eq+ 100…5000 ms Pulse length of reactive exported energy
E- 100…5000 ms Pulse length of active imported energy
Eq- 100…5000 ms Pulse length of reactive imported energy

192 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

Scaling Examples
Example 1

Average active exported power is 250 MW.


Peak active exported power is 400 MW.
Pulse size is 250 kWh.
The average pulse frequency is 250/0.250 = 1000 pulses/h.
The peak pulse frequency is 400/0.250 = 1600 pulses/h.
Set pulse length to 3600/1600 – 0.2 = 2.0 s or less.
The lifetime of the mechanical output relay is 50 x 106/1000 h = 6 years.

This example is not a practical scaling example unless an output relay lifetime
of about six years is accepted.

Example 2

Average active exported power is 100 MW.


Peak active exported power is 800 MW.
Pulse size is 400 kWh.
The average pulse frequency is 100/0.400 = 250 pulses/h.
The peak pulse frequency is 800/0.400 = 2000 pulses/h.
Set pulse length to 3600/2000 – 0.2 = 1.6 s or less.
The lifetime of the mechanical output relay is 50 x 106/250 h = 23 years.

Example 3

Average active exported power is 20 MW.


Peak active exported power is 70 MW.
Pulse size is 60 kWh.
The average pulse frequency is 25/0.060 = 416.7 pulses/h.
The peak pulse frequency is 70/0.060 = 1166.7 pulses/h.
Set pulse length to 3600/1167 – 0.2 = 2.8 s or less.
The lifetime of the mechanical output relay is 50 x106/417 h = 14 years.

Example 4

Average active exported power is 1900 kW.


Peak active exported power is 50 MW.
Pulse size is 10 kWh.
The average pulse frequency is 1900/10 = 190 pulses/h.
The peak pulse frequency is 50000/10 = 5000 pulses/h.
Set pulse length to 3600/5000 – 0.2 = 0.5 s or less.
The lifetime of the mechanical output relay is 50 x 106/190 h = 30 years.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 193


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Figure 100 - Application Example of Wiring the Energy Pulse Outputs to a PLC Having Common
Plus and Using an External Wetting Voltage

857 Protection System


+
PLC

Pulse counter-input 1
Active exported
energy pulses (+E)

Pulse counter-input 2
Reactive exported
energy pulses (+Eq)

Pulse counter-input 3
Active imported
energy pulses (- E)

Pulse counter-input 4
Reactive imported
energy pulses (- Eq)

Figure 101 - Application Example of Wiring the Energy Pulse Outputs to a PLC Having Common
Minus and Using an External Wetting Voltage

857 Protection System

+
PLC

Active exported
energy pulses (+E)
Pulse counter-input 1

Reactive exported
energy pulses (+Eq)
Pulse counter-input 2

Active imported
energy pulses (- E)
Pulse counter-input 3

Reactive imported
energy pulses (- Eq)
Pulse counter-input 4

194 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

Figure 102 - Application Example of Wiring the Energy Pulse Outputs to a PLC Having Common
Minus and an Internal Wetting Voltage

857 Protection System


PLC

Active exported
Pulse counter-input 1
energy pulses (+E)

Reactive exported Pulse counter-input 2


energy pulses (+Eq)

Active imported
Pulse counter-input 3
energy pulses (- E)

Reactive imported
Pulse counter-input 4
energy pulses (- Eq)

System Clock and The internal clock of the device is used to time stamp events and disturbance
recordings. The system clock must be externally synchronized to get event time
Synchronization stamps that are comparable for all relays in the system.

The synchronizing is based on the difference of the internal time and the
synchronizing message or pulse. This deviation is filtered and the internal time
is corrected softly towards a zero deviation.

Time Zone Offsets

Time zone offset (or bias) can be provided to adjust the local time for IED. The
Offset can be set as a Positive (+) or Negative (-) value within a range of -
15.00…+15.00 hours and a resolution of 0.01/h. Basically quarter hour
resolution is enough.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 195


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Daylight Savings Time (DST)

The 857 Protection System provides automatic DST adjustments when


configured. A DST (summer time) adjustment can be configured separately
with a time zone offset.

DST time standards vary widely throughout the world. Traditional daylight/
summer time is configured as 1-hour positive bias. The current US/Canada
DST standard, adopted in 2007 is: 1-hour positive bias, starts at 2:00 a.m. on
the second Sunday in March, and ends at 2:00 a.m. on the first Sunday in
November.

In the European Union, daylight change times are defined relative to the UTC
time of day instead of local time of day (as in U.S.). European customers, verify
your local rules for DST.

Automatic daylight time adjustments must be configured using the “Enable


DST”. Do not use the time zone offset option.

Adapt Auto Adjust


During tens of hours of synchronizing, the device learns its average error and
makes small corrections by itself. The target is that when the next
synchronizing message is received, the deviation is near zero. Parameters
“AAIntv” and “AvDrft” shows the adapted correction time interval of this
±1 ms auto-adjust function.

196 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

Time Drift Correction without External Sync

To correct the clock error, if the system clock has a steady drift and no external
synchronizing source is available, edit the parameters “AAIntv” and “AvDrft”.
Use this equation if the previous “AAIntv” value has been zero:

604.8
AAIntv = --------------------------------------------
-
DriftInOneWeek

If the auto-adjust interval “AAIntv” has not been zero, but further trimming is
still needed. Use this equation to calculate a new auto-adjust interval:

1
AAIntv = -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
1 DriftInOneWeek
-------------------------------------------- + ---------------------------------------------
AAIntv PREVIOUS 604.8

The term DriftInOneWeek/604.8 can be replaced with the relative drift that is
multiplied by 1000, if some other period than one week has been used. For
example if the drift has been 37 seconds in 14 days, the relative drift is
37 x 1000/(14 x 24 x 3600) = 0.0306 ms/s.

Example 1

If there is no external sync and the device clock is leading 61 seconds a week
and the parameter AAIntv is 0, the parameters are set as:

AvDrft = Lead

AAIntv = 604.8
------------- = 9.9s
61

With these parameter values, the system clock corrects itself with –1 ms every
9.9 seconds, which equals –61.091 s/week.

Example 2

If external sync is unavailable, the device clock lags 5 seconds in 9 days, and the
AAIntv is 9.9 s, then the parameters are set as:
1
AAIntv NEW = --------------------------------------------- = 10.6
1 5000
------- – -------------------------------
9.9 9 ( 24 • 3600 )
AvDrft = Lead

TIP When the internal time is roughly correct, deviation is less than 4 seconds,
any synchronizing or auto-adjust does not turn the clock backwards.
Instead, in case the clock is leading, it is softly slowed to maintain causality.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 197


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Table 80 - System Clock Parameters


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Date Current date Set (4)
Time Current time Set(4)
Style Date format: Set(4)
y-d-m Year-Month-Day
d.m.y Day.Month.Year
m/d/y Month/Day/Year
(3)
SyncDI – DI not used for synchronizing
DI1…DI6 Minute pulse input
TZone –15.00…+15.00 UTC time zone for SNTP synchronization. Set(4)
(1)
Note: A decimal number. For example, for state of Nepal
the time zone 5:45 is given as 5.75.
DST No Daylight Savings Time for SNTP Set(4)
Yes
SySrc Clock synchronization source:
Internal No sync that is recognized since 200 s
DI Digital input
SNTP Protocol sync
SPA-Bus Protocol sync
ModBus Protocol sync
Modbus TCP Protocol sync
PROFIBUS Protocol sync
IEC-103 Protocol sync
IEC-101 Protocol sync
DNP3 Protocol sync
IRIG-B003 IRIG timecode B003(2)
MsgCnt 0…65535, 0… The number of received synchronization messages or
And so on pulses
Dev ±32767 ms Latest time deviation between the system clock and the
received synchronization
SyOS ±10000.000 s Synchronization correction for any constant error in the Set(4)
synchronizing source
AAIntv ±10000 s Adapted auto adjust interval for 1-ms correction Set(4)
AvDrft Lead Adapted average clock drift sign Set(4)
Lag
FilDev ±125 ms Filtered synchronization deviation
(1) A range of -11…+12 h would cover the whole Earth. But because the International Date Line does not follow the 180°
meridian, a wider range is needed.
(2) The relay is required to be equipped with a hardware option module to receive IRIG-B clock synchronization signal. See Catalog
Number Explanation on page 24.
(3) Set the DI delay to its minimum and the polarity such that the leading edge is the synchronizing edge.
(4) If external synchronization is used, this parameter is set automatically. Set is an editable parameter (configurator password
required).

Synchronization Using a Digital Input

The clock can be synchronized by reading minute pulses from digital inputs,
virtual inputs, or virtual outputs. Sync source is selected with SyncDI setting.
When a rising edge is detected from the selected input, system clock is adjusted
to the nearest minute. The digital input pulse must be at least 50 ms. Delay of
the selected digital input must be set to zero.

198 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

Synchronization Correction

If the sync source has a known offset delay, it can be compensated with SyOS
setting. This setting is useful when compensating for hardware delays or
transfer delays of communication protocols. A positive value compensates a
lagging external sync and communication delays. A negative value compensates
any leading offset of the external sync source.

Sync Source

When the device receives new sync message, the sync source display is updated.
If no new sync messages are received within next 1.5 minutes, the device
changes to internal sync mode.

Sync Source: IRIG-B003

IRIG-B003 synchronization is supported with a dedicated communication


option with a two-pole or two pins in a D9 rear connector (see Catalog
Number Explanation on page 24). Special signal isolation is required. Contact
Rockwell Automation® for details.

IRIG-B003 input clock signal voltage-level is TLL. The input clock signal that
is originated in the GPS receiver must be taken to multiple relays through an
IRIG-B distribution module. This module acts as a centralized unit for a
point-to-multiple point connection.

IMPORTANT Daisy chain connections of IRIG-B signal inputs to multiple relays must be
avoided.

857 Relays must be ordered with IRIG-B


synchronization capability.
Recommended wiring must be shielded
cable of twisted-pair or coaxial type with
a maximum length of 10 m (3.28 ft) from
the distribution module.

IRIG B
GPS
Distribution
Receiver
Module

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 199


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Deviation

The time deviation means how much the system clock time differs from sync
source time. Time deviation is calculated after receiving new sync message. The
filtered deviation means how much the system clock was adjusted and takes
care of small errors in sync messages.

Auto-Lag/Lead
The device synchronizes to the sync source, meaning it starts automatically
leading or lagging to stay in perfect sync with the master. The learning process
takes few days.

The Running Hour Counter This function calculates the total active time of the selected digital input,
virtual I/O, or output matrix output-signal. The resolution is ten seconds.

Table 81 - The Running Hour Counter Parameters


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Runh 0…876000 h Total active time, hours (Set)(1)
Note: The label text “Runh” can be edited with
SETPOINTPS.
Runs 0…3599 s Total active time, seconds (Set)(1)
Starts 0…65535 Activation counter (Set)(1)
Status Stop Status of the selected digital signal
Run
DI Select the supervised signal: Set(2)
- None
DI1…DI32 Physical inputs
VI1…VI4 Virtual inputs
LedAl Output matrix out signal Al
LedTr Output matrix out signal Tr
LedA Output matrix out signal LA
LedB Output matrix out signal LB
LedC Output matrix out signal LC
LedDR Output matrix out signal DR
VO1…VO6 Virtual outputs
Started at Date and time of the last activation
Stopped at Date and time of the last inactivation
(1) (Set) = An informative value that can be edited.
(2) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

200 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

Timers The 857 Protection System includes four settable timers. These timers can be
used together with the programmable logic. Or to control setting groups and
other applications that require actions that are based on calendar time. Each
timer has its own independent settings. The selected on-time and off-time is
set. The activation of the timer can be set as daily or according to the day of
week (See the setting parameters for details). The timer outputs are available
for logic functions and for the block and output matrix.

Figure 103 - Timer Output Sequence in Simultaneously Modes


Monday Tuesday Wednesday Thursday Friday Saturday Sunday

(not in use)
Daily
Monday
Tuesday
Wednesday
Thursday
Friday
Saturday
Sunday
MTWTF
MTWTFS
Sat/Sun

Any timer that is in use on or off can be forced by writing a new status value.
No forcing flag is needed, as in, for example, forcing the output relays.

The forced time is valid until the next forcing or until the next reversing timed
act from the timer itself.

The status of each timer is stored in nonvolatile memory when the auxiliary
power is switched off. At startup, the status of each timer is recovered.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 201


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Table 82 - Setting Parameters of Timers


Parameter Value Description
TimerN Timer status:
– Not in use
0 Output is inactive
1 Output is active
On “hh: mm: ss” Activation time of the timer
Off “hh: mm: ss” De-activation time of the timer
Mode For each of the four timers there are 12 simultaneously modes available:
– The timer is off and not running. The output is off, 0.
Daily The timer switches on and off once every day.
Monday The timer switches on and off every Monday.
Tuesday The timer switches on and off every Tuesday.
Wednesday The timer switches on and off every Wednesday.
Thursday The timer switches on and off every Thursday.
Friday The timer switches on and off every Friday.
Saturday The timer switches on and off every Saturday.
Sunday The timer switches on and off every Sunday.
MTWTF The timer switches on and off every day except Saturdays and Sundays
MTWTFS The timer switches on and off every day except Sundays.
SatSun The timer switches on and off every Saturday and Sunday.

202 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

Combined Overcurrent Status This function collects faults, fault types, and registered fault currents of all
enabled overcurrent stages.
Table 83 - Line Fault Parameters
Parameter Value Unit Description Note
IFltLas xImode Current of the latest overcurrent fault (Set)(3)
LINE ALARM
AlrL1 Start (=alarm) status for each phase:
AlrL2 0 0=No start since alarm ClrDly
AlrL3 1 1=Start is on
OCs Combined overcurrent start status:
0 AlrL1=AlrL2=AlrL3=0
1 AlrL1=1 orAlrL2=1 or AlrL3=1
LxAlarm “On” Event enabling for AlrL1…3: Set(4)
On Events are enabled
Off Events are disabled
LxAlarmOff “Off” Event enabling for AlrL1…3: Set(4)
On Events are enabled
Off Events are disabled
OCAlarm “On” Event enabling for combined o/c starts: Set(4)
On Events are enabled
Off Events are disabled
OCAlarmOff “Off” Event enabling for combined o/c starts: Set(4)
On Events are enabled
Off Events are disabled
IncFltEvnt Disabling several start and trip events of the same fault: Set(4)
On Several events are enabled(1)
Off Several events of an increasing fault are disabled(2)
ClrDly 0…65535 s Duration for active alarm status AlrL1, Alr2, AlrL3, and OCs Set(4)
LINE FAULT
FltL1 Fault (=trip) status for each phase:
FltL2 0 0=No fault since fault ClrDly
FltL3 1 1=Fault is on
OCt Combined overcurrent trip status:
0 FltL1=FltL2=FltL3=0
1 FltL1=1 or FltL2=1 or FltL3=1
LxTrip “On” Event enabling for FltL1…3: Set(4)
On Events are enabled
Off Events are disabled
LxTripOff “Off” Event enabling for FltL1…3: Set(4)
On Events are enabled
Off Events are disabled
OCTrip “On” Event enabling for combined o/c trips: Set(4)
On Events are enabled
Off Events are disabled

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 203


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Table 83 - Line Fault Parameters (Continued)


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
OCTripOff “Off” Event enabling for combined o/c starts: Set(4)
On Events are enabled
Off Events are disabled
IncFltEvnt Disabling several events of the same fault: Set(4)
On Several events are enabled(1)
Off Several events of an increasing fault are disabled(2)
ClrDly 0…65535 s Duration for active alarm status FltL1, Flt2, FltL3, and OCt Set(4)
(1) Used with IEC 60870-105-103 communication protocol. The alarm screen shows the latest if it is the biggest registered fault
current, too. Not used with SPA-bus, because SPA-bus masters usually do not like to have unpaired On/Off events.
(2) Used with SPA-bus protocol, because most SPA-bus masters do need an off-event for each corresponding on-event.
(3) (Set) = An informative value that can be edited.
(4) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

Self-supervision The functions of the micro controller, the associated circuitry, and the program
execution are supervised with a separate watchdog circuit. The watchdog
circuit supervises the device and attempts to restart the micro controller in a
fault situation. If the restart fails, the watchdog issues a self-supervision alarm
to indicate a permanent internal fault.

When the watchdog circuit detects a permanent fault, it blocks any control of
other output relays (except for the self-supervision output relay).

In addition, the internal supply voltages are supervised. If the auxiliary supply
of the device disappears, an alarm is automatically given because the internal
fault (IF) output relay functions on a working current principle. The IF relay is
energized when the auxiliary supply is on and no internal fault is detected.

Diagnostics

The device runs self-diagnostic tests for hardware and software in every boot
sequence and also accesses runtime checking.
Fatal Errors If fatal error has been detected, the device releases IF relay contact and error
status indicator is set on. Local panel also displays an error message about the
detected fault. Fatal error state is entered when the device cannot handle
protections.
Runtime Errors When self-diagnostic function detects a fault, Selfdiag Alarm matrix signal is set
and an event (E56) is generated. In case the error was only temporary, an off event
is generated (E57). Self-diagnostic error can be reset through local panel
interface.
Error Registers There are four 16-bit error registers that are readable through remote protocols.
Table 84 shows the meaning of each error register and their bits.

204 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

Table 84 - Error Registers

The error code is displayed in self-diagnostic events and on the diagnostic


menu on local panel and SetPointPS.
Table 85 - Error Registers
Register Bit Code Description
SelfDiag1 0 (LSB) T1 Output relay fault
1 T2
2 T3
3 T4
4 A1
5 A2
6 A3
7 A4
8 A5
10 T5
11 T6
12 T7
13 T8
14 T9
SelfDiag2 0 (LSB) T10 Output relay fault
1 T11
2 T12
3 T13
4 T14
5 T15
6 T16
7 T17
8 T18
9 T19
10 T20
11 T21
12 T22
13 T23
14 T24
SelfDiag3 0 (LSB) DAC mA-output fault
1 STACK OS: stack fault
2 MemChk OS: memory fault
3 BGTask OS: background task timeout
4 DI Digital input fault (DI1, DI2)
5
6 Arc Arc card fault

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 205


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Table 85 - Error Registers (Continued)


Register Bit Code Description
SelfDiag3 7 SecPulse Hardware error
8 RangeChk Database: Setting outside range
9 CPULoad OS: overload
10 +24V Internal voltage fault
11 -15V
12 ITemp Internal temperature too high
13 ADChk1 A/D converter error
14 ADChk2 A/D converter error
15 (MSB) E2prom E2prom error
SelfDiag4 0 (LSB) +12V Internal voltage fault
1 ComBuff BUS: buffer error

Incomer Short Circuit Fault The 857 Protection System includes a standalone fault locator algorithm. The
algorithm can locate a short circuit in radial operated networks. The fault
Locator (Feeder Mode) location is given as in reactance (ohms) and kilometers. The fault value can
then be exported, for example, with the event log to a Distribution
Management System (DMS). The system can then localize the fault. If a DMS
is not available, the distance to the fault is displayed as kilometers, and a
reactance value. However, the distance value is valid only if the line reactance is
set correctly.

The wire type of the line must be the same for the whole length. If there are
several wire types on the same line, use the value of average line reactance to get
an approximate distance value to the fault. Examples of line reactance values:
Overhead wire Line A: 0.408 Ω/km and Line B: 0.378 Ω/km).

The fault locator is normally used in the incoming bay of the substation. The
fault location is obtained for the whole network with just one device.

206 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

Order of Algorithmic Functions

Perform the algorithm functions in this order:

1. The measurements (phase currents and voltages) are continuously


available.
2. The fault distance calculation can be triggered in two ways:
• By opening a feeder circuit-breaker, due to a fault and sudden
increase in phase currents (Enable Xfault calc1 + triggering digital
input).
• By using only the sudden increase, in the phase currents (Enable
Xfault calc1).
3. Phase currents and voltages are registered in three stages: before the
fault, during the fault and after the faulty feeder circuit-breaker was
opened.
4. The fault distance quantities are calculated.
5. Two phases with the biggest fault current are selected.
6. The load currents are compensated.
7. The faulty line length reactance is calculated.

Table 86 - Setting Parameters of Incomer Short Circuit Fault Locator

Parameter Value Unit Default Description


Triggering -; Trigger mode (trigger is based on sudden
digital input DI1…DI18 increase of phase current, otherwise sudden
VI1…VI4 increase of phase current + DIx/VIx).
VO1…VO6
NI1…NI64
POC1…POC16
Line reactance 0.010…10.000 Ohms/km 0.389 Line reactance of the line. Used only to
convert the fault reactance to kilometers.
dItrig 10…800% Imode 50 Trig current (sudden increase of phase
current)
Blocked before 10…600 s 70 Blocks function for this time after trigger.
next trig Used for the blocking calculation in
autoreclose.
Xmax limit 0.5…500.0 Ohm 11.0 Limit for maximum reactance. If reactance
value is above set limit, calculation results are
not shown.
Event Disabled; Enabled — Enabled Event mask

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 207


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Table 87 - Measured and Recorded Values of Incomer Short Circuit Fault Locator
Parameter Value Unit Description
Distance km Distance to the fault
Xfault ohm Fault reactance
Date — Fault date
Time — Fault time
Time ms Fault time
Cntr — Number of faults
Pre A Pre-fault current (=load current)
Fault A Current during the fault
Post A Post-fault current
Udrop % Un Voltage dip during the fault
Durati s Fault duration
Type — Fault type (1-2,2-3,1-3,1-2-3)

Figure 104 is a representation of an application example where the fault


location algorithm is used at the incomer side.

Figure 104 - Incomer SC Fault Locator, Incomer Side Algorithm

208 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

Figure 105 - Incomer Side Algorithm (Example)


Voltages

Currents

Pre-fault time Fault time with the Breaker Operation Time included; Post-fault
more than must be 0.08…1 s. only a few

In case the digital input is used together with the currect change, the
input signal must be activated >0.5 s after the fault occurs.

Figure 105 is an application example where the fault location algorithm is used
at the feeder side.

Figure 106 - Incomer SC Fault Locator, Feeder Side Algorithm

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 209


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Figure 107 - Feeder Side Algorithm (Example)

Voltages

Currents

Pre-fault time Fault time with the Breaker Operation Time included; Post-fault
more than must be 0.08…1 s. only a few

In case the digital input is used together with the current change, the
input signal must be activated >0.5 s after the fault occurs.

Feeder Fault Locator The device includes a standalone fault locator algorithm. The algorithm can
locate a short circuit and earth-fault in radial operated networks. The fault
location is given as in reactance (ohms) and kilometers. Fault value can then be
exported, for example, with event to a Distribution Management System
(DMS). The system can then localize the fault. If a DMS is not available, the
distance to the fault is displayed as kilometers and a reactance value.

The distance value is valid only if the line reactance is set correctly. The wire
type of the line must be the same for the whole length. If there are several wire
types on the same line, use an average line reactance value to get an
approximate distance value to the fault. Examples of line reactance values:
Overhead wire Line A: 0.408 Ω/km and Line B: 0.378 Ω/km).

This fault locator cannot be used in incomer because this locator has not
ability to compensate healthy feeders away. When feeder fault locator is
calculating short circuit impedance, this formula is used:

UA – UB
Z AB = --------------------
-
IA – IB

• UA = Vector between the voltage and the ground.


• UB = Vector between the voltage and the ground.
• IA = Vector between the current and the ground.
• IB = Vector between the current and the ground.

210 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

When feeder fault locator is calculating ground fault impedance, this formula
is used:
UA
Z A = ----------------------------
-
I A + k + 3I 0

• UA = Vector between the voltage and the ground.


• IA = Vector between the current and the ground.
• k = Earth factor k. Set by you.
• 3I0 = Residual current, which is calculated from phase currents (I0Calc).

Earth factor k is calculated with following formula:


• K0 = (Z0L-Z1L) / (3 x Z1L).
• Z0L = Zero sequence line impedance.
• Z1L = Positive sequence line impedance.

The fault reactance calculation is triggered when the “Pick-up setting” value is
exceeded. Or if both “Pick-up setting” and “Triggering digital input” terms are
configured and fulfilled. When used, “Triggering digital input” can be digital
or virtual input.

Table 88 - Setting Parameters of Feeder Fault Locator

Parameter Value Unit Default Description


Pick-up setting 0.10…5.00 xIn 1.2 Current limit for triggering.
Triggering digital - — Trigger mode (The triggering is based on
input sudden increase of phase current, or sudden
DI1…DI18 increase of phase current + DIx/VIx/VOx/NIx/
POCx).
VI1…VI4

VO1…VO6

NI1…NI64

POC1…POC16

Line reactance 0.010 … 10.000 Ohms/km 0.491 Line reactance of the line. Used only to convert
the fault reactance to kilometers.

Earth factor 0.000…10.000 — 0.678 Calculated earth factor from line specifications.
Earth factor angle -60…60 ° 10 Angle of calculated earth factor from line
specifications.

Event enabling Off; On — On Event mask.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 211


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Table 89 - Measured and Recorded Values of Feeder Fault Locator

Parameter Value Unit Description


Distance km Distance to the fault
Xfault ohm Fault reactance
Date — Fault date
Time — Fault time
Cntr — Number of faults
Fault A Current during the fault
Udrop % Un Voltage dip during the fault
Type — Fault type (1-2, 2-3,1-3,1-2-3,1-N, 2-N, 3-N, 1-N-2-N, 2-N-3-N, 3-N-1-N,
1-N-2-N-3-N).

Figure 108 - Feeder Fault Locator, Fault Log, and Settings

212 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Support Functions Chapter 4

Earth-fault Location The 857 Protection System includes a sophisticated standalone earth-fault
location algorithm that can locate an earth-fault accurately in radically
operated compensated earthed networks.

The function can locate a fault only if the fault resistance is less than 50 ohms.
The fault location is given in reactance value. This value can then be exported,
for example, with event to a DMS (Distribution Management System). The
system can then localize the fault and display it on a map.

The fault location must be used in the incoming bay of the substation. It can be
obtained for the whole network with just one 857 Protection System. A cost-
effective upgrade of an existing system.

IMPORTANT ATTENTION: The earth-fault location function requires a change during


an earth-fault. This change is done by switching the secondary resistor of
the compensation coil on or off. The fault must be allowed to be on at
least 200 ms, of which 100 ms without the resistor. The resistor change
can be done by using the logic functionality of the Protection System.

The reactance value is converted to distance in the DMS by using this formula:

3•X -
s = -------------------------------- , where
X0 + X1 + X2

s = Distance in km
X = Reactance. Calculated by the 857 Protection System
X0 = Zero sequence reactance per kilometer of the line
X1 = Positive sequence reactance per kilometer of the line
X2 = Negative sequence reactance per kilometer of the line

Algorithm Functions
1. The measurements of phase currents and voltages are continuously
available.
2. The fault distance calculation can be triggered in two ways. By a digital
input to switch the secondary resistor ON or OFF, or by a change in
earth-fault or negative sequence current.
3. The fault phase is identified and the voltage of the faulted phase is
decreased at least by half.
4. The fault distance is calculated by dividing the change of the voltage by
the change of the negative sequence current.
5. Only the imaginary part is used, so then the reactance is solved.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 213


Chapter 4 Support Functions

Table 90 - Setting Parameters of Earth-fault Location: EFDi


Parameter Value Unit Default Description
EFMode Normal – Normal Normal: The resistor is switched ON during a fault.
Reverse Reverse: The resistor is switched OFF during a fault
TrigIn – Io The triggering input:
Io1 I/O1: earth-fault current will trig the function.
Io2 I/O2: negative-phase sequence current will trig the function
DI1 DI1: the function is triggered by activating the digital input 1
UoTrig 1…80 % Uon 20 Trig level for Uo
Itrig 10…800 % In 80 Trig level for current
Event On – On Event mask
Off

Table 91 - Measured and Recorded Values of Earth-fault Location: EFDi


Parameter Value Unit Description
Measured values/ Fault ph Fault phase information
recorded values
X ohm Fault reactance
Date – Fault date
Time – Fault time
Time ms Fault time
Count – Number of faults

214 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Chapter 5

Measurement Functions

All direct measurements are based on fundamental frequency values (the


exceptions are frequency and instantaneous current for arc protection).
Figure 109 shows a current waveform and the corresponding fundamental
frequency component, second harmonic and rms value in a special case, when
the current deviates significantly from a pure sine-wave.

Figure 109 - Example of Various Current Values of a Transformer Inrush Current

10 Load = 0% 100

rms f2/f1 (%)


5 f1 50

Harmonic f2/f1 (%)


Relative second
f2
Current (PU)

0 0

-5
IL2
-10

0.00 0.05 0.10 0.15 0.20 0.25 0.30


Time

Measurement Accuracy Table 92 - Phase Current Inputs IL1, IL2, IL3

The Measuring Range 25 mA – 250 A (5 A)


Inaccuracy I ≤ 7.5 A 0.5% of value or 15 mA
I > 7.5 A 3% of value

The specified frequency range is 45…65 Hz.


Squelch Limit
Phase Current Inputs 0.5% of INOM (±0.05%)
Residual Current 0.2% of INOM (±0.05%)

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 215


Chapter 5 Measurement Functions

UA, UB, UC Voltage Inputs

The use of voltage inputs depends on the configuration parameter “voltage


measurement mode”. For example, Uc is the zero sequence voltage input U0 if
the mode “1LL+U0/LLy” is selected.

Table 93 - Voltage Inputs UA, UB, UC

Measurement Range 0.5…175V


Inaccuracy ± 0.5% or ± 0.3V

The specified frequency range is 45…65 Hz.

The rated input In is 5 A, 1 A, or 0.2 A. It is specified in the order code of the


device.

Table 94 - Residual Current Inputs I01, I02


Measurement Range 0…10 x In
Inaccuracy I ≤ 1.5 x ln ±0.3% of value or ± 0.2% of In
I > 1.5 x In ±3% of value

The specified frequency range is 45…65 Hz.

Table 95 - Frequency
Measurement Range 16…75 Hz
Inaccuracy ±10 MHz

Table 96 - Power Measurement P, Q, S


Inaccuracy | PF | > 0.5 ±1% of value or ±3VASEC

The specified frequency range is 45…65 Hz.

Table 97 - Power Factor

Inaccuracy | PF | > 0.5 ±0.02 unit or ±2 °

The specified frequency range is 45…65 Hz.

Table 98 - Energy Counters E+, Eq+, E-, Eq-

Inaccuracy | PF | > 0.5 ±1% of value or ±3 Whsecondary/1 h

The specified frequency range is 45…65 Hz.

Table 99 - THD and Harmonics


Inaccuracy I, U > 0.1 PU ±2% units
Update rate Once a second

The specified frequency range is 45…65 Hz.

216 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Measurement Functions Chapter 5

RMS Values RMS Currents

The 857 Protection System calculates the RMS value of each phase current.
The minimum and the maximum of RMS values are recorded and stored (see
Minimum and Maximum Values on page 218).

I rms = I f 12 + I f 22 + … + I f 152

RMS Voltages

The 857 Protection System calculates the RMS value of each voltage input.
The minimum and the maximum of RMS values are recorded and stored (see
Minimum and Maximum Values on page 218).

U rms = U f 12 + U f 22 + … + U f 152

Harmonics and Total The 857 Protection System calculates THDs as percentage of the base
frequency for currents and voltages. The device calculates the harmonics from
Harmonic Distortion (THD) the second to the 15th of phase currents and voltages. The 17th harmonic
component is shown partly in the value of the 15th harmonic component, due
to the nature of digital-sampling. The harmonic distortion is calculated using
the equation.
15

 hi
2

i=2 - , where
THD = -------------------
h1

h1 = Fundamental value
h2…15 = Harmonics

Example:

h1 = 100 A
h3 = 10 A
h7 = 3A
h11 = 8A
2 2 2
10 + 3 + 8 - = 13.2%
THD = -----------------------------------
100

For reference, the RMS value is:


2 2 2 2
RMS = 100 + 10 + 3 + 8 = 100.9A

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 217


Chapter 5 Measurement Functions

Another way to calculate THD is to use the RMS value as reference instead of
the fundamental frequency value. In the example above, the result would be
13%.

Demand Values The device calculates an average value of the phase currents IL1, IL2, IL3, and
power values S, P, and Q. The demand time is configurable from 10…30
minutes with parameter “Demand time”.

Table 100 - Demand Value Parameters


Parameter Value Unit Description Set
Time 10…30 min Demand time (average time) Set
Fundamental frequency values
IL1da A Demand of phase current IL1
IL2da A Demand of phase current IL2
IL3da A Demand of phase current IL3
Pda kW Demand of active power P
PFda Demand of power factor PF
Qda kVAR Demand of reactive power Q
Sda kVA Demand of apparent power S
RMS values
IL1da A Demand of phase current IL1
IL2da A Demand of phase current IL2
IL3da A Demand of phase current IL3

Minimum and Maximum Minimum and maximum values are registered with a time stamp (since the last
manual clear or since the last device restart). The available registered minimum
Values and maximum values are listed in this table.

Table 101 - Minimum and Maximum Values


Minimum and Maximum Measurement Description
IL1, IL2, IL3 Phase current (fundamental frequency value)
IL1RMS, IL2RMS, IL3RMS Phase current, rms value
Io1, Io2 Residual current
U12, U23, U31 Line-to-line voltage
Uo Zero sequence voltage
f Frequency
P, Q, S Active, reactive, apparent power
IL1da, IL2da, IL3da Demand values of phase currents
IL1da, IL2da, IL3da (rms value) Demand values of phase currents, rms values
PFda Power factor demand-value

The clearing parameter “ClrMax” is common for all these values.

218 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Measurement Functions Chapter 5

Table 102 - Parameters


Parameter Value Description Set
ClrMax – Reset all minimum and maximum values S
Clear

Maximum Values of the Last Some minimum and maximum values of the last 31 days and the last 12
months are stored in the nonvolatile memory of the device. The corresponding
31 Days and 12 Months time stamps are stored for the last 31 days.

Table 103 - Registered Values


Measurement Maximum Minimum Description
IL1, IL2, IL3 X Phase current (fundamental frequency value)
Io1, Io2 X Residual current
S X Apparent power
P X X Active power
Q X X Reactive power

The value can be a one cycle value or an average, according to the Time Base
parameter.

Table 104 - Parameters of the Day and Month Registers


Parameter Value Description Set
Timebase Parameter to select the type of the registered values: S
20 ms Collect minimum and maximum of one cycle values(1)
200 ms Collect minimum and maximum of 200-ms average values
1s Collect minimum and maximum of 1-s average values
1 min Collect minimum and maximum of 1-minute average values
Demand Collect minimum and maximum of demand values (see Demand Values on
page 218)
ResetDays Reset the 31-day registers S
ResetMon Reset the 12-month registers S
(1) Update of the fundamental frequency rms value of one cycle is every 20 ms.

Voltage Measurement Mode The Bulletin 857 can be connected to line-to-line or phase-to-ground voltages.
The connection is dependent on the application and available voltage
transformers. Set the configuration parameter “Voltage measurement mode”
according to the used connection. The available modes are:
Table 105 - Available Voltage Measurement Modes
Mode Description
“2LL+Uo” The device is connected to line-to-line voltages U12 (X1-11 and X1-12) and U23 (X1-13
and X1-14). Also to zero sequence voltage U0 (X1-17 and X1-18). The phase-to-ground
voltages are calculated. The network must use only three wires. Any neutral wire must not
exist (two PTs/VTs in open delta).
“3LN” The device is connected to phase-to-ground voltages UL1 (X1-11 and X1-12), UL2 (X1-13
and X1-14), and UL3 (X1-17 and X1-18). The zero sequence voltage is calculated. A neutral
wire can exist (three PTs/VTs “Y” connected).

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 219


Chapter 5 Measurement Functions

Table 105 - Available Voltage Measurement Modes (Continued)


“1LL+U0/LLy” This mode is used with the Synchrocheck function. See Table 49 on page 145 (Chapter 3).
2LL/LLy” This mode is used with the Synchrocheck function. See Table 49 on page 145 (Chapter 3).
““LL/LLy/LLz” This mode is used with the Synchrocheck function. See Table 49 on page 145 (Chapter 3).

The overvoltage protection is based on the line-to-line voltage regardless of the


measurement mode.

Power Calculations The power calculations in the 857 are dependent on the voltage measurement
mode (see Voltage Measurement Mode on page 219).

Line-to-Line Voltages
When the 857 is connected to line-to-line voltages, the voltage measurement
mode is set to equal to “2LL+Uo”. The following Aron equation is used for
power calculation.

S = U12 • I*LI – U23 • I*L3 , where

S = Three-phase power phasor.

U12 = Measured voltage phasor that corresponds to the fundamental


frequency voltage between phases L1 and L2.

I*LI = Complex conjugate of the measured phase L1 fundamental


frequency current phasor.

U23 = Measured voltage phasor that corresponds to the fundamental


frequency voltage between phases L2 and L3.

I*L3 = Complex conjugate of the measured phase L3 fundamental


frequency current phasor.

Apparent power, active power, and reactive power are calculated as follows:

S=|S|

P = real( S)

Q = imag( S)

cos ϕ = P
---
S

220 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Measurement Functions Chapter 5

Line-to-Neutral Voltages

When the device is connected to line-to-neutral voltages, the voltage


measurement mode is set to equal to “3LN”. The following equation is used for
power calculation.

S = UL1 • I*LI + UL2 • I*L2 + UL3 • I*L3 , where

S = Three-phase power phasor

UL1 = Measured voltage phasor that corresponds to the fundamental


frequency voltage of phase L1.

I*LI = Complex conjugate of the measured phase L1 fundamental


frequency current phasor.

UL2 = Measured voltage phasor that corresponds to the fundamental


frequency voltage of phase L2.

I*L2 = Complex conjugate of the measured phase L2 fundamental


frequency current phasor.

UL3 = Measured voltage phasor that corresponds to the fundamental


frequency voltage of phase L3.

I*L3 = Complex conjugate of the measured phase L3 fundamental


frequency current phasor.

Apparent power, active power, and reactive power are calculated similarly as
with line-to-line voltages by using the following equation:

S=|S|

P = real( S)

Q = imag( S)

cos ϕ = P
---
S

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 221


Chapter 5 Measurement Functions

Direction of Power and Figure 110 shows the concept of three-phase current direction and sign of cosϕ
and power factor PF. Figure 111 shows the same concepts, but on a PQ-power
Current plane.

Figure 110 - Quadrants of Voltage/Current Phasor Plane

-inductive +Capacitive
Reverse inductive power current Forward capacitive power
is leading current is leading
cosφ = - cosφ = +
PF = + PF = -

-Capacitive
Reverse capacitive power current is +Inductive
lagging Forward inductive power
cosφ = - current is lagging
PF = - cosφ = +
PF = +

Figure 111 - Quadrants of Power Plane

-Capacitive +inductive
Reverse capacitive power Forward inductive power
current is lagging current is lagging
cosφ = - cosφ = +
PF = - PF = +

-Inductive +Capacitive
Reverse inductive power current Forward capacitive power
is lagging current is leading
cosφ = - cosφ = +
PF = + PF = -

Table 106 - Table of Power Quadrants


Power Quadrant Current Related to Voltage Power Direction cosϕ Power Factor PF
+ inductive Lagging Forward + +
+ capacitive Leading Forward + -
- inductive Leading Reverse - +
- capacitive Lagging Reverse - -

222 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Measurement Functions Chapter 5

Symmetric Components In a three-phase system, the voltage or current phasors can be divided in the
symmetric components:
• Positive sequence 1.
• Negative sequence 2.
• Zero sequence 0.

Symmetric components are calculated according to these equations.

S 1 1 1 U
0 1---
S = 1 a a 2 V , where
1 3
S2 1 a2 a W

S0 = Zero sequence component.


S1 = Positive sequence component.
S2 = Negative sequence component.

3
a = 1 ∠120° = – 1--- + j ------- , a phasor rotating constant
2 2

U = Phasor of phase L1 (phase current or line-to-neutral voltage).


V = Phasor of phase L2.
W = Phasor of phase L3.

In case the voltage measurement mode is “2LL+Uo” (that is two line-to-line


voltages are measured) this equation is used:

U1 1 2 U
= --- 1 – a 12
, where
U2 3 1 –a U
23

U12 = Voltage between phases L1 and L2.


U23 = Voltage between phases L2 and L3.

When using line-to-line voltages, any zero sequence voltage cannot be


calculated.

TIP The zero sequence or residual measurement signals connected to the device
are -U0 and 3I0. However, usually the name “I0” is used instead of the correct
name “3I0”

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 223


Chapter 5 Measurement Functions

Example 1 – Single Phase Injection

UN = 100V
Voltage measurement mode is “2LL+Uo”.
Injection:
Ua = U12= 100V
Ub = U23= 0

= --- 1 – a 100 ∠0° = --- 100 ∠0° = 33


U1 1 2 1
U2 3 1 –a 0 3 100 ∠0° 33

U1 = 33%
U2 = 33%
U2/U1 = 100%

When using a single-phase test device, the relative unbalance U2/U1 is 100%.

Example 2 – Two-phase Injection with Adjustable Phase Angle

UN = 100V
Voltage measurement mode is “2LL+Uo”.
Injection:
Ua = U12 = 100V ∠0°
Ub = U23 = 100/√ 3V ∠–150° = 57.7V ∠–150°

U 2
100 ∠0°
1 = 1 = --------- 1 ∠0° – 1 ⁄ 3 ∠+ 90° =
--- 1 a 100
3 2 100 ⁄ 3 ∠– 150° 3
U
2 1 a 1 ∠0° – 1 ⁄ 3 ∠– 30 °

= --------- 2 ⁄ 3 ∠– 30° = 38.5 ∠– 30°


100
3
1 ⁄ 3 ∠+30° 19.2 ∠+ 30°

U1 = 38.5%
U2 = 19.2%
U2/U1 = 50%

Figure 112 shows a geometric solution. The input values have been scaled with
√ 3/100 to make the calculation easier.

224 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Measurement Functions Chapter 5

Figure 112 - Example of Symmetric Component Calculation Using Line-to-Line Voltages


Positive sequence
U1 = 2/3
√3 U12
2
a U23
2
Injected line-to-line voltages

1
√3 U12-a2U23
2
120° -a U23
U12 U12
1 150° 120°
Negative sequence
U23 U23 aU23

-aU23 U12-aU23
1 1
√3 U12

U2 = 1/3

Unscaling the geometric results gives:

U1 =100/√ 3 x 2/3=38.5%
U2 = 100/√ 3 x 1/3 = 19.2%
U2/U1 = 1/3:2/3 = 50%

Example 3 – Two-phase Injection with Adjustable Phase Angle

UN = 100V
Voltage measurement mode is “3LN”.
Injection:
Ua = UL1 = 100/√ 3V ∠0° = 57.7V ∠0°
Ub = UL2 = 100/√ 3V ∠− 120° = 57.7V ∠− 120°
Uc = UL3 = 0V
An identical case with Example 2. The resulting line-to-line voltages
U12=UL1 – UL2=100V ∠30° and U23= UL2 – UL3 =UL2=100/√ 3V∠120°
are the same. The only difference is a 30° phase angle difference, but without
any absolute angle reference the device does not see this phase angle difference.
100
U 1 1 1 --------- ∠0°
0 3 100 ∠0° + 100 ∠– 120°
1 1
U = --- 1 a a 2 100 = ---------- 100 ∠0° + 100 ∠0° =
1 3 --------- ∠– 120° 3 3
U 2 3 100 ∠0° + 100 ∠+120°
2 1 a a
0

100 ∠– 60° 19.2 ∠– 60°


1
= ---------- 200 ∠0° = 38.5 ∠0°
3 3
100 ∠60° 19.2 ∠+60°

U0 = 19.2%
U1 = 38.5%
U2 = 19.2%
U2/U1 = 50%

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 225


Chapter 5 Measurement Functions

Figure 113 shows a graphical solution. The input values have been scaled with
√ 3/100 to make the calculation easier.

Figure 113 - Example of Symmetric Component Calculation Using Line-to-Neutral Voltages


Positive sequence

U1 = 2/3
2
a UL2
UL1+aUL2
Injected line-to-line voltages

UL3=0 120° Negative sequence


UL1 UL1
120° 120° aUL2 a2U UL1+a2UL2
L2

UL2 UL2
UL1

U2 = 1/3

Unscaling the geometric results gives

U1 = 100/√ 3 x 2/3 = 38.5%


U2 = 100√ 3 x 1/3 = 19.2%
U2/U1 = 1/3:2/3 = 50%

Primary, Secondary, and Per Many measurement values are shown as primary values although the 857 is
connected to secondary signals. Some measurement values are shown as
Unit Scaling relative values – per unit or percent. Almost all pick-up setting values are using
relative scaling. The scaling is done using the given CT, VT in feeder mode and
motor nameplate values in motor mode.

For scaling equations that are useful when doing secondary testing see:
• Current Scaling on page 227
• Per Unit [pu] Scaling of Line-to-Line Voltages on page 230
• Primary, Secondary, and Per Unit Scaling on page 226
• Voltage Scaling on page 229

226 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Measurement Functions Chapter 5

Current Scaling

TIP The current input, 5 A or 1 A rated value of the device, has no effect in the
scaling equations. It defines the measurement range and the Maximum
allowed continuous current. See Measuring the Circuitry on page 347 for
details.

Table 107 - Primary and Secondary Scaling


Current scaling

CT PRI
Secondary  Primary I PRI = I SEC • -----------------
CT SEC
CT SEC
Primary  Secondary I SEC = I PRI • -----------------
CT PRI

For residual currents to inputs I01 or I02, use the corresponding CTPRI and
CTSEC values. For earth-fault stages that use I0Calc signals, use the phase
current CT values for CTPRI and CTSEC.

Example 1 – Secondary to Primary

CT = 500/5
Current to the device input is 4 A.
 Primary current is IPRI = 4 x 500/5 = 400 A.
Example 2 – Primary to Secondary

CT = 500/5
The device displays IPRI = 400 A
 Injected current is ISEC = 400 x 5/500 = 4 A.

Per unit [pu] Scaling

For phase currents excluding ArcI> stage


IPU = 1 x IMODE= 100%, where
IMODE is the rated current according to the mode (see page 495).

For residual currents and ArcI> stage


IPU = 1 x CTSEC for secondary side and
IPU = 1 x CTPRI for primary side.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 227


Chapter 5 Measurement Functions

Table 108 - Phase Current Scaling


Phase Current Scaling for Motor Mode Phase Current Scaling for Feeder
Mode, ArcI> Stage and Residual
Current (3I0)
Secondary  Per I SEC • CT PRI I SEC
unit I PU = ----------------------------------
- I PU = ----------------
-
CT SEC • I MOT CT SEC
Per unit I MOT
 Secondary I PU = I PU • CT SEC • --------------- I SEC = I PU • CT SEC
CT PRI

Example 1 – Secondary to per unit for Feeder Mode and ArcI>

CT = 750/5
Current injected to the device inputs is 7 A.
 Per unit current is
IPU = 7/5 = 1.4 pu= 140%

Example 2 – Secondary to per unit and Percent for Phase Currents in Motor Mode Excluding
ArcI>

CT = 750/5
IMOT = 525 A
Current injected to the device inputs is 7 A.
 Per unit current is
IPU = 7 x 750/(5 x 525) = 2.00 pu= 2.00 x IMOT = 200%

Example 3 – Per unit to Secondary for Feeder Mode and ArcI>

CT = 750/5
The device setting is 2 pu= 200%.
 Secondary current is
ISEC = 2 x 5= 10 A

Example 4 – Per unit and Percent to Secondary for Phase Currents in Motor Mode Excluding
ArcI>

CT = 750/5
IMOT = 525 A
The device setting is 2 x IMOT = 2 pu= 200%.
 Secondary current is
ISEC = 2 x 5 x 525/750= 7 A

Example 5 – Secondary to per unit for Residual Current

Input is I01 or I02.


CT0 = 50/1
Current injected to the device input is 30 mA.
 Per unit current is
IPU = 0.03/1= 0.03 pu= 3%

228 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Measurement Functions Chapter 5

Example 6 – Per unit to Secondary for Residual Current

Input is I01 or I02.


CT0 = 50/1
The device setting is 0.03 pu= 3%.
 Secondary current is
ISEC = 0.03 x 1= 30 mA

Example 7 – Secondary to per unit for Residual Current

Input is I0Calc.
CT = 750/5
Currents that are injected to the device IL1 input are 0.5 A.
IL2 = IL3 = 0.
 Per unit current is
IPU = 0.5/5= 0.1 pu= 10%

Example 8 – Per unit to Secondary for Residual Current

Input is I0Calc.
CT = 750/5
The device setting is 0.1 pu= 10%.
 If IL2 = IL3 = 0, then secondary current to IL11 is
ISEC = 0.1 x 5 = 0.5 A

Voltage Scaling Table 109 - Primary/Secondary Scaling of Line-to-Line Voltages


Line-to-line Voltage Scaling
Voltage Measurement Mode = “2LL+Uo” Voltage Measurement Mode = “3LN”

VT PRI VT
PRI-
Secondary  Primary U PRI = U SEC • ----------------- U PRI = 3 • U SEC • -------------------
VT SEC VT SEC

VT SEC U PRI VT SEC


Primary  Secondary U SEC = U PRI • ----------------- U SEC = ------------ • -----------------
VT PRI 3 VT PRI

Example 1 – Secondary to Primary. Voltage Measurement Mode Is “2LL+Uo”

VT = 12000/110
Voltage that is connected to the device input Ua or Ub is 100V.
 Primary voltage is upRI = 100 x 12000/110 = 10909V
Example 2 – Secondary to Primary. Voltage Measurement Mode Is “3LN”

VT = 12000/110
Three-phase symmetric voltages that are connected to the device inputs Ua, Ub
and Uc are 57.7V.
 Primary voltage is upRI = √ 3 x 58 x 12000/110 = 10902V

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 229


Chapter 5 Measurement Functions

Example 3 – Primary to Secondary. Voltage Measurement Mode Is “2LL+Uo”

VT = 12000/110
The device displays upRI = 10910V.
 Secondary voltage is USEC = 10910 x 110/12000 = 100V
Example 4 – Primary to Secondary. Voltage Measurement Mode Is “3LN”

VT = 12000/110
The device displays U12 = U23 = U31 = 10910V.
 Symmetric secondary voltages at Ua, Ub, and Uc are
USEC = 10910/√ 3 x 110/12000 = 57.7 V4

Per Unit [pu] Scaling of Line-to-Line Voltages


1 per unit= 1 pu= 1 x UN = 100%, where UN = rated voltage of the VT.

Table 110 - Scaling of Line-to-Line Voltages


Line-to-line Voltage Scaling
Voltage Measurement Mode = “2LL+Uo”, “1LL+Uo/ Voltage Measurement Mode = “3LN”
LLy”, “2LL/LLy”, “LL/LLy/LLz”
Secondary  U SEC VT U VT
per unit
U PU = --------------------
VT SEC
• -----------------
U
PRI-
U PRI = 3 • -------------------
VT
SEC-
U
PRI
• ------------------
N SEC N
per unit  U VT U
Secondary
U SEC = U PU • VTSEC • -----------------
VT
N -
U SEC = U PU • -------------------
SEC- N
• ------------------
VT
PRI 3 PRI

Example 1 – Secondary to per unit. Voltage Measurement Mode Is “2LL+Uo”

VT = 12000/110
Voltage that is connected to the device input Ua or Ub is 110V.
 Per unit voltage is
upU = 110/110 = 1.00 pu= 1.00 x UN = 100%

Example 2 – Secondary to per unit. Voltage Measurement Mode Is “3LN”

VT = 12000/110
Three symmetric phase-to-neutral voltages that are connected to the device
inputs Ua,Ub and Uc are 63.5V
 Per unit voltage is
upU = √ 3 x 63.5 /110 x 12000 /11000 = 1.00 pu = 1.00 x UN = 100%

Example 3 – Per unit to Secondary. Voltage Measurement Mode Is “2LL+Uo”

VT = 12000/110
The device displays 1.00 pu= 100%.
 Secondary voltage is
USEC = 1.00 x 110 x 11000/12000 = 100.8V

230 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Measurement Functions Chapter 5

Example 4 – Per unit to Secondary. Voltage Measurement Mode Is “3LN”

VT = 12,000/110
UN = 11,000V
The device displays 1.00 pu= 100%.
 Three symmetric phase-to-neutral voltages that are connected to the
device inputs Ua, Ub and Uc are
USEC = 1.00 x 110/√3 x 11000/12000 = 58.2V

Table 111 - Per Unit [pu] Scaling of Zero Sequence Voltage


Zero-sequence Voltage (U0) Scaling
Voltage Measurement Mode = Voltage Measurement Mode = “3LN”
“2LL+Uo”, “1LL+Uo/LLy”

Secondary 
U SEC 1 Ua + Ub + Uc
Per unit
UPU = --------------- U PU = ---------------- • -----------------------------------
U 0SEC VTSEC 3
Per unit 
Secondary U SEC = U PU • U 0SEC U a + U b + U c
SEC
= 3 • U PU • VT SEC

Example 1 – Secondary to per unit. Voltages Measurement Mode Is “2LL+Uo”

U0SEC = 110V (A configuration value that corresponds to U0 at full earth-


fault)
Voltage that is connected to the device input Uc is 22V.
 Per unit voltage is
upU = 22/110 = 0.20 pu= 20%

Example 2 – Secondary to per unit. Voltage Measurement Mode Is “3LN”

VT = 12000/110
Voltage that is connected to the device input Ua is 66V, while
Ua = Ub = 0.
 Per unit voltage is
upU = (66+0+0)/(3x110) = 0.20 pu= 20%

Example 3 – Per unit to Secondary. Voltage Measurement Mode Is “2LL+Uo”

U0SEC = 110V (A configuration value that corresponds to U0 at full earth-


fault)
The device displays U0 = 20%.
 Secondary voltage at input Uc is
USEC = 0.20 x 110 = 22V

Example 4 – Per unit to Secondary. Voltage Measurement Mode Is “3LN”

VT = 12000/110
The device displays U0 = 20%.
 If Ub = Uc = 0, then secondary voltages at Ua are
USEC = √3 x 0.2 x 3 x 110 = 38.1V

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 231


Chapter 5 Measurement Functions

Notes:

232 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Chapter 6

Control Functions

Output Relays Output relays are also called digital outputs. Any internal signal can be logically
connected to the output relays by using output matrix. An output relay can be
configured as latched or non-latched. See Output Matrix on page 236 for more
details.

The difference between trip contacts and alarm contacts is the DC break
capacity. See Table 173 on page 349 and Table 174 on page 349 for details. The
contacts are SPST, except alarm relays A1 and A5, which have change over
contacts (SPDT). T1…T14 and A1…A5 can be configured for N.O. or N.C.
polarity through the front panel or SetPointPS.

Table 112 - Parameters of Output Relays


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
T1…T14 0 Status of trip output relay. F(3)
1 (The actual number of relays depends on the ordering code).
A1…A5 0 Status of alarm output relay. F(3)
1
IF 0 Status of the internal fault-indication relay. F(3)
1
Force On Force flag for output relay, forcing for test purposes. A Set(4)
Off common flag for all output relays and protection stage status.
Any forced relays and this flag are automatically reset by a 5-
minute timeout.
REMOTE PULSES
A1…A5 0.00…99.98 s Pulse length for direct output relay control through Set(4)
Or communication protocols.
99.99 99.99 s = Infinite. Release by writing “0” to the direct control
parameter.
POLARITY
T1…T14(1)=NC NO (2) Output relay polarity Normally Open (N.O.) or Normally Closed Set(4)
A1…A5 = NO NC (N.C.).
NAMES for OUTPUT RELAYS (Editable with SetPointPS Only)
Description String of max. Names for DO on SetPointPS screens. Default is Set(4)
32 characters “Trip relay n”, n=1…14 or “Alarm relay n”, n=1…5.
(1) Dependent on order code. More output relays are available on some models.
(2) All relay polarities can be selected for N.O. or N.C..
(3) F = Editable when force flag is on.
(4) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 233


Chapter 6 Control Functions

Digital Inputs There are up to 32 digital inputs available for control purposes (varies by
model). The polarity – normal open (N.O.) / normal closed (N.C.) – and a
delay can be configured according to the application. The signals are available
for the output matrix, block matrix, programmable logic, and so on. When
120V or 220V AC is used to activate the digital input. Use the SetPointPS
software to select the AC Mode.

The contacts that are connected to digital inputs DI1…DI6 must be dry. These
inputs use the common internal 48-Vdc wetting-voltage from terminal X3:1,
only.

TIP Do not connect Digital inputs DI1… DI6 parallel with inputs of another
device.

Label and description texts can be edited with SetPointPS according to the
application. Labels are the short parameter names that are used on the local
panel and descriptions are the longer names that are used by SetPointPS.

Table 113 - Parameters of Digital Inputs


Parameter Value Unit Description Set
DI1…DIn 0 Status of digital input
1 (The actual number of digital inputs depends on the ordering
code)
DI COUNTERS
DI1…DIn 0…65535 Cumulative active edge counter (Set)(1)
(The actual number of digital inputs depends on the ordering
code)
DELAYS FOR DIGITAL INPUTS
DI1…DIn 0.00…60.00 s Definite delay for both on and off transitions Set(1)
(The actual number of digital inputs depends on the ordering
code)
CONFIGURATION DI1…DI6 (32)
Inverted No For normal open contacts (N.O.). Active edge is 0  1 Set(1)
Yes For normal closed contacts (N.C.).Active edge is 1  0
Alarm display No No popup display Set(1)
Yes Alarm popup display is activated at active DI edge
On event On Active edge event enabled Set(1)
Off Active edge event disabled
Off event On Inactive edge event enabled Set(1)
Off Inactive edge event disabled
NAMES for DIGITAL INPUTS (Editable with SetPointPS Only)
Label String of Short name for DIs on the local display Set(1)
max. 10 Default is “DIn”, n=1…32
characters
Description String of Long name for DIs. Set(1)
max. 32 Default is “Digital input n”, n=1…32
characters
(1) @Set = An editable parameter (password required).

234 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Control Functions Chapter 6

An additional input card is available as an option. The additional option card is


in the X8 location and has the same ratings as the card in X7.
Table 114 - Summary of Digital Inputs
DI Terminal Operating Voltage Availability
- X3:1 48V DC supply for DI1…6 Always available
1 X3:2 Internal 48V DC
2 X3:3
3 X3:4
4 X3:5
5 X3:6
6 X3:7
7 X7:1 External 18…265V DC
50…250 V AC
8 X7:2
9 X7:3
10 X7:4
11 X7:5
12 X7:6
- X7:7 Common for DI7…12
13 X7:8 External 18…265V DC
50…250 V AC
14 X7:9
15 X7:10
16 X7:11
17 X7:12
18 X7:13
- X7:14 Common for DI13…17
19 X6:1…2 External 18…265V DC ARC card with 2 DIs
50…250V AC
20 X6:3…4

The digital input signals can be used for blocking and control signals for the
output relays. An additional input card is available as an option. The additional
option card is in the X8 location and has the same ratings as the card in X7.
Table 115 - Digital Input Threshold Voltages
Common Input group Wetting-voltage
input
On Off
X7:7 X7: 1…6 (DI 7…12) ≥18V DC or ≥50V AC ≤ 10V DC or ≤ 5V AC
X7:14 X7: 8…13 (DI ≥18V DC or ≥50V AC ≤ 10 Vdc or ≤ 5V AC
13…18)

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 235


Chapter 6 Control Functions

Virtual Inputs and Outputs There are four virtual inputs and six virtual outputs. The four virtual inputs act
like normal digital inputs. The state of the virtual input can be changed from
the display, through a communication bus and from SetPointPS. The setting of
groups can be done using virtual inputs. The polarity (V=value) can be
configured, according to the application use, using the SetPointPS tool.

Table 116 - Parameters of Virtual Inputs


Parameter Value Unit Description Set
VI1…VI4 0 Status of virtual input
1
Events On Event enabling Set (1)
Off
NAMES for VIRTUAL INPUTS (Editable with SetPointPS Only)
Label String of max. 10 Short name for VIs on the local display Set (1)
characters Default is “VIn”, n=1…4
Description String of max. 32 Long name for VIs. Set (1)
characters Default is “Virtual input n”, n=1…4
(1) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

The six virtual outputs act like output relays, but there are no physical contacts.
Virtual outputs are shown in the output matrix and the block matrix. Virtual
outputs can be used with the programmable logic and to change the active
setting group, and so on. Virtual inputs and outputs can be used to start and
stop an application remotely. They can also be used for condition or switching
device status feedback, or to open, or close, the main switching device such as a
contactor or circuit breaker.

Output Matrix The output matrix connects, the output signals of the various protection stages,
digital inputs, and logic outputs. The output matrix also connects to other
internal signals to the output relays, front-panel status indicators, virtual
outputs, and so on.

There are two status indicators named ‘Alarm’” and ‘Trip’ on the front panel.
There are three general-purpose status indicators – ‘A’, ‘B’, and ‘C’ – available
for customer-specific indications. In addition, the triggering of the disturbance
recorder (DR) and virtual outputs are configurable in the output matrix. See an
example in Figure 114.

An output relay or status indicator can be configured as latched or non-latched.


A non-latched relay follows the controlling signal. A latched relay remains
activated although the controlling signal releases.

236 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Control Functions Chapter 6

There is a common “release latched” signal to release all latched relays. This
release signal resets all latched output relays and indicators. Use a digital input,
a keypad, or by communication.to give the reset signal. Any digital input can be
used for resetting. The selection of the input is done with the SetPointPS
software under the menu ‘Release output matrix latches’. Under the same
menu, the ‘Release latches’ parameter can be used for resetting. The enter key
releases the latches from the front panel.

Figure 114 - Typical Output Matrix (Varies by Model)


OUTPUT MATRIX
T1 T2 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 Alarm Trip A B C DR VO1
Connected
Connected and latched

Block Matrix With a block matrix, the operation of any protection stage can be blocked. The
blocking signal can:
• Originate from the digital inputs DI1 to DIn (see chapter order
code).
• Be a start or trip signal from a protection stage.
• Be an output signal from the programmable logic.

In the block matrix (Figure 115), active blocking is indicated with a black dot
(•) in the crossing point of a blocking signal and the signal to be blocked.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 237


Chapter 6 Control Functions

Figure 115 - Block Matrix and Output Matrix

Output Relays Operation


Indicators

Stage 1
Start
Trip
Block
Stage 2
Start
Trip
Block

Digital Inputs

Block Matrix Relay Matrix


Reset all latches

Controllable Objects The relay allows controlling of six objects, that is, circuit-breakers,
disconnectors and earthing switches. Control is done using the “select-execute”
or “direct control” principle.

The logic functions can configure interlocking for controlling before the
output pulse is issued. Objects 1…6 are controllable while objects 7…8 are only
able to show the status. Control is possible through:
• The local HMI.
• Remote communication.
• Digital input.

The connection of an object to specific output relays is done through an


output matrix (object 1…6 open output, object 1…6 close output). There is an
output signal “Object failed”, which is activated if the control of an object fails.

Object States
Each object has the states shown in Table 117.

238 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Control Functions Chapter 6

Table 117 - Object States


Setting Value Description
Object state Undefined (00) Actual state of the object
Open
Close
Undefined (11)

Basic Settings for Controllable Objects

Each controllable object has the settings shown in the following table.

Table 118 - Basic Settings for Controllable Objects


Setting Value Description
DI for “obj open” None, any digital input, virtual input, or Open information
virtual output
DI for “obj close” Close information
DI for “obj ready” Ready information
Max ctrl pulse length 0.02…600 s Pulse length for open and close commands
Completion timeout 0.02…600 s Timeout of ready indication
Object control Open/Close Direct object control

If a state change exceeds the “Max ctrl pulse length” setting, the object fails and
the “Object failure” matrix signal is set. Also an undefined-event is generated.
“Completion timeout” is only used for the ready indication. If “DI for ‘obj
ready’” is not set, completion timeout has no meaning.

Output Signals of Controllable Objects

Each controllable object has two control signals in matrix.

Table 119 - Output Signals of Controllable Objects


Output Signal Description
Object x Open Open control signal for the object
Object x Close Close control signal for the object

When digital input, remote bus, auto-reclose (and so forth) control an object,
these signals send a control pulse.

Settings for Read-only Objects

Each read-only object has the settings shown in the following table.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 239


Chapter 6 Control Functions

Table 120 - Settings for Read-only Objects


Setting Value Description
DI for “obj open” None, any digital input, virtual input, or virtual Open information
output
DI for “obj close” Close information
Object timeout 0.02…600 s Timeout for state changes

If a state change takes longer than the time defined by the “Object timeout”
setting, the object fails and an“Object failure” matrix signal is set. Also
undefined-event is generated.

Controlling with DI

Objects can be controlled with digital input, virtual input, or virtual output.
There are four settings for each controllable object.

Table 121 - Controlling with DI


Setting Active
DI for remote open control In remote state
DI for remote close control
DI for local open control In local state
DI for local close control

If the device is in local control state, the remote control inputs are ignored and
vice versa. Object is controlled when a rising edge is detected from the selected
input. The length of a digital input pulse is at least 60 ms.

Local/Remote Selection

In Local mode, the output relays can be controlled through a local HMI. Also a
serial communication interface cannot control the output relays remotely.

In Remote mode, the output relays cannot be controlled though a local HMI,
but a serial communication interface can control them remotely.

The selection of the Local/Remote mode is done by using a local HMI, or by


one selectable digital input. The digital input is normally used to change a
whole station to a local or remote mode. The selection of the L/R digital input
is done in the “Objects” menu of the SetPointPS software.

TIP A password is not required for a remote control operation.

240 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Control Functions Chapter 6

Auto-reclose Function (79) The 857 Protection System protection relays include a sophisticated Auto-
reclosing (AR) function. The AR function is normally used in feeder
protection relays that helps protect an overhead line. Most overhead line faults
are temporary. An estimated 85% can be cleared by using the AR function.

General

Normal protection functions detect the fault. The protection function then
triggers the AR function. After tripping the circuit-breaker (CB) or contactor,
the AR function can reclose the CB or contactor. Normally, the first reclose (or
shot) is so short in time that consumers cannot notice anything. However, the
fault is cleared and the feeder continues in normal service.

Terminology

There are five reclose shots. A shot consists of open time (so called “dead” time)
and close time (so called “burning” time or discrimination time). A high-speed
shot means that the dead time is less than 1 s. The time-delayed shot means
longer dead times up to 2…3 minutes.

There are four AR lines. A line means an initialization signal for AR. Normally,
start or trip signals of protection functions are used to initiate an AR-sequence.
Each AR line has a priority. AR1 has the highest and AR4 has the lowest one. If
two lines are initiated simultaneously, AR follows only the highest priority
line. A typical configuration of the lines is that the instantaneous overcurrent
stage initiates the AR1 line, time-delayed overcurrent stage the AR2 line, and
earth-fault-protection uses lines AR3 and AR4.

Contact Rockwell Automation® for more information or see our application


notes regarding the Auto-reclosing function in the 857 Protection System
relays.

The auto-reclose (AR) matrix in Figure 116 describes the start and trip signals
that are forwarded to the auto-reclose function.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 241


Chapter 6 Control Functions

Figure 116 - Auto-reclose Matrix

AR-matrix Start delay

Open CB
Dead time Discrimination time Reclaim time

Open CB
.
.
I>>s
I>t
I>s
Critical 0…300 s 0…300 s
Shot 1 AR1 In use
AR2 In use 0…300 s 0…300 s 0…300 s 0…300 s

Not in use 0…300 s 0…300 s


Shot 2 In use

shot
time, continue on the next
activated during reclaim
If new AR request is
make final trip
during discrimination time,
If critical signal is activated
Shot 3…5

The AR matrix (Figure 116) defines which signals (the start and trip signals
from protection stages or digital input) are forwarded to the auto-reclose
function. In the AR function, the AR signals can be configured to initiate the
reclose sequence. Each shot from 1…5 has its own enabled/disabled flag. If
multiple AR signals activate simultaneously, AR1 has highest priority and AR2
the lowest. Each AR signal has an independent start delay for the shot 1. If a
higher priority AR signal activates during the start delay, the start delay setting
is changed to that of the highest priority AR signal.

After the start delay, the circuit-breaker (CB) opens. When the CB opens, a
dead time timer is started. Each shot from 1…5 has its own dead time setting.

After the dead time, the CB closes and a discrimination time timer is started.
Each shot from 1…5 has its own discrimination time setting. If a critical signal
is activated during the discrimination time, the AR function makes a final trip.
The CB opens and the AR sequence is locked. The CB manually clears the
“locked” state when it is closed

After the discrimination time has elapsed, the reclaim time timer starts. If any
AR signal is activated during the reclaim time or the discrimination time, the
AR function moves to the next shot. The reclaim time setting is common for
every shot.

If the reclaim time expires, the auto-reclose sequence is successfully executed and
the AR function moves to ready-state and waits for a new AR request in shot 1.

A trip signal from the protection stage can be used as a backup. Configure the
start signal of the protection stage to initiate the AR function. If something
fails in the AR function, the trip signal of the protection stage opens the CB.

242 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Control Functions Chapter 6

The delay setting for the protection stage must be longer than the AR start
delay and discrimination time.

If a critical signal is used to interrupt an AR sequence, the discrimination time


setting must be long enough for the critical stage, usually at least 100 ms.

Manual Closing

When a CB is closed manually, for example with the local panel, remote bus,
digital inputs, the reclaim state is activated. Within the reclaim time, all AR
requests are ignored. It is up to the protection stages to take care of tripping.
Trip signals of the protection stages must be connected to a trip relay in the
output matrix.

Manual Opening

If a manual CB open command is given during AR sequence, it stops the


sequence and leaves the CB open.

Reclaim Time Setting

There are two Reclaim Time Settings.


• Use shot specific reclaim Time: No - The reclaim time setting defines
reclaim time between simultaneously shots during sequence and reclaim
time after manual closing.
• Use shot specific reclaim time: Yes - The reclaim time setting defines
reclaim time only for manual control. Shot specific reclaim time settings
defines reclaim time between simultaneous shots.

Support for Two Circuit Breakers

AR function can be configured to manage two controllable objects. Object 1 is


used as CB1 and any other controllable object can be used as CB2. The object
selection for CB2 is made with the Breaker 2 object setting. To switch between
the two objects, use a digital input, virtual input, virtual output, or choose
Auto CB selection. AR controls CB2 when the input defined by Input for
selecting CB2 setting is active. The exception being, when using auto CB
selection when operated CB 1 or 2 is that which was last in close state. Control
is changed to another object only if the current object is not close.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 243


Chapter 6 Control Functions

Blocking of AR Shots

Each AR shot can be blocked with a digital input, virtual input, or virtual
output. The blocking input, is selected with Block setting. When selected
input is active, the shot is blocked. A blocked shot is treated like it does not
exist and AR sequence jumps over it. If the last shot in use is blocked, any AR
request during the reclaiming of the previous shot causes a final trip.

Starting AR Sequence

Each AR request has a separate counter for the starting delay. The one where
the starting delay has elapsed first, is selected. If multiple delays elapse
simultaneously, an AR request of the highest priority is selected. AR1 has the
highest priority and AR4 has the lowest priority. First shot is selected
according to the AR request. Next AR opens the CB and starts counting dead
time.

The Starting Sequence at Shot 2…5 and Skipping of AR Shots

Each AR request line can be enabled to any combination of the five shots. For
example, a sequence of Shot 2 and Shot 4 for AR request 1 is done by enabling
AR1 only for those two shots.

TIP If AR sequence is started at shot 2…5, the starting delay is taken from the
discrimination time setting of the previous shot. For example, if Shot 3 is the
first shot for AR2, Discrimination time of Shot 2 for AR2 defines the starting
delay for the sequence.

Critical AR Request

Critical AR request stops the AR sequence and causes final tripping. Critical
request is ignored when AR sequence is not running and when AR is
reclaiming. Critical signal is accepted only during dead time and
discrimination time.

Shot Active Matrix Signals

When a starting delay has elapsed, active signal of the first shot is set. If
successful reclosing is executed at the end of the shot, the active signal is reset
after reclaim time. If reclosing was not successful or new fault appears during
reclaim time, the active of the current shot is reset. Then the active signal of the
next shot is set (if any shots remain before final trip).

244 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Control Functions Chapter 6

AR Running Matrix Signal

This signal indicates dead time. The signal is set after controlling CB open.
When dead time ends, the signal is reset and CB is controlled close.

Final Trip Matrix Signals

There are five final trip signals in the matrix, one for each AR request (1…4 and
critical). When final trip is generated, one of these signals is set according to
the AR request, which caused the final tripping. The final trip signal stays
active for 0.5 seconds and then resets automatically.

Digital Input to Block AR Setting


This setting is useful with an external Synchrocheck device. This setting only
affects the reclosing of the CB. Reclosing can be blocked with a digital input,
virtual input, or virtual output. CB does not close while the blocking input is
active. CB closes when the blocking input is inactive. When blocking becomes
inactive, the CB is controlled closed immediately.

AR Info for Mimic Display Setting

When AR info is enabled, the local panel mimic display shows a small info box
during AR sequence.
Table 122 - Setting Parameters
Parameter Value Unit Default Description
ARena ARon; ARoff - ARon Enabling/disabling the Auto reclose.
Block None - - The digital input for block information, can be
Any digital input, used, for example, for Synchrocheck.
virtual input, or
virtual output
AR_DI None - - The digital input for toggling the ARena
Any digital input, parameter.
virtual input, or
virtual output
AR2grp ARon; ARoff - ARon Enabling/disabling the Auto reclose for group 2.
ReclT 0.02…300.00 s 10.00 Reclaim time setting. Common for all shots.
ARreq On - Off AR request event.
Off
ShotS On - Off AR shot start event.
Off
ARlock On - Off AR locked event
Off
CritAr On - Off AR critical signal event.
Off

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 245


Chapter 6 Control Functions

Table 122 - Setting Parameters (Continued)


Parameter Value Unit Default Description
ARrun On - Off AR event running.
Off
FinTrp On - Off AR final trip event.
Off
ReqEnd On - Off AR end of request event.
Off
ShtEnd On - Off AR end of shot event.
Off
CriEnd On - Off AR end of critical signal event.
Off
ARUnl On - Off AR release event.
Off
ARStop On - Off AR stopped event.
Off
FTrEnd On - Off AR final trip ready event.
Off
ARon On - Off AR enabled event.
Off
ARoff On - Off AR disabled event.
Off
CRITri On - On AR critical final trip on event.
Off
AR1Tri On - On AR AR1 final trip on event.
Off
AR2Tri On - On AR AR2 final trip on event.
Off
Shot Settings
DeadT 0.02…300.00 s 5.00 The dead time setting for this shot. A common
setting for all AR lines in this shot.
AR1 On - Off Indicates if this AR signal starts this shot.
Off
AR2 On - Off Indicates if this AR signal starts this shot.
Off
AR3 On - Off Indicates if this AR signal starts this shot.
Off
AR4 On - Off Indicates if this AR signal starts this shot.
Off
Start1 0.02…300.00 s 0.02 AR1 Start delay setting for this shot.
Start2 0.02…300.00 s 0.02 AR2 Start delay setting for this shot.
Start3 0.02…300.00 s 0.02 AR3 Start delay setting for this shot.
Start4 0.02…300.00 s 0.02 AR4 Start delay setting for this shot.
Discr1 0.02…300.00 s 0.02 AR1 Discrimination time setting for this shot.
Discr2 0.02…300.00 s 0.02 AR2 Discrimination time setting for this shot.
Discr3 0.02…300.00 s 0.02 AR3 Discrimination time setting for this shot.
Discr4 0.02…300.00 s 0.02 AR4 Discrimination time setting for this shot.

246 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Control Functions Chapter 6

Table 123 - Measured and Recorded Values of AR Function


Parameter Value Unit Description
Measured or Obj1 UNDEFINED - Object 1 state
recorded OPEN
values CLOSE
OPEN_REQUEST
CLOSE_REQUEST
READY
NOT_READY
info_NOT_AVAILABLE
FAIL
Status INIT - AR-function state
RECLAIM_TIME
READY
WAIT_CB_OPEN
WAIT_CB_CLOSE
DISCRIMINATION_TIM
E
LOCKED
FINAL_TRIP
CB_FAIL
INHIBIT
Shot# 1…5 - The currently running shot
ReclT RECLAIMTIME - The currently running time (or last
STARTTIME executed)
DEADTIME
DISCRIMINATIONTIME
SCntr - Total start counter
Fail - The counter for failed AR shots
(1)
Shot1 - Shot1 start counter
Shot2 (1) - Shot2 start counter
Shot3 (1) - Shot3 start counter
Shot4(1) - Shot4 start counter
Shot5(1) - Shot5 start counter
(1) There are five counters available for each one of the two AR signals.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 247


Chapter 6 Control Functions

Figure 117 - AR Signals (after Shot 2 the Fault is Cleared)


Example sequence of

Discrimination

Discrimination

Reclaim Time
Start Delay1

Dead Time1

Dead Time2
two shots. After shot 2
the fault is cleared.

Time1

time2
I> setting
Current

Open CB

Close CB

CB close state

CB open state

1. Current exceeds the I> setting; the start delay from shot 1 starts.
2. After the start delay, an OpenCB relay output closes.
3. A CB opens. The dead time from shot 1 starts, and the OpenCB relay
output opens.
4. The dead time from shot 1 expires; a CloseCB output relay closes.
5. The CB closes. The CloseCB output relay opens, and the discrimination
time from shot 1 starts. The current is still over the I> setting.
6. The discrimination time from the shot 1 expires; the OpenCB relay
output closes.
7. The CB opens. The dead time from shot 2 starts, and the OpenCB relay
output opens.
8. The dead time from shot 2 expires; the CloseCB output relay closes.
9. The CB closes. The CloseCB output relay opens, and the discrimination
time from shot 2 starts. The current is now under I> setting.
10. Reclaim time starts. After the reclaim time, the AR sequence is
successfully executed. The AR function moves to wait for a new AR
request in shot 1.

248 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Control Functions Chapter 6

Logic Functions The device supports customer-defined programmable logic for Boolean signals
with the same functionality as DeviceLogix™. However, this implementation is
not in the same format as DeviceLogix™ and is not configurable other than
through SetPointPS.

The logic is designed by using the SetPointPS setting tool and downloaded to
the device. Functions available are:
• NOT
• COUNTERs
• RS and D flip-flops
• AND
• OR
• XOR

The maximum number of outputs is 20, and the maximum number of input
gates is 31. An input gate can include any number of inputs.

Logic is generated by using the SetPointPS setting tool. The amount of


consumed memory is dynamically shown in percentage on the top left corner
of the configuration view. The first value indicates amount of used inputs,
second amount of gates, and third values shows amount of outputs consumed.
These values cannot exceed 100%.

Figure 118 - Logic Menu in SetPointPS

See Figure 119 …Figure 121 that illustrate the basics of logic creation.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 249


Chapter 6 Control Functions

Figure 119 - Create Logical Nodes

1. To add a logic gate, click an empty area


2. Confirm a new function by clicking “Yes”.
3. The added Logic Function Block defaults to an “AND" gate.
The logic function can be changed, see Figure 120.
As the number of logic devices increases, the memory capacity is
decreased.
4. To make the connection to other logic functions input, use the mouse to
left click and drag the output line of the gate to an adjacent logic
element.

250 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Control Functions Chapter 6

Figure 120 - Logic Creation (Edit Properties)

1. Left click any logic function to activate the “Select operation” view.
2. Edit properties button opens the “Function properties” window.
3. It is possible to choose the type of logic function required. The pull-
down option window displays all available logic functions available.
4. When a counter element is selected, counter-setting must be set.
5. Separate Time ON (TON) and Time OFF (TOF) delay setting for
logic activation and deactivation.
6. It can be possible to invert the output of logic. Any inverted logic output
is marked with a small circle at the output.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 251


Chapter 6 Control Functions

Figure 121 - Logic Creation

1. To select the input signals for a logic element, click the “1”button. Or
left click the logic input line.
2. To select the outputs for a logic element, click the “2” button. Or left
click the logic output line.
3. To delete the logic function, click the button “1”.
4. When logic is created and settings are written to the IED, the unit
requires a restart. After restarting the logic, output is automatically
assigned in Output Matrix.

IMPORTANT SetPointPS software requires a unit restart whenever new logic is written to
the 857.

252 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Chapter 7

Communications

Communication Ports The relay has the option of having multiple communication ports. An
additional Ethernet port is available as an option. When this option is chosen,
it takes over the option 2 slot.

There can be up to three ports in the rear panel. The front panel RS-232 port
shuts off the local port on the rear panel when a programming cable
(857-VX003-3) is inserted.

Figure 122 - Communication Ports and Connectors


The connector type (X9 or
X10) depends on the type of
Communication option that is Communication Ports
configured (see Chapter 9).

Local Port Extension Port Remote Port Ethernet Port

Communication
Option 1
Front panel in use

X9

Communication
RS-232 Option 2

GND
X10
DTR out
Tx out
Rx in Ethernet

D9S
DSR in X10

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 253


Chapter 7 Communications

Local Port

The local port has two connectors:


• One on the front panel.
• One on the rear panel (see Chapter 9).

Only one can be used at a time.

TIP The local port functionality can be available through connector X9 or X10,
depending on the type of communication modules and DIP switch settings
(see Chapter 9).

TIP When the programming cable (857-VX003-3) is inserted to the front panel
connector, it activates the front panel port. This action disables the rear-
panel local port by connecting the DTR pin 6 and DSR pin 4 together. See
Figure 122.

Protocol for the Local Port

The front panel port uses the command-line protocol for SetPointPS,
regardless of the selected protocol for the rear-panel local port.

If a protocol other than “None” is selected for the rear-panel local port.

The front panel connector continues using the plain command-line interface
with the original speed, parity, and so on, when selected.

For example, if the rear-panel local port is used for remote SetPointPS
communication using SPA-bus default 9600/7E1. It is possible to connect a
personal computer, temporarily, with SetPointPS to the front panel connector
with the default 38400/8N1. While the front panel connector is in use, the
rear-panel local port is disabled. The communication parameter display on the
local display shows the active parameter values for the local port.

Physical Interface

The physical standard of this port is RS-232. The physical connector depends
on the option module selected.

254 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

Table 124 - Local Port Parameters


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Protocol Protocol selection for the rear-panel local port: Set(1)
None Command-line interface for SetPointPS
SPA-Bus SPA-bus (slave)
PROFIBUSDP PROFIBUS Data base (slave)
ModbusSla Modbus RTU slave
ModbusTCPs Modbus TCP slave
IEC-103 IEC-60870-5-103 (slave)
ExternalIO Modbus RTU master for external I/O-modules
DNP3 DNP 3.0
Msg# 0…232–1 Message counter since the device has restarted or since last C(2)
clearing
Errors 0…216–1 Protocol errors since the device has restarted or since last C(2)
clearing
Tout 0…216–1 Timeout errors since the device has restarted or since last C(2)
clearing
Display of actual Communication parameters. Speed = bit/ (3)

speed/DPS s.
Default = 38400/ D = number of Data bits
8N1 for SetPointPS P = parity: none, even, odd
S = number of stop bits
SetPointPS Communication (Direct or SPA-bus embedded command-line interface)
Tx bytes/size Unsent bytes in transmitter buffer/size of the buffer
Msg# 0…232–1 Message counter since the device has restarted or since last C(2)
clearing
Errors 0…216–1 Errors since the device has restarted or since last clearing C(2)
Tout 0…216–1 Timeout errors since the device has restarted or since last C(2)
clearing
(1) Set = An editable parameter (password required).
(2) C = Clearing to zero is possible.
(3) The Communication parameters are set in the protocol-specific menus. For the local port command-line interface, the
parameters are set in configuration menu.

Remote Port X9

Physical Interface

The physical interface of this port depends on the communication letter in the
order code. See Figure 122 and Table 125. The TTL interface is for external
converters and converter cables only. It is not suitable for direct connection in
excess of 1 meter.
Table 125 - Physical Interface and Connector Types of Remote Port X5 with Various Options.
TTL (A) Is the Default
Order Code Communication Interface Connector Type
A TTL (for external converters only) D9S
B Plastic fiber interface HFBR-0500
C Not available –
D RS-485 (isolated) Screw crimp

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 255


Chapter 7 Communications

Table 125 - Physical Interface and Connector Types of Remote Port X5 with Various Options.
TTL (A) Is the Default (Continued)
Order Code Communication Interface Connector Type
E Glass fiber interface (62.5/125 μm) (For 857-RAD) SMA
F Plastic Rx/glass (62.5/125 μm) Tx fiber interface HFBR-0500/SMA
G Glass (62.5/125 μm) Rx/plastic fiber interface SMA/HFBR-0500
I RJ45 (RS-232) –
M Dual ST 100-Mbps fiber Ethernet SMA
N Single glass fiber interface (62.5/125 μm) for 857-RAA SMA

Table 126 - Remote Port X9 Parameters


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Protocol Protocol selection for remote port: Set(1)
None –
SPA-bus SPA-bus (slave)
PROFIBUSDP PROFIBUS Data base (slave)
ModbusSla Modbus RTU slave
ModbusTCPs Modbus TCP slave
IEC-103 IEC-60870-5-103 (slave)
ExternalIO Modbus RTU master for external I/O-modules
DNP3 DNP 3.0
Msg# 0…232–1 Message counter since the device has restarted or since last C(2)
clearing
Errors 0…216–1 Protocol errors since the device has restarted or since last C(2)
clearing
Tout 0…216–1 Timeout errors since the device has restarted or since last C(2)
clearing
Display of current Communication parameters. Speed = bit/s. (3)

speed/DPS D = number of Data bits


P = parity: none, even, odd
S = number of stop bits
Debug Echo to local port: Set(1)
No No echo
Binary For binary protocols
ASCII For SPA-bus protocol
(1) Set = An editable parameter (password required).
(2) C = Clearing to zero is possible.
(3) The Communication parameters are set in the protocol-specific menus. For the local port command-line interface, the
parameters are set in configuration menu.

256 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

Extension Port

The physical interface of this port depends on the type of communication


module selected. Typically this port is an RS-485 port for external I/O devices.
The port is in the same rear panel connector X9 or X10. See Figure 122 and
Chapter 9.

Table 127 - Extension Port X4 Parameters


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Protocol Protocol selection for the extension port: Set(1)
None Command-line interface for SetPointPS
SPA-bus SPA-bus (slave)
PROFIBUSDP PROFIBUS dB (slave)
ModbusSla Modbus RTU slave
ModbusTCPs Modbus TCP slave
IEC-103 IEC-60870-5-103 (slave)
ExternalIO Modbus RTU master for external I/O-modules
DNP3 DNP 3.0
Msg# 0…232–1 Message counter since the device has restarted or since last C(2)
clearing
Errors 0…216–1 Protocol errors since the device has restarted or since last C(2)
clearing
Tout 0…216–1 Timeout errors since the device has restarted or since last C(2)
clearing
(3)
Display of actual Communication parameters.
speed/DPS Speed = bit/s.
Default = 38400/ D = number of Data bits
8N1 for SetPointPS P = parity: none, even, odd
S = number of stop bits
(1) Set = An editable parameter (password required).
(2) C = Clearing to zero is possible.
(3) The Communication parameters are set in the protocol-specific menus. For the local port command-line interface, the
parameters are set in configuration menu.

Ethernet Port (Optional)

The 857 supports two Ethernet protocols that run simultaneously on the same
physical port. These settings are defined in Ethernet Protocol 1and 2. For each
protocol, an IP (logical) port number is required. The default port numbers in
the relay are 44818 for EtherNet/IP, 102 for 61850 and 102 for Modbus TCP.
Other protocols require an alternate port number to be set.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 257


Chapter 7 Communications

Figure 123 - Ethernet Protocol 1 and 2

The Protocol Configuration Menu contains the address and other related
information for the Ethernet port. TCP port 1st and 2nd instance include
selection for the protocol, IP port settings, message, error, and timeout
counters. See Table 128 for more information.

Figure 124 - Protocol Configuration Menu

Table 128 - Main Configuration Parameters (Local Display), Built in Ethernet Port
Parameter Value Description Note
Protocol Protocol selection for the extension port Set(3)
None Command-line interface for SetPointPS
ModbusTCPs Modbus TCP slave
IEC-101 IEC-101
IEC 61850 IEC-61850 protocol(2)
EtherNet/IP EtherNet/IP protocol
DNP3 DNP/TCP
Port nnn Ip port for protocol, default 502 Set(3)

258 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

Table 128 - Main Configuration Parameters (Local Display), Built in Ethernet Port (Continued)
Parameter Value Description Note
IpAddr n.n.n.n Internet Protocol address Set(3)
(set with SetPointPS)
NetMsk n.n.n.n Net mask (set with SetPointPS) Set(3)
Gatew Default = 0.0.0.0 Gateway IP Address Set(3)
(set with SetPointPS)
NTPSvr n.n.n.n Network-time protocol server Set(3)
(set with SetPointPS) 0.0.0.0 = no SNTP
KeepAlive(1) nn TCP keep alive interval Set(3)
FTP server on/off Enable FTP server (click to turn on) Set(3)
FTP speed 4 Kb/s (default) Maximum transmission speed for FTP Set(3)
FTP password ? = User Mode FTP password Set(3)

Config =configurator
mode
MAC address 001D9CF23B40 through Media Access Control Address —
001D9CF2433F
IP Port for Nn IP port for SetPointPS Set(3)
setting tool 23 (default)
Msg# nnn Message counter —
Errors nnn Error counter —
Tout nnn Timeout counter —
EthSffEn on/off Sniffer port enabled Set(3)
SniffPort Port2 Sniffer port —
(1) The KeepAlive parameter sets the time between two keep alive packets that are sent from the 857 (in seconds). The setting
range for this parameter is 1…20 seconds. A set long duration time can be set by entering zero. The zero entry defines a
120 seconds (2 minutes) time. The purpose of a Keep Alive packet is for the 857 to send a probe packet to a connected client. It
checks the status of the TCP-connection when no other packet is being sent, for example client does not poll Data from the 857.
If the Keep Alive packet is not acknowledged, the 857 closes the TCP connection. Connection must be resumed on the client side.
(2) The IEC 61850 protocol must be specified at the time of order placement. A relay with the standard Ethernet option does not
support IEC 61850.
(3) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 259


Chapter 7 Communications

Table 129 - Ethernet Protocol 1 Parameters


Parameter Value Description Note
Protocol   Protocol selection for the extension port. Set(2)
None Command-line interface for SetPointPS
ModbusTCPs Modbus TCP slave
IEC 61850 IEC-61850 protocol
EtherNet/IP EtherNet/IP protocol(1)
DNP3 DNP/TCP
Port nnn Ip port for protocol, default 502 Set(2)
EtherNet/IP =44818
Msg# nnn Message counter
Errors nnn Error counter
Tout nnn Timeout counter
(1) The Data Base IEC 61850 protocol must be specified at the time of order placement. A relay with the standard Ethernet-option
does not support IEC 61850.
(2) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

Table 130 - Ethernet Protocol 2 Parameters


Parameter Value Description Note
Ethernet port   Protocol selection for the extension port. Set(2)
protocol (TCP
PORT second None Command-line interface for SetPointPS
INST)
ModbusTCP Modbus TCP slave
IEC 61850 IEC-61850 protocol(1)
EtherNet/IP EtherNet/IP protocol
DNP3 DNP/TCP
Port nnn Ip port for protocol, default 502 Set(2)
EtherNet/IP =44818
Msg# nnn Message counter -
Errors nnn Error counter -
Tout nnn Timeout counter -
(1) The IEC 61850 protocol must be specified at the time of order placement. A relay with the standard Ethernet-option does not
support IEC 61850.
(2) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

Communication Protocols These protocols enable the transfer of this type of data:
• Events
• Status information
• Measurements
• Control Commands
• Clock synchronizing
• Settings (SPA-bus and embedded SPA-bus only)

260 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

Personal Computer Communication

Personal computer communication is using an Allen-Bradley® specified


command-line interface. The SetPointPS program can communicate using the
local RS-232 port or the Ethernet interface. It is also possible to select SPA-bus
protocol for the local port and configure the SetPointPS to embed the
command-line interface inside SPA-bus messages.

Modbus TCP and Modbus RTU

These Modbus protocols are often used in power plants and in industrial
applications. The difference between these two protocols is the media.
Modbus TCP uses Ethernet and Modbus RTU uses asynchronous
communication (RS-485, optic fiber, RS-232).

SetPointPS shows the list of all available data items for Modbus. See page 459
for a list of Modbus parameters.

The Modbus communication is activated for remote port through a menu


selection with parameter “Protocol”. See Communication Ports on page 253.

Table 131 - Modbus TCP and Modbus RTU Parameters


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Addr 1…247 Modbus address for the device. Set(1)
Broadcast address 0 can be used for clock synchronizing.
Modbus TCP also uses the TCP port settings.
bit/s 1200 bps Communication speed for Modbus RTU Set(1)
2400
4800
9600
19200
Parity None Parity for Modbus RTU Set(1)
Even
Odd
(1) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

Configure the Modbus Overview


Protocol
This section describes the configuration and use of the Modbus RTU (Remote
Terminal Unit) and Modbus TCP protocols in 857 Protection Systems.

IMPORTANT To configure an 857 Protection System, the SetPointPS relay setting and
configuration tool is needed (obtain SetPointPS from
www.rockwellautomation.com).

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 261


Chapter 7 Communications

The configurator of a relay must be logged in with access level Configurator to


change the protocol settings. Enter the password when connecting to the relay
with SetPointPS (the default password for the configurator access level is “2”).

Modbus RTU Overview

The Modbus protocol is a Master-Slave protocol that is typically implemented


on an RS-232 or RS-485 physical interface. There are two versions of the
(serial) Modbus protocol, Modbus RTU and Modbus ASCII, Modbus RTU is
available in 857 Protection Systems. There is also a TCP/IP implementation of
the protocol, Modbus TCP, which is covered at the end of this section.
Modbus TCP is available in 857 Protection Systems.

In the master-slave setup of Modbus, only the master can initiate transactions
(queries). The slaves respond by supplying the requested data to the master, or
by the action that is requested in the query. The master can address individual
slaves, or initiate a broadcast message to all slaves. The address space for slaves
in Modbus RTU ranges from 1…247 on one data link. Address 0 is reserved for
broadcast.

The Modbus protocol defines four simultaneously categories of data


(Table 132). The mapping of data to these categories is implementation-
dependent. In 857 Protection Systems, all data is mapped to the Holding
Registers.

Table 132 - Modbus Data Organization


Primary Tables Object Type Type of Comments
Discrete Input Single bit Read-only I/O system can provide Data
Coils Single bit Read-write An application program can alter and provide
Data
Input Registers 16-bit word Read-only I/O system can provide Data
The Holding 16-bit word Read-write An application program can provide Data
Registers

To check the mapping of particular data items to the holding registers in 857
Protection Systems, use SetPointPS. Select the items below the Modbus Main
Configuration (see Figure 125). See page 459 for Modbus mappings.

TIP The data mappings are not visible if the Modbus protocol is not activated.
See See Configuration on page 263 for instructions how to activate the
protocol.
The values in the Address column (ex. “40xxxx”) consist of two parts: “40”
and “xxxx”. The prefix “40” denotes a reference to Read/Write Output or
Holding Registers. The “xxxx” denotes the address of a particular register.

The bit rate of Modbus RTU is typically 9600 bps and for the transmission of
frames, a parity check mode must be selected (even, odd, or none parity
checking).

262 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

Figure 125 - Modbus Data Mappings in SetPointPS (from 857 Protection System)

The Modbus RTU and Modbus TCP protocols in 857 Protection System can
transfer these types of data:
• Events
• Status information
• Measurements
• Control commands
• Clock synchronization

Configuration

This section describes how to configure an 857 Protection System to use the
Modbus RTU protocol.

TIP The configuration and features vary between simultaneously 857 Protection
System models, such as what scaling settings there are and what data is
available in the holding registers.

General

The Modbus RTU protocol is activated by setting it as the Port protocol for a
serial port on the relay at hand. This setting can be found by navigating to the
Protocol Configuration List in SetPointPS. See Figure 126, Figure 127, and
Figure 128 for a series of graphics to illustrate the enabling of the Modbus
protocol on the Remote port of a relay.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 263


Chapter 7 Communications

Figure 126 - Protocol Selection for the Remote Port without Any Protocol Selected

Figure 127 - Protocol Selection Box Visible for the Remote Port. ModBusSlv (Modbus as Slave)
Highlighted

Figure 128 - Modbus That Is Selected for the Remote Port

The protocol is enabled through the local panel of an 857 Protection System
(enter the password for the configurator access level).

264 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

After the protocol is activated, it must be configured with SetPointPS in the


Modbus Main Configuration. Go to the group view that is located under the
Protocol Configuration item in the Group List, see Figure 129.

IMPORTANT To set a relay to function as a Modbus RTU Slave: select the protocol that is
called “ModbusSlv” in SetPointPS and on the Bus-menu of the local display
of the relay.
Restart the relay for a communication protocol change, for any port, to take
effect.
The holding register address, which is sent though Modbus, is one less than
that indicated by an 857 Protection System. For example, if the Alive
Indicator, with the holding register address 2001 (see Figure 125), is sent
over a Modbus data link. The frame indicates that the address of the holding
register is 2000.

In the Modbus main configuration, you can view the Modbus Slave Address
(or number), and the bit rate. You can also set the parity of the connection
(highlighted as “Editable fields” in Figure 129).

IMPORTANT The parity and bit rate must be set to the same value on all devices that are
connected to the same data link.

Figure 129 - Modbus Main Configuration in SetPointPS

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 265


Chapter 7 Communications

Clock Synchronization

The internal clock of a relay can be synchronized through the Modbus


protocol. This feature is not a Modbus protocol, but an 857 Protection System
specific system. The accuracy of the clock synchronization is in the scale of a
few hundred milliseconds.

The clock can be synchronized (all fields: seconds, minutes, hours, days,
month, and year) or by synchronizing only the minutes, which in turn sets the
seconds and milliseconds to zero.

EXAMPLE For minute synchronization, when the reference clock is 7 minutes past (any
hour), a minute synchronization is performed. The result is that the internal
clock, of the relay, is set to HH: 07:00.000 (“Hours: Minutes: Seconds:
Milliseconds”) “HH” does not change. As a recommendation, perform time
synchronization hourly.

These two ways to synchronize the clock, “Set RTC”, where “RTC” represents
“Real-Time Clock” and “Synchronize Minutes” in the data map. The holding
register address of the minute synchronization is 2502. See Table 133 for the
holding registers allocated to the Set RTC synchronization.

Table 133 - Description of Holding Registers Allocated to Set RTC Synchronization


The Holding Register Content
2504 Lower byte: seconds, milliseconds are Zero
2505 Upper byte: Minutes
Lower byte: Hours
2506 Upper byte: Day
Lower byte: Month
2507 Year

Events

Use the Modbus RTU Protocol to read the event buffer of an 857 Protection
System, one event at a time, from the holding registers 2101…2105. The event
registers contain the latest event, and are cleared when they are read. The
registers are then updated to contain the following event from the event buffer.
A description of the registers is shown in Table 134.

If an error occurs when reading an event from registers 2101…2105, then the
previously read event is available registers 2490…2494 for re-reading.

IMPORTANT Events can also be read from holding registers996…2000.

266 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

Events are coded with a numbering starting from 0…8900 (software version
Rockwell Automation® 12.001. New features are added to software that create
event codes. For the meaning of event codes, contact Rockwell Automation or
run the GETSET-command “to get event codes” in the SetPointPS Terminal.
To start type “Ctrl + T”.

Table 134 - Description of Events in Holding Registers

The Holding Register Content


2101 Event Code
2102 Event Time Stamp
Bits 15…6 = milliseconds
Bits 5…0 = seconds
2103 Event Time Stamp
Upper byte: Minutes
Lower byte: Hours
2104 Event Time Stamp
Upper byte: Day
Lower byte: Month
2105 Event Time Stamp, Year

Scaling

The holding registers are 16 bits. They can directly represent 216 = 65535
simultaneously values, which are not enough to describe the values of some
physical quantity such as voltage or power. Therefore, values that are
transmitted over a Modbus data link must be scaled.

The equation of the line where two points are connected in a two-dimensional
space (x1, y1) and (x2, y2) determines the scaling. That is, the trajectory of the
line and the offset from origin (Figure 130).

IMPORTANT There is no offset in the example if the point (x1, y1) is assumed to lie at the
origin.

It is common to use a scale factor with base ten (10, 100, 1000…) since, in such
cases, the original measurements only lose decimals. The values are easy to read
and rescale to actual values on the client side after transmission.

IMPORTANT Scaled measurements get rounded.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 267


Chapter 7 Communications

Figure 130 - Line Defined by Two Points in a Two Dimensional Space

Settings for scaling can be used for the power-, power factor-, tan phi-,
voltage-, and frequency scaling. Settings can be done by navigating to the
MODBUS & PROFIBUS: SCALINGS item in the Group List in SetPointPS
(see Figure 132.

A short example: The frequency is internally (in the relay) stored as an integer
value, which also holds three decimal places, that is, 50.000 Hz is represented as
50000. A value too large to be represented with 16 bits (signed integer). By
default, frequency is scaled with the points: (x1, y1) = (0, 0) and (x2, y2) = (10,
1) (see Figure 131 and Figure 132), so it to be sent over Modbus.

y2 – y1 1–0
The slope is: ----------------
- = --------------- = 0.1 and there is no offset.
x2 – x1 10 – 0

Thus, the value on the receiving side (the Modbus value) is:

valuemodbus = k • value internal = 0.1 • 50000 = 5000

Figure 131 - Default Frequency Scaling

To make sure that a scaling has been set as intended, it can be checked in
SetPointPS by viewing the Scaling column for each holding register in the
MODBUS SLAVE: 40xxxx-> items in the Group List in SetPointPS, see
Figure 133.

268 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

Figure 132 - Default Scaling Settings in SetPointPS

An example is shown in Figure 134, which shows the voltage scaling changed
(x2 changed to 10 from 1). Figure 135, shows the meaning of the scaling for
some affected and non-affected holding registers. Compare the value of the
scaling for the holding registers that use Voltage scaling in Figure 133.

IMPORTANT It is highly recommended to scale values so that they are kept in the interval
0…32768 to avoid overflow.

Figure 133 - Meaning of the Default Scaling for Some Holding Registers

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 269


Chapter 7 Communications

Figure 134 - Voltage Scaling Is Changed from Default

Figure 135 - Result of the Change in Voltage Scaling

Modbus TCP

Modbus TCP (or Modbus TCP/IP) is the Modbus protocol encapsulated


with a TCP interface that runs on Ethernet. TCP/IP refers to the Transmission
Control Protocol and Internet Protocol that provide the transmission medium
for Modbus TCP/IP messaging. In practice, Modbus TCP embeds a standard
Modbus data frame into a TCP frame.

Several devices can be connected to one IP address, provided the appropriate


equipment is used (some Modbus TCP-to-Modbus RTU bridge). These
devices are differentiated from each other with a Unit Identifier in the TCP
frame, which corresponds to the Slave ID. The range of the Unit Identifier is
1…247. In VAMP relays, the Modbus Slave ID corresponds to the Unit
Identifier when Modbus TCP is used, see Figure 129.

IMPORTANT Default port for Modbus TCP is 502. There are cases where it can change
depending on the device that is used to poll it.

Configuration

The Modbus TCP protocol is activated by configuring the Ethernet port


settings (Figure 136). The IP address, subnet mask, and Gateway must be set.

IMPORTANT 857 Protection Systems do not support DHCP, Dynamic Host Configuration
Protocol, and require a static IP address to be configured

Considered DHCP before connecting a relay to an existing network, so that


no conflicts emerge

270 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

IMPORTANT There are two TCP port instances “TCP PORT first INST” and “TCP PORT second
INST”, that is, two independent sockets for two simultaneously protocols.
The default TCP/IP port for Modbus TCP is 502.

When these settings are configured, one of the TCP PORT Ethernet port
protocol selections can be set to “ModbusTCPs” (Modbus TCP, slave), see
Figure 136.

Before the protocol is activated, SetPointPS prompts for a device restart when
any of the settings, mentioned earlier, are changed.

Data access can be done by using SNTP (Simple Network Time Protocol).
SNTP is used for reading and writing to the holding registers, event reading,
clock synchronization, and scaling work as described in the previous sections,
with the addition that clock synchronization. An NTP server is required with
the address set in the Ethernet Port setting-section of the Protocol
Configuration view in SetPointPS, see Figure 136.

Figure 136 - Ethernet and TCP Port Settings in SetPointPS

IP Address of the relay


Subnet mask of the relay
Gateway to which the relay is connected
SNTP Server IP Address (if used)

Ethernet port protocol selection

IP port selection

Ethernet port protocol selection


IP port selection

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 271


Chapter 7 Communications

Testing Modbus with Simple Tester

This section gives examples of how to test that the Modbus protocol (Modbus
RTU or Modbus TCP) is successfully configured using the 857 Protection
System protocol test tool, Simple Tester.

Simple Tester Overview

Simple Tester is a basic protocol tool for testing (for Personal Computer) that
supports several protocols, including Modbus RTU and TCP. Simple Tester
can be used to test reading data from the holding registers, writing to the
holding registers, event viewing, and clock synchronization from the personal
computer. The user interface of Simple Tester with Modbus selected as
protocol (but not connected to a relay) is shown and explained in Figure 137.
Simple Tester can be requested from Rockwell Automation® as required.

Figure 137 - User Interface of Simple Tester with Modbus Selected as Protocol

Communication
parameters (protocol
selection and device
connection configuration

Modbus Slave ID selector

Selections for data reading

Selections for data writing


Time controls

Event View Window

Connection Status

Connect with Modbus RTU

To connect a relay with Modbus RTU, the device must first be configured as
described in Configuration on page 263. A physical connection must be made
to the relay. As the physical connection varies depending on the relay models
and selection of serial ports to be used, the making of the physical connection is
not described in this section.

272 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

When a physical connection has been made, Simple Tester can be connected to
the relay with these steps:

1. Select “Modbus” in the Protocol selector in the Communication


Parameters section.
2. In the Connection type selection, mark Serial line. Select the COM-port
that corresponds to the USB port (or personal computer serial port if
available) to which the relay is connected to.
3. Set the Communication Rate (bit rate) and Parity to the same values as
the relay is configured to use.
4. Set the Slave ID in the Modbus Slave ID selector to the slave ID set on
the relay.
5. Click “GO”.
6. OK indicates a successful connection. OK is displayed in the rightmost
connection Status Indicator furthest down in the Simple Tester window.
An example of a successful connection is shown in Figure 6.

Connect with Modbus TCP

To connect a relay with Modbus TCP, the device Ethernet port and TCP port
instances must be configured as described in Modbus TCP on page 270. An
Ethernet connection (physical) to the relay from the personal computer that is
running Simple Tester must be made.

To connect Simple Tester to a relay configured to use Modbus TCP, follow


these steps:

1. Select “Modbus” in the Protocol selector in the Communication


Parameters section.
2. In the Connection type selection, mark TCP Connection and set the Host
to the IP address set on the relay.
3. Set the Port to the same TCP/IP port as configured on the relay. (“IP
port for protocol in Figure 136).
4. Set the Slave ID in the Modbus Slave ID selector to the slave ID set on
the relay.
5. Click “GO”.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 273


Chapter 7 Communications

6. OK indicates a successful connection. OK is displayed in the rightmost


connection status indicator furthest down in the Simple Tester window.
An example of a successful connection is shown in Figure 138.Simple
Tester When Connected with Modbus RTU

Figure 138 - Simple Tester When Connected with Modbus TCP

274 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

Read Data

To read Data, follow these steps (for reference see Figure 6 or Figure 138):

1. Set Type of Data (HR = Holding register).


2. Select which Index to be read, to read some data item from an 857
Protection System (see the Data map that is provided by SetPointPS, see
Figure 125).
3. The Count value indicates how many consecutive indices are read. For
instance, setting Index to 2001 and Count to Click2 displays the values
of Index 2001 and Index 2002 in the Values-box.
4. To initiate a read, click Read. Reads can also be done cyclically, by
checking the Cyclic read box. To change the length of one cycle, set a
value in the Cycles field (seconds).

Figure 139 features an example of reading the Alive Counter (HR 2001)
cyclically every 3 seconds.

Figure 139 - Performing a Cyclic Read on the Alive Counter with Simple Tester

Write Data

1. Set Type of Data to be written. (HR = Holding register).


2. Select which Index is used
3. Set Value to be written.
4. Click Write.
5. The Status field indicates the success of the operation.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 275


Chapter 7 Communications

Figure 140 features an example of the value 1 to Virtual Input 1 (the holding
register 3427).

Figure 140 - Simple Tester after Write to Virtual Input 1

The Event view of Simple Tester now contains an event, which corresponds to
“Virtual Input 1 ON”.

If there are events in the event buffer when Simple Tester is connected, they are
listed in the event view. Writes that are done with Simple Tester trigger new
events that also show up.

A clock synchronization can be performed with Simple Tester. Set the desired
behavior in the Time Controls (Figure 137).

The two leftmost fields are used for setting the time manually. The time can be
taken from the personal computer, by checking the Time checkbox in Simple
Tester.

To set the clock synchronization to be cyclic, check the Cyclic timesync


checkbox in Simple Tester. The length of a cycle is set in the rightmost field
(minutes).

276 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

PROFIBUS DP

The PROFIBUS DP protocol is widely used in parts of the world. An external


module (857-VPA3CG) is required along with an 857-VX007-F3 cable. See
publication 857-UM003, which includes the code available for the continuous
mode and request mode.

Device Profile “Continuous Mode”

In this mode, the device is sending a configured set of data parameters


continuously to the PROFIBUS DP master. The benefit is the speed and easy
access to the data in the PROFIBUS master. The drawback is the maximum
buffer size of 128 bytes, which limits the number of data items that are
transferred to the master. Some PLCs have their own limitation for the
PROFIBUS buffer size, which can further limit the number of transferred data
items.

Device Profile “Request Mode”

Use the request mode to read all available data from the 857 device and still use
only a short buffer for PROFIBUS data transfer. The drawback is slower data
transfer and increased data that is processed at the PROFIBUS master. The
master requests every data item separately.

TIP In request mode, it is not possible to read continuously — only one single
data item. At least two data items must be read in turn to get updated data
from the device.

Available Data

SetPointPS shows the list of all available data items for both modes.

The PROFIBUS DP communication is activated for remote port through a


menu selection with parameter “Protocol”. See Communication Ports on
page 253.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 277


Chapter 7 Communications

Table 135 - PROFIBUS DP Parameters


Paramete Value Unit Description Note
r
Mode Profile selection: Set(1)
Cont Continuous mode
Reqst Request mode
bit/s 2400 bps Communication speed from the main CPU to the PROFIBUS
converter. The PROFIBUS master automatically sets the actual
PROFIBUS bit rate and can be up to 12 Mbit/s.
Emode Event number style: (Set)
Channel Used for new installations.
(Limit60) (The other modes are for compatibility with old systems).
(NoLimit)
(2)(4)
InBuf bytes Size of PROFIBUS master Rx buffer. (data to the master).
(3)(4)
OutBuf bytes Size of PROFIBUS master Tx buffer. (data from the master).
Addr 1...247 This address must be unique within the PROFIBUS network Set(1)
system.
(5)
Conv Converter type:
– No converter is recognized
VE Converter type “VE” is recognized
(1) Set = An editable parameter (password required).
(2) In continuous mode, the size depends on the biggest configured data offset of a data item to be sent to the master. In request
mode, the size is 8 bytes.
(3) In continuous mode, the size depends on the biggest configured data offset of a data to be read from the master. In request
mode, the size is 8 bytes.
(4) When configuring the PROFIBUS master system, the length of these buffers is needed. The device calculates the lengths
according to the PROFIBUS data and profile configuration, and the values define the in/out module to be configured for the
PROFIBUS master.
(5) If the value is “–”, PROFIBUS protocol has not been selected or the device has not restarted after protocol change. Or there is a
communication problem between the main CPU and the PROFIBUS ASIC.

SPA-Bus

The 857 relay has full support for the SPA-bus protocol including reading and
writing the setting values. Reading multiple (or consecutive) status data bits,
measurement values, or setting values with one message is supported.

Several simultaneous instances of this protocol that simultaneously physical


ports are possible, but one instance reads the events. Contact Rockwell
Automation® for more details.

278 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

Table 136 - SPA-Bus Parameters


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Addr 1...899 SPA-bus address. Must be unique in the system. Set(1)
bit/s 1200 bps Communication speed Set(1)
2400
4800
9600
(default)
19200
Emode Event number style: (Set)
Channel Used for new installations.
(Limit60) (The other modes are for compatibility with old systems).
(NoLimit)
(1) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

IEC 60870-5-103
The IEC standard 60870-5-103 “Companion standard for the informative
interface of protection equipment” provides standardized communication
interface to a primary system (master system).

The unbalanced transmission mode of the protocol is used, and the device
functions as a secondary station (slave) in the communication. Data is
transferred to the primary system by using “data acquisition by polling”
principle. The IEC functionality includes these application functions:
• Station initialization
• General interrogation
• Clock synchronization and
• Command transmission

Parameter data or disturbance recordings cannot transfer through the IEC 103
protocol interface.

Application Service Data Unit (ASDU) types are used in communication from
the device are:
• ASDU 1: time tagged message
• ASDU 3: Measurands I
• ASDU 5: Identification message
• ASDU 6: Time synchronization and
• ASDU 8: Termination of general interrogation

The device accepts:


• ASDU 6: Time synchronization
• ASDU 7: Initiation of general interrogation and
• ASDU 20: General command

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 279


Chapter 7 Communications

The identity of the message frame data is by:


• Type identification
• Function type
• Information number

These identifications are fixed for data items in the compatible range of the
protocol. For example, the trip of I> function has: type identification = 1,
function type = 160 and information number = 90. “Private range” function
types are used for data items that are undefined by the standard. For example,
the status of the digital inputs and the control of the objects.

The function type and information number that is used in private range
messages is configurable to enable flexible interfacing to simultaneously master
systems. For more information on IEC 60870-5-103 in the 857 Protection
System, contact Rockwell Automation.

Table 137 - Parameters


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Addr 1…254 A unique address within the system Set(1)
bit/s 9600 bps Communication speed Set(1)
19200
MeasInt 200…10000 ms Minimum measurement response-interval Set(1)
SyncRe Sync ASDU6 response time mode Set(1)
Sync+Proc
Msg
Msg+Proc
(1) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

Table 138 - Parameters for Disturbance Record Reading


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
ASDU23 On Enable record info message Set(1)
Off
Smpls/msg 1…25 Record samples in one message Set(1)
Timeout 10…10000 s Record the reading timeout Set(1)
Fault Fault identifier number for IEC-103. Starts + trips of all
stages.
TagPos Position of read pointer
Chn Active channel
ChnPos Channel read position
Fault numbering
Faults Total number of faults
GridFlts Fault burst identifier-number
Grid Time window to classify faults together to the same Set(1)
burst.
(1) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

280 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

DNP 3.0

The relay uses DNP 3.0 protocol to support communication.

These DNP 3.0 data types are supported:


• Binary input
• Binary input change
• Double-bit input
• Binary output
• Analog input
• Counters

A menu selection activates DNP 3.0 communication. RS-485 interface is often


used but also RS-232 and fiber-optic interfaces are possible.

Table 139 - DPN 3.0 Parameters


Parameter Value Unit Description Set
bit/s 4800 bps Communication speed Set(1)
9600 (default)
19200
38400
Parity None (default) Parity Set(1)
Even
Odd
SlvAddr 1…65519 A unique address for the device within the system Set(1)
MstrAddr 1…65519 Address of master Set(1)
(255 = default)
LLTout 0…65535 ms Link layer confirmation-timeout Set(1)
LLRetry 1…255 Link layer retry-count Set(1)
(1 = default)
APLTout 0…65535 ms Application layer confirmation-timeout Set(1)
(5000 =
default)
CnfMode EvOnly Application layer confirmation-mode Set(1)
(default)
All
DBISup No (default) Double-bit input support Set(1)
Yes
SyncMode 0…65535 s Clock synchronization request-interval. Set(1)
0 = only at boot.
(1) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 281


Chapter 7 Communications

IEC 60870-5-101

The IEC 60870-5-101 standard is derived from the IEC 60870-5 protocol
standard definition. In 857 devices, IEC 60870-5-101 communication
protocol is available through menu selection. The 857 relay works as a
controlled outstation (slave) unit in unbalanced mode.

Supported application functions include process data transmission, event


transmission, command transmission, general interrogation, clock
synchronization, transmission of integrated totals, and acquisition of
transmission delay.

For more information on IEC 60870-5-101 with the 857, contact Rockwell
Automation.

Table 140 - IEC 60870-5-101 Parameters


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
bit/s 1200 bps Bitrate that is used for serial communication. Set(1)
2400
4800
9600
Parity None Parity that is used for serial communication Set(1)
Even
Odd
LLAddr 1…65534 Link layer address Set(1)
LLAddrSize 1…2 bytes Size of Link layer address Set(1)
ALAddr 1…65534 ASDU address Set(1)
ALAddrSize 1…2 Bytes Size of ASDU address Set(1)
IOAddrSize 2…3 Bytes Information object address-size. Set(1)
(3-octet addresses are created from 2-octet addresses by
adding MSB with value 0).
COTsize 1 Bytes Cause of transmission size
TTFormat Short The parameter determines time tag format: 3-octet time tag or Set(1)
Full 7-octet time tag.
MeasFormat Scaled The parameter determines measurement data format: Set(1)
Normalized normalized value or scaled value.
DbandEna No Deadband calculation enable flag Set(1)
Yes
DbandCy 100…1000 ms Deadband calculation interval Set(1)
0
(1) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

External I/O (Modbus RTU Master)

External Modbus I/O devices can be connected to the device uses this
protocol. See External Input/Output Modules on page 338 for more
information.

282 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

IEC 61850

IEC 61850 protocol with native implementation is used by relay to support


communication. IEC 61850 protocol is available with the optional in-built
Ethernet port. The protocol can be used to read/write static data from the relay
or to receive events and to receive/send GOOSE messages to other relays.

See publication 857-UM004, Bulletin 857/865 Protection Systems IEC


61850 Interface Configuration Instructions, for complete details on relay
configuration and 61850 protocol troubleshooting.

IEC 61850 serve interface has:


• Configurable data model: selection of logical nodes that correspond to
active application functions
• Configurable pre-defined data sets
• Supported dynamic data sets created by clients
• Supported report function with buffered and unbuffered Report
Control Blocks
• Supported control model: direct with normal security
• Supported horizontal communication with GOOSE: configurable
GOOSE publisher data sets, configurable filters for GOOSE subscriber
inputs, GOOSE inputs available in the application logic matrix

Table 141 - IEC 61850 Parameters


Parameter Value Unit Description Note
Port 0…64000 IP protocol port Set(1)
Check upper Yes If the checkbox “Check upper addresses” is checked, the Set(1)
addresses No parameters are also checked and used for addressing when
the client is communicating to the device. By default “Check
upper addresses” is disabled.
The following parameters are ACSE association parameters
that are described in the standard part 61850-8-1.
AP ID nnn.nnn.nnn.n ACSE AP title value. Set(1)
nn
AE Qualifier 0…64000 ACSE AE qualifier.
P Selector 0…420000000 Presentation selector.
0
S Selector 0…64000 Session selector.
T Selector 0…64000 Transport selector.
IED Name String Identification of the device. Each device must have unique
name..
Delete Command Send command to clear all dynamic datasets.
dynamic
datasets
(1) Set = An editable parameter (password required)

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 283


Chapter 7 Communications

EtherNet/IP

The relay, when configured, uses EtherNet/IP for communication, which is a


part of CIP (Common Industrial Protocol) family. EtherNet/IP is available
with the optional built-in Ethernet port. EtherNet/IP can be used to read /
write data from the relay using request / response communication or throough
cyclic messages transporting data that are assigned to assemblies (sets of data).

EtherNet/IP main features:


• Static data model: Two standard objects (Overload and Control
Supervisor), two private objects (one for digital data and one for analog
data), and 14 configuration objects for protection functions
configuration. See Appendix C.
• One configurable and eight static assemblies (one producing and one
consuming) with the maximum capacity of 128 bytes can be generated
at any time. All changes to EtherNet/IP configuration (see
configuration parameters in Table 142) or to the assembly content
require the generation of the new EDS file.
• Three types are supported: UCMM (one time request/response), Class
3 connection (cyclic request / response), and Class 1 connection (cyclic
I/O messages that contain the assembly data).

EtherNet/IP implementation on the 857 relay serves as a server and is not


capable of initiating communication.

Table 142 - EtherNet/IP Main Configuration Parameters


Parameter Range Description
IP address IP protocol address identifying the device in the network.
Multicast IP Multicast IP Address that is used for sending I/O messages.
Multicast TTL 1…100 Time to live of the I/O messages sent to multi-cast address.
Vendor ID 1…65535 Identification of a vendor by number.
Device Type 0…65535 Indication of general type of product.
Product Code 1…65535 Identification of a particular product of an individual
vendor.
Major Revision 1…127 Major revision of the item the Identity Object represents.
Minor Revision 1…255 Minor revision of the item the Identity Object represents.
Serial Number 0…429496729 Serial number of device.
5
Product Name 32 chars Human readable identification.
Producing Instance 1…1278 Instance number of the producing assembly.
Include Run/Idle Header On Include or exclude Run/Idle Header in an outgoing I/O
(Producing) Off message.

Consuming Instance 1…1278 Instance number of the consuming assembly.


Include Run/Idle Header On Expect presence or absence of Run/Idle Header in an
(Consuming) Off incoming I/O message.

284 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

File Transfer Protocol (FTP) The FTP server is available on the 857 devices that are equipped with a built-in
or optional Ethernet card.
Server
The FTP server is used to pull these files from an 857:
• Disturbance recordings.
• The MasterICD and MasterICDEd2 files.

The FTP server can be enabled using one these processes:(1)

• With SetPointPS version 2.2.134 or higher, place a check mark in the


box “Enable FTP server” in the Protocol Configuration group
(Figure 141).

• Use the 857 HMI by navigating to Bus, Ethernet Port, FTP server, and
setting the value to “On”.

• Use the Terminal application within SetPointPS. Enter the command


“s ftpserver=On”.

Figure 141 - Configuration of the FTP Server in SetPointPS Version 2.2.134 or Higher.

IMPORTANT For information about how to log in with SetPointPS version 2.2.134 or
higher, publication 857-PM001.

(1) In all of these cases, a 0, 1login with configurator access level is required.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 285


Chapter 7 Communications

To log in use the Terminal routines in SetPointPS and with the 857, follow
these Terminal steps (Bold text indicates user entered data).

Step Parameter User Input Result


1 Communication initiation Terminal or [Control T]
2 Login login [enter]
3 User: config [enter] The 857prompts you to
enter “config”.
4 Password: 2 or 0002 [enter] The 857 prompts for a
Password to be entered.
Enter the password for the
configurator access level. In
this example, the default
password “2” was entered.
5 Application: terminal [enter] The 857prompts for the
Application - enter
“terminal”.
6 OK Login completed.
7 Command line (>) Terminal commands can be
entered.

Figure 142 - Terminal Command Screen

The MasterICD and MasterICDEd2 files are specific reference files that can be
used for offline IEC61850 configuration. The built-in FTP client in Microsoft
Windows or any other compatible FTP client can be used to pull files from the
device.

Table 143 - FTP Server Selections

Parameter Value Unit Description Note


Enable FTP server Yes   Enable or disable the FTP server. Set(1)
 
No
FTP password Max 33   Required to access the FTP server with an FTP Set(1)
characters client. Default is “config”.
FTP max speed 1…10 KB/s The maximum speed at which the FTP server Set(1)
transfers data.
(1) Set = An editable parameter (password required).

286 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

Connect to the FTP Server Once the FTP server has been enabled and the Ethernet connection is
established between a personal computer and the 857, there are two options
Using Windows DOS for connecting to it: The FTP client through the command-line, and the FTP
client by Windows Explorer.

Using the FTP Client in Windows by Command Line


See Figure 143.

1. Click Win + R, type in “cmd”, and click Enter.


2. Type “ftp”, press Enter.
3. Type “open” (+ space) and the IP address of the 857.
4. Type “rockwell” as the user.
5. Type the FTP password. The default password is “config”.
6. Issue the DIR command, to display the available files. Pull any of the
files by issuing the command “get” (+ space) and the desired file name.
7. Disconnect from the FTP server by issuing the commands “disconnect”
and “bye”. The downloaded file is now in the current directory on the
personal computer.

Figure 143 - Pulling a File


Step number…

2
3
4
5
6

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 287


Chapter 7 Communications

Using the FTP Client in Windows Through Windows Explorer

1. Open Windows Explorer.


2. In the Address field, type ftp:// and the IP address of the IED. See
Figure 144.
3. Press Enter.

Figure 144 - Enter the IP Address Into the Address Field of Windows Explorer

4. Type user name “vamp” and password into the prompt. The default
password is “config”. See Figure 145.
5. Click “Log on”.
The files appear in the Explorer™ window.

Figure 145 - Enter Credentials Into the FTP Authorization Prompt

6. Right-click on the desired file. Select “Copy” to copy the file to the
clipboard. See Figure 146.
The file can now be pasted to a desired directory on the personal
computer.

288 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

Figure 146 - Selecting a File for Download by Copying It

EtherNet/IP Network Design

The 857 Protection System can be supplied with one Ethernet with a RJ45
port to connect Ethernet CAT5 or better cables or an optional dual fiber-optic
interface. Rockwell Automation offers a wide variety of Allen-Bradley®
Ethernet patch cables with its Bulletin 1585 line of Ethernet cables (http://
ab.rockwellautomation.com/Connection-Devices/RJ45-Network-Media).

The 857 Protection System supports a Star, Linear, and Ring Ethernet
topology. A Star Ethernet Topology is shown in Figure 147, where all Ethernet
nodes wire back to a central Ethernet switch, hub, or router.

Figure 147 - Star Ethernet Topology

857

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 289


Chapter 7 Communications

Rockwell Automation offers a line of managed and unmanaged Allen-Bradley®


Ethernet switches with its Stratix™ family of Ethernet switches. See http://
ab.rockwellautomation.com/Connection-Devices/RJ45-Network-Media for
more information.

The EtherNet/IP 857 Protection Relay supports an Ethernet Ring topology.


All Ethernet nodes are wired in series with one another until a complete
network ring is made as shown in Figure 148. The 857 Protection System
supports Rockwell Automation® Device Level Ring (DLR) topology as a slave
device. The EtherNet/IP network continues to communicate when one of the
network chains is disrupted.

Figure 148 - Ring Ethernet Topology

Ethernet Switch

Fiber Fiber

857 857 857 857

290 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

Determine Network To operate an EtherNet/IP network, you must define these parameters.
Parameters Table 144 - EtherNet/IP Network Parameters
Network Parameter Description
IP Address The IP Address uniquely identifies the module. The IP Address is in the
form xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx where each xxx is a number from 0...255. Do not
use these IP Addresses, they are reserved values:
• 0.0.0.1…0.255.255.255
• 127.0.0.0…127.255.255.255
• 224.255.255.255…255.255.255.255
Subnet Mask Subnet addressing is an extension of the IP Address scheme that allows
a site to use one network ID for multiple physical networks. Routing
outside of the site continues by dividing the IP Address into a net ID and
a host ID by the class. Inside a site, the Subnet Mask is used to redivide
the IP Address into a custom network ID portion and host ID portion.
Important: If the Subnet Mask of a configured module is changed,
cycle power to the module for the change to take effect.
Gateway A gateway connects individual physical networks into a system of
networks. When a node is required to communicate with a node on
another network, a gateway transfers the data between the two
networks.

Define these parameters if DNS addressing is used or if a Host Name in an


MSG instruction references the module.

IMPORTANT Consult with your Ethernet network administrator to determine if these


parameters must be specified.

Table 145 - EtherNet/IP Network Parameters for DNS Addressing


Network Parameter Description
Host Name A Host Name is part of a text address that identifies the module. The full
text address of a module is: host_name.domain_name.
Domain Name A domain name is part of a text address that identifies the domain in
which the module resides. The full text address of a module is:
host_name.domain_name. The domain name has a 48-character limit.
Primary DNS Server Address Identifies any DNS servers that are used in the network. You must have a
DNS server that is configured if you specify an SMTP server with a name.
Secondary DNS Server Address The DNS server converts the domain name or Host Name to an IP Address
that is used by the network.

Set the Network IP Address The 857 Protection System is shipped with DHCP disabled. To set the
network Internet Protocol (IP) address, use the following tools and software:
• The SetPointPS Configuration Software Tool.
• A Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP)/Dynamic Host Configuration
Protocol (DHCP) server (for example, the Rockwell Automation®
BOOTP-DHCP Server Utility, which is included RSLinx® Classic
software).
• A web browser and MAC scanner software.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 291


Chapter 7 Communications

Assign Network Parameters with the BOOTP/ DHCP Utility

By default, the 857 has DHCP disabled. It can only be enabled by using the
SetPointPS software. The BOOTP/DHCP utility is a standalone program
that is a separate program available as part of the Rockwell Software suite. The
utility is located in the BOOTPDHCP Server folder that is accessed from the
Start menu.

IMPORTANT Before starting the BOOTP/DHCP utility, make sure that you have the
hardware MAC ID of the module. The module is located in the Port Settings
section while connected through the SetPointPS software. The module can
also be accessed from the Ethernet display screens from the front panel. The
MAC ID has a format similar to the following: 00-0b-db-14-55-35.

This utility recognizes DHCP-enabled devices and provides an interface to


configure a static IP address for each device. To assign network parameters with
the BOOTP/DHCP utility, perform this procedure:

1. Execute the BOOTP/DHCP software.


2. Choose Tool >Network Settings.
3. If appropriate for the network, type the subnet mask, gateway address,
primary/secondary server addresses, and domain name in their
respective fields.

4. Click OK.
The Request History panel displays the hardware addresses of modules
that are issuing BOOTP or DHCP requests.
5. Double-click the MAC address of the module to be configured.

IMPORTANT The MAC address of the relay can be located in the Port Settings while
connected through the SetPointPS software or in the Ethernet section from
the front panel displays.

292 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

The format of the hardware address resembles the following: 00-0b-db-14-55-


35.

The New Entry dialog appears with the Ethernet Address (MAC) of the
module.

6. Type the IP address, host name, and a module description.


7. Click OK.
8. Cycle power to the 857 Protection System.
9. To assign this configuration to the module permanently: Select the
module in the Relation List panel and click Disable BOOTP/DHCP.

When module power is cycled, it uses the assigned configuration and does not
issue a DHCP request.

If you do not click Disable BOOTP/DHCP, on a power cycle, the module


clears the current IP configuration and starts sending DHCP requests.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 293


Chapter 7 Communications

Electronic Data Sheet (EDS) Before the 857 Relay is configured to communicate on an EtherNet/IP
network, it must be registered to the software that configures the network. For
File example, Rockwell Automation® RSLinx® Classic and RSNetWorx™ for
EtherNet/IP software). Register the module by installing an EDS file. EDS
files are simple text files that are used by network configuration tools to
identify products and commission them on a network. Relay firmware, version
13 and higher, supports an EtherNet/IP EDS AOP approach within the
Studio5000 environment. The EDS file for the 857 Protection System can be
obtained directly from the relay.

Upload the EDS File

The EDS file for the 857 Protection System is embedded within the device. To
upload the file, use the SetPointPS software.

See the Software Programming Tool documentation for details on how to


connect to the 857 Protection System.

To upload the current EDS file for the device (recommended), use these steps.

1. Connected to the 857 Protection System in Configurator Mode


2. Select the tab.
3. Click Get Ethernet EDS (Figure 149).

IMPORTANT DeviceNet is not supported in the 857 Protection System.

Figure 149 - Ethernet EDS

294 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

The relay reads the EDS information from the relay in preparation to
create an EDS data file.

Figure 150 - Reading EDS File

4. Navigate to the desired location.


5. Enter a file name
6. Click Save.

Figure 151 - Save as Window

EDS Add On Profile Support The 857 with firmware version 13.001 or higher provides for EDS Add On
Profile (AOP) support. The EDS (AOP) feature in combination with
Rockwell Software® Logix Designer provides an easy integration path within
the Logix Designer environment. The EDS file format for the Ethernet
Common Industrial Protocol (CIP) networks is defined by ODVA.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 295


Chapter 7 Communications

The EDS file can be extracted directly from the 857 using the SetPointPS
software Configuration tool. The EDS AOP provides both the values for
Input and Output assembly and the tags for the static assembly selected. This
support is provided only for the static assemblies and the pre-configured in the
device. The selection of static assembly within Logix Designer must match the
selection that is made in the relay.

The 857 does support one dynamic assembly (input/output assembly


100+150). The dynamic input and output assembly (100+150) is available for
you to create a custom input/output assembly configuration if the predefined
static assemblies are not suitable. The use of a dynamic assembly requires that a
Generic Device AOP be used. The generic device user interface only specifies
the basic connection parameters (Assembly Instance and the size of the
Configuration, Input, and Output arrays). You must still create documentation
that describes the instance values and tag details based on the parameters
selected in the 100+150 input/output assembly in the 857. You must manually
enter all configuration parameters. The generic approach does not facilitate the
automatic transmission of all data tags.

Predefined Static Ethernet The mapping for static assemblies is permanently programmed in the Read
Only Memory (ROM) of the 857 protection system. They cannot be modified
Input and Output Assemblies in any way and must be used as is. The content of the predefined static
assemblies, which exist within the 857 protection system with firmware version
13.001 or higher, are listed in the following tables. See Appendix C for more
information related to the parameters.

Table 146 - Summary of Static and Dynamic Assemblies (Version 13.001 or Higher Firmware)
Assembly Reference Name shown in Assembly Type 3 PH Voltage 857-RAA 857-RAD Protection Mode Parameter Count
Studio 5000 Transformers Support Support
Supported
2+50 Basic Static No No No(1) — 2
100+150 Configurable Dynamic Yes Yes Yes Motor/Feeder Up to 255
101+151 Static Advance Static No No No(1) Motor 31
102+152 Static Advance 2 Static 2 in Open Delta Yes No(1) Motor 50
103+153 Static Advance 3 Static 3 in ‘Y’ connected Yes No(1) Motor 50
104+154 Static Advance 4 Static 2 in Open Delta No No(1) Motor 38
105+155 Static Advance 5 Static 3 in ‘Y’ connected No No(1) Motor 38
106+156 Static Advance 6 Static 2 in Open Delta No No(1) Feeder 39
107+157 Static Advance 7 Static 3 in ‘Y’ connected No No(1) Feeder 39
(1) 857-RAD only supported via dynamic assembly.

296 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

2+50 Static Assembly (Basic)


Table 147 - 2+50 Static Assembly (Basic)
Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly
Count Offset Type
Control Supervisor#10 Faulted 1 1=1 Producing
Control Supervisor#12 Fault Reset 1 1=1 Consuming

100+150 Dynamic Assembly (Configurable)

The dynamic assembly can be modified and extended through dynamic


mapping in the random access memory (RAM) of the 857 protection relay.
Dynamic Assembly Objects can be used in more complex applications but it
requires the individual parameter selection and the parsing of the data. Object
tags are not supported with the dynamic assembly.

101+151 Advanced Static Assembly (Static Advanced)

This assembly is designed for configurations where the 857 protection system
that has no voltage potential connections and NO RTD scanner connected.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 297


Chapter 7 Communications

Table 148 - 101+151 Advanced Static Assembly (Static Advanced) Parameter List
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly Type
Number number Count Offset
4 0x29 10 Control Supervisor Faulted 1 1=1 000 Producing
5 0x29 11 Control Supervisor Warning 1 1=1 001
7 0x29 13 Control Supervisor Fault Code 1 See Appendix 002
A for details
8 0x29 14 Control Supervisor Warn Code 1 See Appendix 003
A for details
11 0x2C 6 Overload %Phase Unbalance 1 1% =1 004
12 0x2C 7 Overload %Thermal 1 1% =1 005
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 006
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 007
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 008
10 0x2C 5 Overload Average Current 2 1A=1 012
13 0x2C 8 Overload Current L1 2 1 A=1 014
14 0x2C 9 Overload Current L2 2 1A=1 016
15 0x2C 10 Overload Current L3 2 1 A=1 018
16 0x2C 11 Overload Ground Current 2 1A=1 020
78 0x382 62 857/865 Digital N> alarm 1 1=1 022
80 0x382 64 857/865 Digital Motor starting 1 1=1 023
17 0x382 1 857/865 Digital Digital inputs 4 1=1 024
18 0x382 2 857/865 Digital Output relays 4 1=1 028
895 0x384 54 857/865 Analog 2 Estimated time to trip 4 1=1 032
81 0x382 65 857/865 Digital Motor running 1 1=1 036
896 0x382 170 857/865 Digital Virtual output 1 1 1=1 037
897 0x382 171 857/865 Digital Virtual output 2 1 1=1 038
898 0x382 172 857/865 Digital Virtual output 3 1 1=1 039
899 0x382 173 857/865 Digital Virtual output 4 1 1=1 040
900 0x382 174 857/865 Digital Virtual output 5 1 1=1 041
901 0x382 175 857/865 Digital Virtual output 6 1 1=1 042
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 000 Consuming
6 0x29 12 Control Supervisor Fault Reset 1 1=1 004
123 0x382 107 857/865 Digital Virtual input 1 1 0, 1 005
124 0x382 108 857/865 Digital Virtual input 2 1 0, 1 006
125 0x382 109 857/865 Digital Virtual input 3 1 0, 1 007
126 0x382 110 857/865 Digital Virtual input 4 1 0, 1 008

298 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

102+152 Advanced Static Assembly 2 (Static Advanced 2)

This assembly is when the 857 protection system is configured as a MOTOR


protection device. It has voltage potential connections from two open delta
voltage transformers and an optional 857-RAA, 12-channel RTD scanner. The
dynamic assembly 100+150 must be used for the 857-RAD if any of the 4-
analog inputs or 4-analog outputs or the PTC input are configured for use.
Table 149 - 102+152 Advanced Static Assembly 2 (Static Advanced 2) Parameter List
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Offset Assembly Type
Number number Count
4 0x29 10 Control Supervisor Faulted 1 1=1 000 Producing
5 0x29 11 Control Supervisor Warning 1 1=1 001
11 0x2C 6 Overload %Phase Unbalance 1 1% =1 002
12 0x2C 7 Overload %Thermal 1 1% =1 003
78 0x382 62 857/865 Digital N> alarm 1 1=1 004
80 0x382 64 857/865 Digital Motor starting 1 1=1 005
81 0x382 65 857/865 Digital Motor running 1 1=1 006
8 0x29 14 Control Supervisor Warn Code 1 See Appendix A 007
for details
7 0x29 13 Control Supervisor Fault Code 1 See Appendix A 008
for details
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 009
10 0x2C 5 Overload Avg. Current 2 1A=1 010
13 0x2C 8 Overload CurrentL1 2 1A=1 012
14 0x2C 9 Overload CurrentL2 2 1A=1 014
15 0x2C 10 Overload CurrentL3 2 1A=1 016
16 0x2C 11 Overload Ground Current 2 1A=1 018
17 0x382 1 857/865 Digital Digital inputs 4 1=1 020
18 0x382 2 857/865 Digital Output relays 4 1=1 026
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 030
896 0x382 170 857/865 Digita Virtual output 1 1 1=1 031
897 0x382 171 857/865 Digital Virtual output 2 1 1=1 032
898 0x382 172 857/865 Digital Virtual output 3 1 1=1 033
899 0x382 173 857/865 Digital Virtual output 4 1 1=1 034
900 0x382 174 857/865 Digital Virtual output 5 1 1=1 035
901 0x382 175 857/865 Digital Virtual output 6 1 1=1 036
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 037
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 038
373 0x383 188 857/865 Analog External AI1 4 1.00C=100 042
374 0x383 189 857/865 Analog External AI2 4 1.00C=100 044
375 0x383 190 857/865 Analog External AI3 4 1.00C=100 048
376 0x383 191 857/865 Analog External AI4 4 1.00C=100 052
377 0x383 192 857/865 Analog External AI5 4 1.00C=100 056
378 0x383 193 857/865 Analog External AI6 4 1.00C=100 060

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 299


Chapter 7 Communications

Table 149 - 102+152 Advanced Static Assembly 2 (Static Advanced 2) Parameter List (Continued)
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Offset Assembly Type
Number number Count
379 0x383 194 857/865 Analog External AI7 4 1.00C=100 064 Producing
380 0x383 195 857/865 Analog External AI8 4 1.00C=100 068
381 0x383 196 857/865 Analog External AI9 4 1.00C=100 072
382 0x383 197 857/865 Analog External AI10 4 1.00C=100 076
383 0x383 198 857/865 Analog External AI11 4 1.00C=100 080
384 0x383 199 857/865 Analog External AI12 4 1.00C=100 084
842 0x384 1 857/865 Analog 2 Frequency 4 50.000 Hz=5000 088
846 0x384 5 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage U12 4 1000V=1000 092
847 0x384 6 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage U23 4 1000V=1000 096
848 0x384 7 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage U31 4 1000V=1000 100
849 0x384 8 857/865 Analog 2 Power factor 4 1.00=100 104
854 0x384 13 857/865 Analog 2 Average line voltage 4 1000V=1000 108
895 0x384 54 857/865 Analog 2 Estimated time to trip 4 1=1 112
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 000 Consuming
6 0x29 12 Control Supervisor Fault Reset 1 1=1 004
123 0x382 107 857/865 Digital Virtual input 1 1 0, 1 005
124 0x382 108 857/865 Digital Virtual input 2 1 0, 1 006
125 0x382 109 857/865 Digital Virtual input 3 1 0, 1 007
126 0x382 110 857/865 Digital Virtual input 4 1 0, 1 008

103+153 Advanced Static Assembly 3 (Static Advanced 3)

This assembly is for an 857 protection system that is configured as a MOTOR


protection device. It has voltage potential connections from three wye
connected voltage transformers and an optional 857-RAA, 12-channel RTD
scanner. The dynamic assembly 100+150 must be used for the 857-RAD).
Table 150 - 103+153 Advanced Static Assembly 3 (Static Advanced 3) Parameter List
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly Type
Number number Count Offset
4 0x29 10 Control Supervisor Faulted 1 1=1 000 Producing
5 0x29 11 Control Supervisor Warning 1 1=1 001
8 0x29 14 Control Supervisor Warn Code 1 See 002
Appendix A
for details
7 0x29 13 Control Supervisor Fault Code 1 See 003
Appendix A
for details
11 0x2C 6 Overload %PhImbal 1 1%=1 004
12 0x2C 7 Overload %Thermal 1 1%=1 005
78 0x382 62 857/865 Digital N> alarm 1 1=1 006
80 0x382 64 857/865 Digital Motor starting 1 1=1 007

300 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

Table 150 - 103+153 Advanced Static Assembly 3 (Static Advanced 3) Parameter List (Continued)
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly Type
Number number Count Offset
81 0x382 65 857/865 Digital Motor running 1 1=1 008 Producing
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 009
10 0x2C 5 Overload Avg. Current 2 1 A=1 010
13 0x2C 8 Overload CurrentL1 2 1 A=1 012
14 0x2C 9 Overload CurrentL2 2 1 A=1 014
15 0x2C 10 Overload CurrentL3 2 1 A=1 016
16 0x2C 11 Overload Ground Current 2 1 A=1 018
17 0x382 1 857/865 Digital Digital inputs 4 1=1 020
18 0x382 2 857/865 Digital Output relays 4 1=1 026
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 030
896 0x382 170 857/865 Digital Virtual output 1 1 1=1 031
897 0x382 171 857/865 Digital Virtual output 2 1 1 =1 032
898 0x382 172 857/865 Digital Virtual output 3 1 1=1 033
899 0x382 173 857/865 Digital Virtual output 4 1 1=1 034
900 0x382 174 857/865 Digital Virtual output 5 1 1=1 035
901 0x382 175 857/865 Digital Virtual output 6 1 1=1 036
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 037
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1.00C= 100 038
373 0x383 188 857/865 Analog External AI1 4 1.00C= 100 042
374 0x383 189 857/865 Analog External AI2 4 1.00C= 100 044
375 0x383 190 857/865 Analog External AI3 4 1.00C= 100 048
376 0x383 191 857/865 Analog External AI4 4 1.00C= 100 052
377 0x383 192 857/865 Analog External AI5 4 1.00C= 100 056
378 0x383 193 857/865 Analog External AI6 4 1.00C= 100 060
379 0x383 194 857/865 Analog External AI7 4 1.00C= 100 064
380 0x383 195 857/865 Analog External AI8 4 1.00C= 100 068
381 0x383 196 857/865 Analog External AI9 4 1.00C= 100 072
382 0x383 197 857/865 Analog External AI10 4 1.00C = 100 076
383 0x383 198 857/865 Analog External AI11 4 1.00C = 100 080
384 0x383 199 857/865 Analog External AI12 4 50.000 Hz = 084
5000
842 0x384 1 857/865 Analog 2 Frequency 4 1.00 = 100 088
850 0x384 9 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage UL1 4 1000 v = 1000 092
851 0x384 10 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-linevoltageUL2 4 1000V= 1000 096
852 0x384 11 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage UL3 4 1000V= 1000 100
849 0x384 8 857/865 Analog 2 Power factor 4 1.00 = 100 104
855 0x384 14 857/865 Analog 2 Average phase voltage 4 1000V = 1000 108
895 0x384 54 857/865 Analog 2 Estimated time to trip 4 1=1 112

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 301


Chapter 7 Communications

Table 150 - 103+153 Advanced Static Assembly 3 (Static Advanced 3) Parameter List (Continued)
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly Type
Number number Count Offset
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 000 Consuming
6 0x29 12 Control Supervisor Fault Reset 1 1=1 004
123 0x382 107 857/865 Digital Virtual input 1 1 0, 1 005
124 0x382 108 857/865 Digital Virtual input 2 1 0, 1 006
125 0x382 109 857/865 Digital Virtual input 3 1 0, 1 007
126 0x382 110 857/865 Digital Virtual input 4 1 0, 1 008

104+154 Advanced Static Assembly 4 (Static Advanced 4)

This assembly is for when the 857 protection system is configured as a


MOTOR protection device with voltage potential connections from two open
delta voltage transformers and NO RTD scanner connected.
Table 151 - 104+154 Advanced Static Assembly 4 (Static Advanced 4) Parameter List
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly Type
Number number Count Offset
4 0x29 10 Control Supervisor Faulted 1 1=1 000 Producing
5 0x29 11 Control Supervisor Warning 1 1=1 001
7 0x29 13 Control Supervisor Fault Code 1 See 002
Appendix A
for details
8 0x29 14 Control Supervisor Warn Code 1 See 003
Appendix A
for details
11 0x2C 6 Overload %PhImbal 1 1%=1 004
12 0x2C 7 Overload %Thermal 1 1%=1 005
78 0x382 62 857/865 Digital N> alarm 1 1=1 006
80 0x382 64 857/865 Digital Motor starting 1 1=1 007
81 0x382 65 857/865 Digital Motor running 1 1=1 008
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 009
10 0x2C 5 Overload Avg. Current 2 1 A=1 010
13 0x2C 8 Overload CurrentL1 2 1 A=1 012
14 0x2C 9 Overload CurrentL2 2 1 A=1 014
15 0x2C 10 Overload CurrentL3 2 1 A=1 016
16 0x2C 11 Overload Ground Current 2 1 A=1 018
17 0x382 1 857/865 Digital Digital inputs 4 1=1 020
18 0x382 2 857/865 Digital Output relays 4 1=1 026
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 030
896 0x382 170 857/865 Digital Virtual output 1 1 1=1 031
897 0x382 171 857/865 Digital Virtual output 2 1 1=1 032
898 0x382 172 857/865 Digital Virtual output 3 1 1=1 033
899 0x382 173 857/865 Digital Virtual output 4 1 1=1 034

302 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

Table 151 - 104+154 Advanced Static Assembly 4 (Static Advanced 4) Parameter List (Continued)
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly Type
Number number Count Offset
900 0x382 174 857/865 Digital Virtual output 5 1 1=1 035 Producing
901 0x382 175 857/865 Digital Virtual output 6 1 1=1 036
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 037
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 038
842 0x384 1 857/865 Analog 2 Frequency 4 50.000 042
Hz=5000
846 0x384 5 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-linevoltageU12 4 1000V = 1000 044
847 0x384 6 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-linevoltageU23 4 1000V = 1000 048
848 0x384 7 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage U31 4 1000V = 1000 052
849 0x384 8 857/865 Analog 2 Power factor 4 1.00 = 100 056
854 0x384 13 857/865 Analog 2 Average line voltage 4 1000V=1000 060
895 0x384 54 857/865 Analog 2 Estimated time to trip 4 1=1 064
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 000 Consuming
6 0x29 12 Control Supervisor Fault Reset 1 1=1 004
123 0x382 107 857/865 Digital Virtual input 1 1 0, 1 005
124 0x382 108 857/865 Digital Virtual input 2 1 0, 1 006
125 0x382 109 857/865 Digital Virtual input 3 1 0, 1 007
126 0x382 110 857/865 Digital Virtual input 4 1 0, 1 008

105+155 Advanced Static Assembly 5 (Static Advanced 5)

This assembly is for when the 857 protection system is configured as a


MOTOR protection device with voltage potential connections from three wye
connected voltage transformers and NO RTD scanner connected.
Table 152 - 105+155 Advanced Static Assembly 5 (Static Advanced 5) Parameter List
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly Type
Number number Count Offset
4 0x29 10 Control Supervisor Faulted 1 1=1 000 Producing
5 0x29 11 Control Supervisor Warning 1 1=1 001
7 0x29 13 Control Supervisor Fault Code 1 See 002
Appendix A
for details
8 0x29 14 Control Supervisor Warn Code 1 See 003
Appendix A
for details
11 0x2C 6 Overload %PhImbal 1 1%=1 004
12 0x2C 7 Overload %Thermal 1 1% =1 005
78 0x382 62 857/865 Digital N> alarm 1 1 =1 006
80 0x382 64 857/865 Digital Motor starting 1 1 =1 007
81 0x382 65 857/865 Digital Motor running 1 1 =1 008
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 009

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 303


Chapter 7 Communications

Table 152 - 105+155 Advanced Static Assembly 5 (Static Advanced 5) Parameter List (Continued)
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly Type
Number number Count Offset
10 0x2C 5 Overload Avg. Current 2 1% =1 010 Producing
13 0x2C 8 Overload CurrentL1 2 1 A=1 012
14 0x2C 9 Overload CurrentL2 2 1 A=1 014
15 0x2C 10 Overload CurrentL3 2 1 A=1 016
16 0x2C 11 Overload Ground Current 2 1 A=1 018
17 0x382 1 857/865 Digital Digital inputs 4 1=1 020
18 0x382 2 857/865 Digital Output relays 4 1=1 026
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 030
896 0x382 170 857/865 Digital Virtual output 1 1 1=1 031
897 0x382 171 857/865 Digital Virtual output 2 1 1=1 032
898 0x382 172 857/865 Digital Virtual output 3 1 1=1 033
899 0x382 173 857/865 Digital Virtual output 4 1 1=1 034
900 0x382 174 857/865 Digital Virtual output 5 1 1=1 035
901 0x382 175 857/865 Digital Virtual output 6 1 1=1 036
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 037
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 038
842 0x384 1 857/865 Analog 2 Frequency 4 50.000 042
Hz=5000
850 0x384 9 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage UL1 4 1000V = 1000 044
851 0x384 10 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-linevoltageUL2 4 1000V = 1000 048
852 0x384 11 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage UL3 4 1000V = 1000 052
849 0x384 8 857/865 Analog 2 Power factor 4 1.00 = 100 056
855 0x384 14 857/865 Analog 2 Average line voltage 4 1000V = 1000 060
895 0x384 54 857/865 Analog 2 Estimated time to trip 4 1=1 064
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 000 Consuming
6 0x29 12 Control Supervisor Fault Reset 1 1=1 004
123 0x382 107 857/865 Digital Virtual input 1 1 0, 1 005
124 0x382 108 857/865 Digital Virtual input 2 1 0, 1 006
125 0x382 109 857/865 Digital Virtual input 3 1 0, 1 007
126 0x382 110 857/865 Digital Virtual input 4 1 0, 1 008

304 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

106+156 Advanced Static Assembly 6 (Static Advanced 6)

This assembly is for when the 857 protection system is configured as a


FEEDER protection device with voltage potential connections from two open
delta voltage transformers and NO RTD scanner connected.
Table 153 - 106+156 Advanced Static Assembly 6 (Static Advanced 6) Parameter List
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly Type
Number number Count Offset
4 0x29 10 Control Supervisor Faulted 1 1 =1 000 Producing
5 0x29 11 Control Supervisor Warning 1 1 =1 001
7 0x29 13 Control Supervisor Fault Code 1 See 002
Appendix A
for details
8 0x29 14 Control Supervisor Warn Code 1 See 003
Appendix A
for details
11 0x2C 6 Overload %PhImbal 1 1%:1 004
12 0x2C 7 Overload %Thermal 1 1%=1 005
78 0x382 62 857/865 Digital N> alarm 1 1=1 006
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 007
10 0x2C 5 Overload Avg Current 1 1 A=1 008
13 0x2C 8 Overload CurrentL1 2 1 A=1 010
14 0x2C 9 Overload CurrentL2 2 1 A=1 012
15 0x2C 10 Overload CurrentL3 2 1 A=1 014
16 0x2C 11 Overload Ground Current 2 1 A=1 016
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 018
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 019
17 0x382 1 857/865 Digital Digital inputs 4 1=1 020
18 0x382 2 857/865 Digital Output relays 4 1=1 024
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 028
896 0x382 170 857/865 Digital Virtual output 1 1 1=1 032
897 0x382 171 857/865 Digital Virtual output 2 1 1=1 033
898 0x382 172 857/865 Digital Virtual output 3 1 1=1 034
899 0x382 173 857/865 Digital Virtual output 4 1 1=1 035
900 0x382 174 857/865 Digital Virtual output 5 1 1=1 036
901 0x382 175 857/865 Digital Virtual output 6 1 1=1 037
819 0x387 108 857/865 StgProtO CBFP Enable for CBFP 1 Off=0, On=1 038
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 039
842 0x384 1 857/865 Analog 2 Frequency 4 50.000 Hz= 040
5000
843 0x384 2 857/865 Analog 2 Active power 4 1000 044
kW=1000
844 0x384 3 857/865 Analog 2 Reactive power 4 1000kvar=10 048
00

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 305


Chapter 7 Communications

Table 153 - 106+156 Advanced Static Assembly 6 (Static Advanced 6) Parameter List (Continued)
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly Type
Number number Count Offset
845 0x384 4 857/865 Analog 2 Apparent power 4 1000 052 Producing
kVA=1000
846 0x384 5 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-linevoltageU12 4 1000V = 1000 056
847 0x384 6 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-linevoltageU23 4 1000V = 1000 060
848 0x384 7 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage U31 4 1000V = 1000 064
849 0x384 8 857/865 Analog 2 Power factor 4 1.00 = 100 068
854 0x384 13 857/865 Analog 2 Average line voltage 4 1000V = 1000 072
895 0x384 54 857/865 Analog 2 Estimated time to trip 4 1 =1 076
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 000 Consuming
6 0x29 12 Control Supervisor Fault Reset 1 1=1 004
123 0x382 107 857/865 Digital Virtual input 1 1 0, 1 005
124 0x382 108 857/865 Digital Virtual input 2 1 0, 1 006
125 0x382 109 857/865 Digital Virtual input 3 1 0, 1 007
126 0x382 110 857/865 Digital Virtual input 4 1 0, 1 008

107+157 Advanced Static Assembly 7 (Static Advanced 7)

This assembly is for when an 857 protection system is configured as a


FEEDER protection device with voltage potential connections from three wye
connected voltage transformers and has NO RTD scanner. connected.
Table 154 - 107+157 Advanced Static Assembly 7 (Static Advanced 7) Parameter List
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly Type
Number number Count Offset
4 0x29 10 Control Supervisor Faulted 1 1=1 000 Producing
5 0x29 11 Control Supervisor Warning 1 1=1 001
7 0x29 13 Control Supervisor Fault Code 1 See 002
Appendix A
for details
8 0x29 14 Control Supervisor Warn Code 1 See 003
Appendix A
for details
11 0x2C 6 Overload %PhImbal 1 1%=1 004
12 0x2C 7 Overload %Thermal 1 1% =1 005
78 0x382 62 857/865 Digital N> alarm 1 1=1 006
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 007
10 0x2C 5 Overload Avg Current 2 1A=1 008
13 0x2C 8 Overload#0 CurrentL1 2 1A=1 010
14 0x2C 9 Overload CurrentL2 2 1A=1 012
15 0x2C 10 Overload CurrentL3 2 1A=1 014
16 0x2C 11 Overload Ground Current 2 1A=1 016
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 018
17 0x382 1 857/865 Digital Digital inputs 4 1=1 020

306 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Communications Chapter 7

Table 154 - 107+157 Advanced Static Assembly 7 (Static Advanced 7) Parameter List (Continued)
Parameter Object Attribute Name Description Byte Scaling Byte Assembly Type
Number number Count Offset
18 0x382 2 857/865 Digital Output relays 4 1=1 024 Producing
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 028
896 0x382 170 857/865 Digital Virtual output 1 1 1=1 032
897 0x382 171 857/865 Digital Virtual output 2 1 1=1 033
898 0x382 172 857/865 Digital Virtual output 3 1 1=1 034
899 0x382 173 857/865 Digital Virtual output 4 1 1=1 035
900 0x382 174 857/865 Digital Virtual output 5 1 1=1 036
901 0x382 175 857/865 Digital Virtual output 6 1 1=1 037
819 0x387 108 857/865 StgProtO CBFP Enable for CBFP 1 Off=0, On=1 038
1 0x389 1 857/865 Special 1 byte padding 1 1=1 039
842 0x384 1 857/865 Analog 2 Frequency 4 50.000 Hz= 040
5000
843 0x384 2 857/865 Analog 2 Active power 4 1000 044
kW=1000
844 0x384 3 857/865 Analog 2 Reactive power 4 1000kvar = 048
1000
845 0x384 4 857/865 Analog 2 Apparent power 4 1000 052
kVA=1000
849 0x384 8 857/865 Analog 2 Power factor 4 1.00 = 100 056
846 0x384 5 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-linevoltageUL1 4 1000V = 1000 060
847 0x384 6 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-linevoltageUL2 4 1000V = 1000 064
848 0x384 7 857/865 Analog 2 Line-to-line voltage UL3 4 1000V = 1000 068
854 0x384 13 857/865 Analog 2 Average line voltage 4 1000V = 1000 072
895 0x384 54 857/865 Analog 2 Estimated time to trip 4 1=1 076
9 0x29 22 Control Supervisor Cycle Count 4 1=1 000 Consuming
6 0x29 12 Control Supervisor Fault Reset 1 1=1 004
123 0x382 107 857/865 Digital Virtual input 1 1 0, 1 005
124 0x382 108 857/865 Digital Virtual input 2 1 0, 1 006
125 0x382 109 857/865 Digital Virtual input 3 1 0, 1 007
126 0x382 110 857/865 Digital Virtual input 4 1 0, 1 008

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 307


Chapter 7 Communications

Notes:

308 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Chapter 8

Applications

These examples illustrate the versatile functions in simultaneously applications.

Substation Feeder Protection The feeder device includes three-phase overcurrent protection, directional
earth-fault-protection, and fast arc protection. At the incoming feeder, the
instantaneous stage I>>> of the 857 feeder devices is blocked with the start
signal of the overcurrent stage. This block helps prevent the trip signal if the
fault occurs on the outgoing feeder.

Figure 152 - 857 Feeder and Motor Devices That Are Used in Substation Feeder Protection

857

857

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 309


Chapter 8 Applications

The directional function of earth-fault function uses the status information


(on/off ) of a Petersen coil. It is routed to one of the digital inputs of the feeder
device so that I0sinϕ or I0cosϕ function is obtained.

The function I0sinϕ is used in isolated networks, and the function I0cosϕ is used
in resistance or resonant earthed networks.

Industrial Feeder Protection Directional earth-fault-protection and three-phase overcurrent protection is


required in a cable feeder. The thermal stage can be used to help protect the
cable against being overloaded. This example also includes fast arc protection.

Figure 153 - 857 Feeder and Motor Devices That Are Used in Cable Protection of an Industry
Plant Network

857

857

vamp257app2

310 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Applications Chapter 8

Parallel Line Protection Figure 154 shows two parallel lines, A and B, protected with overcurrent relays
R1, R2, R3, and R4. The relays R3 and R4 are directional.

Figure 154 - Feeder and Motor Device Allen-Bradley 857 Used for Protection of Parallel Lines
LOAD

R1 R3
A
LOAD
SUPPLY
B
LOAD
R2 R4

LOAD/SPARE SUPPLY LOAD


R5

If there is a fault in one of the lines, only the faulty line is switched off because
of the direction functions of the relays R3 and R4. A detailed schematic of, for
example, the relay R3 is shown in Figure 155.

Figure 155 - Example Connection of Allen-Bradley 857


Both short circuits and earth-
faults are detected. The
outgoing line is one of several
parallel lines or the line is
feeding a ring network.
Communication
Communication

+
option 2
option 1

X3:14

X3:15
X3:12

X3:13
X7:17

X7:18
X7:15

X7:16
X8:19

X8:20
X8:17

X8:18
X8:15

X8:16
X8:13

X8:14

X3:11
X3:10

X2:10
X2:11
X3:9

X2:7

X2:8
X2:5

X2:6
X2:3

X2:4
X2:1

X2:2
X2:9
X10
X9
Front

A1

A2

A3

A4

A5
T1

T2

T3

T4

T5

T6

T7

T8

IF
Extension port
Remote port
Local port

857-3C7xxx
Optio n Block

DI
DI

DI
DI

Comm
~

Comm

X8:9 Comm
Comm

Comm

X8:3 Comm
+48V

DI12

X7:10 DI15

X7:13 DI18
DI10

DI13
DI14

X7:11 DI16
X7:12 DI17

DI26
DI25
DI11

DI24

X8:11 DI28
DI23

X8:10 DI27
DI22
DI21
U12

U23

DI6
DI2

DI5

DI9
DI1

DI3
DI4

DI7
DI8
U0
I01

I02
IL1

IL2

IL3

X8:12
X7:14
X1:13

X1:17
X3:17

X3:18

X1:10

X1:12

X1:14

X1:18
X1:11

X6:1
X6:2
X6:3
X6:4
X6:5
X6:6
X6:7

X3:1
X3:2
X3:3
X3:4
X3:5
X3:6
X3:7

X7:1
X7:2
X7:3
X7:4
X7:5
X7:6
X7:7

X7:8
X7:9

X8:1
X8:2

X8:4
X8:5
X8:6
X8:7
X8:8
X1:1

X1:3
X1:4
X1:5
X1:6
X1:7
X1:8
X1:9
X1:2

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 311


Chapter 8 Applications

Ring Network Protection Ring networks can be selectively protected, by using directional overcurrent
relays, as long as there is only one feeding point in the network. Figure 156
shows an example of a ring main with five nodes that use one circuit breaker at
each end of each line section (for example a ring main unit). When there is a
short-circuit fault in any line section, only the faulty section is disconnected.
The grading time in this example is 150 ms.

Figure 156 - Feeder Terminals, 857 Protection System Used for Protection of Ring Main Circuit
with One Feeding Point
LOAD 2

Used for protection of


ring main circuit with
one feeding point. LOAD 3

SupPLY LOAD 1

LOAD 4

LOAD 5

Trip Circuit Supervision Trip circuit supervision is used to make sure that the wiring from a protective
device to a circuit-breaker is in order. The circuit is unused most of the time.
When a protection device detects a fault in the network, it is too late to notice
that the circuit-breaker cannot be tripped because of broken trip circuitry.

The digital inputs of the device can be used for trip circuit monitoring. The
dry digital inputs are most suitable for trip circuit supervision. The first six
digital inputs of 857 Protection Systems are not dry contacts and an auxiliary
miniature relay is needed, if these inputs are used for trip circuit supervision.

The closing circuit can be supervised using the same principle.

The optimum digital inputs for trip circuit supervision are inputs
DI29…DI32, which are internally wired in parallel within trip relays T5…T8.
These inputs do not share the common terminal with other inputs.
DI29…DI32 and T5…T8 are optional by catalog number.

312 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Applications Chapter 8

Internal Parallel Digital Inputs

In Allen-Bradley 857-3C7 and Allen-Bradley 857-3C8, the output relays T5


(DI29), T6 (DI30), T7 (DI31) and T8 (DI32) have internal, parallel digital
inputs available for trip circuit supervision. They are optional by catalog
number.

Trip Circuit Supervision with One Digital Input


The benefits of this scheme are that only one digital input is needed and no
extra wiring from the relay to the circuit breaker (CB) is needed. Supervision of
a 24 Vdc trip circuit is possible.

The drawback is that an external resistor must supervise the trip circuit on both
CB positions. If supervision during the closed position only is enough, the
resistor is not needed.
• The digital input is connected parallel with the trip contacts
(Figure 157).
• The digital input is configured as Normal Closed (NC).
• The digital input delay is configured longer than maximum fault time to
inhibit any unnecessary trip circuit fault alarm when the trip contact is
closed.
• The trip relay must be configured as non-latched. Otherwise the trip
contact operates, a superfluous trip-circuit fault alarm is raised, and the
relay remains closed because of latching.

By using an auxiliary contact of the CB for the external resistor, the auxiliary
contact in the trip circuit can be supervised.
• When using the dry digital input DI7, there is limited use of the other
inputs of the same group and limited common terminal sharing.
• When using the wet digital inputs DI1…DI6, an auxiliary relay is
needed.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 313


Chapter 8 Applications

Figure 157 - Trip Circuit Supervision When the Circuit Breaker Is Closed
The supervised circuitry in this CB +V AUX
position is double-lined. The digital
input is in active state. For the Trip circuit
application to work when the circuit- failure alarm
breaker is opened, a resistor R1 must Digital input
be placed. The value for it can be
calculated from the external wetting
supply, so that the current over R1 is
>1 mA.
Trip relay

Alarm relay
for trip circuit

Relay compartment
Circuit breaker compartment
Close Control

R1

-V AUX
Open Coil
CB

-V AUX
Close Coil

Figure 158 - Trip Circuit Supervision When the Circuit Breaker Is Open
The supervised circuitry in this CB +V AUX = 24…240V DC
position is doubled-lined. The value for 857 Relay Digital input
R1 in this application is 3k3 and 2 W.
These values can be calculated from the
resistance and voltage operating range
of the coil of K1 and the tolerance of the
wetting voltage.
Trip relay

Alarm relay for


trip circuit failure Trip circuit
Failure alarm

Relay compartment

Circuit breaker compartment


Close Control

-V AUX
Open Coil
CB

R -V AUX
Close Coil

314 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Applications Chapter 8

If DI7 is used for trip circuit supervision, the usage of DI8…DI14 is limited to
the same circuitry that shares the Vaux in the common terminal.

Figure 159 - Example of a Digital Input DI7 Configuration for Trip Circuit Supervision with One
Dry Digital Input

Figure 160 - Example of Output Matrix Configuration for Trip Circuit Supervision with One Dry
Digital Input

Example of dimensioning the external resistor R:


• UAUX = 110 Vdc - 20% + 10%

Auxiliary voltage with tolerance:


• UDI =18 Vdc

Threshold voltage of the digital input:


• IDI = 3 mA

Typical current that is required to activate the digital input including a 1 mA


safety margin:
• PCoil= 50 W

Rated power of the open coil of the circuit breaker. If this value is not known,
0Ω can be used for the RCoil :
• UMIN = UAUX - 20% = 88V
• UMAX = UAUX + 10% = 121V
• RCoil = U2AUX/P = 242 Ω

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 315


Chapter 8 Applications

The external resistance value is calculated using Equation 8.1.

Equation 8.1

U MIN – U DI – I DI • R coil
R = -----------------------------------------------------------
-
I DI

EXAMPLE – 18 – 003 • 242


R = 88
----------------------------------------------- = 23.1 kΩ
0.003

In practice, the coil resistance has no effect. By selecting the next smaller
standard size, we get 22 kΩ.

The power rating for the external resistor is estimated using Equation 8.2 and
Equation 8.3. The Equation 8.2 is for the CB open situation including a 100%
safety margin to limit the maximum temperature of the resistor.

Equation 8.2
2
P = 2 • I DI • R

EXAMPLE 2
P = 2 • 0.003 • 22000 = 0.40 W

Select the next bigger standard size, for example 0.5 W.

When the trip contacts are still closed and the CB is open, the resistor must
withstand much higher power (Equation 8.3) for this short time.

Equation 8.3

2
U MAX
P = --------------
-
R

EXAMPLE 2
122 - = 0.67 W
P = --------------
22000

A 0.5 W resistor is enough for this short time peak-power, too. However, if the
trip relay is closed for longer time than a few seconds, use a 1 W resistor.

316 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Applications Chapter 8

Non-dry Digital Inputs DI1…DI6

In this scheme, an auxiliary relay must connect the wet digital input to the trip
circuit (Figure 161). The rated coil voltage of the auxiliary relay is selected
according to the rated auxiliary voltage that is used in the trip circuit. The
operating voltage range of the relay must be as wide as possible to cover the
tolerance of the auxiliary voltage.

In this application, the use of other wet inputs for other purposes is not limited
unlike, when using the dry inputs.

Figure 161 - Trip Circuit Supervision


Shown with an internally wetted +V AUX = 110…125V DC
digital input (DI1…DI6) and an 857 Relay
Digital input 48V
auxiliary relay K1 along with an
external resistor, R. The circuit- 1…6
breaker is in the closed position. The
supervised circuitry in this CB position K1
is double-lined. The digital input is in
active state when the trip circuit is Trip relay
complete.
Alarm relay for
Trip circuit
trip circuit failure Failure alarm

0.5 s

Relay compartment

Close Control Circuit breaker compartment

-V AUX Relay K1
Open Coil EMG 17-REL/KSR-120/21-21-LC Au
Coil: 96…127V, 20 kΩ
CB

R
-V AUX
Close Coil

Figure 162 - Digital Input DI1 Configuration for Trip Circuit Supervision with One Wet Digital
Input

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 317


Chapter 8 Applications

Figure 163 - Output Matrix Configuration for Trip Circuit Supervision with One Wet Digital
Input

Example of Dimensioning the External Resistor R:


• UAUX =110 Vdc – 5% + 10%

Auxiliary voltage with tolerance. Short time voltage dips more than 5% are not
critical from the trip circuit supervision point of view.

Relay type for the K1 auxiliary relay:

Phoenix Contact 2941455 EMG 17-REL/KSR-120/21-21-LC Au


• UK1=120 Vac/dc – 20% + 10%

Coil voltage of the auxiliary relay K1:


• IK1 = 6 mA

Nom coil current of the auxiliary relay K1:


• PCBcoil = 50 W

Rated power of the open coil of the circuit breaker.:


• UMIN =UAUX – 5% = 104.5V
• UMAX =UAUX + 10% = 121V
• UK1Min = UK1 – 10% = 96V
• RK1coil =UK1/IK1 = 20 kΩ
• IK1Min =UK1Min/RK1coil = 4.8 mA
• IK1Max=UK1Max/RK1coil = 6.1 mA
• RCBcoil=U2AUX/P = 242 Ω

318 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Applications Chapter 8

The external resistance value is calculated using Equation 8.4:

Equation 8.4

U MIN – U K1MIN
R = --------------------------------------
- = R Coil
I K1MIN

EXAMPLE 104.5 – 96- – 242


R = ------------------------ = 1.5 kΩ
0.0048

By selecting the next smaller standard size, we get 1.5 kΩ.>

The power rating for the external resistor is calculated using Equation 8.5. This
equation includes a 100% safety margin to limit the maximum temperature of
the resistor, because modern resistors are hot at their rated maximum power.

Equation 8.5

2
P = 2 • I K1MAX • R

EXAMPLE 2
P = 2 • 0.0061 • 1500R = 0.11 W

Select the next bigger standard size, for example 0.5 W.

When the trip contacts are still closed and the CB is open, the resistor must
withstand much higher power (Equation 8.6) for this short time.

Equation 8.6

2
121 -
P = ----------- = 9.8 W
1500

Select the A 1 W resistor to withstand this short time peak-power. However, if


the trip relay can be closed for longer than a few seconds, use a 20 W resistor.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 319


Chapter 8 Applications

Trip Circuit Supervision with Two Digital Inputs

The benefit of this scheme is that no external resistor is needed.

The drawbacks are that two digital inputs from two separate groups are needed
and two extra wires from the relay to the CB compartment are needed.
Additionally, the minimum allowed auxiliary voltage is 48V DC, which is
more than twice the threshold voltage of the dry digital input. When the CB is
in the open position, the two digital inputs are in series.
• The first digital input is connected parallel with the trip contacts
(Figure 164).
• Another auxiliary contact is connected in series with the circuitry of the
first digital input. This makes it possible to supervise the auxiliary
contact in the trip circuit.
• The second digital input is connected parallel with the auxiliary contact
of the circuit breaker.
• Both inputs are configured as normal closed (NC).

The programmable logic is used to combine the digital input signals with an
AND port. The delay is configured longer than the maximum fault time to
inhibit any superfluous trip-circuit fault alarm when the trip contact is closed.
• The output from the logic is connected to a relay in the output matrix
that gives out any trip circuit alarm.
• Configure the trip relay as non-latched. Otherwise, the trip contact
operates, a superfluous trip-circuit fault alarm follows, and the relay
remains closed because of latching.
• Both digital inputs must have their own common potential. The use of
the other digital inputs in the same group as the upper DI in Figure 164
is not possible in most applications. The use of the other digital inputs in
the same group as the lower DI in Figure 164 is limited. Because the
whole group is tied to the auxiliary voltage Vaux.

TIP For some applications, the optimal digital inputs for trip circuit supervision
are the optional inputs DI19 and DI20 because they do not share their
terminals with any other digital inputs.

320 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Applications Chapter 8

Figure 164 - Trip Circuit Supervision with Two Dry Digital Inputs
The circuit breaker is closed. The +V AUX = 48…240V DC
supervisory circuit in this circuit 857 Relay
breaker position is double-lined.
The digital input state is in active
state when the trip circuit is Digital Inputs
complete. Applicable for dry
inputs DI7…DI20 only. comm

Trip relay

Alarm relay for


trip circuit failure Trip circuit
Failure alarm
0.5 s

Relay compartment
Circuit breaker compartment
Close Control

-V AUX
Open Coil
CB

-V AUX
Close Coil

Figure 165 - Trip Supervision with Two Dry Digital Inputs


The circuit breaker is in +V AUX = 48…240V DC
the open position. The 857 Relay
two digital inputs are
now in series.
Digital Inputs
comm

Trip relay

Alarm relay for


trip circuit failure Trip circuit
Failure alarm
0.5 s

Relay compartment
Circuit breaker compartment
Close Control

-V AUX
Open Coil
CB

-V AUX
Close Coil

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 321


Chapter 8 Applications

TIP If DI13 and DI7 are used as the upper and lower digital inputs. The usage of
DI8… DI14 is limited to the same circuitry shared by the Vaux in the
common terminal. The DI14… DI18 and cannot be used, because they
share a common terminal with DI13.

Figure 166 - Digital Input Configuration for Trip Circuit Supervision with Two Dry Digital Inputs
DI7 and DI13

Figure 167 - Logic Configuration for Trip Circuit Supervision with Two Dry Digital Inputs DI7
and DI13

Figure 168 - Output Matrix Configuration for Trip Circuit Supervision with Two Dry Digital
Inputs

322 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Rear Panel View

X3 X6 X8 X7 X1

+48V 1 BI DI7 1
1

(TTL)
DI1 2 BO DI8

REMOTE
2 2 IL1 (S2)
IL1 (S1)
2
DI2 3 COM DI9 3 1
3
IL2 (S2)
Connections

DI3 4 S1> + DI10 4 4


4 IL2 (S1) 3
DI4 5 S1> DI11 5
5 IL3 (S2)
DI5 S2> + IL3 (S1)
6
6 6 DI12 6 5
Io1/
DI6 7 S2> 7 COM1 7 Io1/ 8 1A(S2)
1A(S1) 7
-- 8 DI13 8 Io2/
A5- 1
Io2/ 10 5A(S2)
A1 COM 9 DI14 9 9
A5 2 5A(S1)
Ua
A1 NO 10 DI15 10
A4 Ua 12

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


3
Figure 169 - Rear Panel Connections of an 857-3C6

A1 NC 11 DI16
11
A4 4 11
Ub
T2 12 DI17 Ub 14
A3 5 12 13
T2 13 DI18 13 --
A3 6 16
-- 15
T1 14 COM2 14
A2 7 Uc
T1 15 T4 15 Uc 18
A2 8 17
-- 16 T4 16
IF COM 9 20 --
Uaux 17 T3 -- 19
IF NC 10 17
Uaux 18 T3
IF NO 11 18
protect) through the following measuring and control connections.

X2
Chapter

Allen-Bradley® 857 Protection System is connected to the object (that it helps


9

323
324
Chapter 9
Connections

X3 X6 X8 X7 X1
DI21 1
+48V 1 BI DI22 DI7 1
1 2

(TTL)
DI1 2 BO Com. DI8

REMOTE
2 3 2 IL1 (S2)
IL1 (S1)
2
DI2 3 COM DI23 DI9 3 1
3 4
DI3 S1> + IL2 (S2)
4 4 DI24 5 DI10 4 4
IL2 (S1) 3
DI4 5 S1> Com. 6 DI11 5
5 IL3 (S2)
DI5 S2> + IL3 (S1)
6
6 6 DI25 7 DI12 6 5
Io1/
DI6 7 S2> 7 DI26 8 COM1 7 Io1/ 8 1A(S2)
1A(S1) 7
-- 8 Com. 9 DI13 8
A5- 1 Io2/
Io2/ 10 5A(S2)
A1 COM 9 DI27 10 DI14 9 9
A5 2 5A(S1)
DI28 Ua
A1 NO 10 11 DI15 10

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


A4 3 Ua 12
Figure 170 - Rear Panel Connections of an 857-3C7

A1 NC 11 Com. 12 DI16
11
A4 4 11
Ub
T2 12 T8 13 DI17 Ub 14
A3 5 12 13
T2 T8 14
13 DI18 13 --
A3 6 16
--
T1 14 T7 15 COM2 14
15
A2 7 Uc
T1 T7 16 Uc
15 A2 8 T4 15 18
17
-- T6 17
16 T4 16
IF COM 9 20 --
Uaux T6 18 --
17 T3 17 19
IF NC 10
T5 19
Uaux 18 T3
IF NO 11 18
T5 20

X2
X3 X6 X8 X7 X1
T14
1
+48V 1 BI DI7 1
1 T14 2

(TTL)
DI1 2 BO DI8

REMOTE
2 T13 3 2 IL1 (S2)
IL1 (S1)
2
DI2 3 COM DI9 1
3 T13 4 3
DI3 S1> + IL2 (S2)
4 4 T12 5 DI10 4 4
IL2 (S1) 3
DI4 5 S1> T12 6 DI11 5
5 IL3 (S2)
DI5 S2> + IL3 (S1)
6
6 6 T11 7 DI12 6 5
Io1/
DI6 7 S2> T11 8 COM1 7 Io1/ 1A(S2)
7 8
T10 1A(S1) 7
-- 8 9 DI13 8 Io2/
A5- 1
Io2/ 10 5A(S2)
A1 COM 9 T10 10 DI14
A5 2 9 5A(S1)
9
T9 Ua
A1 NO 10 11 DI15 10

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


A4 3 Ua 12
Figure 171 - Rear Panel Connections of an 857-3C8

A1 NC 11 T9 12 DI16
11
A4 4 11
Ub
T2 12 T8 13 DI17 Ub 14
A3 5 12 13
T2 T8 14
13 DI18 13 --
A3 6 16
--
T1 14 T7 15 COM2 14
15
A2 7 Uc
T1 T7 16 Uc
15 A2 8 T4 15 18
17
-- T6 17
16 T4 16
IF COM 9 20 --
Uaux T6 18 --
17 T3 17 19
IF NC 10
T5 19
Uaux 18 T3
IF NO 11 18
T5 20
Connections

X2

325
Chapter 9
Chapter 9 Connections

Details of Terminal Table 155 - Terminal X1 Left Side

Connections No: Symbol Description


1 IL1(S1) Phase current L1 (S1)
3 IL2(S1) Phase current L2 (S1)
5 IL3(S1) Phase current L3 (S1)
7 Io1/1A(S1) Residual current I/O1(S1)
9 Io2/5A(S1) Residual current I/O2(S1)
11 Ua See Voltage Measurement Mode on page 219
13 Ub See Voltage Measurement Mode on page 219
15 -- --
17 Uc See Voltage Measurement Mode on page 219
19 -- --

Table 156 - Terminal X1 Right Side


No: Symbol Description
2 IL1(S2) Phase current L1 (S2)
4 IL2(S2) Phase current L2 (S2)
6 IL3(S2) Phase current L3 (S2)
8 Io1/1A(S2) Residual current I/O1 (S2)
10 Io2/5A(S2) Residual current I/O2 (S2)
12 Ua See Voltage Measurement Mode on page 219
14 Ub See Voltage Measurement Mode on page 219
16 -- --
18 Uc See Voltage Measurement Mode on page 219
20 -- --

326 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Connections Chapter 9

Table 157 - Terminal X2


No: Symbol Description
1 A5 Alarm relay 5
2 A5 Alarm relay 5
3 A4 Alarm relay 4
4 A4 Alarm relay 4
5 A3 Alarm relay 3
6 A3 Alarm relay 3
7 A2 Alarm relay 2
8 A2 Alarm relay 2
9 IF COM Internal fault relay, common connector
10 IF NC Internal fault relay, normal closed connector
11 IF NO Internal fault relay, normal open connector

Table 158 - Terminal X3


No: Symbol Description
1 +48V Internal control voltage for digital inputs 1…6
2 DI1 Digital input 1
3 DI2 Digital input 2
4 DI3 Digital input 3
5 DI4 Digital input 4
6 DI5 Digital input 5
7 DI6 Digital input 6
8 -- --
9 A1 COM Alarm relay 1, common connector
10 A1 NO Alarm relay 1, normal open connector
11 A1 NC Alarm relay 1, normal closed connector
12 T2 Trip relay 2
13 T2 Trip relay 2
14 T1 Trip relay 1
15 T1 Trip relay 1
16 -- --
17 Uaux Auxiliary voltage
18 Uaux Auxiliary voltage

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 327


Chapter 9 Connections

Table 159 - Terminal X7


No: Symbol Description
1 DI7 Digital input 7
2 DI8 Digital input 8
3 DI9 Digital input 9
4 DI10 Digital input 10
5 DI11 Digital input 11
6 DI12 Digital input 12
7 COM1 Common potential of digital inputs 7…12
8 DI13 Digital input 13
9 DI14 Digital input 14
10 DI15 Digital input 15
11 DI16 Digital input 16
12 D117 Digital input 17
13 DI18 Digital input 18
14 COM2 Common potential of digital inputs 13…18
15 T4 Trip relay 4
16 T4 Trip relay 4
17 T3 Trip relay 3
18 T3 Trip relay 3

328 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Connections Chapter 9

Table 160 - Terminal X8 Model 857-3C7


No: Symbol Description
1 DI21 Digital input 21
2 DI22 Digital input 22
3 COM1 Common potential of digital inputs 21…2
4 DI23 Digital input 23
5 DI24 Digital input 24
6 COM2 Common potential of digital inputs 23…24
7 DI25 Digital input 25
8 DI26 Digital input 26
9 COM3 Common potential of digital inputs 25…26
10 DI27 Digital input 27
11 DI28 Digital input 28
12 COM4 Common potential of digital inputs 27…28
13 T8 Trip relay 8 / Digital input 32
14 T8 Trip relay 8 / Digital input 32
15 T7 Trip relay 7 / Digital input 31
16 T7 Trip relay 7 / Digital input 31
17 T6 Trip relay 6 / Digital input 30
18 T6 Trip relay 6 / Digital input 30
19 T5 Trip relay 5 / Digital input 29
20 T5 Trip relay 5 / Digital input 29

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 329


Chapter 9 Connections

Table 161 - Terminal X8 Model 857-3C8


No: Symbol Description
1 DI21 Trip relay 14
2 DI22 Trip relay 14
3 COM1 Trip relay 13
4 DI23 Trip relay 13
5 DI24 Trip relay 12
6 COM2 Trip relay 12
7 DI25 Trip relay 11
8 DI26 Trip relay 11
9 COM3 Trip relay 10
10 DI27 Trip relay 10
11 DI28 Trip relay 9
12 COM4 Trip relay 9
13 T8 Trip relay 8 / Digital input 32
14 T8 Trip relay 8 / Digital input 32
15 T7 Trip relay 7 / Digital input 31
16 T7 Trip relay 7 / Digital input 31
17 T6 Trip relay 6 / Digital input 30
18 T6 Trip relay 6 / Digital input 30
19 T5 Trip relay 5 / Digital input 29
20 T5 Trip relay 5 / Digital input 29

Table 162 - Terminal X6


No: Symbol Description
1 BI External arc light input
2 BO Arc light output
3 COM Common connector of arc light I/O
4 S1>+ Arc sensor 1, positive connector (1)
5 S1>– Arc sensor 1, negative connector (1)
6 S2>+ Arc sensor 2, positive connector (1)
7 S2>– Arc sensor 2, negative connector (1)

(1) Arc sensor itself is polarity free.

330 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Connections Chapter 9

Table 163 - Terminal X6 with DI19/DI20 Option


No: Symbol Description
1 DI19 Digital input 19
2 DI19 Digital input 19
3 DI20 Digital input 20
4 DI20 Digital input 20
5 — —
6 S1>+ Arc sensor 1, positive connector(1)
7 S1>– Arc sensor 1, negative connector(1)

(1) Arc sensor itself is polarity free.

Auxiliary Voltage The external auxiliary voltage Uaux (standard 40…265V AC or DC) for the
terminal is connected to the terminals X3: 17…18.

TIP When optional 18…36V DC power module is used, the polarity is as


follows:
X3: 17 = Negative Connection and X3: 18 = Positive Connection.

Serial Communication Connection

The device can be equipped with two optional communication interfaces:


• Option 1: inbuilt Ethernet ST-fiber optic interface or option module 1
• Option 2: inbuilt Ethernet RJ45 interface or option module 2

The physical location of the communication options is at the back of the relay.
The option modules can be installed at the site, but the built-in Ethernet
modules are installed at the factory.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 331


Chapter 9 Connections

Figure 172 - Example of Allen-Bradley 857 Back Panel Serial Communication Connection

Communication option 1 Communication option 2

X3 X6 X8 X7 X1

REMOTE
1

(TTL)
1 2 1
2 3 2
1 2
3 4 3
4 5 4
3 4
5 6 5
5 6
6 7 6
7 8 7
7 8
8 9 8
1
9 10 9 9 10
2
10 11 10 12
3 11
11 12 11
4
12 13 12 13 14
5
13 14 13
6
15 16
14 15 14
7
15 8
16 15 17 18
16 17 16
9 20
17 10
18
17 19
19
18 11 18
20

X2

The internal connection in both communication modules is identical (see


Figure 173). The transmit and receive lines of all three “logical communication
ports” REMOTE, LOCAL, and EXTENSION port are available for both
modules (RS-232 signal levels). The module type determines if one or more of
these ports are physically available at the external connector.

The communication modules convert the RS-232 signal levels to some other
levels, for example, TTL, RS-485 or fiber-optics. The modules can contain
intelligence to make protocol conversion on software level.

332 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Connections Chapter 9

Figure 173 - Internal Connection to Communication Modules


X3-1
EXT TX X3-2
EXT RX X3-3

Remote TX X3-4

Remote RX X3-5
+8Vdc X3-6

X3-7

X3-8
Local TX X3-9
Local RX
X3-10

UART_OUT X3-11
Sync. in X3-12

OPTx_ID X3-13

X3-14

The internal connection of the communication modules contains the RX/TX


signals from the communication ports, general output (UART_OUT), clock
sync/general input (Sync.in), and OPTx_ID for module detection.

Figure 174 - TTL Communication Module (31 mm)

31 mm (1.2 in.)

Figure 175 - Communication Module (18 mm)

External connector,
signal levels depend
on the type of the
module

External connector

18 mm (0.71 in.)

Internal 14-pin connector,


RS-232 signal levels for
REMOTE, LOCAL, and
EXTENSION ports

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 333


Chapter 9 Connections

The device has a 31 mm high “slot” for Communication option 1 and 18 mm


high “slot” for Communication option 2. The option modules are 31 mm or
18 mm high, the 18 mm modules can be used in the 31 mm or 18 mm slot.

Pin Assignments of Communication Options

The communication module types and their pin assignments are introduced in
these tables.

Table 164 - Optional Built-in Ethernet/61850 Interfaces


Type Communication Ports Signal Levels Connector Pin Usage
Ethernet TCP Port Ethernet RJ45 Connector 1 = Transmit+
2 = Transmit-
3 = Receive+
4 = Reserved
5 = Reserved
6 = Receive-
7 = Reserved
8 = Reserved
Ethernet TCP Port Fiber Ethernet ST Connectors (dual-port)

Table 165 - 18 mm High Modules


Type Communication Signal Levels Connector Pin Usage
Ports
857-VCM232 REMOTE, LOCAL, and RS-232 RJ45 Connector 1 = LOC TX
EXTENSION 2 = EXT TX
3 = +8V
4 = GND
5 = REM TX
6 = REM RX
7 = LOC RX
8 = EXT RX
857-VCM485 REMOTE, LOCAL, or RS-485 (2-wire 3-pole screw 1=–
857-VCM485-2 EXTENSION port connection) connector 2=+
selectable with a DIP 3 = GND
switch
857-VCMRTD Remote/Local Light, switch for ST Connector Used with 857-
(required for 857- echo/ no-echo and RAA
RAA) light/ no-light
selection

334 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Connections Chapter 9

Table 166 - 32 mm High Modules


Type Communication Ports Signal Levels Connector Pin Usage
(1)
TTL/RS232 REMOTE REMOTE: TTL or RS- D-connector 1= EXT TX
232 selectable 2= REM TX
with a DIP Switch 3= REM RX
4= SYNC IN
LOCAL LOCAL: RS-232 5= LOC TX
6= LOC RX
EXTENSION EXTENSION: RS- 7= GND
232
8= EXT RX
9= +8V
857-VCM485-4 REMOTE, LOCAL, or RS-485 (2- or 4- 5-pole screw 1= GND
EXTENSION port selectable wire connection) connector 2= R-
with a DIP switch 3= R+
4= T-
5= T+
857-VCM fiber REMOTE or LOCAL Light, switch for Snap-in connectors
PP selectable with a DIP echo/ no-echo and
switch light/ no-light
selection
857-VCM fiber REMOTE or LOCAL Light, switch for ST connectors Used with 857-
GG selectable with a DIP echo/ no-echo and VCMFIBER
(required for switch light/ no-light
857-RAD) selection
857-VCM fiber REMOTE or LOCAL Light, switch for Snap-in and ST
PG selectable with a DIP echo/ no-echo and connectors
switch light/ no-light
selection
857-VCM fiber REMOTE or LOCAL Light, switch for ST and Snap-in
GP selectable with a DIP echo/ no-echo and connectors
switch light/ no-light
selection
(1) PROFIBUS is supported by the external 857-VPA 3CG module. The module is connected with an 857-VX007-F3 cable to the VCM
TTL module (VCM TTL DIP switch must be set to TTL).

Figure 176 - TTL − Module DIP Switches


S1 S2
Open Open

TTL Close Close

S1 S2
Open Open
1 2 1 2

S1 S2 RS-232 Close Close


REM RX REM TX

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 335


Chapter 9 Connections

Figure 177 - 857-VCM485-2


EXT. I/O Termination OFF
On S1 On S2

1 2 3 4 5 6
Off Off
Remote Termination ON
On S1 On S2

1 2 3 4 5 6
Off Off
S1 S2
Local
On S1 On S2

1 2 3 4 5 6
Off Off

Figure 178 - 857-VCM485-4 − Module DIP Switches


EXT. I/O Termination ON, 4-wire
On Off

S1 1 2 S23 4 5 6 4 3 2 1

Off On
Remote Termination OFF, 4-wire
Off

1 2 3 4 5 6 4 3 2 1
On
S2 S1 Termination OFF, 2-wire
Local
On Off

1 2 3 4 5 6 4 3 2 1

Off On

Figure 179 - 857-VCM Fiber − Module DIP Switches


S1:1 Echo OFF
S1:2 IDLE light ON
S1:3,5 REMOTE ON
S1:4,6 LOCAL OFF
On S1

1 2 3 4 5 6
Off
S1:1 Echo ON
S1:2 IDLE light OFF
S1 S1:3,5 REMOTE OFF
S1:4,6 LOCAL ON
On S1

1 2 3 4 5 6
Off

336 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Connections Chapter 9

Front Panel Connector


Figure 180 - Pin Numbering of the Front Panel D9S Connector

Table 167 - RS-232 Signals


Pin RS-232 Signal
1 Not connected
2 Rx in
3 Tx out
4 DTR out (+8V)
5 GND
6 DSR in (activates this port and disables the X4 RS-232 port)
7 RTS in (Internally connected to pin 8)
8 CTS out (Internally connected to pin 7)
9 No connected

TIP Connect DSR to DTR to activate the front panel connector and disable the
rear panel X4 RS-232 port. The other port in the same X4 connector is not
disabled.

Optional Two-channel Arc The optional arc protection card includes two arc sensor channels. The arc
sensors are connected to terminals X6: 4-5 and 6-7.
Protection Card
The arc information can be transmitted and/or received through digital input
and output channels. A 48V DC signal.

TIP When this option card is installed, the parameter “Arc card type” has value
“2Arc+BI/O”.

TIP If the slot X6 is occupied with the DI19/DI20 digital input card, this option is
not available. There is still one arc sensor channel available (see Optional
Digital I/O Card (DI19/DI20) on page 338).

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 337


Chapter 9 Connections

Table 168 - Two-channel Arc Protection Card Connections:


X6: 1 Binary input (BI)
X6: 2 Binary output (BO)
X6: 3 Common for BI and BO.
X6: 4-5 Sensor Channel 1
X6: 6-7 Sensor Channel 2

Activate the binary output of the arc option card by using the arc sensors or by
any available signal in the output matrix. The binary output can be connected
to an arc binary input of another Allen-Bradley® protection device or other
compatible product.

Optional Digital I/O Card The DI19/DI20 option permits two more digital inputs. These inputs are
useful in applications where the contact signals are not potential free. For
(DI19/DI20) example, trip circuit supervision is such an application. The inputs are
connected to terminals X6:1 – X6:2 and X6:3 – X6:4.

TIP When this option card is installed, the parameter “Arc card type” has value
“Arc+2DI”. With DI19/DI20 option, only one arc sensor channel is available.

TIP If the slot X6 is occupied with the two-channel arc sensor card, this option is
not available.

Table 169 - Digital I/O Card Connections:


1 DI19+
X6:2 DI19-
X6:3 DI20+
X6:4 DI20-
X6:5 NC
X6:6 L+
X6:7 L-

External Input/Output Modules

The 857 device supports optional external input/output modules that are used
to extend the system capabilities. A module for analog inputs and outputs is
available. These types of devices are supported:
• 12-channel RTD scanner, 857-RAA.
• 12-channel RTD scanner with analog inputs and outputs, and a
thermistor input, 857-RAD. See publication 857-UM002.

338 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Connections Chapter 9

Block Diagrams
Figure 181 - Block Diagram of Allen-Bradley 857-3C6

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 339


Chapter 9 Connections

Figure 182 - Block Diagram of Allen-Bradley 857-3C7

340 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Connections Chapter 9

Figure 183 - Block Diagram of Allen-Bradley 857-3C8

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 341


Chapter 9 Connections

Block Diagrams of Option Optional Arc Protection


Modules Figure 184 - Block Diagram of Optional Arc Protection Module

Figure 185 - Block Diagram of Optional D10/D20 Module with One Arc Channel

342 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


L1

L2
mode is set to “2LL+U0”.
The voltage measurement

L3

+ 1 -

- 0

X3:17 ~ Front

X3:18 Communication
Local port option 1
Remote port X9
X1:1 IL1
Extension port
X1:2 Communication
X1:3 option 2
IL2 X10
X1:4
X1:5 IL3
X1:6
T1 X3:14
X1:7 I01
X1:8 X3:15
X1:9 I02
U
T2 X3:12
X1:10
X1:11 U12
X1:12 X3:13 U
X1:13 T3 X7:17
U23
Connection Examples

X1:14
X7:18
T4 X7:15
X1:17 U0
X1:18
Option Block X7:16
X6:1 T5 X8:19
X6:2
X6:3 X8:20
X6:4 X8:17
857-3C7

X6:5 T6
X6:6
X6:7 X8:18
T7 X8:15
VAMP 255 +48V
X3:1 DI
DI1

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


X3:2 X8:16
DI2
X3:3
DI3 T8 X8:13
X3:4 DI4
X3:5 DI5
X3:6 X8:14
DI6
X3:7 A1 X3:9
DI7 X3:11
X7:1
Figure 186 - Connection Example of Allen-Bradley 857-3C7

DI8 DI X3:10
X7:2
X7:3 DI9 A2 X2:7
X7:4 DI10
X7:5 DI11
DI12 X2:8
X7:6 X2:5
X7:7 Comm A3

X2:6
X7:8 DI13 A4 X2:3
DI14 DI
X7:9
X7:10 DI15 X2:4
X7:11 DI16 A5 X2:1
X7:12 DI17
X7:13 DI18
X7:14 Comm X2:2
IF X2:9
DI21
X8:1 X2:10
X8:2 DI22 DI
Comm X2:11
X8:3
Connections

X8:4 DI23
DI24
X8:5
Comm
X8:6 DI25
X8:7 DI26
X8:8
X8:9 Comm
X8:10 DI27
X8:11 DI28
Comm
X8:12

343
Chapter 9
344
L1
Chapter 9

L2

L3
Connections

measurement mode is set to “3LN”.

+ 1 -

- 0
The device is calculating the residual voltage. The voltage

X3:17 Front
~
X3:18 Communication
Local port option 1
Remote port X9
X1:1 Extension port
X1:2 IL1 Communication
X1:3 option 2
X1:4 IL2 X10

X1:5 IL3
X1:6
T1 X3:14
X1:7 I01
X1:8
X3:15
X1:9 U
I02 T2 X3:12
X1:10
X1:11
X1:12 UL1 X3:13 U
X1:13 T3 X7:17
X1:14 UL2
X1:17 X7:18
X1:18 UL3
T4 X7:15
Option Block
X6:1 X7:16
X6:2 X8:19
T5
X6:3
X6:4
X6:5 X8:20
857-3C7

X6:6 X8:17
T6
X6:7
+48V X8:18
X3:1 DI1 DI
X3:2 T7 X8:15
DI2
X3:3 DI3
X3:4 DI4 X8:16

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


X3:5 DI5
X3:6 T8 X8:13
DI6
X3:7
X8:14

X7:1 DI7 A1 X3:9


DI8 DI
X7:2 X3:11
X7:3 DI9
DI10 X3:10
X7:4
DI11 A2 X2:7
X7:5
X7:6 DI12
X7:7 Comm X2:8
A3 X2:5
X7:8 DI13
DI14 DI
X7:9
X7:10 DI15 X2:6
X7:11 DI16 X2:3
A4
X7:12 DI17
DI18
X7:13 X2:4
Comm
X7:14
A5 X2:1
DI21
X8:1 DI22 DI
X8:2 Comm X2:2
X8:3 DI23 X2:9
IF
X8:4 DI24
X8:5 X2:10
Comm
X8:6 X2:11
DI25
X8:7 DI26
X8:8 Comm
X8:9 DI27
X8:10
DI28
X8:11 Comm
X8:12
Figure 187 - Connection Example of Allen-Bradley 857-3C7 with Three Voltage Transformers
L1

L2

L3 polarizing U0 voltage.

+
1 -

+
The voltage measurement mode is set to “2LL+U0”.

- 0
Directional earth-fault stages are not available without the

X3:17 Front
~
Communication
X3:18
Local port option 1
Remote port X9
X1:1 Extension port
X1:2 IL1 Communication
option 2
X1:3
IL2 X10
X1:4
Transformer

X1:5 IL3
X1:6
T1 X3:14
X1:7
I01
X1:8
X3:15
X1:9 U
I02 X3:12
X1:10 T2
X1:11
X1:12 U12 X3:13 U
X1:13 T3 X7:17
X1:14 U23

X1:17 X7:18
X1:18 U0
T4 X7:15
Option Block
X6:1 X7:16
X6:2 X8:19
T5
X6:3
X6:4
X8:20
857-3C7

X6:5
X6:6 X8:17
T6
X6:7
+48V X8:18
X3:1 DI1 DI
T7 X8:15
VAMP 255 X3:2 DI2
X3:3 DI3
X3:4 DI4 X8:16
X3:5 DI5 T8 X8:13

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


X3:6 DI6
X3:7
X8:14

X7:1 DI7 A1 X3:9


DI8 DI
X7:2 X3:11
X7:3 DI9
DI10 X3:10
X7:4
DI11 A2 X2:7
X7:5
X7:6 DI12
Comm X2:8
X7:7
A3 X2:5
X7:8 DI13
DI14 DI
X7:9
X7:10 DI15 X2:6
X7:11 DI16 X2:3
DI17
A4
X7:12
DI18
X7:13 X2:4
Comm
X7:14
A5 X2:1
DI21
X8:1 DI22 DI
X8:2 Comm X2:2
X8:3 DI23 X2:9
IF
X8:4 DI24
X8:5 X2:10
Comm
X8:6 DI25 X2:11
Connections

X8:7 DI26
X8:8 Comm
X8:9 DI27
Figure 188 - Connection Example of Allen-Bradley 857-3C7 with V-connected Voltage

X8:10
DI28
X8:11 Comm
X8:12

345
Chapter 9
L1

346
Chapter 9

L2

L3
Connections

+ 1 -

- 0

+
The voltage measurement mode is set to “2LL+U0”.

X3:17 Front
~
Communication
X3:18
Local port option 1
Remote port X9
X1:1 Extension port
X1:2 IL1
Communication
X1:3 option 2
X1:4 IL2
X10
X1:5
IL3
X1:6
T1 X3:14
X1:7 I01
X1:8
X3:15 U
X1:9 I02
X1:10 T2 X3:12
X1:11
X1:12 U12 X3:13 U
X1:13 T3 X7:17
X1:14 U23
X7:18
T4 X7:15
X1:17
X1:18 U0
Option Block X7:16
X6:1 T5 X8:19
X6:2
X6:3 X8:20
X6:4 X8:17
857-3C7

X6:5 T6
X6:6
X6:7 X8:18
T7 X8:15
X3:1 +48V
X3:2 DI1 DI
X8:16
X3:3 DI2

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


X3:4 DI3 T8 X8:13
X3:5 DI4
X3:6 DI5 X8:14
X3:7 DI6
A1 X3:9
DI7 X3:11
X7:1 DI8 DI
X7:2 X3:10
DI9
X7:3 A2 X2:7
DI10
X7:4 DI11
X7:5 DI12 X2:8
X7:6 Comm A3 X2:5
X7:7
DI13
X7:8 DI14 DI X2:6
X7:9 DI15 X2:3
A4
X7:10 DI16
X7:11 DI17
X7:12 X2:4
DI18
X7:13 Comm A5 X2:1
X7:14

DI21 X2:2
X8:1
X8:2 DI22 DI IF X2:9
X8:3 Comm
X2:10
X8:4 DI23
DI24 X2:11
X8:5
Comm
X8:6
DI25
X8:7
X8:8 DI26
Comm
Figure 189 - Connection Example of Allen-Bradley 857-3C7 as a Motor Protection Device

X8:9
X8:10 DI27
X8:11 DI28
Comm
M X8:12
Chapter 10

Specifications

Connections Table 170 - Measuring the Circuitry


Rated phase current 5 A (configurable for CT secondaries 1…10 A)
- Current measurement range 0…250 A
- Thermal withstand 20 A (continuously)
100 A (for 10 s), 500 A (for 1 s)
- Burden 0.125VA
- Impedance 0.005 Ohms
I02 Input, Option C(1) 5 A (configurable for CT secondaries 1…10 A)
Rated residual current (optional) 0…50 A
- Current measurement range 20 A (continuously)
- Thermal withstand 100 A (for 10 s), 500 A (for 1 s)

- Burden 0.125VA
- Impedance 0.005 Ohms
I01 Input, Option C / I012 Input, Option D(1) 1 A (configurable for CT secondaries 0.1…10.0 A)
Rated residual current 0…10 A
- Current measurement range 4 A (continuously)
- Thermal withstand 20 A (for 10 s), 100 A (for 1 s)

- Burden 0.04VA
- Impedance 0.04 Ohms
I01 Input, Option D(1) 0.2 A (configurable for CT secondaries 0.1…10.0 A)
Rated residual current (optional) 0…2 A
- Current measurement range 0.8 A (continuously)
- Thermal withstand 4 A (for 10 s), 20 A (for 1 s)

- Burden 0.04VA
- Impedance 0.04 Ohms
Serial Numbers < 857- Serial Numbers > 857-
001071 001070
Rated voltage Un Configurable for VT Configurable for VT
Secondaries of 50…120V Secondaries of 50…400V(2)
(110/110V default) (110/110V default)
Voltage measurement range 0…190V (100/110V) 0…260V (180/215V)(2)
Continuous voltage withstands 250V 250V
Burden <0.5 A <0.5 A
Rated frequency fn 45…65 Hz
- Frequency measurement range
Terminal block: Maximum wire dimension:
- Solid or stranded wire 4 mm2 (10…12 AWG)
(1) See Catalog Number Explanation on page 24.
(2) For configurable rated voltages greater than 215V (180V), the device must be wired to line-to-neutral voltages. The network
neutral must not be ungrounded. The given limit 215V allows 20% overvoltage.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 347


Chapter 10 Specifications

Table 171 - Auxiliary Voltage


Catalog No./ Option Type A (Standard) Type B (Option)
Rated voltage Uaux 40…265V AC/DC 18…36V DC
110/120/220/240V AC 24V DC Nominal
48/60/110/125/220V DC
X3:17= Negative (-)
X3:18= Positive (+)
Start Up Peak:
110V 15 A with a time constant of 1 ms
220V 25 A with a time constant of 1 ms
Power consumption <15 W (normal conditions)
< 25 W (output relays activated)
Max. permitted interruption time < 50 ms (110V DC)
Terminal Block: Max. wire dimension:
- Phoenix MVSTBW or equivalent 2.5 mm2 (13…14 AWG)

Table 172 - Digital Inputs


Internal Operating Voltage
Number of inputs 6
Internal operating voltage 48V DC
Current drain when active (max.) Approximately 20 mA
Current drain, average value < 1 mA
Terminal block: Max. wire dimension:
- Phoenix MVSTBW or equivalent 2.5 mm2 (13…14 AWG).
Maximum torque for removable terminals is 0.5…0.6 N•m
External Operating Voltage
Number of inputs 12/24/16 (selected by Catalog Number)
External operating voltage 24 V…265V DC
Rated voltage selectable in order code:
3: 24V dc/ac (maximum 265V)
5: 24V dc/ac (maximum 265V) (UL)
6: 110V dc/ac (maximum 265V)
7: 220V dc/ac (maximum 265V)
Current drain Approx. 2 mA
Activation Time dc/ac < 11 ms/ < 15 ms
Reset time dc/ac < 11 ms/ < 15 ms
Terminal block: Max. wire dimension:
- Phoenix MVSTBW or equivalent 2.5 mm2 (13…14 AWG).
Maximum torque for removable terminals is 0.5…0.6 N•m.

348 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Specifications Chapter 10

Table 173 - Trip Contacts


Number of contacts 4/8/14 (depends on the ordering code, or selected by Catalog
Number)
Rated voltage 250V AC/DC
Continuous carry 5A
Make and carry, 0.5 s 30 A
Make and carry, 3 s 15 A
Breaking capacity, DC (L/R=40 ms)
At 48V DC: 5A
At 110V DC: 3A
At 220V DC 1A
Contact material AgNi 90/10
Terminal block: Maximum wire dimension:
- Phoenix MVSTBW or equivalent 2.5 mm2 (13…14 AWG). Minimum 1.5 mm2 (15...16 AWG)
Maximum torque for removable terminals is 0.5…0.6 N•m.

Table 174 - Alarm Contacts


Number of contacts 3 - Change-over contacts (relays A1, A2, and A3)
2 - Making contacts (relays A4 and A5)
1 - Change-over contact (IF relay)
Rated voltage 250V ac/dc
Max. make current, 4 s at duty cycle 10% 15 A
Continuous carry 5A
Break capacity, AC 2000VA
Break capacity, DC (L/R=40 ms)
At 48V DC 1.3 A
At 110V DC 0.4 A
At 220V DC 0.2 A
Contact material AgNi 0.15 gold plated
AgNi 90/10
Terminal Block: Max. wire dimension:
- Phoenix MVSTBW or equivalent 2.5 mm (3/32 in.)2 (13…14 AWG). Minimum 1.5 mm2 (15...16
AWG)
Maximum torque for removable terminals is 0.5…0.6 N•m.

Table 175 - Local Serial Communication Port


Number of ports 1 on front and 1 on rear panel
Electrical connection RS-232 in the front
RS-232 with VCM-TTL (standard)
RS-485 with VCM 485-2 or VCM 485-4
Plastic fiber with VCM-fiber (option)
Glass fiber with VCM-fiber (option)
Data transfer rate 2400…38,400 kb/s

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 349


Chapter 10 Specifications

Table 176 - Remote Control Connection

Number of ports 1 on rear panel


Electrical connection TTL with VCM TTL (standard)
RS-485 with VCM 485 – 4(option)
RS-232 with VCM TTL (standard)
Plastic fiber connection with VCM fiber (option)
Glass fiber connection (option)
100M Ethernet fiber
100M Ethernet copper (RJ-45)
Data transfer rate 1200…19,200 kb/s
Protocols Modbus, RTU master
Modbus‚ RTU slave
SPA-Bus, slave
IEC 60870-5-103
IEC 61850
PROFIBUS DP (option, with external module)
DNP 3.0
Modbus TCP (internal / external optional module)
IEC 60870-5-101
IEC 60870-5-101 TCP
DNP 3.0 TCP

Table 177 - Ethernet Connections


Number of Copper Based Ports One
Electrical Connection Ethernet RJ45 (Ethernet 10Base-T)
Protocols SetPointPS
Modbus TCP
IEC 61850
EtherNet/IP
Data Transfer Rate 10 Mb/s
Fiber Connection (Optional)
Type Multimode
Connector ST
Physical layer 100 Base-Fx
Maximum cable distance 2 km (3.2 mi.)
Optical wavelength 1300 nm
Cable core / cladding size 50/125 or 62.5/125 μm

Table 178 - Arc Protection Interface (Option)


Number of arc sensor inputs 2
Sensor type to be connected VA 1 DA
Operating voltage level 12V DC
Current drain, when active > 11.9 mA
Current drain range 1.3…31 mA
NOTE: If the drain is outside the range, either the
sensor or the wiring is defected.
Number of binary inputs 1 (optically isolated)
Operating voltage level 48V DC
Number of binary outputs 1 (transistor controlled)
Operating voltage level 48V DC

350 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Specifications Chapter 10

IMPORTANT Maximally three arc binary inputs can be connected to one arc binary output
without an external amplifier.

Tests and Environmental Table 179 - Disturbance Tests


Conditions Test Standard and Test Class/ Test Value
Level

Emission Conducted EN 55011, Class A 0.15…30 MHz


(EN 61000-6-4/ Emitted EN 55011, Class A/IEC 30…1000 MHz
IEC 60255-25) 60255-25 / CISPR 11
1 MHz damped oscillatory IEC 60255-22-1 ±2.5 kVp CM, ±1.0 kVp DM
wave
Static discharge (ESD) EN 61000-4-2 Level 4 / 8-kV contact discharge
IEC 60255-22-2 Class 4 15-kV air discharge
Emitted HF Field EN 61000-4-3 Level 3 / 80…1000 MHz, 10V/m
IEC 60255-22-3
Fast transients (EFT) EN 61000-4-4 Level 3 / 2 kV, 5/50 ns, 5 kHz
IEC 60255-22-4 Class B
Surge EN 61000-4-5 Level 3 / 2 kV, 1.2/50 μs, CM
Immunity IEC 60255-22-5 1 kV, 1.2/50 μs, DM
(EN 61000-6-2/
IEC 60255-26) Conducted HF field EN 61000-4-6 Level 3 / 0.15…80 MHz, 10V emf
IEC 60255-22-6
Power-frequency magnetic EN 61000-4-8 300 A/m (continuous)
field
Pulse magnetic field EN 61000-4-9 Level 5 1000 A/m, 1.2/50 μs
Voltage interruptions IEC 60255-11 100 ms / 100%
Voltage alternative component IEC 60255-11 12% of operating voltage
(DC)
Voltage dips and short EN 61000-4-11 30%/10 ms, 100%/10 ms,
interruptions 60%/100 ms, >95%/5000 ms

Table 180 - Electrical Safety Tests


Test Standard and Test Class/ Test Value
Level
Impulse Voltage Withstand EN60255-5, Class III 5 kV, 1.2/50 μs
1 kV, 1.2/50ms, 0.5 J Communication
Dielectric Test EN60255-5, Class III 2 kV, 50 Hz
0.5 kV, 50 Hz Communication
Insulation Resistance EN60255-5
Protective Bonding Resistance EN60255-27
Power Supply Burden EN60255-1

Table 181 - Mechanical Tests


Vibration (IEC 60255-21-1) 10…60 Hz, amplitude ±0.035 mm

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 351


Chapter 10 Specifications

Class I 60…150 Hz, acceleration 0.5 g


Sweep rate 1 octave/min
20 periods in X-, Y-, and Z-axis direction
Shock (IEC 60255-21-1) Half sine, acceleration 5 g, duration 11 ms
Class I 3 shocks in X-, Y-, and Z-axis direction

Table 182 - Environmental Conditions


Operating temperature -40…+55 °C (-40…+131°F)
Transport and storage temperature - 40…+70 °C (-40…+158 °F)
Relative humidity < 95%
Maximum Altitude, without derating 2000 m (6500 ft)
Cold Performance Warm/Cold Cycle (IEC 60068-2-1:2005) -40…+55°C (-40…+131°F), 10…98% RH: 3 days
Cold Operational Test (IEC 60068-2-1:2005) -40°C (-40°F), 16 hours
Cold Storage Test (IEC 60068-2-1:2005) -40°C (-40°F), 16 hours
Dry Heat Test (IEC 60068-2-2:2007) 70°C, 20 hours followed by 65°C, 16 hours; Total 36
hours

Table 183 - Casing


Degree of protection (IEC 60529) Standard: IP30 front panel. IP20 rear panel
Option Via special order: IP54 front panel, IP 20 rear
panel, conformal coated electronic assemblies
Dimensions (W x H x D) 208 x 155 x 225 mm (8.19 x 6.10 x 8.86 in.)
Material 1 mm steel plate
Weight 4.2 kg (9 lb) maximum
Color code RAL 7032 (Casing) / RAL 7035 (Back plate)

Table 184 - Package


Dimensions (W x H x D) 215 x 160 x 275 mm (8.46 x 6.30 x 10.83 in.)
Weight (Terminal, Package, and Manual) 5.2 kg (11.5 lb) maximum
Cold Performance Warm/Cold Cycle (IEC 60068-2-1:2005) -40°C…+55°C (-40°F…+131°F) 98% RH: 3 days
Cold Operational Test (IEC 60068-2-1:2005) -40°C (-40°F) 16 hours
Cold Storage Test (IEC 60068-2-1:2005) -40°C (-40°F) 16 hours
Dry Heat Test (IEC 60068-2-2:2007)| 70°C, (158°F)20 hours followed by 65°C (149°F), 16
hours; Total 36 hours

352 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Specifications Chapter 10

Protection Stages Non-directional Current Protection


Table 185 - Overcurrent Stage I> (50/51)
Pick-up current 0.10…5.00 x IMODE
Definite time function: DT
- Operating time 0.08(1)…300.00 s (step 0.02 s)
IDMT function:
- Delay curve family (DT), IEC, IEEE, RI Prg
- Curve type EI, VI, NI, LTI, MI…depends on the family(2)
- Time multiplier k 0.05…20.0, except
0.50…20.0 for RXIDG, IEEE, and IEEE2
Start time Typically 30 ms
Reset time <95 ms
Retardation time <50 ms
Reset ratio 0.97
Transient over-reach, any τ <10%
Inaccuracy:
- Starting ± 3% of the set value
- Operating time at definite time function ± 1% or ± 25 ms
- Operating time at IDMT function ± 5% or at least ±25 ms(1)
(1) The instantaneous time, that is, the minimum total operational-time including the fault detection time and operation time of
the trip contacts.
(2) EI = Extremely Inverse, NI = Normal Inverse, VI = Very Inverse, LTI = Long Time Inverse, MI= Moderately Inverse.

Table 186 - Overcurrent Stages I>> and I>>> (50/51)


Pick-up current 0.10…20.00 x IMODE (I>>)
0.10…40.00 x IMODE (I>>>)
Definite time function: DT
- Operating time 0.04(1)…300.00 s (step 0.01 s)
Start time Typically 30 ms for I>>, 20 ms for I>>>
Reset time <95 ms
Retardation time <50 ms
Reset ratio 0.97
Transient over-reach, any τ <10%
Inaccuracy:
- Starting ±3% of the set value or 5 mA secondary
- Operation time DT (Im/Iset ratio > 1.5) ±1% or ±25 ms

Operational delay DT (Im/Iset ratio 1.03…1.5)


(1) The instantaneous time, that is, the minimum total operational-time including the fault detection time and operation time of
the trip contacts.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 353


Chapter 10 Specifications

Table 187 - Stall Protection Stage Ist in Motor Protection Mode(48)

Setting range:
- Motor start detection current 1.30…10.00 xIMOT (step 0.01)
- Nom motor start current 1.50…10.00 xIMOT (step 0.01)
Delay Type DT, INV
Definite time characteristic DT:
- operating time 1.0…300.0 s (step 0.1)(1)
Inverse time characteristic INV:
- Operational Delay 1.0…300.0 s (step 0.1)(1)
- Inverse Time Efficient (K) 1.0…200.0 s (step 0.1)
- Minimum motor stop time to activate stall protection 500 ms
- Maximum current raise times from motor stop to start 200 ms
Motor Stop Limit 0.10 x Imot(2)
Motor Running Lower Limit 0.20 x Imot(2)
Motor Running Limit after Starting 1.20 x Imot(2)
Start time Typically 60 ms
Reset time <95 ms
Resetting ratio 0.95
Inaccuracy:
- Starting ±3% of the set value
- Operating time at definite time function ±1% or at ±30 ms
- Operating time at IDMT function ±5% or at least ±30 ms(1)
(1) The instantaneous time, that is, the minimum total operational-time including the fault detection time and operation time of
the trip contacts.
(2) Motor is stopped and the running limits are based on the average of the three phase currents.

Table 188 - Thermal Overload Stage T> (49)


Setting range: 0.1…2.40 x IMOT or IN (step 0.01)
Alarm setting range: 60…99% (step 1%)
Time constant Tau: 2…180 min (step 1)
Cooling time coefficient: 1.0…10.0 x Tau (step 0.1)
Max. overload at 40 °C (104 °F) 70…120%IMOT (step 1)
Max. overload at 70 °C (158 °F) 50…100%IMOT (step 1)
Ambient temperature -55…125 °C (step 1°)
Resetting ratio (Start and trip) 0.95
Accuracy:
- operating time ±5% or ±1 s

354 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Specifications Chapter 10

Table 189 - Unbalance Stage I2> (46)

This stage is operational when all secondary currents are >250 mA.
Setting range: K2 2…70% (step 1%)
Definite time characteristic:
- operating time 1.0…600.0 s (step 0.1)
Inverse time characteristic:
- one characteristic curve Inv
- time multiplier K1 1…50 s (step 1)
- upper limit for inverse time 1000 s
Start time Typically 300 ms
Reset time <450 ms
Reset ratio 0.95
Inaccuracy:
- Starting ±1% – unit
- Operate time ±5% or ±200 ms

Table 190 - Incorrect Phase Sequence I2>> (47)

Stage is blocked when motor has been running for 2 seconds.


Setting: 80% (fixed)
- Operating time <120 ms
- Reset time <105 ms

Table 191 - Undercurrent Protection Stage I< (37)


Current setting range: 20…70%IMODE (step 1%)
Definite time characteristic:
- operating time 0.3…300.0 s (step 0.1)
Block limit: 15% (fixed)
Start time Typically 200 ms
Reset time <450 ms
Resetting ratio 1.05
Accuracy:
- starting ±2% of set value or ±0.5% of the rated value
- operating time ±1% or ± 150 ms

Table 192 - Current Unbalance I2> (46) in Feeder Mode

Settings:
- Setting range of K2 2…70%
Definite time function:
- Operating time 1.0…600.0 s (step 0.3 s)
Start time Typically 200 ms
Reset time <450 ms
Reset ratio 0.95
Inaccuracy:
- Starting ±1% unit
- Operate time ±5% or ± 200 ms

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 355


Chapter 10 Specifications

Table 193 - Earth-fault Stage I0> (50N/51N), (50G/51G)

Input signal I01 (input X1…7 and 8)


I02 (input X1…9 and 10)
I0CALC (= IL1+IL2+IL3)
Setting range I0> 0.005…8.00 When I01 or I02
0.05…20.0 When I0CALC
Definite time function: DT
- Operating time 0.04(1)…300.00 s (step 0.01 s)
IDMT function:
- Delay curve family (DT), IEC, IEEE, IEEE2, RI Prg
- Curve type EI, VI, NI, LTI, MI…depends on the family(2)
- Time multiplier k 0.05…20.0, except
0.50…20.0 for RXIDG, IEEE, and IEEE2
Start time Typically 30 ms
Reset time <95 ms
Reset ratio 0.95
Inaccuracy:
- Starting ±2% of the set value or ±0.3% of the rated value
- Starting (Peak mode) ±5% of the set value or ±2% of the rated value
(Sine-wave <65 Hz)
- Operating time at definite time function ±1% or ± 25 ms
- Operating time at IDMT function. ±5% or at least ±25 ms(1)
(1) The instantaneous time, that is, the total operational-time minimum total operational-time including the fault detection time
and operation time of the trip contacts.
(2) EI = Extremely Inverse, NI = Normal Inverse, VI = Very Inverse, LTI = Long Time Inverse, MI= Moderately Inverse.

Table 194 - Earth Fault Stages I0>>, I0>>>, I0>>>> (50N/51N), (50G/51G)

Input signal I0 (input X1-7 and 8)


I02 (input X1-9 and 10)
I0CALC (= IL1+IL2+IL3)
Setting range I0>> 0.01…8.00 When I01 or I02
0.05…20.0 When I0CALC
Definite time function:
- Operating time 0.08(1)…300.00 s (step 0.01 s)
Start time Typically 30 ms
Reset time <95 ms
Reset ratio 0.95
Inaccuracy:
- Starting ±2% of the set value or ±0.3% of the rated value
- Starting (Peak mode) ±5% of the set value or ±2% of the rated value
(Sine-wave <65 Hz)
- Operate time ±1% or ± 25 ms
(1) The instantaneous time, that is, the minimum total operational-time including the fault detection time and operation time of
the trip contacts.

356 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Specifications Chapter 10

Table 195 - Directional Intermittent Transient Earth-fault Stage Ioint> (67NI)

Input selection for I0 peak signal I01 Connectors X1…7 and 8


I02 Connectors X1…9 and 10
I0 peak pickup level (fixed) 0.1 x I0N @ 50 Hz
U0 pickup level 1…60% U0N
Definite operating time 0.12…300.00 s (step 0.01)
Intermittent time 0.00…300.00 s (step 0.01)
Start time <60 ms
Reset time <60 ms
Reset ratio (hysteresis) for U0 0.97
Inaccuracy:
- starting ±3% for U0. No inaccuracy is defined for I0 transients
- time ±1% or ±30 ms(1)
(1) The actual operation time depends on the intermittent behavior of the fault and the intermittent time setting.

Directional Current Protection


Table 196 - Directional Overcurrent Stages Iφ> and Iφ>> (67)

Pick-up current 0.10…4.00 x IMODE


Mode Directional/non-directional
Minimum voltage for the direction solving 0.1 VSECONDARY
Base angle setting range -180…179°
Operation angle ±88°
Definite time function: DT(1)
- Operating time 0.06…300.00 s (step 0.02 s)
IDMT function:
- Delay curve family (DT), IEC, IEEE, IEEE2, RI Prg
- Curve type EI, VI, NI, LTI, MI, depends on the family(2)
- Time multiplier k 0.05…20.0, except
0.50…20.0 for RXIDG, IEEE, and IEEE2
Start time Typically 60 ms
Reset time <95 ms
Retardation time <50 ms
Reset ratio/angle 0.95/2 degrees
Transient over-reach, any τ <10%
Adjustable voltage memory length 0.2…3.2 s
Inaccuracy:
- Starting (rated value IN= 1…5A) ±3% of the set value or ±0.5% of the rated value
- Angle ±2° U>5V
±30° U=0.1…5.0V
- Operate time at definite time function ±1% or ±30 ms
- Operate time at IDMT function ±5% or at least ±30 ms(1)
(1) The instantaneous time, that is, the minimum total operational-time including the fault detection time and operation time of
the trip contacts.
(2) EI = Extremely Inverse, NI = Normal Inverse, VI = Very Inverse, LTI = Long Time Inverse, MI= Moderately Inverse.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 357


Chapter 10 Specifications

Table 197 - Directional Overcurrent Stages Iφ>>> and Iφ>>>> (67)


Pick-up current 0.10…20.0 x IMODE
Mode Directional/non-directional
Minimum voltage for the direction solving 2V SECONDARY
Base angle setting range -180...179°
Operation angle ±88°
Definite time function: DT(1)
- Operating time 0.06…300.00 s (step 0.02 s)
Start time Typically 60 ms
Reset time <95 ms
Retardation time <50 ms
Reset ratio 0.95
Reset ratio (angle) 2 degrees
Transient over-reach, any τ <10%
Inaccuracy:
- Starting (rated value IN= 1…5A) ±3% of the set value or ± 0.5% of the rated value
- Angle ±2° U>5V
±30° U>0.1…5.0V
- Operate time at definite time function ±1% or ±30 ms
(1) The instantaneous time, that is the minimum total operational-time including the fault detection time and operation time of
the trip contacts.

Table 198 - Directional Intermittent Earth-fault Stages I0φ>, I0φ>> (67N)

Pick-up current 0.005…8.0 pu (for I0φ>)


0.01…8.0 pu (for I0φ>>)
0.005…20.0 pu When IDCalc (for I0φ>)
0.01…20.0 pu When IDCalc (for I0φ>>)
- for I0φ> 0.005…8.0 pu (when I01 or I02)
0.005…20.0 pu (when IDCalc)
- for I0φ>> 0.01…8.00 pu (when I01 or I02)
0.01…20.0 pu (when IDCalc)
Start voltage 1…50% U0n
Input signal I01 (input X1-7 and 8)
I02 (input X1-9 and 10)
I0Calc (= IL1+IL2+IL3)
Mode Non-directional/Sector/ResCap
Base angle setting range -180...179°
Operation angle ±88° (10...170°)
Definite time function:
- Operating time 0.10(1) …300.00 s (step 0.02 s)
IDMT function:
- Delay curve family (DT), IEC, IEEE, IEEE2, RI Prg
- Curve type EI, VI, NI, LTI, MI, depends on the family(2)
- Time multiplier k 0.05…20.0, except
0.50…20.0 for RXIDG, IEEE, and IEEE2
Start time Typically 60 ms
Reset time <95 ms
Reset ratio 0.95
Reset Angle 2°

358 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Specifications Chapter 10

Table 198 - Directional Intermittent Earth-fault Stages I0φ>, I0φ>> (67N) (Continued)

Inaccuracy:
- Starting U0 and I0 (rated value In= 1…5A) ±3% of the set value or ±0.3% of the rated value
- Starting U0 and I0 (Peak Mode when, rated value Ion= ±5% of the set value or ±2% of the rated value (sine-
1…10A) wave <65 Hz)
- Staring U0 and I0 (I0calc) ±3% of the set value or ±0.5% of the rated value
- Angle ±2° (when U>IV or I0>5% of rated value ION
- Operate time at definite time function ±1% or ±30 ms
- Operate time at IDMT function ±5% or at least ±30 ms(1)
(1) The instantaneous time, that is, the minimum total operational-time including the fault detection time and operation time of
the trip contacts.
(2) EI = Extremely Inverse, NI = Normal Inverse, VI = Very Inverse, LTI = Long Time Inverse, MI= Moderately Inverse.

Frequent Start Protection


Table 199 - Frequent Start Protection N> (66)
Settings:
- Max motor starts 1…20
- Min time between motor starts 0.0…100 min. (step 0.1 min)
Operation time <250 ms
Inaccuracy:
- Min time between motor starts ±5% of the set value

Voltage Protection
Table 200 - Overvoltage Stages U>, U>>, and U>>> (59)
Overvoltage setting range: 50…150%Un for U>, U>>(1)
50…160% Un for U>>>(1)
Definite time characteristic:
- operating time 0.08(2)…300.00 s (step 0.01) (U>, U>>)
0.06(2)…300.00 s (step 0.01) (U>>>)
Start time Typically 60 ms
Reset time U> 0.06…300.00 s (step 0.01)
Reset time U>>, U>>> <95 ms
Retardation time <50 ms
Reset ratio 0.99…0.800 (0.1…20.0%, step 0.1%)
Inaccuracy:
- starting ±3% of the set value(1)
- operate time ±1% or ±30 ms
(1) The measurement range is up to 160V to limit the maximum usable setting when rated VT secondary is more than 100V.
(2) The instantaneous time, that is, the minimum total operational-time including the fault detection time and operation time of
the trip contacts.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 359


Chapter 10 Specifications

Table 201 - Undervoltage Stages U<, U<<, and U<<< (27)


Setting range 20…120% x UN
Definite time function:
- Operating time U< 0.08(1)…300.00 s (step 0.01 s)
- Operating time U<< and U<<< 0.06(1)…300.00 s (step 0.01 s)
Undervoltage blocking 0…80% x UN
Start time Typically 60 ms
Reset time for U< 0.06…300.00 s (step 0.02 s)
Reset time for U<< and U<<< <95 ms
Retardation time <50 ms
Reset ratio (hysteresis) 1.001…1.200 (0.1…20.0%, step 0.1%)
Reset ratio (Block limit) 0.5V or 1.03 (3%)
Inaccuracy:
- starting ±3% of set value
- time ±1% or ±30 ms
Operating time ±1% or ±30 ms
(1) The total operational-time including the fault detection time and operation time of the trip contacts.

Table 202 - Zero Sequence Voltage Stages U0> and U0>> (59N)

Zero sequence voltage setting range 1…60% U0n


Definite time function:
- Operating time 0.3…300.0 s (step 0.1 s)
Start time Typically 200 ms
Reset time <450 ms
Reset ratio 0.97
Inaccuracy:
- Starting ± 2% of the set value or ±0.3% of the rated value
- Starting UoCalc (3LN mode) ± 1V
- Operate time ± 1% or ±150 ms

Frequency Protection
Table 203 - Overfrequency and Underfrequency Protection Stages f>< and f>><< (81)
Frequency measuring area 16.0…75.0 Hz
Current and voltage meas. range 45.0…65.0 Hz
Frequency stage setting range 40.0…70.0 Hz
Low voltage blocking (range of 45…65 Hz) 10…100%Un
Definite time function:
-operating time 0.10(1)…300.0 s (step 0.02 s)
Start time <100 ms
Reset time <120 ms
Reset ratio (f> and f>>) 0.998
Reset ratio (f< and f<<) 1.002
Reset ratio (LV block) 0.5V or 1.03 (3%)
Inaccuracy:
- starting ±20 MHz
- starting (LV block) 3% of the set value
- operating time ±1% or ± 30 ms
(1) The instantaneous time, that is, the minimum total operational-time including the fault detection time and operation time of
the trip contacts.

360 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Specifications Chapter 10

TIP Frequency measurement functions when secondary voltage is over 5V.


f> Low voltage block only freezes the present situation. If start has
appeared, block freezes the start signal but there is no trip. A trip cannot be
blocked.
f< If device restarts for some reason, there is no trip. Even if the frequency is
below the set limit during the start-up (Start and trip is blocked). To cancel
this block, frequency must visit above the set limit.

Table 204 - Underfrequency Stages f< and f<< (81L)


Frequency measuring area 16.0…75.0 Hz
Current and voltage meas. range 45.0…65.0 Hz
Frequency stage setting range 40.0…64.0 Hz
Low voltage blocking 10…100%Un
Definite time function:
-operating time 0.10(1)…300.0 s (step 0.02 s)
Start time <100 ms
Reset time <120 ms
Reset ratio 1.002
Reset ratio (LV block) Instant
Inaccuracy:
- starting ±20 MHz
- starting (LV block) 3% of the set value
- operating time ±1% or ±30 ms
(1) The instantaneous time, that is, the minimum total operational-time including the fault detection time and operation time of
the trip contacts.

TIP Frequency measurement functions when secondary voltage is over 5V.


f> If device restarts for some reason there is no trip. Even if the frequency is
below the set limit during the start-up (Start and trip is blocked). To cancel
this block, frequency must visit above the set limit.

Table 205 - Rate of Change of Frequency (ROCOF) Stage df/dt> (81R)


Pick-up setting df/dt 0.2…10.0 Hz/s (step 0.1 Hz/s)
Definite time delay (t> and tMin> are equal):
- operating time t> 0.14(1)…10.00 s (step 0.02 s)
Inverse time delay (t> is more than tMin>):
- minimum operating time tMin> 0.14(1)…10.00 s (step 0.02 s)
Start time 140 ms
Reset time t>
Inaccuracy:
- starting ± 0.1 Hz/s or 10% of set value
- operating time (overshoot ≥ 0.2 Hz/s) ± 1% or ± 35 ms when area is 0.2…1.0 Hz/s
(1) The instantaneous time, that is, the minimum total operational-time including the fault detection time and operation time of
the trip contacts.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 361


Chapter 10 Specifications

Power Protection
Table 206 - Reverse Power and Underpower Stages P<, P<< (32)
Pick-up setting range -200.0…200.0% of SN (step 0.5)
Definite time function:
- Operating time 0.3…300.0 s (step 0.1)
Start time Typically 200 ms
Reset time <500 ms
Reset ratio 1.05
Inaccuracy:
- Starting ±3% of set value or ± 0.5% of rated value
- Operating time at definite time function ±1% or ±150 ms

TIP When pick-up setting is +1…200%, an internal block is activated if max.


voltage of all phases drops below 5% of rated.

Synchrocheck Function Δf, ΔU, Δφ (25)

The ∆f must be less than 0.2 Hz.

Table 207 - Synchrocheck Function


Sync mode Off; ASync, Sync;
Voltage check mode DD; DL; LD, DD/DL; DD/LD; DL/LD; DD/DL/LD
CB closing time 0.04…0.6 s
Udead limit setting 10…120% Un
Ulive limit setting 10…120% Un
Frequency difference 0.01…1.00 Hz
Voltage difference 1…60% Un
Phase angle difference 2…90 deg
Request timeout 0.1…600.0 s
Frequency measurement range 46.0…64.0 Hz
Reset ratio (U) 0.97
Inaccuracy:
- voltage ±3% Un
- frequency ±20 MHz
- phase angle ±2 deg when Δf<0.2 Hz, else 5º
- operating time ±1% or ±30 ms

362 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Specifications Chapter 10

Circuit-breaker Failure Protection


Table 208 - Circuit Breaker Failure Protection CBFP (50BF)
Relay to be supervised Any assigned output
Definite time function
- Operating time 0.1(1)…10.0 s (step 0.1 s)
Reset time <95 ms
Inaccuracy
- Operating time ± 20 ms
(1) The instantaneous time, that is, the minimum total operational-time including the fault detection time and operation time of
the trip contacts.

Magnetizing Inrush If2 > (68F2)

This stage is used to block other stages. The ratio between the second
harmonic component and the fundamental frequency component is measured
on all phase currents. When the ratio in any phase exceeds the setting value, the
stage gives a start signal.

After a settable delay, the stage gives a trip signal. The start and trip signals can
be used for blocking the other stages. The trip delay is irrelevant if only the start
signal is used for blocking. The trip delay of the stages to be blocked must be
more than 60 ms to help maintain proper blocking.

Table 209 - 2nd Harmonic Overcurrent Protection Stage If2> (68F2)

Pick up Settings:
- Setting range 2.Harmonic 10…100%
- Operation delay 0.05…300.00 s (step 0.01 s)
Inaccuracy:
- Starting ±1% unit

TIP The amplitude of second harmonic content must be at least 2% of the


nominal of CT secondary current. If the nominal current is 5 A, the 100 Hz
component is required to exceed 100 mA.

Transformer Over Excitation If5> (68F5)

Overexciting a transformer creates significant odd harmonics. This stage


detects over excitation and can be used to block some other stages.

The ratio between the over excitation component and the fundamental
frequency component is measured on all phase currents. When the ratio in any
phase exceeds the setting value, the stage gives a start signal. After a settable
delay, the stage gives a trip signal.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 363


Chapter 10 Specifications

The trip delay of the stages to be blocked must be more than 60 ms to help
maintain proper blocking.

Table 210 - 5th Harmonic Stage If5> (68F5)

Settings:
- Setting range 5th Harmonic 10…100%
- Operating time 0.05…300.00 s (step 0.01 s)
Inaccuracy:
- Starting ±2% unit

TIP The amplitude of fifth harmonic content must be at least 2% of the nominal
of CT secondary current. If the nominal current is 5 A, the 250 Hz component
is required to exceed 100 mA.

Arc Fault-protection Stages (Option)

The arc protection operation depends on the setting value of the ArcI>, ArcI0>
and ArcI02> current limits. The arc current limits cannot be set unless the 857
relay can be provided with the optional arc protection card.

Table 211 - Arc Protection Stage ArcI> (50AR), Option


Setting range 0.5…10.0 x In
Arc sensor connection S1; S2; S1/S2; BI; S1/BI; S2/BI; S1/S2/BI
- Operating time (Light only) 13 ms
- Operating time (4xIset + light) 17 ms
- Operating time (BIN) 10 ms
- Operating time (delayed Arc L>) 0.01…0.15 s
- BO operating time <3 ms
Reset time <95 ms
Reset time (Delayed ARC L) <120 ms
Reset time (BO) <80 ms
Reset ratio 0.90
Inaccuracy:
- Starting 10% of the set value
- Operating time ±5 ms
- Delayed ARC light ±10 ms

Table 212 - Arc Protection Stage ArcI0> (50NARC), Option


Setting range 0.5…1.00 pu
Arc sensor connection S1; S2; S1/S2; BI; S1/BI; S2/BI; S1/S2/BI
- Operating time (Light only) 13 ms
- Operating time (4xIset + light) 17 ms
- Operating time (BIN) 10 ms
- Operating time (delayed Arc L>) 0.01…0.15 s
- BO operating time <3 ms
Reset time <95 ms
Reset time (Delayed Arc L) <120 ms
Reset time (BO) <80 ms
Reset ratio 0.90

364 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Specifications Chapter 10

Table 212 - Arc Protection Stage ArcI0> (50NARC), Option (Continued)


Inaccuracy:
- Starting 10% of the set value
- Operating time ±5 ms
- Delayed ARC light ±10 ms

Table 213 - Arc Protection Stage ArcI02> (50NARC), Option

Setting range 0.5…1.0 pu


Arc sensor connection S1; S2; S1/S2; BI; S1/BI; S2/BI; S1/S2/BI
- Operating time (Light only) 13 ms
- Operating time (4xIset + light) 17 ms
- Operating time (BIN) 10 ms
- Operating time (delayed Arc L>) 0.01…0.15 s
- BO operating time <3 ms
Reset time <95 ms
Reset time (Delayed ARC L) <120 ms
Reset time (BO) <80 ms
Reset ratio 0.90
Inaccuracy:
- Starting 10% of the set value
- Operating time ±5 ms
- Delayed ARC light ±10 ms

Supporting Functions Table 214 - Cold Load/Inrush Current Detection (68)


Settings:
- Idle current 0.01…0.50 x IN
- Pickup current 0.30…10.00 x IN
- Maximum time 0.01(1)…300.00 s (step 0.01 s)
- Setting range 2.Harmonic 0…99%
(1) The instantaneous time, that is, the 40°C (104°F)minimum of total operational-time including the fault detection time and
operation time of the trip contacts.

Disturbance Recorder (DR)

The operation of disturbance recorder depends on these settings. The


recording time and the number of records depend on the time setting and the
number of selected channels.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 365


Chapter 10 Specifications

Table 215 - Disturbance Recorder (DR)


Mode of recording Saturated / Overflow
Sample rate:
- Waveform recording 32/cycle, 16/cycle, 8/cycle
- Trend curve recording 10, 20, 200 ms
1, 5, 10, 15, 30 s
1 min
Recording time (one record) 0.1 s…12,000 min
(must be shorter than MAX time)
Pre-trigger rate 0…100%
Number of selected channels 0…12

Transformer Supervision
Table 216 - Current Transformer Supervision
IMAX > setting 0.00…10.00 x IN (step 0.01)
IMIN < setting 0.00…10.00 x IN (step 0.01)
Definite time function: DT
- Operating time 0.04…600.00 s (step 0.01 s)
Reset time <60 ms
Reset ratio Imax> 0.97
Reset ratio Imin< 1.03
Inaccuracy:
- Activation ± 3% of the set value
- Operating time at definite time function ± 1% or ± 30 ms

Table 217 - Voltage Transformer Supervision


Pick-up setting U2> 0.0…200.0%
Pick-up setting I2< 0.0…200.0%
Definite time function: DT
- Operating time 0.04…600.00 s (step 0.01 s)
Reset time <60 ms
Reset ratio 3% of the pick-up value
Inaccuracy:
- Activation U2> ±3% of the set value
- Activation I2< ±1% unit
- Operating time at definite time function ±1% or ±30 ms

366 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Specifications Chapter 10

Voltage Sag and Swell


Table 218 - Voltage Sag and Swell
Measurement Mode Default; L-; L-N
Voltage sag limit (L-L; L-N) 10…120%
Voltage swell limit (L-L; L-N) 20…150%
Definite time function: DT
- Operating time 0.06…1.00 s (step 0.01 s)
Low voltage blocking 0…50%of UN
Reset time <60 ms
Reset ration:
- Sag 1.03
- Swell 0.97
Block limit 0.5V or 1.03 (3%)
Inaccuracy:
- Activation ±0.5V or 3% of the set value
- Activation (block limit) ±5% of the set value
- Operating time at definite time function ±1% or ±30 ms

IMPORTANT If one of the phase voltages is below sag limit and above block limit but
another phase voltage drops below block limit, blocking is disabled.

Voltage Interruptions
Table 219 - Voltage Interruptions
Voltage low limit (U1) 10…120% of UN (step 1%)
Definite time function: DT
- Operating time <50 ms (Fixed)
Reset time <60 ms
Reset ratio: 1.03
Inaccuracy:
- Activation 3% of the set value

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 367


Chapter 10 Specifications

Notes:

368 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Chapter 11

Installation

Mounting Instructions Figure 190 - Mounting Instructions

2a 2b
Dimensions are in millimeters

4
2

139

4
1
193
1.0
-10
m
m

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 369


Chapter 11 Installation

Figure 191 - Dimensions

208 mm 190 mm
(8.19 in.) (7.48 in.)

155 mm
(56.1 in.)

1.0…10.0 mm
(0.04…0.4 in.)

Optional Projection Mounting Collar


28 mm 181 mm 27 mm 21 mm
(1.1 in.) (7.13 in.) (1.07 in.) (0.83 in.) B A

137 mm
(5.4 in.)

Collar Part Number A B


857-VYX076 40 mm (1.57 in.) 169 mm (6.65 in.)
857-VYX077 60 mm (2.36 in.) 149 mm (5.87 in.)
857-VYX233 100 mm (3.94 in.) 109 mm (4.29 in.)

370 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Appendix A

Parameter List

Overview This appendix lists all accessible parameters of the Bulletin 857 protection
system in numerical order. The setting range for each parameter is provided to
assist especially for applications where it is desirable to set values from a logic
controller via a network connection. The CIP class codes are provided for
troubleshooting purposes.

Information values that are provided are shown in the following table.

Value Function
Setting Range Indicated as raw numerical values
Scale Factor Indicate the decimal precision that is associated with
each parameter. Pay close attention to the decimal
when writing or reading values
Default Indicate that the factory pre-programmed values

The mode value determines the ability of the parameter to be read (Get),
written (Set) or both (Get/Set).

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 371


372

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
1 Misc. 0x389 1 1 byte 1 Byte padding-used when the USINT 1 Set

Parameter List
padding configuration tool requires assembly data to
be word or double-word aligned, to align
the assembly contents appropriately.
2 Misc. 0x389 2 2 bytes 2 Bytes padding-used when the UINT 2 Set
padding configuration tool requires assembly data to
be word or double-word aligned, to align
the assembly contents appropriately.
3 Control Supervisor Object 0x29 3 Run1 Run command from the network is BOOL 1 1 1= Running 0 Get/Set
internally blocked. Not used. 0= Stopped
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

4 Control Supervisor Object 0x29 10 Faulted Relay is in tripped condition BOOL 1 1 0 Get
Red Trip status indicator illuminated 1 = Trip Occurred (latched in programmed)
0 = No Faults present
5 Control Supervisor Object 0x29 11 Warning Relay is in an Alarm condition BOOL 1 1 0 Get
Amber Alarm status indicator illuminated 1 = Alarm Occurred (latched in programmed)
0 = N14o Alarm present
6 Control Supervisor Object 0x29 12 FaultRst Fault Reset BOOL 1 1 1 = Reset Fault 0 Get/Set
0 = No action
7 Control Supervisor Object 0x29 13 FaultCode If in Faulted state, FaultCode indicates the UINT 2 1 CurrTrip=20 0 Get
fault that caused the transition to Faulted ThermOverl=21
state. If not in Faulted state, Power up state PhasImbal=26
of fault code is 0. GndFault=27
Underload=29
Stall=31,
Undervol=51,
Overvol=52,
Phrevers=54,
Freq=55,
StHrExceed=73

(limit 65535)
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
8 Control Supervisor Object 0x29 14 WarnCode Code word indicating warnings present. UINT 2 1 CurrTrip=20 0 Get
ThermOverl=21
PhasImbal=26
GndFault=27
Underload=29
Stall=31,
Undervol=51,
Overvol=52,
Phrevers=54,
Freq=55,
StHrExceed=73
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

(limit 65535)
9 Control Supervisor Object 0x29 22 CycleCount Number of operations (motor starts) on the UDINT 4 1 0 1000000000 0 Get/Set
equipment
10 Over Load Object 0x2C 5 AvgCurrent Average Running Current INT 2 1=0.01 0 32767 0 Get
A
11 Over Load Object 0x2C 6 %PhImbal Percentage Phase Imbalance USINT 1 1 = 1% 0 127 0 Get
12 Over Load Object 0x2C 7 %Thermal Percentage Thermal Capacity USINT 1 1 = 1% 0 127 0 Get
13 Over Load Object 0x2C 8 CurrentL1 L1 Current INT 2 1=0.1 A 0 32767 0 Get
14 Over Load Object 0x2C 9 CurrentL2 L2 Current INT 2 1=0.1 A 0 32767 0 Get
15 Over Load Object 0x2C 10 CurrentL3 L3 Current INT 2 1=0.1 A 0 32767 0 Get
16 Over Load Object 0x2C 11 GroundCurr Ground Current INT 2 1=0.1 A 0 32767 0 Get
ent

Parameter List
Appendix A
373
374

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
17 Digital Object 0x382 1 Digital Digital Input State UDINT 4 1 Bit0= DI1 0 Get
inputs

Parameter List
0 = Input inactive Bit1= DI2
1 = Input active Bit2= DI3
Bit3= DI4
Bit4= DI5
Bit5= DI6
Bit6= DI7
Bit7= DI8
Bit8= DI9
Bit9= DI10
Bit10= DI11
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

Bit11= DI12
Bit12= DI13
Bit13= DI14
Bit14= DI15
Bit15= DI16
Bit16= DI17
Bit17= DI18
Bit18= DI19
Bit19= DI20
Bit20= DI21
Bit21= DI22
Bit22= DI23
Bit23= DI24
Bit24= DI25
Bit25= DI26
Bit26= DI27
Bit27= DI28
Bit28= DI29
Bit29= DI30
Bit30= DI31
Bit31=DI32
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
18 Digital Object 0x382 2 Output Output Relay State UDINT 4 1 Bit0=T1 0 Get
relays Bit1=T2
0 = Output inactive Bit2=T3
1 = Output active Bit3=T4
Bit4=A1
T1=Trip relay 1, and so forth. Bit5=A2
A1=Alarm relay 1, and so forth. Bit6=A3
VO1=Virtual Output 1, and so forth. Bit7=A4
Bit8=A5
Bit9=BO
Bit10=T5
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

Bit11=T6
Bit12=T7
Bit13=T8
Bit14=Not Used
Bit15=Not Used
Bit16=Alarm status indicator
Bit17=Trip status indicator
Bit18=status indicator A
Bit19=status indicator B
Bit20=status indicator C
Bit21=Dist. Rec.
Bit22=VO1
Bit23=VO2
Bit24=VO3
Bit25=VO4
Bit26=VO5
Bit27=VO6
Bit28=Not Used
Bit29=Not Used
Bit30=Not Used
Bit31=Not Used
19 Digital Object 0x382 3 Alive Alive indicator- Watch Dog OK USINT 2 1 1=Faulted 0 Get
indicator

Parameter List
Appendix A
375
376

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
20 Digital Object 0x382 4 Events Event Data from the device. UDINT 4 1=1 Bits 0 … 7 sec Since Genesis 0 Get

Parameter List
FIFO style. Individual reads to obtain UINT
sequential data UINT milliseconds
STRUCT- Bits 8...11
UDINT = sec Since Genesis event code
UINT =milliseconds Bits 12...15
UINT = event code
21 Digital Object 0x382 5 Obj1 state Object 1 State USINT 1 1 0=Open 0 Get
1=Close
2=Undefined
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

22 Digital Object 0x382 6 Obj2 state Object 2 State USINT 1 1 0=Open 0 Get
1=Close
2=Undefined
23 Digital Object 0x382 7 Obj3 state Object 3 State USINT 1 1 0=Open 0 Get
1=Close
2=Undefined
24 Digital Object 0x382 8 Obj4 state Object 4 State USINT 1 1 0=Open 0 Get
1=Close
2=Undefined
25 Digital Object 0x382 9 Obj5 state Object 5 State USINT 1 1 0=Open 0 Get
1=Close
2=Undefined
26 Digital Object 0x382 10 Obj6 state Object 6 State USINT 1 1 0=Open 0 Get
1=Close
2=Undefined
27 Digital Object 0x382 11 Remote/ Relay Control Mode BOOL 1 1 0=REMOTE 0 Get/Set
Local State 1=LOCAL
28 Digital Object 0x382 12 Open select Open select Obj1 BOOL 1 1 Open=1 0 Get/Set
Obj1 (enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
29 Digital Object 0x382 13 Close select Close select Obj1 BOOL 1 1 Close=1 0 Get/Set
Obj1 (enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
30 Digital Object 0x382 14 Execute Execute operation Obj1 BOOL 1 1 Execute Selection=1 0 Set
operation (enabled only in remote mode)
Obj1
31 Digital Object 0x382 15 Cancel Cancel selected operation BOOL 1 1 No Action=0 0 Set
selected (enabled only in remote mode) Cancel=1
operation
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
32 Digital Object 0x382 16 Max ctrl Maximum control pulse length of Obj1 UDINT 4 1=0.01 2 600000 0 Get/Set
pulse s
length of
Obj1
33 Digital Object 0x382 17 Open select Open select Obj2 BOOL 1 1 Open=1 0 Get/Set
Obj2 (enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
34 Digital Object 0x382 18 Close select Close select Obj2 BOOL 1 1 Close=1 0 Get/Set
Obj2 (enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
35 Digital Object 0x382 19 Execute Execute operation Obj2 BOOL 1 1 Execute Selection=1 0 Set
operation (enabled only in remote mode)
Obj2
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

36 Digital Object 0x382 20 Max ctrl Maximum control pulse length of Obj2 UDINT 4 1=0.01 2 600000 0 Get/Set
pulse s
length of
Obj2
37 Digital Object 0x382 21 OM_MB_R Output Matrix BOOL 1 1 1=Reset 0 Get/Set
esetLatches Reset Latches
38 Digital Object 0x382 22 Synchronize Synchronize minutes BOOL 1 1 0 0 Get/Set
minutes
39 Digital Object 0x382 23 Open select Open select Obj3 BOOL 1 1 Open=1 0 Get/Set
Obj3 (enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
40 Digital Object 0x382 24 Close select Close select Obj3 BOOL 1 1 Close=1 0 Get/Set
Obj3 (enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
41 Digital Object 0x382 25 Execute Execute operation Obj3 BOOL 1 1 Execute Selection=1 0 Set
operation (enabled only in remote mode)
Obj3
42 Digital Object 0x382 26 Max ctrl Maximum control pulse length of Obj3 UDINT 4 1=0.01 0 600000 0 Get/Set
pulse s
length of
Obj3
43 Digital Object 0x382 27 Open select Open select Obj4 BOOL 1 1 Open=1 0 Get/Set
Obj4

Parameter List
(enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
44 Digital Object 0x382 28 Close select Close select Obj4 BOOL 1 1 Close=1 0 Get/Set
Obj4 (enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
45 Digital Object 0x382 29 Execute Execute operation Obj4 BOOL 1 1 Execute Selection=1 0 Set
operation

Appendix A
(enabled only in remote mode)
Obj4
377
378

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
46 Digital Object 0x382 30 Max ctrl Maximum control pulse length of Obj4 UDINT 4 1=0.01 2 600000 0 Get/Set
pulse s

Parameter List
length of
Obj4
47 Digital Object 0x382 31 Pos. Positive Sequence Current Line 1 INT 4 1=1A 0 0 Get
sequence I1
48 Digital Object 0x382 32 Neg. Negative Sequence Current Line 2 INT 4 1=1A 0 0 Get
sequence I2
49 Digital Object 0x382 33 Current - Current -seq./+seq. INT 4 1=0.01 0 10000 0 Get
seq./+seq. %
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

50 Digital Object 0x382 34 Current Current Phase Sequence USINT 1 1 0=Unknown State 0 Get
phase seq. 1=OK
2=Reverse
51 Digital Object 0x382 35 Pos. Positive Sequence Voltage Line 1 INT 4 1=1V 0 450000 0 Get
sequence
U1
52 Digital Object 0x382 36 Neg. Negative Sequence Voltage Line 2 INT 4 1=1V 0 450000 0 Get
sequence
U2
53 Digital Object 0x382 37 Voltage - Voltage -seq./+seq. INT 4 1=0.01 0 10000 0 Get
seq./+seq. %
54 Digital Object 0x382 38 Voltage Voltage Phase Sequence SINT 1 1 0=Unknown State 0 Get
phase seq. 1=OK
2=Reverse
55 Digital Object 0x382 39 DI1 counter DI1 counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
56 Digital Object 0x382 40 DI2 counter DI2 counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
57 Digital Object 0x382 41 DI3 counter DI3 counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
58 Digital Object 0x382 42 DI4 counter DI4 counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
59 Digital Object 0x382 43 DI5 counter DI5 counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
60 Digital Object 0x382 44 DI6 counter DI6 counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
61 Digital Object 0x382 45 DI19 DI19 counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
counter
62 Digital Object 0x382 46 DI20 DI20 counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
counter
63 Digital Object 0x382 47 Shot1 start Auto Reclose Shot1 start counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
counter
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
64 Digital Object 0x382 48 Shot2 start Auto Reclose Shot2 start counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
counter
65 Digital Object 0x382 49 Shot3 start Auto Reclose Shot3 start counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
counter
66 Digital Object 0x382 50 Shot4 start Auto Reclose Shot4 start counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
counter
67 Digital Object 0x382 51 Shot5 start Auto Reclose Shot5 start counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
counter
68 Digital Object 0x382 52 AR start AR start counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get
counter
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

69 Digital Object 0x382 53 AR fail AR fails counter UINT 2 1 0 64000 0 Get


counter
70 Digital Object 0x382 54 Stage start Relay in start state BOOL 1 1 1=Starting 0 Get
state 0=Not Starting
71 Digital Object 0x382 55 Stage trip Stage trip state BOOL 1 1 1=Trip 0 Get
state 0=Not Tripped
72 Digital Object 0x382 56 AR shot AR shot count number USINT 1 1 1 0 Get
number 2
3
4
5
Last (END)=6
73 Digital Object 0x382 57 Critical AR Critical AR request USINT 2 1 0 0 Get
req.
74 Digital Object 0x382 58 Reclose Reclose locked USINT 2 1 1=Locked 0 Get
locked 0=Not Locked
75 Digital Object 0x382 59 Reclose Reclose running USINT 2 1 1=Reclose Running 0 Get
running 0=Reclose Not Running
76 Digital Object 0x382 60 Final trip Auto Reclose Final trip USINT 2 1 0=Open 0 Get
1=Tripped

Parameter List
77 Digital Object 0x382 61 Autoreclose Auto reclose on USINT 2 1 0=Off 0 Get
on 1=On
78 Digital Object 0x382 62 N> alarm Number of starts alarm BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get
1=Alarm

Appendix A
79 Digital Object 0x382 63 Motor start Motor start disabled BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get
disabled 1=Disable
379
380

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
80 Digital Object 0x382 64 Motor Motor is in start state BOOL 1 1 1=Motor Starting 0 Get
starting

Parameter List
0=Motor Not Starting
81 Digital Object 0x382 65 Motor Motor is in run state BOOL 1 1 1=Motor Running 0 Get
running 0=Motor Not Running
82 Digital Object 0x382 66 Voltage Indicates a voltage lower than the setpoint USINT 1 1 0=LOW VOLTAGE 0 Get
interrupt condition has occurred 1=OK
83 Digital Object 0x382 67 Timer 1 Timer 1 status USINT 1 1 0=Output is inactive 0 Get
status 1=Output is active
84 Digital Object 0x382 68 Timer 2 Timer 2 status USINT 1 1 0=Output is inactive 0 Get
status
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

1=Output is active
85 Digital Object 0x382 69 Timer 3 Timer 3 status USINT 1 1 0=Output is inactive 0 Get
status 1=Output is active
86 Digital Object 0x382 70 Timer 4 Timer 4 status USINT 1 1 0=Output is inactive 0 Get
status 1=Output is active
87 Digital Object 0x382 71 Voltage Voltage Status USINT 1 1 0=OK 0 Get
status 1=LOW
2=HIGH
3-LOW/HIGH
4=(OK)
5=(LOW)
6=(HIGH)
7=(LOW)/HIGH
88 Digital Object 0x382 72 Logic State of Logic output 1...8 USINT 1 1 Bit 0: Logic Output 1 0 Get
output See parameter 129 for output 9 & 10 Bit 1: Logic Output 2
states 1...10 Bit 2: Logic Output 3
Bit 3: Logic Output 4
Bit 4: Logic Output 5
Bit 5: Logic Output 6
Bit 6: Logic Output 7
Bit 7: Logic Output 8

0 = Output inactive
1 = Output active
89 Digital Object 0x382 73 CBWAlarm CB Wear Alarm 1 BOOL 1 1 0= No Wear Alarm 0 Get
1 1=Wear Alarm
90 Digital Object 0x382 74 CBWAlarm CB Wear Alarm 2 BOOL 1 1 0= No Wear Alarm 0 Get
2 1=Wear Alarm
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
91 Digital Object 0x382 75 Alarm Alarm L1..L3 BOOL 1 1 0= No Line Alarm 0 Get
L1..L3 1= Line Alarm
92 Digital Object 0x382 76 Fault L1..L3 Fault L1..L3 BOOL 1 0= No Line Fault 0 Get
1= Line Fault
93 Digital Object 0x382 77 SetGrp Set Group Common Change BOOL 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get
common 1=Group 2
change
94 Digital Object 0x382 78 Open select Open select Obj5 BOOL 1 1 Open=1 0 Get/Set
Obj5 (enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
95 Digital Object 0x382 79 Close select Close select Obj5 BOOL 1 1 Close=1 0 Get/Set
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

Obj5 (enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0


96 Digital Object 0x382 80 Execute Execute operation Obj5 BOOL 1 1 Execute Selection=1 0 Set
operation (enabled only in remote mode)
Obj5
97 Digital Object 0x382 81 Max ctrl Maximum Control Pulse Length of Obj5 UDINT 4 1=0.01 2 600000 0 Get/Set
pulse s
length of
Obj5
98 Digital Object 0x382 82 Open select Open select Obj6 BOOL 1 1 Open=1 0 Get/Set
Obj6 (enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
99 Digital Object 0x382 83 Close select Close select Obj6 BOOL 1 1 Close=1 0 Get/Set
Obj6 (enabled only in remote mode) Unselected=0
100 Digital Object 0x382 84 Execute Execute operation Obj6 BOOL 1 1 Execute Selection=1 0 Set
operation (enabled only in remote mode)
Obj6
101 Digital Object 0x382 85 Max ctrl Maximum Control Pulse Length of Obj6 UDINT 4 1=0.01 2 600000 0 Get/Set
pulse s
length of
Obj6
102 Digital Object 0x382 86 Sync1 req. Sync1 request BOOL 1 1 0= No Sync 1 Request 0 Get
1=Sync 1 Request

Parameter List
103 Digital Object 0x382 87 Sync1 OK Sync1 OK BOOL 1 1 0= Sync 1 Not OK 0 Get
1=Sync 1 OK
104 Digital Object 0x382 88 SYNC1 SYNC1 Bypass BOOL 1 1 0= Sync 1 No Bypass 0 Get
Bypass 1=Sync 1 Bypass

Appendix A
105 Digital Object 0x382 89 Sync1 fail Sync1 fail BOOL 1 1 0=Sync 1 OK 0 Get
1=Sync 1 Failure
381
382

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
106 Digital Object 0x382 90 U12/U12y U12/U12y Phase angle difference INT 2 1=1° 0 180 0 Get
Phase angle

Parameter List
difference
107 Digital Object 0x382 91 Sync2 req. Sync2 request BOOL 1 1 0= No Sync 2 Request 0 Get
1=Sync 2 Request
108 Digital Object 0x382 92 Sync2 OK Sync2 OK BOOL 1 1 0= Sync 2 Not OK 0 Get
1=Sync 2 OK
109 Digital Object 0x382 93 SYNC2 SYNC2 Bypass BOOL 1 1 0= Sync 2 No Bypass 0 Get
Bypass 1=Sync 2 Bypass
110 Digital Object 0x382 94 Sync2 fail Sync2 fail BOOL 1 1 0=Sync 2 OK 0 Get
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

1=Sync 2 Failure
111 Digital Object 0x382 95 DirectO1O Command DirectO1 to Open BOOL 1 1 1=Open 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
112 Digital Object 0x382 96 DirectO1C Command DirectO1 to Closed BOOL 1 1 1=Closed 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
113 Digital Object 0x382 97 DirectO2O Command DirectO2 to Open BOOL 1 1 1=Open 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
114 Digital Object 0x382 98 DirectO2C Command DirectO2 to Closed BOOL 1 1 1=Closed 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
115 Digital Object 0x382 99 DirectO3O Command DirectO3 to Open BOOL 1 1 1=Open 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
116 Digital Object 0x382 100 DirectO3C Command Status of DirectO3 Closed BOOL 1 1 1=Closed 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
117 Digital Object 0x382 101 DirectO4O Command DirectO4 to Open BOOL 1 1 1=Open 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
118 Digital Object 0x382 102 DirectO4C Command DirectO4 to Closed BOOL 1 1 1=Closed 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
119 Digital Object 0x382 103 DirectO5O Command DirectO5 to Open BOOL 1 1 1=Open 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
120 Digital Object 0x382 104 DirectO5C Command DirectO5 to Closed BOOL 1 1 1=Closed 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
121 Digital Object 0x382 105 DirectO6O Command DirectO6 to Open BOOL 1 1 1=Open 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
122 Digital Object 0x382 106 DirectO6C Command DirectO6 to Closed BOOL 1 1 1=Closed 0 Set
(only in Remote mode)
123 Digital Object 0x382 107 Virtual State of Virtual Input 1 BOOL 1 1 Output inactive = 0 0 Get/Set
input 1 Output active = 1
124 Digital Object 0x382 108 Virtual State of Virtual Input 2 BOOL 1 1 Output inactive = 0 0 Get/Set
input 2 Output active = 1
125 Digital Object 0x382 109 Virtual State of Virtual Input 3 BOOL 1 1 Output inactive = 0 0 Get/Set
input 3 Output active = 1
126 Digital Object 0x382 110 Virtual State of Virtual Input 4 BOOL 1 1 Output inactive = 0 0 Get/Set
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

input 4 Output active = 1


127 Digital Object 0x382 111 Obj7 state Object 7 state USINT 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Close=1
Undef=2
128 Digital Object 0x382 112 Obj8 state Object 8 State USINT 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Close=1
Undef=2
129 Digital Object 0x382 113 Logic Logic output states 9...16 USINT 1 1 Bit 0= Logic Output 9 0 Get
output Bit 1= Logic Output 10
states 9...16 Bit 2= Logic Output 11
Bit 3= Logic Output 12
Bit 4= Logic Output 13
Bit 5= Logic Output 14
Bit 6= Logic Output 15
Bit 7= Logic Output 16
Output inactive = 0
Output active = 1
130 Digital Object 0x382 114 Logic Logic output states 17...20 USINT 1 1 Bit 0= Logic output 17 0 Get
output Bit 1= Logic Output 18
states Bit 2= Logic Output 19
17...20
Bit 3= Logic Output 20
Bit 4…7= not used

Parameter List
Output inactive = 0
Output active = 1

Appendix A
383
384

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
131 Digital Object 0x382 115 Virtual Virtual outputs USINT 1 0 Bit 0= Virtual Output 1 0 Get
outputs

Parameter List
Bit 1= Virtual Output 2
Bit 2= Virtual Output 3
Bit 3= Virtual Output 4
Bit 4= Virtual Output 5
Bit 5= Virtual Output 6
Bit 6…7= not used
Output inactive = 0
Output active = 1
132 Digital Object 0x382 116 Diagnostic Potential output relay problem UINT 2 1 Bit 0: T1 0 Get
register 1 Bit 1: T2
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

Bit 2: T3
Bit 3: T4
Bit 4: A1
Bit 5: A2
Bit 6: A3
Bit 7: A4
Bit 8: A5
Bit 9:
Bit 10: T5
Bit 11: T6
Bit 12: T7
Bit 13: T8
Bit 14: T9
Bit 15:

No fault = 0
Fault = 1
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
133 Digital Object 0x382 117 Diagnostic Diagnostic register 2 UINT 2 1 Bit 0: Trip relay 10 0 Get
register 2 Bit 1: Trip relay 11
Bit 2: Trip relay 12
Bit 3: Trip relay 13
Bit 4: Trip relay 14
Bit 5: Trip relay 15
Bit 6: Trip relay 16
Bit 7: Trip relay 17
Bit 8: Trip relay 18
Bit 9: Trip relay 19
Bit 10: Trip relay 20
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

Bit 11: Trip relay 21


Bit 12: Trip relay 22
Bit 13: Trip relay 23
Bit 14: Trip relay 24
Bit 15: [not used]

No fault = 0
Fault = 1

Parameter List
Appendix A
385
386

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
134 Digital Object 0x382 118 Diagnostic Diagnostic register 3 UINT 2 1 Bit 0= DAC 0 Get
register 3

Parameter List
Potential mA-output problem
Bit 1= STACK
Potential stack problem
Bit 2= MemChk
Potential memory problem
Bit 3 = BGTask
Potential background task timeout
Bit 4= DI
Potential input problem (Remove DI1, DI2)
Bit 5= Reserved
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

Bit 6 = Arc
Potential arc card problem
Bit 7= SecPulse
Potential hardware problem
Bit 8= RangeChk
DB: Setting outside range
Bit 9= CPULoad
CPU Overloaded
Bit 10= +24V
Potential internal voltage problem
Bit 11= -15V
Potential internal voltage problem
Bit 12= ITemp
Internal temperature too high
Bit 13= ADChk1
Potential A/D converter problem
Bit 14= ADChk2
Potential A/D converter problem
Bit 15= E2prom
Potential E2Prom problem
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
135 Digital Object 0x382 119 Diagnostic Diagnostic register 4 UINT 2 1 Bit 0: +12V 0 Get
register 4 Bit 1: COM buffer
Bit 2: Not used
Bit 3: Not used
Bit 4: Not used
Bit 5: Not used
Bit 6: Not used
Bit 7: Not used
Bit 8: Not used
Bit 9: Low AUX
Bit 10: Not used
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

Bit 11: [not used]


Bit 12: [not used]
Bit 13: [not used]
Bit 14: [not used]
Bit 15: [not used]

No fault = 0
Fault = 1
136 Digital Object 0x382 120 Engine Engine running hours UDINT 4 1= 1 h 0 876000 0 Get
running
hours
137 Digital Object 0x382 121 Engine Engine running seconds UINT 2 1=1s 0 3599 0 Get
running
seconds
138 Digital Object 0x382 122 Start Start counter UINT 2 1 0 65535 0 Get
counter
139 Digital Object 0x382 123 Reset Reset diagnostics BOOL 1 1 Reset=1 0 Get/Set
diagnostics
140 Digital Object 0x382 124 Clear min & Minimum and maximum clear BOOL 1 1 Clear=1 0 Get
max
141 Digital Object 0x382 125 Pos. Positive sequence Current INT 4 1=1A 0 0 Get
sequence I1

Parameter List
142 Digital Object 0x382 126 Neg. Negative sequence Current INT 4 1=1A 0 0 Get
sequence I2
143 Digital Object 0x382 127 Current I - Current I -seq./+seq. INT 4 1= 0 1000 0 Get
seq./+seq. 0.1%

Appendix A
387
388

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
144 Digital Object 0x382 128 Current I Current I phase sequence SINT 1 1 ??=0 0 Get
phase seq. OK=1

Parameter List
Reverse=2
145 Digital Object 0x382 129 External DI1 External DI1 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Close=1
146 Digital Object 0x382 130 External DI2 External DI2 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Close=1
147 Digital Object 0x382 131 External DI3 External DI3 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Close=1
148 Digital Object 0x382 132 External DI4 External DI4 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

Close=1
149 Digital Object 0x382 133 External DI5 External DI5 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Close=1
150 Digital Object 0x382 134 External DI6 External DI6 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Close=1
151 Digital Object 0x382 135 External DI7 External DI7 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Close=1
152 Digital Object 0x382 136 External DI8 External DI8 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Close=1
153 Digital Object 0x382 137 External DI9 External DI9 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Close=1
154 Digital Object 0x382 138 External External DI10 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DI10 Close=1
155 Digital Object 0x382 139 External External DI11 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DI11 Close=1
156 Digital Object 0x382 140 External Condition of External DI12 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DI12 Close=1
157 Digital Object 0x382 141 External Condition of External DI13 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DI13 Close=1
158 Digital Object 0x382 142 External Condition of External DI14 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DI14 Close=1
159 Digital Object 0x382 143 External Condition of External DI15 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DI15 Close=1
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
160 Digital Object 0x382 144 External Condition of External DI16 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DI16 Close=1
161 Digital Object 0x382 145 External Condition of External DI17 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DI17 Close=1
162 Digital Object 0x382 146 External Condition of External DI18 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DI18 Close=1
163 Digital Object 0x382 147 Event Code Event Buffer UINT 2 1 Bits 0…5 Code 0 Get
Event Code Bits 6…15 Channel
164 Digital Object 0x382 148 Event Event Millisecond And Second UINT 2 1 Bits 0…5 secs 0 Get
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

Millisec And Bits 6…15 milliseconds


Sec
165 Digital Object 0x382 149 Event Min Event Minute And Hour UINT 2 1 Bits 0…7 minutes 0 Get
And Hour Bits 8…15 hour
166 Digital Object 0x382 150 Event Day Event Day And Month UINT 2 1 Bits 0…7 Day 0 Get
And Month Bits 8…15 Month
167 Digital Object 0x382 151 Event Year Event Year UINT 2 1 Bits 0…15 Year 0 Get
168 Digital Object 0x382 152 Event Ack Event Acknowledgement BOOL 1 1 Ack Read=1 0 Get
169 Digital Object 0x382 153 External Condition of External DO1 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO1 Close=1
170 Digital Object 0x382 154 External Condition of External DO2 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO2 Close=1
171 Digital Object 0x382 155 External Condition of External DO3 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO3 Close=1
172 Digital Object 0x382 156 External Condition of External DO4 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO4 Close=1
173 Digital Object 0x382 157 External Condition of External DO5 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO5 Close=1
174 Digital Object 0x382 158 External Condition of External DO6 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get

Parameter List
DO6 Close=1
175 Digital Object 0x382 159 External Condition of External DO7 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO7 Close=1
176 Digital Object 0x382 160 External Condition of External DO8 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get

Appendix A
DO8 Close=1
389
390

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
177 Digital Object 0x382 161 External Condition of External DO9 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO9

Parameter List
Close=1
178 Digital Object 0x382 162 External Condition of External DO10 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO10 Close=1
179 Digital Object 0x382 163 External Condition of External DO11 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO11 Close=1
180 Digital Object 0x382 164 External Condition of External DO12 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO12 Close=1
181 Digital Object 0x382 165 External Condition of External DO13 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

DO13 Close=1
182 Digital Object 0x382 166 External Condition of External DO14 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO14 Close=1
183 Digital Object 0x382 167 External Condition of External DO15 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO15 Close=1
184 Digital Object 0x382 168 External Condition of External DO16 BOOL 1 1 Open=0 0 Get
DO16 Close=1
185 Digital Object 0x382 169 Device Device Status Codes USINT 1 1 Motor Running=0 0 Get
status Warning=1
Fault=2
186 Analog Object 0x383 1 Phase Phase current IL1 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
current IL1
187 Analog Object 0x383 2 Phase Phase current IL2 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
current IL2
188 Analog Object 0x383 3 Phase Phase current IL3 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
current IL3
189 Analog Object 0x383 4 Frequency Frequency INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
Hz
190 Analog Object 0x383 5 Io1 residual Io1 residual current INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
current 0.001
pu
191 Analog Object 0x383 6 Io2 residual Io2 residual current INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
current 0.001
pu
192 Analog Object 0x383 7 Zero Zero sequence voltage INT 2 1= 0 1000 0 Get
sequence 0.1%
voltage
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
193 Analog Object 0x383 8 Active Active power INT 2 1=1 -65000 65000 0 Get
power kW
194 Analog Object 0x383 9 Reactive Reactive power INT 2 1=1 -65000 65000 0 Get
power kVAR
195 Analog Object 0x383 10 Apparent Apparent power INT 2 1=1 -65000 65000 0 Get
power kVA
196 Analog Object 0x383 11 Line-to-line Line-to-line voltage U12 UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
voltage U12
197 Analog Object 0x383 12 Line-to-line Line-to-line voltage U23 UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
voltage U23
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

198 Analog Object 0x383 13 Line-to-line Line-to-line voltage U31 UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
voltage U31
199 Analog Object 0x383 14 Exported Exported energy UDINT 4 1= 0 999999 0 Get
energy 0.001
MWh
200 Analog Object 0x383 15 Imported Imported energy UDINT 4 1= 0 999999 0 Get
energy 0.001
MWh
201 Analog Object 0x383 16 Exp. Exported Reactive Energy UDINT 4 1= 0 999999 0 Get
reactive 0.001
energy Mvarh
202 Analog Object 0x383 17 Imp. Imported Reactive Energy UDINT 4 1= 0 999999 0 Get
reactive 0.001
energy Mvarh
203 Analog Object 0x383 18 Power Power factor UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -100 +100 0 Get
factor Range -1 to +1
(Internal range to 65000)
204 Analog Object 0x383 19 Phase-to- Phase-to-earth voltage UL1 UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 999999 0 Get
earth
voltage UL1
205 Analog Object 0x383 20 Phase-to- Phase-to-earth voltage UL2 UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 999999 0 Get
earth

Parameter List
voltage UL2
206 Analog Object 0x383 21 Phase-to- Phase-to-earth voltage UL3 UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 999999 0 Get
earth
voltage UL3

Appendix A
207 Analog Object 0x383 22 Tan phi Tan phi INT 2 1= -99999 99999 0 Get
Use parameter 853 for higher accuracy 0.001
391
392

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
208 Analog Object 0x383 23 Phase Phase current IL INT 2 1A=1 0 0 Get
current IL

Parameter List
209 Analog Object 0x383 24 Average Average line voltage UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
line voltage
210 Analog Object 0x383 25 Average Average phase voltage UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
phase
voltage
211 Analog Object 0x383 26 Phase Phase current total harmonic distortion DINT 4 1= 0 0 Get
current THD 0.1%
212 Analog Object 0x383 27 IL1 THD IL1 total harmonic distortion DINT 4 1= 1% 0 0 Get
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

213 Analog Object 0x383 28 IL2 THD IL2 total harmonic distortion DINT 4 1= 1% 0 0 Get
214 Analog Object 0x383 29 IL3 THD IL3 total harmonic distortion DINT 4 1= 1% 0 0 Get
215 Analog Object 0x383 30 HARMONIC Harmonics of IL1 UDINT 4 1=1% 0 0 Get
S of IL1 (5)

216 Analog Object 0x383 31 HARMONIC Harmonics of IL2 UDINT 4 1=1% 0 0 Get
S of IL2 (5)

217 Analog Object 0x383 32 HARMONIC Harmonics of IL3 SINT 4 1=1% 0 0 Get
S of IL3 (5)

218 Analog Object 0x383 33 Min. of IL1 Minimum Current of L1,L2,L3 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
IL2 IL3
219 Analog Object 0x383 34 Max. of IL1 Maximum Current of L1,L2,L3 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
IL2 IL3
220 Analog Object 0x383 35 Phase Phase current ILRMS INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
current Arms
ILRMS
221 Analog Object 0x383 36 Phase Phase current IL1RMS INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
current Arms
IL1RMS
222 Analog Object 0x383 37 Phase Phase current IL2RMS INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
current Arms
IL2RMS
223 Analog Object 0x383 38 Phase Phase current IL3RMS INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
current Arms
IL3RMS
224 Analog Object 0x383 39 Temperatur Temperature rise UDINT 4 1=0.1% 0 8000 100 Get
e rise
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
225 Analog Object 0x383 40 Ambient Ambient temperature SINT 1 1 = 1° 0 0 Get/Set
temperatur
e
226 Analog Object 0x383 41 IL1da IL1da demand amps INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
demand
227 Analog Object 0x383 42 IL2da IL2da demand amps INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
demand
228 Analog Object 0x383 43 IL3da IL3da demand amps INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
demand
229 Analog Object 0x383 44 IoCalc Io Calculated demand amps INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

demand pu
230 Analog Object 0x383 45 Io1 demand Io1 demand INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
0.001
pu
231 Analog Object 0x383 46 Io2 demand Io2 demand INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
0.001
pu
232 Analog Object 0x383 47 Voltage Voltage Total Harmonic Distortion UINT 2 1= 1% 0 0 Get
THD
233 Analog Object 0x383 48 Ua THD Ua Total Harmonic Distortion UINT 2 1= 1% 0 0 Get
234 Analog Object 0x383 49 Ub THD Ub Total Harmonic Distortion UINT 2 1= 1% 0 0 Get
235 Analog Object 0x383 50 Uc THD Uc Total Harmonic Distortion UINT 2 1= 0 0 Get
0.1%
236 Analog Object 0x383 51 HARMONIC Harmonics of UL1 USINT 4 1 = 1% 0 0 Get
S of UL1 (5)

237 Analog Object 0x383 52 HARMONIC Harmonics of UL2 USINT 4 1 = 1% 0 0 Get


(5)
S of UL2
238 Analog Object 0x383 53 HARMONIC Harmonics of UL3 USINT 4 1 = 1% 0 0 Get
S of UL3 (5)

239 Analog Object 0x383 54 Min. of line Minimum of line voltages UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get

Parameter List
voltages
240 Analog Object 0x383 55 Max. of line Maximum of line voltages UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
voltages
241 Analog Object 0x383 56 Min. of Minimum of phase voltages UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
phase

Appendix A
voltages
393
394

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
242 Analog Object 0x383 57 Max. of Maximum of phase voltages UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
phase

Parameter List
voltages
243 Analog Object 0x383 58 RMS Mean RMS voltage UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
voltage rms
mean
244 Analog Object 0x383 59 Input Input voltage UL1RMS UINT 2 1= 0 0 Get
voltage 1Vrms
UL1RMS
245 Analog Object 0x383 60 Input Input voltage UL2RMS UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
voltage rms
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

UL2RMS
246 Analog Object 0x383 61 Input Input voltage UL3RMS UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
voltage rms
UL3RMS
247 Analog Object 0x383 62 U12 U12 demand UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
demand
248 Analog Object 0x383 63 U23 U23 demand UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
demand
249 Analog Object 0x383 64 U31 U31 demand UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
demand
250 Analog Object 0x383 65 UL1 UL1 demand UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
demand
251 Analog Object 0x383 66 UL2 UL2 demand UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
demand
252 Analog Object 0x383 67 UL3 UL3 demand UINT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
demand
253 Analog Object 0x383 68 Cosine phi Cosine phi INT 2 1= 0.01 0 Get
254 Analog Object 0x383 69 Cosine of Cosine of phase L1 INT 2 1= 0.01 0 Get
phase L1
255 Analog Object 0x383 70 Cosine of Cosine of phase L2 INT 2 1= 0.01 0 Get
phase L2
256 Analog Object 0x383 71 Cosine of Cosine of phase L3 INT 2 1= 0.01 0 Get
phase L3
257 Analog Object 0x383 72 Power Power angle INT 2 1= 1° 0 0 Get
angle
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
258 Analog Object 0x383 73 Phase L1 Phase L1 active power INT 2 1= 1 0 0 Get
active kW
power
259 Analog Object 0x383 74 Phase L2 Phase L2 active power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
active kW
power
260 Analog Object 0x383 75 Phase L3 Phase L3 active power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
active kW
power
261 Analog Object 0x383 76 Phase L1 Phase L1 reactive power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
reactive kVAR
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

power
262 Analog Object 0x383 77 Phase L2 Phase L2 reactive power INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
reactive 1kVAR
power
263 Analog Object 0x383 78 Phase L3 Phase L3 reactive power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
reactive kVAR
power
264 Analog Object 0x383 79 Phase L1 Phase L1 apparent power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
apparent kVA
power
265 Analog Object 0x383 80 Phase L2 Phase L2 apparent power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
apparent kVA
power
266 Analog Object 0x383 81 Phase L3 Phase L3 apparent power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
apparent kVA
power
267 Analog Object 0x383 82 RMS active RMS active power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
power kW
268 Analog Object 0x383 83 RMS RMS reactive power INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
reactive 1kVAR
power
269 Analog Object 0x383 84 RMS RMS apparent power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get

Parameter List
apparent kVA
power
270 Analog Object 0x383 85 Active Active power demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
power kW
demand

Appendix A
395
396

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
271 Analog Object 0x383 86 Reactive Reactive power demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
power kVAR

Parameter List
demand
272 Analog Object 0x383 87 Apparent Apparent power demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
power kVA
demand
273 Analog Object 0x383 88 Power Demand Power factor INT 2 1 = 0.01 -100 +100 0 Get
factor Range -1 to +1
demand (Internal range to 65000)
274 Analog Object 0x383 89 RMS active RMS active power demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
power kW
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

demand
275 Analog Object 0x383 90 RMS RMS reactive power demand INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
reactive 1kVAR
power
demand
276 Analog Object 0x383 91 RMS RMS apparent power demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
apparent kVA
power
demand
277 Analog Object 0x383 92 Calculated Calculated Io INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
Io 0.001
pu
278 Analog Object 0x383 93 Fault Fault current level of I> INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
current of
I>
279 Analog Object 0x383 94 Fault Fault current level of I>> INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
current of
I>>
280 Analog Object 0x383 95 Fault Fault current level of I>>> INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
current of
I>>>
281 Analog Object 0x383 96 Fault Fault reactance UINT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
reactance ohm
282 Analog Object 0x383 97 Frequency Frequency fy UINT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
fy Hz
283 Analog Object 0x383 98 Line-to-line Line-to-line voltage U12y INT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
voltage
U12y
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
284 Analog Object 0x383 99 Frequency Frequency fz UINT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
fz Hz
285 Analog Object 0x383 100 Line-to-line Line-to-line voltage U12z INT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get
voltage
U12z
286 Analog Object 0x383 101 U12/U12z U12/U12z Phase angle difference INT 2 1° = 1 0 0 Get
Phase angle
difference
287 Analog Object 0x383 102 Minimum Minimum frequency INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get/Set
frequency Hz
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

288 Analog Object 0x383 103 Minimum Minimum active power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
active kW
power
289 Analog Object 0x383 104 Minimum Minimum react. power INT 2 1= 0 0 Get/Set
react. 1kVAR
power
290 Analog Object 0x383 105 Minimum Minimum apparent power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
apparent kVA
power
291 Analog Object 0x383 106 Min power Minimum Power factor INT 2 1 = 0.01 -100 +100 0 Get/Set
factor Range -1 to +1
(Internal range to 65000)
292 Analog Object 0x383 107 Minimum Minimum of Io INT 2 1= 0 0 Get/Set
of Io 0.1%
293 Analog Object 0x383 108 Minimum Minimum of Io2 INT 2 1= 0 0 Get/Set
of Io2 0.1%
294 Analog Object 0x383 109 Minimum Minimum active power demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
active kW
power
demand
295 Analog Object 0x383 110 Minimum Minimum react. power demand INT 2 1= 1 0 0 Get/Set
react. kVAR

Parameter List
power
demand
296 Analog Object 0x383 111 Minimum Minimum apparent power demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
apparent kVA
power

Appendix A
demand
397
398

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
297 Analog Object 0x383 112 15 min 15 Min Minimum Power factor INT 2 1 = 0.01 -100 +100 0 Get/Set
minimum

Parameter List
Range -1 to +1
power (Internal range to 65000)
factor
298 Analog Object 0x383 113 Minimum Minimum active power RMS demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
active kW
power RMS
demand
299 Analog Object 0x383 114 Minimum Minimum react. power RMS demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
react. kVAR
power RMS
demand
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

300 Analog Object 0x383 115 Minimum Minimum apparent power RMS demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
apparent kVA
power RMS
demand
301 Analog Object 0x383 116 Minimum Minimum of IL1 INT 2 1A=1 0 0 Get/Set
of IL1
302 Analog Object 0x383 117 Minimum Minimum of IL2 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL2
303 Analog Object 0x383 118 Minimum Minimum of IL3 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL3
304 Analog Object 0x383 119 RMS RMS minimum of IL1 INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
minimum Arms
of IL1
305 Analog Object 0x383 120 RMS RMS minimum of IL2 INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
minimum Arms
of IL2
306 Analog Object 0x383 121 RMS RMS minimum of IL3 INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
minimum Arms
of IL3
307 Analog Object 0x383 122 Minimum Minimum of IL1 demand INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL1
demand
308 Analog Object 0x383 123 Minimum Minimum of IL2 demand INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL2
demand
309 Analog Object 0x383 124 Minimum Minimum of IL3 demand INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL3
demand
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
310 Analog Object 0x383 125 RMS RMS minimum of IL1 demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
minimum Arms
of IL1
demand
311 Analog Object 0x383 126 RMS RMS minimum of IL2 demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
minimum Arms
of IL2
demand
312 Analog Object 0x383 127 RMS RMS minimum of IL3 demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
minimum Arms
of IL3
demand
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

313 Analog Object 0x383 128 Minimum Minimum of U12 INT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get/Set
of U12
314 Analog Object 0x383 129 Minimum Minimum of U23 INT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get/Set
of U23
315 Analog Object 0x383 130 Minimum Minimum of U31 INT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get/Set
of U31
316 Analog Object 0x383 131 Maximum Maximum frequency INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get/Set
frequency Hz
317 Analog Object 0x383 132 Maximum Maximum active power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
active kW
power
318 Analog Object 0x383 133 Maximum Maximum react. power INT 2 1= 1 0 0 Get/Set
react. kVAR
power
319 Analog Object 0x383 134 Maximum Maximum apparent power INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
apparent kVA
power
320 Analog Object 0x383 135 Max power Maximum Power factor INT 2 1 = 0.01 -100 +100 0 Get/Set
factor Range -1 to +1
(Internal range to 65000)

Parameter List
321 Analog Object 0x383 136 Maximum Maximum of Io INT 2 1= 0 0 Get/Set
of Io 0.1%
322 Analog Object 0x383 137 Maximum Maximum of Io2 INT 2 1= 0 0 Get/Set
of Io2 0.1%

Appendix A
399
400

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
323 Analog Object 0x383 138 Maximum Maximum active power demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
active kW

Parameter List
power
demand
324 Analog Object 0x383 139 Maximum Maximum react. power demand INT 2 1= 1 0 0 Get/Set
react. kVAR
power
demand
325 Analog Object 0x383 140 Maximum Maximum apparent power demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
apparent kVA
power
demand
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

326 Analog Object 0x383 141 15 min 15 Min Maximum Power factor INT 2 1 = 0.01 -100 +100 0 Get/Set
maximum Range -1 to +1
power (Internal range to 65000)
factor
327 Analog Object 0x383 142 Maximum Maximum active power RMS demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
active kW
power RMS
demand
328 Analog Object 0x383 143 Maximum Maximum reactive power RMS demand INT 2 1= 1 0 0 Get/Set
react. kVAR
power RMS
demand
329 Analog Object 0x383 144 Maximum Maximum apparent power RMS demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
apparent kVA
power RMS
demand
330 Analog Object 0x383 145 Maximum Maximum of IL1 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL1
331 Analog Object 0x383 146 Maximum Maximum of IL2 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL2
332 Analog Object 0x383 147 Maximum Maximum of IL3 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL3
333 Analog Object 0x383 148 RMS RMS maximum of IL1 INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
maximum Arms
of IL1
334 Analog Object 0x383 149 RMS RMS maximum of IL2 INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
maximum Arms
of IL2
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
335 Analog Object 0x383 150 RMS RMS maximum of IL3 INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
maximum Arms
of IL3
336 Analog Object 0x383 151 Maximum Maximum of IL1 demand INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL1
demand
337 Analog Object 0x383 152 Maximum Maximum of IL2 demand INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL2
demand
338 Analog Object 0x383 153 Maximum Maximum of IL3 demand INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get/Set
of IL3
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

demand
339 Analog Object 0x383 154 RMS RMS maximum of IL1 demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
maximum Arms
of IL1
demand
340 Analog Object 0x383 155 RMS RMS maximum of IL2 demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
maximum Arms
of IL2
demand
341 Analog Object 0x383 156 RMS RMS maximum of IL3 demand INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get/Set
maximum Arms
of IL3
demand
342 Analog Object 0x383 157 Maximum Maximum of U12 INT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get/Set
of U12
343 Analog Object 0x383 158 Maximum Maximum of U23 INT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get/Set
of U23
344 Analog Object 0x383 159 Maximum Maximum of U31 INT 2 1 = 1V 0 0 Get/Set
of U31
345 Analog Object 0x383 160 Z12 primary Z12 primary impedance INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
impedance ohm
346 Analog Object 0x383 161 Z23 primary Z23 primary impedance INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get

Parameter List
impedance ohm
347 Analog Object 0x383 162 Z31 primary Z31 primary impedance INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
impedance ohm
348 Analog Object 0x383 163 Z12 Z12 secondary impedance INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get

Appendix A
secondary ohm
impedance
401
402

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
349 Analog Object 0x383 164 Z23 Z23 secondary impedance INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
secondary ohm

Parameter List
impedance
350 Analog Object 0x383 165 Z31 Z31 secondary impedance INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
secondary ohm
impedance
351 Analog Object 0x383 166 Z12 angle Z12 angle INT 2 1= 1 ° 0 0 Get
352 Analog Object 0x383 167 Z23 angle Z23 angle INT 2 1= 1 ° 0 0 Get
353 Analog Object 0x383 168 Z31 angle Z31 angle INT 2 1= 1 ° 0 0 Get
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

354 Analog Object 0x383 169 Phase Phase current IL1 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
current IL1
355 Analog Object 0x383 170 Phase Phase current IL2 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
current IL2
356 Analog Object 0x383 171 Phase Phase current IL3 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
current IL3
357 Analog Object 0x383 172 IL1 IL1 difference INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
difference x Imot
358 Analog Object 0x383 173 IL2 IL2 difference INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
difference x Imot
359 Analog Object 0x383 174 IL3 IL3 difference INT 2 1 = 0.01 0 0 Get
difference x Imot
360 Analog Object 0x383 175 Phase Total phase-current harmonic distortion INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
current I 0.1%
THD
361 Analog Object 0x383 176 IL1 THD IL1 total harmonic distortion INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
0.1%
362 Analog Object 0x383 177 IL2 THD IL2 total harmonic distortion INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
0.1%
363 Analog Object 0x383 178 IL3 THD IL3 total harmonic distortion INT 2 1= 0 0 Get
0.1%
364 Analog Object 0x383 179 HARMONIC Harmonics of IL1 USINT 1 1 = 1% 0 0 Get
S of IL1
365 Analog Object 0x383 180 HARMONIC Harmonics of IL2 USINT 1 1 = 1% 0 0 Get
S of IL2
366 Analog Object 0x383 181 HARMONIC Harmonics of IL3 USINT 1 1 = 1% 0 0 Get
S of IL3
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
367 Analog Object 0x383 182 Min. of IL1 Minimum of IL1 IL2 IL3 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
IL2 IL3
368 Analog Object 0x383 183 Max. of IL1 Maximum of IL1 IL2 IL3 INT 2 1=1A 0 0 Get
IL2 IL3
369 Analog Object 0x383 184 Phase Phase current ILRMS INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
current Arms
ILRMS
370 Analog Object 0x383 185 Phase Phase current IL1RMS INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
current Arms
IL1RMS
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

371 Analog Object 0x383 186 Phase Phase current IL2RMS INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
current Arms
IL2RMS
372 Analog Object 0x383 187 Phase Phase current IL3RMS INT 2 1=1 0 0 Get
current Arms
IL3RMS
373 Analog Object 0x383 188 External AI1 External AI1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
374 Analog Object 0x383 189 External AI2 External AI2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
375 Analog Object 0x383 190 External AI3 External AI3 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
376 Analog Object 0x383 191 External AI4 External AI4 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
377 Analog Object 0x383 192 External AI5 External AI5 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
378 Analog Object 0x383 193 External AI6 External AI6 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
379 Analog Object 0x383 194 External AI7 External AI7 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
380 Analog Object 0x383 195 External AI8 External AI8 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
381 Analog Object 0x383 196 External AI9 External AI9 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
382 Analog Object 0x383 197 External External AI10 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
AI10
383 Analog Object 0x383 198 External External AI11 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
AI11

Parameter List
384 Analog Object 0x383 199 External External AI12 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -25000 +25000 0 Get
AI12
385 Analog Object 0x383 200 External External AI13 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 0 2000 0 Get
AI13 mA

Appendix A
386 Analog Object 0x383 201 External External AI14 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 0 2000 0 Get
AI14 mA
403
404

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
387 Analog Object 0x383 202 External External AI15 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 0 2000 0 Get
AI15 mA

Parameter List
388 Analog Object 0x383 203 External External AI16 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 0 2000 0 Get
AI16 mA
389 Analog Object 0x383 204 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 1 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>1
390 Analog Object 0x383 205 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 2 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>2
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

391 Analog Object 0x383 206 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 3 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>3
392 Analog Object 0x383 207 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 4 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>4
393 Analog Object 0x383 208 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 5 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>5
394 Analog Object 0x383 209 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 6 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>6
395 Analog Object 0x383 210 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 7 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>7
396 Analog Object 0x383 211 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 8 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>8
397 Analog Object 0x383 212 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 9 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>9
398 Analog Object 0x383 213 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 10 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
> 10
399 Analog Object 0x383 214 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 11 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
> 11
400 Analog Object 0x383 215 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 12 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
> 12
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
401 Analog Object 0x383 216 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 13 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
> 13
402 Analog Object 0x383 217 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 14 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
> 14
403 Analog Object 0x383 218 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 15 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
> 15
404 Analog Object 0x383 219 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 16 Alarm=1 0 Get
Alarm State
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

> 16
405 Analog Object 0x383 220 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 1 Trip=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 1
406 Analog Object 0x383 221 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 2 Trip=1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 2
407 Analog Object 0x383 222 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 3 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 3
408 Analog Object 0x383 223 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 4 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 4
409 Analog Object 0x383 224 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 5 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 5
410 Analog Object 0x383 225 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 6 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 6
411 Analog Object 0x383 226 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 7 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 7

Parameter List
412 Analog Object 0x383 227 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 8 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 8
413 Analog Object 0x383 228 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 9 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State

Appendix A
>> 9
405
406

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
414 Analog Object 0x383 229 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 10 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State

Parameter List
>> 10
415 Analog Object 0x383 230 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 11 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 11
416 Analog Object 0x383 231 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 12 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 12
417 Analog Object 0x383 232 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 13 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

>> 13
418 Analog Object 0x383 233 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 14 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 14
419 Analog Object 0x383 234 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 15 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 15
420 Analog Object 0x383 235 External AI External AI Input Status BOOL 1 1 Channel 16 Trip =1 0 Get
Alarm State
>> 16
421 Analog Object 0x383 236 External External Analog Output Channel 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO1
422 Analog Object 0x383 237 External External Analog Output Channel 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO2
423 Analog Object 0x383 238 External External Analog Output Channel 3 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO3
424 Analog Object 0x383 239 External External Analog Output Channel 4 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO4
425 Analog Object 0x383 240 External External Analog Output Channel 5 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO5
426 Analog Object 0x383 241 External External Analog Output Channel 6 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO6
427 Analog Object 0x383 242 External External Analog Output Channel 7 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO7
428 Analog Object 0x383 243 External External Analog Output Channel 8 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO8
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
429 Analog Object 0x383 244 External External Analog Output Channel 9 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO9
430 Analog Object 0x383 245 External External Analog Output Channel 10 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO10
431 Analog Object 0x383 246 External External Analog Output Channel 11 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO11
432 Analog Object 0x383 247 External External Analog Output Channel 12 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO12
433 Analog Object 0x383 248 External External Analog Output Channel 13 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO13
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

434 Analog Object 0x383 249 External External Analog Output Channel 14 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO14
435 Analog Object 0x383 250 External External Analog Output Channel 15 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000(6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO15
436 Analog Object 0x383 251 External External Analog Output Channel 16 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 -2100000000 (6) +2100000000 (6) 0 Get
AO16
437 StgProt 0x385 1 I> Enable Protection Enable BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
CurrentObject for I> 1=On

438 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 2 I> Group Setting Group Enable USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
439 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 3 I> Pick-up I> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 500 120 Get/Set
setting 1 x Imot
440 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 4 I> Pick-up I> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 500 120 Get/Set
setting 2 x Imot
441 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 5 I> Delay Delay Curve Type Selected USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
curve 1=IEC
family 1 DT=Definite time 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3

Parameter List
Appendix A
407
408

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
442 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 6 I> Delay Delay Curve Type Selected USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
curve 1=IEC

Parameter List
family 2 DT=Definite time 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
443 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 7 I> Delay Delay Curve Type Selected USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
type 1 1=NI
DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

VI=Very inverse 5=LTEI


EI=Extremely inverse 6=LTVI
LTI=Long time inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 9=STEI
LTVI=Long time very inverse 10=RI
MI=Moderately inverse
STI=Short time inverse
STEI=Short time extremely inverse
RI=Old ASEA type
RXIDG=Old ASEA type
444 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 8 I> Delay Delay Curve Type Selected USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
type 2 1=NI
DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
VI=Very inverse 5=LTEI
EI=Extremely inverse 6=LTVI
LTI=Long time inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 9=STEI
LTVI=Long time very inverse 10=RI
MI=Moderately inverse
STI=Short time inverse
STEI=Short time extremely inverse
RI=Old ASEA type
RXIDG=Old ASEA type
445 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 9 I> Inv. time I> Inv. time coefficient k 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 5 2000 100 Get/Set
coefficient k
1
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
446 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 10 I> Inv. time I> Inv. time coefficient k 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 5 2000 100 Get/Set
coefficient k
2
447 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 11 I> Include I> Include harmonics BOOL 1 1 0=No 0 Get/Set
harmonics 1=Yes
448 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 12 I> Constant I> Constant A UDINT 4 1= 0 200000 1 Get/Set
A 0.001
449 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 13 I> Constant I> Constant B UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
B 0.001
450 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 14 I> Constant I> Constant C UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

C 0.001
451 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 15 I> Constant I> Constant D UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
D 0.001
452 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 16 I> Constant I> Constant E UDINT 4 1= 0 20000 1 Get/Set
E 0.001
453 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 17 I>> Enable I>> Enable for I>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for I>> 1=On
454 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 18 I>> Group I>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
455 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 19 I>> Pick- I>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 2000 250 Get/Set
up setting 1 x Imot
456 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 20 I>> Pick- I>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 2000 250 Get/Set
up setting 2 x Imot
457 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 21 I>> I>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4 180000 60 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
458 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 22 I>> I>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4 180000 60 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
459 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 23 I>>> I>>> Enable for I>>> BOOL 1 1 Off=0 0 Get/Set
Enable for On=1

Parameter List
I>>>
460 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 24 I>>> I>>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
461 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 25 I>>> Pick- I>>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 4000 500 Get/Set

Appendix A
up setting 1 x Imot
409
410

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
462 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 26 I>>> Pick- I>>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 4000 500 Get/Set
up setting 2 x Imot

Parameter List
463 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 27 I>>> I>>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 3 30000 10 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
464 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 28 I>>> I>>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 3 30000 10 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
465 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 29 Idir> Idir> Enable for Idir> BOOL 1 1 Off=0 0 Get/Set
Enable for On=1
Idir>
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

466 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 30 Idir> Idir> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
467 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 31 Idir> Pick- Idir> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 400 120 Get/Set
up setting 1 x Imot
468 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 32 Idir> Pick- Idir> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 400 120 Get/Set
up setting 2 x Imot
469 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 33 Idir> Idir> Direction mode 1 USINT 1 1 0=Directional + Backup 0 Get/Set
Direction 1=Unidirectional
mode 1 2= Directional
470 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 34 Idir> Idir> Direction mode 2 USINT 1 1 0=Directional + Backup 0 Get/Set
Direction 1=Unidirectional
mode 2 2= Directional
471 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 35 Idir> Idir> Angle offset 1 INT 2 1= 1 ° -180 179 8192 Get/Set
Angle offset
1
472 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 36 Idir> Idir> Angle offset 2 INT 2 1= 1 ° -180 179 8192 Get/Set
Angle offset
2
473 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 37 Idir> Idir> Delay curve family 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
Delay curve 1=IEC
family 1 DT=Definite time 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
474 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 38 Idir> Idir> Delay curve family 2 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
Delay curve 1=IEC
family 2 DT=Definite time 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
475 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 39 Idir> Idir> Delay type 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
Delay type 1=NI
1 DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

VI=Very inverse 5=LTEI


EI=Extremely inverse 6=LTVI
LTI=Long time inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 9=STEI
LTVI=Long time very inverse 10=RI
MI=Moderately inverse
STI=Short time inverse
STEI=Short time extremely inverse
RI=Old ASEA type
RXIDG=Old ASEA type
476 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 40 Idir> Idir> Delay type 2 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
Delay type 1=NI
2 DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
VI=Very inverse 5=LTEI
EI=Extremely inverse 6=LTVI
LTI=Long time inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 9=STEI
LTVI=Long time very inverse 10=RI
MI=Moderately inverse
STI=Short time inverse
STEI=Short time extremely inverse

Parameter List
RI=Old ASEA type
RXIDG=Old ASEA type
477 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 41 Idir> Inv. Idir> Inv. time coefficient k 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 5 2000 20 Get/Set
time
coefficient k

Appendix A
1
411
412

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
478 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 42 Idir> Inv. Idir> Inv. time coefficient k 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 5 2000 20 Get/Set
time

Parameter List
coefficient k
2
479 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 43 Idir> Idir> Constant A UDINT 4 1= 0 200000 1 Get/Set
Constant A 0.001
480 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 44 Idir> Idir> Constant B UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
Constant B 0.001
481 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 45 Idir> Idir> Constant C UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
Constant C 0.001
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

482 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 46 Idir> Idir> Constant D DINT 4 1= 0 200000 1 Get/Set


Constant D 0.001
483 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 47 Idir> Idir> Constant E UDINT 4 1= 0 20000 1 Get/Set
Constant E 0.001
484 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 48 Idir>> Idir>> Enable for Idir>> BOOL 1 0 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
Idir>>
485 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 49 Idir>> Idir>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
486 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 50 Idir>> Idir>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 400 120 Get/Set
Pick-up x Imot
setting 1
487 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 51 Idir>> Idir>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 400 120 Get/Set
Pick-up x Imot
setting 2
488 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 52 Idir>> Idir>> Direction mode 1 USINT 1 1 0=ResCap 0 Get/Set
Direction 1=Sector
mode 1 ResCap=High impedance earthed network 2=Undir
Sector= Low impedance earthed network
Undir = Undirectional mode network
489 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 53 Idir>> Idir>> Direction mode 2 USINT 1 1 0=ResCap 0 Get/Set
Direction 1=Sector
mode 2 ResCap=High impedance earthed network 2=Undir
Sector= Low impedance earthed network
Undir = Undirectional mode network
490 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 54 Idir>> Idir>> Angle offset 1 INT 2 1=1° -180 179 0 Get/Set
Angle offset
1
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
491 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 55 Idir>> Idir>> Angle offset 2 INT 2 1=1° -180 179 0 Get/Set
Angle offset
2
492 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 56 Idir>> Delay Curve USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
Delay curve Idir>> Delay curve family 1 1=IEC
family 1 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
DT=Definite time 4=RI
RI=Old ASEA type 5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
493 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 57 Idir>> Delay Curve USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

Delay curve Idir>> Delay curve family 2 1=IEC


family 2 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
DT=Definite time 4=RI
RI=Old ASEA type 5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
494 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 58 Idir>> Delay Curve USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
Delay type Idir>> Delay type 1 1=NI
1 2=VI
3=EI
DT=Definite time 4=LTI
NI=Normal inverse 5=LTEI
VI=Very inverse 6=LTVI
EI=Extremely inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTI=Long time inverse 9=STEI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 10=RI
LTVI=Long time very inverse
MI=Moderately inverse
STI=Short time inverse
STEI=Short time extremely inverse
RI=Old ASEA type
RXIDG=Old ASEA type

Parameter List
Appendix A
413
414

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
495 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 59 Idir>> Delay Curve USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
Delay type 1=NI

Parameter List
Idir>> Delay type 2
2 2=VI
3=EI
DT=Definite time 4=LTI
NI=Normal inverse 5=LTEI
VI=Very inverse 6=LTVI
EI=Extremely inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTI=Long time inverse 9=STEI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 10=RI
LTVI=Long time very inverse
MI=Moderately inverse
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

STI=Short time inverse


STEI=Short time extremely inverse
RI=Old ASEA type
RXIDG=Old ASEA type
496 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 60 Idir>> Inv. Idir>> Inv. time coefficient k 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 5 2000 20 Get/Set
time
coefficient k
1
497 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 61 Idir>> Inv. Idir>> Inv. time coefficient k 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 5 2000 20 Get/Set
time
coefficient k
2
498 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 62 Idir>> Idir>> Constant A UDINT 4 1= 0 200000 1 Get/Set
Constant A 0.001
499 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 63 Idir>> Idir>> Constant B UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
Constant B 0.001
500 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 64 Idir>> Idir>> Constant C UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
Constant C 0.001
501 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 65 Idir>> Idir>> Constant D DINT 4 1= 1 Get/Set
Constant D 0.001
502 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 66 Idir>> Idir>> Constant E UDINT 4 1= 0 20000 1 Get/Set
Constant E 0.001
503 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 67 Idir>>> Idir>>> Enable for Idir>>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
Idir>>>
504 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 68 Idir>>> Idir>>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
505 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 69 Idir>>> Idir>>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 2000 120 Get/Set
Pick-up x Imot
setting 1
506 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 70 Idir>>> Idir>>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 2000 120 Get/Set
Pick-up x Imot
setting 2
507 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 71 Idir>>> Idir>>> Direction mode 1 USINT 1 1 0=ResCap 0 Get/Set
Direction 1=Sector
mode 1 ResCap=High impedance earthed network 2=Undir
Sector= Low impedance earthed network
Undir = Undirectional mode network
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

508 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 72 Idir>>> Idir>>> Direction mode 2 USINT 1 1 0=ResCap 0 Get/Set
Direction 1=Sector
mode 2 ResCap=High impedance earthed network 2=Undir
Sector= Low impedance earthed network
Undir = Undirectional mode network
509 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 73 Idir>>> Idir>>> Angle offset 1 INT 2 1= 1 ° -180 179 0 Get/Set
Angle offset
1
510 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 74 Idir>>> Idir>>> Angle offset 2 INT 2 1= 1 ° -180 179 0 Get/Set
Angle offset
2
511 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 75 Idir>>> Idir>>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4 30000 30 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
512 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 76 Idir>>> Idir>>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4 30000 30 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
513 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 77 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Enable for Idir>>>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
Idir>>>>
514 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 78 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2

Parameter List
515 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 79 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 2000 120 Get/Set
Pick-up x Imot
setting 1
516 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 80 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 2000 120 Get/Set

Appendix A
Pick-up x Imot
setting 2
415
416

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
517 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 81 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Direction mode 1 USINT 1 0 0=ResCap 0 Get/Set
Direction 1=Sector

Parameter List
mode 1 ResCap=High impedance earthed network 2=Undir
Sector= Low impedance earthed network
Undir = Undirectional mode network
518 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 82 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Direction mode 2 USINT 1 0=ResCap 0 Get/Set
Direction 1=Sector
mode 2 ResCap=High impedance earthed network 2=Undir
Sector= Low impedance earthed network
Undir = Undirectional mode network
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

519 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 83 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Angle offset 1 INT 2 1 = 1° -180 179 0 Get/Set
Angle offset
1
520 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 84 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Angle offset 2 INT 2 1 = 1° -180 179 0 Get/Set
Angle offset
2
521 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 85 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4 30000 30 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
522 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 86 Idir>>>> Idir>>>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4 30000 30 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
523 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 87 I2> Enable I2> Enable for I2> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for I2> 1=On
524 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 88 I2> Group I2> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
525 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 89 I2> Pick-up I2> K2 Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 2 70 6554 Get/Set
setting K2 1
526 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 90 I2> Pick-up I2> K2 Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 2 70 6554 Get/Set
setting K2 2
527 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 91 I2> Delay I2> Delay type 1 USINT 1 0 0=DT 0 Get/Set
type 1 1=INV
528 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 92 I2> Delay I2> Delay type 2 USINT 1 0 0=DT 0 Get/Set
type 2 1=INV
529 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 93 I2> I2> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 10 6000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
530 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 94 I2> I2> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 10 6000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
531 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 95 I2>> I2>> Enable for I2>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
I2>>
532 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 96 Ist> Enable Ist> Enable for Ist> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for Ist> 1=On
533 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 97 Ist> Motor Ist> Motor start detection current UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 130 1000 150 Get/Set
start x Imot
detection
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

current
534 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 98 Ist> Nom Ist> Nominal motor start current UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 150 1000 600 Get/Set
motor start x Imot
current
535 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 99 Ist> Delay Ist> Delay type USINT 1 1 0 Get/Set
type DT=0
INV=1
536 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 100 Ist> Ist> Operation delay UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 10 3000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
delay
537 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 101 N> Enable Enable for N> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
for N> 1=Enable
538 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 102 N> Max N> Maximum motor starts/hour UDINT 4 1 1 20 6 Get/Set
motor
starts/hour
539 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 103 N> Min N> Minimum time between motor starts UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 0 1000 600000 Get/Set
time min
between
motor
starts
540 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 104 N> Alarm N> Alarm on event BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
on event 1=On

Parameter List
541 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 105 N> Alarm N> Alarm off event BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
off event 1=On
542 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 106 N> Motor N> Motor start disabled BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
start 1=On

Appendix A
disabled
417
418

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
543 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 107 N> Motor N> Motor start enabled BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
start

Parameter List
1=On
enabled
544 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 108 I< Enable I< Enable for I< BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
for I< 1=On
545 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 109 I< Group I< Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
546 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 110 I< Pick-up I< Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 20 70 50 Get/Set
setting 1 Imot
547 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 111 I< Pick-up I< Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 20 70 50 Get/Set
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

setting 2 Imot
548 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 112 I< I< Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1s 3 3000 10 Get/Set
Operation
delay 1
549 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 113 I< I< Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1s 3 3000 10 Get/Set
Operation
delay 2
550 StgProtCurrentObject(1) 0x385 114 ArcI> ArcI> Enable BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Enable 1=On
551 StgProtCurrentObject(1) 0x385 115 ArcI> Pick- ArcI> Pick-up setting UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 5 100 10
up setting pu
552 StgProtCurrentObject(1) 0x385 116 ArcI> Arc ArcI> Arc inputs in use USINT 1 1 1=S1 15 Get/Set
inputs in 2=S2
use 3=S1/S2
4=BI
5=S1/BI
6=S2/BI
S1/S2/BI=7
553 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 117 dI> Enable dI> Enable BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
1=On
554 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 118 dI> pick-up dI> pick-up (Ibias < 0.5Ign) UDINT 4 1 = 1% 5 50 20 Get/Set
(Ibias < Imot
0.5Ign)
555 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 119 dI> Slope1 dI> Slope1 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 5 100 50 Get/Set
556 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 120 dI> Ibias dI> Ibias for start of slope 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 100 300 200 Get/Set
for start of x Imot
slope 2
557 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 121 dI> Slope2 dI> Slope2 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 50 200 150 Get/Set
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
558 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 122 dI> dI> dI> dI> 2.harm. block enable BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
2.harm. 1=On
block
enable
559 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 123 dI> dI> 2.harm. block limit UDINT 4 1 = 1% 6553 Get/Set
2.harm.
block limit
560 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 124 dI>> dI>> Enable BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable 1=On
561 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 125 dI>> Pick- dI>> Pick-up setting UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 50 400 200 Get/Set
up setting x Imot
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

562 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 126 I2> Enable I2> Enable for I2> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
for I2> 1=On
563 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 127 I2> Group I2> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
564 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 128 I2> Pick-up I2> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 6554 Get/Set
setting 1
565 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 129 I2> Pick-up I2> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 6554 Get/Set
setting 2
566 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 130 I2> Delay I2> Delay type 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 0 Get/Set
type 1 1=INV
567 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 131 I2> Delay I2> Delay type 2 USINT 1 1 0=DT 0 Get/Set
type 2 1=INV
568 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 132 I2> I2> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 10 6000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
569 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 133 I2> I2> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 10 6000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
570 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 134 I> Enable I> Enable for I> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for I> 1=On

Parameter List
571 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 135 I> Group I> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
572 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 136 I> Pick-up I> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 500 120 Get/Set
setting 1 x Imot

Appendix A
573 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 137 I> Pick-up I> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 500 120 Get/Set
setting 2 x Imot
419
420

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
574 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 138 I> Delay I> Delay curve family 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
curve 1=IEC

Parameter List
family 1 DT=Definite time 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
575 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 139 I> Delay I> Delay curve family 2 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
curve 1=IEC
family 2 DT=Definite time 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
576 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 140 I> Delay I> Delay type 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
type 1 1=NI
DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
VI=Very inverse 5=LTEI
EI=Extremely inverse 6=LTVI
LTI=Long time inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 9=STEI
LTVI=Long time very inverse 10=RI
MI=Moderately inverse
STI=Short time inverse
STEI=Short time extremely inverse
RI=Old ASEA type
RXIDG=Old ASEA type
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
577 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 141 I> Delay I> Delay type 2 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
type 2 1=NI
DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
VI=Very inverse 5=LTEI
EI=Extremely inverse 6=LTVI
LTI=Long time inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 9=STEI
LTVI=Long time very inverse 10=RI
MI=Moderately inverse
STI=Short time inverse
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

STEI=Short time extremely inverse


RI=Old ASEA type
RXIDG=Old ASEA type
578 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 142 I> Inv. I> Inv. time coefficient k 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 5 2000 100 Get/Set
time
coefficient k
1
579 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 143 I> Inv. I> Inv. time coefficient k 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 5 2000 100 Get/Set
time
coefficient k
2
580 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 144 I> I> Constant A UDINT 4 1= 0 200000 1 Get/Set
Constant A 0.001
581 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 145 I> I> Constant B UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
Constant B 0.001
582 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 146 I> I> Constant C UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
Constant C 0.001
583 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 147 I> I> Constant D DINT 4 1= 1 Get/Set
Constant D 0.001
584 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 148 I> I> Constant E UDINT 4 1= 0 20000 1 Get/Set
Constant E 0.001

Parameter List
585 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 149 I>> Enable I>> Enable for I>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for I>> 1=On
586 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 150 I>> Group I>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
1=On

Appendix A
587 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 151 I>> Pick- I>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 2000 250 Get/Set
up setting 1 x Imot
421
422

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
588 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 152 I>> Pick- I>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 2000 250 Get/Set
up setting 2 x Imot

Parameter List
589 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 153 I>> I>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 4 30000 60 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
590 StgProtCurrentObject 0x385 154 I>> I>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 4 30000 60 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
591 StgProtEFObject 0x386 1 Io> Enable Enable for Io> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for Io> 1=On
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

592 StgProtEFObject 0x386 2 Io> Group Io> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
593 StgProtEFObject 0x386 3 Io> Pick- Io> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1= 5 20000 50 Get/Set
up setting 1 0.001
pu
594 StgProtEFObject 0x386 4 Io> Pick- Io> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1= 5 20000 50 Get/Set
up setting 2 0.001
pu
595 StgProtEFObject 0x386 5 Io> Delay Io> Delay curve family 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
curve 1=IEC
family 1 DT=Definite time 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
596 StgProtEFObject 0x386 6 Io> Delay Io> Delay curve family 2 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
curve 1=IEC
family 2 DT=Definite time 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
597 StgProtEFObject 0x386 7 Io> Delay Io> Delay type 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 0 Get/Set
type 1 1=NI
DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
VI=Very inverse 5=LTEI
EI=Extremely inverse 6=LTVI
LTI=Long time inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 9=STEI
LTVI=Long time very inverse 10=RI
MI=Moderately inverse
STI=Short time inverse
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

STEI=Short time extremely inverse


RI=Old ASEA type
RXIDG=Old ASEA type
598 StgProtEFObject 0x386 8 Io> Delay Io> Delay type 2 USINT 1 1 0=DT 0
type 2 1=NI
DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
VI=Very inverse 5=LTEI
EI=Extremely inverse 6=LTVI
LTI=Long time inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 9=STEI
LTVI=Long time very inverse 10=RI
MI=Moderately inverse
STI=Short time inverse
STEI=Short time extremely inverse
RI=Old ASEA type
RXIDG=Old ASEA type
599 StgProtEFObject 0x386 9 Io> Io> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4 30000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
600 StgProtEFObject 0x386 10 Io> Io> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4 30000 100 Get/Set
Operation s

Parameter List
delay 2
601 StgProtEFObject 0x386 11 Io> Io> Intermittent time UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 0 30000 0 Get/Set
Intermitten s
t time
602 StgProtEFObject 0x386 12 Io> Io> Constant A UDINT 4 1= 0 200000 1 Get/Set

Appendix A
Constant A 0.001
423
424

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
603 StgProtEFObject 0x386 13 Io> Io> Constant B UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
Constant B 0.001

Parameter List
604 StgProtEFObject 0x386 14 Io> Io> Constant C UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
Constant C 0.001
605 StgProtEFObject 0x386 15 Io> Io> Constant D DINT 4 1= -10000 10000 1 Get/Set
Constant D 0.001
606 StgProtEFObject 0x386 16 Io> Io> Constant E UDINT 4 1= 0 20000 1 Get/Set
Constant E 0.001
607 StgProtEFObject 0x386 17 Io>> Io>> Enable for Io>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable for 1= On
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

Io>>
608 StgProtEFObject 0x386 18 Io>> Io>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
609 StgProtEFObject 0x386 19 Io>> Pick- Io>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 1 2000 10 Get/Set
up setting 1 pu
610 StgProtEFObject 0x386 20 Io>> Pick- Io>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 1 2000 10 Get/Set
up setting 2 pu
611 StgProtEFObject 0x386 21 Io>> Io>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4 30000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
612 StgProtEFObject 0x386 22 Io>> Io>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4 30000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
613 StgProtEFObject 0x386 23 Iodir> Iodir> Enable for Iodir> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
Iodir>
614 StgProtEFObject 0x386 24 Iodir> Iodir> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
615 StgProtEFObject 0x386 25 Iodir> Iodir> Direction mode 1 USINT 1 1 0=ResCap 0 Get/Set
Direction 1=Sector
mode 1 ResCap=High impedance earthed network 2=Undir
Sector= Low impedance earthed network
Undir = Undirectional mode network
616 StgProtEFObject 0x386 26 Iodir> Iodir> Direction mode 2 USINT 1 1 0=ResCap 0 Get/Set
Direction 1=Sector
mode 2 ResCap=High impedance earthed network 2=Undir
Sector= Low impedance earthed network
Undir = Undirectional mode network
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
617 StgProtEFObject 0x386 27 Iodir> Char Iodir> Character control in ResCap mode 1 USINT 1 1 0=Res 0 Get/Set
ctrl. in 1=Cap
ResCap Res= resistive 2=DI1
mode 1 3=DI2
Cap = capacitive 4=DI3
5=DI4
6=DI5
7=DI6
8=DI7
9=DI8
10=DI9
618 StgProtEFObject 0x386 28 Iodir> Char Iodir> Character control in ResCap mode 2 USINT 1 1 0=Res 0 Get/Set
ctrl. in 1=Cap
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

ResCap Res= resistive 2=DI1


mode 2 3=DI2
Cap = capacitive 4=DI3
5=DI4
6=DI5
7=DI6
8=DI7
9=DI8
10=DI9
619 StgProtEFObject 0x386 29 Iodir> Iodir> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1= 5 20000 200 Get/Set
Pick-up 0.001
setting 1 pu
620 StgProtEFObject 0x386 30 Iodir> Iodir> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1= 5 20000 200 Get/Set
Pick-up 0.001
setting 2 pu
621 StgProtEFObject 0x386 31 Iodir> Uo Iodir> Uo setting for IoDir> stage 1 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 1 50 10 Get/Set
setting for
IoDir>
stage 1
622 StgProtEFObject 0x386 32 Iodir> Uo Iodir> Uo setting for IoDir> stage 2 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 1 50 10 Get/Set
setting for
IoDir>
stage 2
623 StgProtEFObject 0x386 33 Iodir> Iodir> Angle offset 1 INT 2 1= 1 ° 0 170 0 Get/Set

Parameter List
Angle offset
1
624 StgProtEFObject 0x386 34 Iodir> Iodir> Angle offset 2 INT 2 1= 1 ° 0 170 0 Get/Set
Angle offset
2

Appendix A
425
426

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
625 StgProtEFObject 0x386 35 Iodir> Pick Iodir> Pick up sector size 1 UINT 2 1 = 1±° 0 170 88 Get/Set
up sector

Parameter List
size 1
626 StgProtEFObject 0x386 36 Iodir> Pick Iodir> Pick up sector size 2 UINT 2 1 = 1±° 0 170 88 Get/Set
up sector
size 2
627 StgProtEFObject 0x386 37 Iodir> Iodir> Delay curve family 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
Delay curve 1=IEC
family 1 DT= Definite Time 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
5=Prg1
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

6=Prg2
7=Prg3
628 StgProtEFObject 0x386 38 Iodir> Iodir> Delay curve family 2 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
Delay curve 1=IEC
family 2 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
4=RI
5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
629 StgProtEFObject 0x386 39 Iodir> Iodir> Delay type 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 0 Get/Set
Delay type 1=NI
1 DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
VI=Very inverse 5=LTEI
EI=Extremely inverse 6=LTVI
LTI=Long time inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 9=STEI
LTVI=Long time very inverse 10=RI
MI=Moderately inverse
STI=Short time inverse
STEI=Short time extremely inverse
RI=Old ASEA type
RXIDG=Old ASEA type
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
630 StgProtEFObject 0x386 40 Iodir> Iodir> Delay type 2 USINT 1 1 0=DT 0 Get/Set
Delay type 1=NI
2 DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
VI=Very inverse 5=LTEI
EI=Extremely inverse 6=LTVI
LTI=Long time inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 9=STEI
LTVI=Long time very inverse 10=RI
MI=Moderately inverse
STI=Short time inverse
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

STEI=Short time extremely inverse


RI=Old ASEA type
RXIDG=Old ASEA type

631 StgProtEFObject 0x386 41 Iodir> Iodir> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 10 30000 50 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
632 StgProtEFObject 0x386 42 Iodir> Iodir> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 10 30000 50 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
633 StgProtEFObject 0x386 43 Iodir> Iodir> Constant A UDINT 4 1= 0 200000 1 Get/Set
Constant A 0.001
634 StgProtEFObject 0x386 44 Iodir> Iodir> Constant B UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
Constant B 0.001
635 StgProtEFObject 0x386 45 Iodir> Iodir> Constant C UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
Constant C 0.001
636 StgProtEFObject 0x386 46 Iodir> Iodir> Constant D DINT 4 1= -10000 10000 1 Get/Set
Constant D 0.001
637 StgProtEFObject 0x386 47 Iodir> Iodir> Constant E UDINT 4 1= 0 20000 1 Get/Set
Constant E 0.001
638 StgProtEFObject 0x386 48 Iodir>> Iodir>> Enable for Iodir>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set

Parameter List
Enable for 1=On
Iodir>>
639 StgProtEFObject 0x386 49 Iodir>> Iodir>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
640 StgProtEFObject 0x386 50 Iodir>> Iodir>> Direction mode 1 USINT 1 1 0=ResCap 0 Get/Set

Appendix A
Direction 1=Sector
mode 1 2=Undir
427
428

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
641 StgProtEFObject 0x386 51 Iodir>> Iodir>> Direction mode 2 USINT 1 1 0=ResCap 0 Get/Set
Direction 1=Sector

Parameter List
mode 2 2=Undir
642 StgProtEFObject 0x386 52 Iodir>> Iodir>> Character control in ResCap mode USINT 1 1 0=Res 0 Get/Set
Char ctrl. in 1 1=Cap
ResCap 2=DI1
mode 1 3=DI2
4=DI3
5=DI4
6=DI5
7=DI6
8=DI7
9=DI8
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

10=DI9
643 StgProtEFObject 0x386 53 Iodir>> Iodir>> Character control in ResCap mode USINT 1 1 0=Res 0 Get/Set
Char ctrl. in 2 1=Cap
ResCap 2=DI1
mode 2 3=DI2
4=DI3
5=DI4
6=DI5
7=DI6
8=DI7
9=DI8
10=DI9
644 StgProtEFObject 0x386 54 Iodir>> Iodir>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 1 2000 20 Get/Set
Pick-up pu
setting 1
645 StgProtEFObject 0x386 55 Iodir>> Iodir>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 1 2000 20 Get/Set
Pick-up pu
setting 2
646 StgProtEFObject 0x386 56 Iodir>> Uo Iodir>> Uo setting for IoDir>> stage 1 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 1 50 10 Get/Set
setting for
IoDir>>
stage 1
647 StgProtEFObject 0x386 57 Iodir>> Uo Iodir>> Uo setting for IoDir>> stage 2 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 1 50 10 Get/Set
setting for
IoDir>>
stage 2
648 StgProtEFObject 0x386 58 Iodir>> Iodir>> Angle offset 1 INT 2 1= 1° 0 170 0 Get/Set
Angle offset
1
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
649 StgProtEFObject 0x386 59 Iodir>> Iodir>> Angle offset 2 INT 2 1= 1° 0 170 0 Get/Set
Angle offset
2
650 StgProtEFObject 0x386 60 Iodir>> Iodir>> Pick up sector size 1 UINT 2 1= 1±° 0 170 88 Get/Set
Pick up
sector size 1
651 StgProtEFObject 0x386 61 Iodir>> Iodir>> Pick up sector size 2 UINT 2 1 = 1±° 0 170 88 Get/Set
Pick up
sector size 2
652 StgProtEFObject 0x386 62 Iodir>> Iodir>> Delay curve family 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
Delay curve 1=IEC
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

family 1 DT=Definite time 2=IEEE


3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
653 StgProtEFObject 0x386 63 Iodir>> Iodir>> Delay curve family 2 USINT 1 1 0=DT 1 Get/Set
Delay curve 1=IEC
family 2 DT=Definite time 2=IEEE
3=IEEE2
RI=Old ASEA type 4=RI
5=Prg1
6=Prg2
7=Prg3
654 StgProtEFObject 0x386 64 Iodir>> Iodir>> Delay type 1 USINT 1 1 0=DT 0 Get/Set
Delay type 1=NI
1 DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
VI=Very inverse 5=LTEI
EI=Extremely inverse 6=LTVI
LTI=Long time inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 9=STEI
LTVI=Long time very inverse 10=RI
MI=Moderately inverse

Parameter List
STI=Short time inverse
STEI=Short time extremely inverse
RI=Old ASEA type
RXIDG=Old ASEA type

Appendix A
429
430

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
655 StgProtEFObject 0x386 65 Iodir>> Iodir>> Delay type 2 USINT 1 1 0=DT 0 Get/Set
Delay type 1=NI

Parameter List
2 DT=Definite time 2=VI
3=EI
NI=Normal inverse 4=LTI
VI=Very inverse 5=LTEI
EI=Extremely inverse 6=LTVI
LTI=Long time inverse 7=MI
8=STI
LTEI=Long time extremely inverse 9=STEI
LTVI=Long time very inverse 10=RI
MI=Moderately inverse
STI=Short time inverse
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

STEI=Short time extremely inverse


RI=Old ASEA type
RXIDG=Old ASEA type
656 StgProtEFObject 0x386 66 Iodir>> Iodir>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 10 30000 50 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
657 StgProtEFObject 0x386 67 Iodir>> Iodir>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 10 30000 50 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
658 StgProtEFObject 0x386 68 Iodir>> Iodir>> Constant A UDINT 4 1= 0 200000 1 Get/Set
Constant A 0.001
659 StgProtEFObject 0x386 69 Iodir>> Iodir>> Constant B UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
Constant B 0.001
660 StgProtEFObject 0x386 70 Iodir>> Iodir>> Constant C UDINT 4 1= 0 5000 1 Get/Set
Constant C 0.001
661 StgProtEFObject 0x386 71 Iodir>> Iodir>> Constant D DINT 4 1= 1 Get/Set
Constant D 0.001
662 StgProtEFObject 0x386 72 Iodir>> Iodir>> Constant E UDINT 4 1= 0 20000 1 Get/Set
Constant E 0.001
663 StgProtEFObject 0x386 73 Io>>> Io>>> Enable for Io>>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
Io>>>
664 StgProtEFObject 0x386 74 Io>>> Io>>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
665 StgProtEFObject 0x386 75 Io>>> Io>>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 1 2000 10 Get/Set
Pick-up pu
setting 1
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
666 StgProtEFObject 0x386 76 Io>>> Io>>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 1 2000 10 Get/Set
Pick-up pu
setting 2
667 StgProtEFObject 0x386 77 Io>>> Io>>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 4 30000 50 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
668 StgProtEFObject 0x386 78 Io>>> Io>>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 4 30000 50 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
669 StgProtEFObject 0x386 79 Io>>> Io>>> Compensation mode USINT 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Compensati 1=On
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

on mode
670 StgProtEFObject 0x386 80 Io>>> Io>>> Compensation current UDINT 4 1= 10 3000 50 Get/Set
Compensati 0.001
on current pu
671 StgProtEFObject 0x386 81 Io>>> Io>>> Save unbalance current USINT 1 1 1=Get 0 Get/Set
Save
unbalance
current
672 StgProtEFObject 0x386 82 Io>>> Io>>> Saving unbalance event BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Saving 1=On
unbal event
673 StgProtEFObject 0x386 83 Io>>> Io>>> Unbalance saved event BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Unbal saved 1=On
event
674 StgProtEFObject 0x386 84 Io>>>> Io>>>> Enable for Io>>>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
Io>>>>
675 StgProtEFObject 0x386 85 Io>>>> Io>>>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
676 StgProtEFObject 0x386 86 Io>>>> Io>>>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 1 2000 20 Get/Set
Pick-up pu
setting 1

Parameter List
677 StgProtEFObject 0x386 87 Io>>>> Io>>>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 1 2000 20 Get/Set
Pick-up pu
setting 2
678 StgProtEFObject 0x386 88 Io>>>> Io>>>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 4 30000 100 Get/Set
Operation s

Appendix A
delay 1
431
432

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
679 StgProtEFObject 0x386 89 Io>>>> Io>>>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 4 30000 100 Get/Set
Operation s

Parameter List
delay 2
680 StgProtEFObject 0x386 90 Io>>>> Io>>>> Compensation mode USINT 1 1 Off=0 0 Get/Set
Compensati Normal=1
on mode Location=2
681 StgProtEFObject 0x386 91 Io>>>> Io>>>> Compensation current UDINT 4 1= 10 3000 50 Get/Set
Compensati 0.001
on current pu
682 StgProtEFObject 0x386 92 Io>>>> Io>>>> Save unbalance current USINT 1 1 1=Get 0 Get/Set
Save
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

unbalance
current
683 StgProtEFObject 0x386 93 Io>>>> Io>>>> Max allowed faults UINT 2 1 0 10 0 Get/Set
Max
allowed
faults
684 StgProtEFObject 0x386 94 Io>>>> Io>>>> Clear location counters USINT 1 1 1=Clear 0 Get/Set
Clear
location
counters
685 StgProtEFObject 0x386 95 Io>>>> Io>>>> Saving unbalance event BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Saving 1=On
unbal event
686 StgProtEFObject 0x386 96 Io>>>> Io>>>> Unbalance saved event BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Unbal saved 1=On
event
687 StgProtEFObject 0x386 97 IoInt> IoInt> Enable for IoInt> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
IoInt>
688 StgProtEFObject 0x386 98 IoInt> IoInt> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Group 1=On
689 StgProtEFObject 0x386 99 IoInt> Uo IoInt> Uo pick-up 1 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 1 60 10 Get/Set
pick-up 1
690 StgProtEFObject 0x386 100 IoInt> Uo IoInt> Uo pick-up 2 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 1 60 10 Get/Set
pick-up 2
691 StgProtEFObject 0x386 101 IoInt> IoInt> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 2 30000 50 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
692 StgProtEFObject 0x386 102 IoInt> IoInt> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 2 30000 50 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
693 StgProtEFObject 0x386 103 IoInt> IoInt> Intermittent time UDINT 4 1 =0.01 0 30000 100 Get/Set
Intermitten s
t time
694 StgProtEFObject 0x386 104 Uo> Uo> Enable for Uo> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
Uo>
695 StgProtEFObject 0x386 105 Uo> Group Uo> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

696 StgProtEFObject 0x386 106 Uo> Pick- Uo> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 1 60 10 Get/Set
up setting 1
697 StgProtEFObject 0x386 107 Uo> Pick- Uo> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 1 60 10 Get/Set
up setting 2
698 StgProtEFObject 0x386 108 Uo> Uo> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 3 3000 20 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
699 StgProtEFObject 0x386 109 Uo> Uo> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 3 3000 20 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
700 StgProtEFObject 0x386 110 Uo>> Uo>> Enable for Uo>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
Uo>>
701 StgProtEFObject 0x386 111 Uo>> Uo>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
702 StgProtEFObject 0x386 112 Uo>> Pick- Uo>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 1 60 20 Get/Set
up setting 1
703 StgProtEFObject 0x386 113 Uo>> Pick- Uo>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 1% 1 60 20 Get/Set
up setting 2
704 StgProtEFObject 0x386 114 Uo>> Uo>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1s 3 3000 5 Get/Set
Operation

Parameter List
delay 1
705 StgProtEFObject 0x386 115 Uo>> Uo>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1s 3 3000 5 Get/Set
Operation
delay 2

Appendix A
433
434

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
706 StgProtEFObject(1) 0x386 116 ArcIo1> ArcIo1> Enable for ArcIo1> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Enable for

Parameter List
1=On
ArcIo1>
707 StgProtEFObject(1) 0x386 117 ArcIo1> ArcIo1> Pick-up setting UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 5 100 10 Get/Set
Pick-up pu
setting
708 StgProtEFObject(1) 0x386 118 ArcIo1> Arc ArcIo1> Arc inputs in use USINT 1 1 S1=1 15 Get/Set
inputs in S2=2
use S1/S2=3
BI=4
S1/BI=5
S2/BI=6
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

S1/S2/BI=7
709 StgProtEFObject(1) 0x386 119 ArcIo2> Enable for ArcIo2> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
ArcIo2>
710 StgProtEFObject(1) 0x386 120 ArcIo2> ArcIo2> Pick-up setting UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 5 100 10 Get/Set
Pick-up pu
setting
711 StgProtEFObject(1) 0x386 121 ArcIo2> Arc ArcIo2> Arc inputs in use USINT 1 1 S1=1 15 Get/Set
inputs in S2=2
use S1/S2=3
BI=4
S1/BI=5
S2/BI=6
S1/S2/BI=7
712 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 1 U> Enable U> Enable for U> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for U> 1=On
713 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 2 U> Group U> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
714 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 3 U> Pick- U> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1= 50 150 120 Get/Set
up setting 1 1%Un
715 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 4 U> Pick- U> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1= 50 150 120 Get/Set
up setting 2 1%Un
716 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 5 U> U> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 8 30000 10 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
717 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 6 U> U> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 8 30000 10 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
718 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 7 U> U> Release delay UDINT 4 1 =0.01 6 300000 0 Get/Set
Release s
delay
719 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 8 U> U> Hysteresis UDINT 4 1= 1 200 30 Get/Set
Hysteresis 0.1%
720 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 9 U>> U>> Enable for U>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
U>>
721 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 10 U>> U>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

722 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 11 U>> Pick- U>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1= 50 150 130 Get/Set
up setting 1 1%Un
723 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 12 U>> Pick- U>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1= 50 150 130 Get/Set
up setting 2 1%Un
724 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 13 U>> U>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 6 300000 5 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
725 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 14 U>> U>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 6 300000 5 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
726 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 15 U>> U>> Hysteresis UDINT 4 1= 1 200 30 Get/Set
Hysteresis 0.1%
727 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 16 U>>> U>>> Enable for U>>> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
U>>>
728 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 17 U>>> U>>> Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
729 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 18 U>>> U>>> Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1= 50 160 135 Get/Set
Pick-up 1%Un
setting 1
730 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 19 U>>> U>>> Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1= 50 160 135 Get/Set
Pick-up 1%Un

Parameter List
setting 2
731 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 20 U>>> U>>> Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 4 300000 5 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1

Appendix A
435
436

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
732 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 21 U>>> U>>> Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 4 300000 5 Get/Set
Operation s

Parameter List
delay 2
733 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 22 U>>> U>>> Hysteresis UDINT 4 1= 1 200 30 Get/Set
Hysteresis 0.1%
734 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 23 U< Enable U< Enable for U< BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for U< 1=On
735 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 24 U< Group U< Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
736 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 25 U< Pick- U< Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1= 20 120 80 Get/Set
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

up setting 1 1%Un
737 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 26 U< Pick- U< Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1= 20 120 80 Get/Set
up setting 2 1%Un
738 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 27 U< U< Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 8 30000 1000 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
739 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 28 U< U< Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 8 30000 1000 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
740 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 29 U< Low U< Low voltage blocking 1 UDINT 4 1= 0 80 10 Get/Set
voltage 1%Un
blocking 1
741 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 30 U< Low U< Low voltage blocking 2 UDINT 4 1= 0 80 10 Get/Set
voltage 1%Un
blocking 2
742 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 31 U< U< Release delay UDINT 4 1 =0.01 6 300000 0 Get/Set
Release s
delay
743 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 32 U< U< Hysteresis UDINT 4 1= 1 200 30 Get/Set
Hysteresis 0.1%
744 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 33 U<< U<< Enable for U<< BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
U<<
745 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 34 U<< U<< Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
746 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 35 U<< Pick- U<< Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1= 20 120 70 Get/Set
up setting 1 1%Un
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
747 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 36 U<< Pick- U<< Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1= 20 120 70 Get/Set
up setting 2 1%Un
748 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 37 U<< U<< Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 6 30000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
749 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 38 U<< U<< Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 6 30000 100 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
750 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 39 U<< Low U<< Low voltage blocking 1 UDINT 4 1= 0 80 10 Get/Set
voltage 1%Un
blocking 1
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

751 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 40 U<< Low U<< Low voltage blocking 2 UDINT 4 1= 0 80 10 Get/Set
voltage 1%Un
blocking 2
752 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 41 U<< U<< Hysteresis UDINT 4 1= 1 200 30 Get/Set
Hysteresis 0.1%
753 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 42 U<<< U<<< Enable for U<<< BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
U<<<
754 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 43 U<<< U<<< Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
Group 1=Group 2
755 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 44 U<<< U<<< Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1= 20 120 70 Get/Set
Pick-up 1%Un
setting 1
756 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 45 U<<< U<<< Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1= 20 120 70 Get/Set
Pick-up 1%Un
setting 2
757 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 46 U<<< U<<< Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 6 30000 50 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
758 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 47 U<<< U<<< Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 6 30000 50 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2

Parameter List
759 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 48 U<<< Low U<<< Low voltage blocking 1 UDINT 4 1= 0 80 10 Get/Set
voltage 1%Un
blocking 1
760 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 49 U<<< Low U<<< Low voltage blocking 2 UDINT 4 1= 0 80 10 Get/Set

Appendix A
voltage 1%Un
blocking 2
437
438

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
761 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 50 U<<< U<<< Hysteresis UDINT 4 1= 1 200 30 Get/Set
Hysteresis 0.1%

Parameter List
762 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 51 fX Enable fX Enable for fX BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for fX 1=On
763 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 52 fX Group fX Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
764 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 53 fX Pick-up fX Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4000 7000 19608 Get/Set
setting 1 Hz
765 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 54 fX Pick-up fX Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4000 7000 19608 Get/Set
setting 2 Hz
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

766 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 55 fX fX Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 10 30000 10 Get/Set


Operation s
delay 1
767 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 56 fX fX Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 10 30000 10 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
768 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 57 Low voltage Low (Under) voltage blocking 1st instance UDINT 4 1= 10 100 40 Get/Set
blocking 1st 1%Un
inst.
769 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 58 fXX Enable fXX Enable for fXX BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
for fXX 1=On
770 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 59 fXX Group fXX Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
771 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 60 fXX Pick-up fXX Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4000 7000 19231 Get/Set
setting 1 Hz
772 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 61 fXX Pick-up fXX Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4000 7000 19231 Get/Set
setting 2 Hz
773 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 62 fXX fXX Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 10 300000 5 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
774 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 63 fXX fXX Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 10 300000 5 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
775 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 64 Low voltage Low (Under) voltage blocking 2nd instance UDINT 4 1= 10 100 40 Get/Set
blocking 1%Un
2nd inst.
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
776 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 65 f< Enable f< Enable for f< BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for f< 1=On
777 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 66 f< Group f< Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
778 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 67 f< Pick-up f< Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4000 6400 20833 Get/Set
setting 1 Hz
779 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 68 f< Pick-up f< Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4000 6400 20833 Get/Set
setting 2 Hz
780 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 69 f< f< Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 10 30000 150 Get/Set
Operation s
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

delay 1
781 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 70 f< f< Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 10 30000 150 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
782 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 71 Low voltage Low (Under) voltage blocking 3rd instance UDINT 4 1= 10 100 40 Get/Set
blocking 1%Un
3rd inst.
783 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 72 f<< Enable f<< Enable for f<< BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
for f<< 1=On
784 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 73 f<< Group f<< Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
785 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 74 f<< Pick- f<< Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4000 6400 20833 Get/Set
up setting 1 Hz
786 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 75 f<< Pick- f<< Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 4000 6400 20833 Get/Set
up setting 2 Hz
787 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 76 f<< f<< Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 300000 5 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
788 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 77 f<< f<< Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 =0.01 10 300000 5 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2

Parameter List
789 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 78 Low voltage Low (Under) voltage blocking 4th instance UDINT 4 1= 10 100 40 Get/Set
blocking 1%Un
4th inst.
790 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 79 df/dt Enable for df/dt BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set

Appendix A
Enable for 1=On
df/dt
439
440

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
791 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 80 df/dt Group df/dt Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set

Parameter List
1=Group 2
792 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 81 df/dt Pick- df/dt Pick-up setting 1 UDINT 4 1= 2 100 50 Get/Set
up setting 1 0.1Hz/s
793 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 82 df/dt Pick- df/dt Pick-up setting 2 UDINT 4 1= 2 100 50 Get/Set
up setting 2 0.1Hz/s
794 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 83 df/dt df/dt Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 14 1000 25 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
795 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 84 df/dt df/dt Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 14 1000 25 Get/Set
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

Operation s
delay 2
796 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 85 df/dt df/dt Minimum delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 14 1000 25 Get/Set
Minimum s
delay 1
797 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 86 df/dt df/dt Minimum delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 14 1000 25 Get/Set
Minimum s
delay 2
798 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 87 P< Enable P< Enable for P< BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
for P< 1=On
799 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 88 P< Group P< Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
800 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 89 P< Pick-up P< Pick-up setting 1 DINT 4 1= -2000 2000 -40 Get/Set
setting 1 0.1%Sn
801 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 90 P< Pick-up P< Pick-up setting 2 DINT 4 1= -2000 2000 -40 Get/Set
setting 2 0.1%Sn
802 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 91 P< P< Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 3 3000 10 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 1
803 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 92 P< P< Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 3 3000 10 Get/Set
Operation s
delay 2
804 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 93 P<< P<< Enable for P<<1 BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Enable for 1=On
P<<
805 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 94 P<< Group P<< Setting Group USINT 1 1 0=Group 1 0 Get/Set
1=Group 2
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
806 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 95 P<< Pick- P<< Pick-up setting 1 DINT 4 1= -2000 2000 -20 Get/Set
up setting 1 0.1%Sn
807 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 96 P<< Pick- P<< Pick-up setting 2 DINT 4 1= -2000 2000 -20 Get/Set
up setting 2 0.1%Sn
808 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 97 P<< P<< Operation delay 1 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1s 3 3000 10 Get/Set
Operation
delay 1
809 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 98 P<< P<< Operation delay 2 UDINT 4 1 = 0.1s 3 3000 10 Get/Set
Operation
delay 2
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

810 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 99 T> Enable T> Enable for T> BOOL 1 1 0=Off 1 Get/Set
for T> 1=On
811 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 100 T> T> Maximum continuous current UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 240 106 Get/Set
Maximum x Imot
continuous
current
812 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 101 T> Alarm T> Alarm setting UDINT 4 1 = 1% 60 99 80 Get/Set
setting
813 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 102 T> Time T> Time constant tau UINT 2 1 min = 2 180 60 Get/Set
constant 1
tau
814 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 103 T> Rel. T> Relative cooling time constant UDINT 4 1= 0.1 x 10 100 10 Get/Set
cooling tau
time
constant
815 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 104 T> Max T> Max overload at +40°C UDINT 4 1 = 1% 70 120 100 Get/Set
overload at Imot
+40°C
816 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 105 T> Max T> Max overload at +70°C UDINT 4 1= 50 100 78 Get/Set
overload at 1%Imot
+70°C
817 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 106 T> T> Ambient temperature INT 2 1=1° -55 125 40 Get/Set
Ambient

Parameter List
temperatur
e

Appendix A
441
442

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
818 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 107 T> T> Ambient temperature sensor selection USINT 1 1 1=ExtAI1 0 Get/Set
Ambient

Parameter List
2=ExtAI2
temp. 3=ExtAI3
sensor
4=ExtAI4
5=ExtAI5
6=ExtAI6
7=ExtAI7
8=ExtAI8
9=ExtAI9
10=ExtAI10
11=ExtAI11
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

12=ExtAI12
13=ExtAI13
14=ExtAI14
15=ExtAI15,
16=ExtAI16
819 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 108 Enable for Enable for Circuit Breaker BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
CBFP Failure Protection 1=On
820 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 109 CBFP Circuit Breaker Failure Protection Monitored USINT 1 1 1=T1 0 Get/Set
Monitored Trip relay 2=T2
Trip relay 3=T3
4=T4
5=T5
6=T6
7=T7
8=T8
9=T9
10=T10
11=T11
12=T12
13=T13
821 StgProtOtherObject 0x387 110 CBFP Circuit Breaker Failure Protection Operation UDINT 4 1 = 0.01 10 1000 25 Get/Set
Operation delay s
delay
822 StgGeneralObject 0x388 1 CT primary Current transformer primary UDINT 4 1=1A 10 20000 500 Get/Set
823 StgGeneralObject 0x388 2 CT Current transformer secondary UINT 2 1=1A 1 10 5 Get/Set
secondary
824 StgGeneralObject 0x388 3 I Nominal I Nominal input UINT 2 1=1A 1 5 5 Get
input
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
825 StgGeneralObject 0x388 4 Io1 CT Io1 CT primary UDINT 4 1=1A 1 20000 50 Get/Set
primary
826 StgGeneralObject 0x388 5 Io1 CT Io1 CT secondary UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 1 100 50 Get/Set
secondary A
827 StgGeneralObject 0x388 6 Nominal Io1 Nominal Io1 input UDINT 4 1= 0.1 1 50 10 Get
input A
828 StgGeneralObject 0x388 7 Io2 CT Io2 CT primary UDINT 4 1=1A 1 20000 50 Get/Set
primary
829 StgGeneralObject 0x388 8 Io2 CT Io2 CT secondary UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 1 100 50 Get/Set
secondary A
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

830 StgGeneralObject 0x388 9 Nominal Io2 Nominal Io2 input UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 1 50 50 Get
input A
831 StgGeneralObject 0x388 10 VT primary Voltage transformer primary UDINT 4 1 = 1V 50 450000 11000 Get/Set
832 StgGeneralObject 0x388 11 VT Voltage transformer secondary UINT 2 1 = 1V 50 400 100 Get/Set
secondary
833 StgGeneralObject 0x388 12 VTo VTo secondary UDINT 4 1= 25000 240000 100000 Get/Set
secondary 0.001V
834 StgGeneralObject 0x388 13 Motor nom Nominal Motor Current UDINT 4 1 = 0.1 50 20000 4000 Get
current A
835 StgGeneralObject 0x388 14 Generator Nominal Generator Current UINT 2 1 = 1V 50 65000 11400 Get/Set
nom
voltage
836 StgGeneralObject 0x388 15 Nominal Nominal power UDINT 4 1=1 100 400000 8000 Get/Set
power kVA
837 StgGeneralObject 0x388 16 Nominal Nominal shaft power Pm UDINT 4 1=1 100 400000 6400 Get/Set
shaft power kW
Pm
838 StgGeneralObject 0x388 17 Reserved Reserved BOOL 1 - - - - Get/Set
839 StgGeneralObject 0x388 18 Bus bar Bus bar nominal voltage UDINT 4 1 = 1V 50 450000 100 Get/Set
nominal

Parameter List
voltage
840 StgGeneralObject 0x388 19 Genrtr side Generator side nominal voltage UDINT 4 1 = 1V 50 65000 100 Get/Set
nom
voltage

Appendix A
443
444

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
841 StgGeneralObject 0x388 20 Connection Connection group USINT 1 1 Yy0=0 0 Get/Set
group Yy6=1

Parameter List
Yd1=2
Yd5=3
Yd7=4
Yd11=5
Dy1=6
Dy5=7
Dy7=8
Dy11=9
Dd0=10
842 Analog2Object 0x384 1 Frequency Frequency DINT 4 1 = 0.01 4500 6500 0 Get
Hz
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

843 Analog2Object 0x384 2 Active Active power DINT 4 1=1 -999999 999999 0 Get
power kW
844 Analog2Object 0x384 3 Reactive Reactive power DINT 4 1=1 -999999 999999 0 Get
power kVAR
845 Analog2Object 0x384 4 Apparent Apparent power DINT 4 1=1 -999999 999999 0 Get
power kVA
846 Analog2Object 0x384 5 Line-to-line Line-to-line voltage U12 UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 999999 0 Get
voltage U12
847 Analog2Object 0x384 6 Line-to-line Line-to-line voltage U23 UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 999999 0 Get
voltage U23
848 Analog2Object 0x384 7 Line-to-line Line-to-line voltage U31 UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 999999 0 Get
voltage U31
849 Analog2Object 0x384 8 Power Power factor DINT 4 1 = 0.01 -100 +100 0 Get
factor Range -1 to +1
(Internal range to 65000)
850 Analog2Object 0x384 9 Phase-to- Phase-to-earth voltage UL1 UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 999999 0 Get
earth
voltage UL1
851 Analog2Object 0x384 10 Phase-to- Phase-to-earth voltage UL2 UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 999999 0 Get
earth
voltage UL2
852 Analog2Object 0x384 11 Phase-to- Phase-to-earth voltage UL3 UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 999999 0 Get
earth
voltage UL3
853 Analog2Object 0x384 12 Tan phi Tan phi DINT 4 1= -99999 99999 0 Get
0.001
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
854 Analog2Object 0x384 13 Average Average line voltage UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
line voltage
855 Analog2Object 0x384 14 Average Average phase voltage UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
phase
voltage
856 Analog2Object 0x384 15 Pos. Positive sequence U1 UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
sequence
U1
857 Analog2Object 0x384 16 Neg. Negative sequence U2 UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
sequence
U2
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

858 Analog2Object 0x384 17 Min of line Minimum of line voltages UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
voltages
859 Analog2Object 0x384 18 Max of line Maximum of line voltages UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
voltages
860 Analog2Object 0x384 19 Min. of Minimum of phase voltages UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
phase
voltages
861 Analog2Object 0x384 20 Max. of Maximum of phase voltages UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
phase
voltages
862 Analog2Object 0x384 21 RMS Mean RMS voltage UDINT 4 1= 0 450000 0 Get
voltage 1Vrms
mean
863 Analog2Object 0x384 22 Input Input voltage UL1RMS UDINT 4 1= 0 450000 0 Get
voltage 1Vrms
UL1RMS
864 Analog2Object 0x384 23 Input Input voltage UL2RMS UDINT 4 1= 0 450000 0 Get
voltage 1Vrms
UL2RMS
865 Analog2Object 0x384 24 Input Input voltage UL3RMS UDINT 4 1= 0 450000 0 Get
voltage 1Vrms
UL3RMS

Parameter List
866 Analog2Object 0x384 25 U12 U12 demand UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
demand
867 Analog2Object 0x384 26 U23 U23 demand UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
demand

Appendix A
868 Analog2Object 0x384 27 U31 U31 demand UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
demand
445
446

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
869 Analog2Object 0x384 28 UL1 UL1 demand UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
demand

Parameter List
870 Analog2Object 0x384 29 UL2 UL2 demand UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
demand
871 Analog2Object 0x384 30 UL3 UL3 demand UDINT 4 1 = 1V 0 450000 0 Get
demand
872 Analog2Object 0x384 31 Cosine phi Cosine phi DINT 4 1 = 0.01 0 767 Get
873 Analog2Object 0x384 32 Cosine of Cosine of phase L1 DINT 4 1 = 0.01 0 32767 Get
phase L1
874 Analog2Object 0x384 33 Cosine of Cosine of phase L2 DINT 4 1 = 0.01 0 32767 Get
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

phase L2
875 Analog2Object 0x384 34 Cosine of Cosine of phase L3 DINT 4 1 = 0.01 0 32767 Get
phase L3
876 Analog2Object 0x384 35 Phase L1 Phase L1 active power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
active kW
power
877 Analog2Object 0x384 36 Phase L2 Phase L2 active power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
active kW
power
878 Analog2Object 0x384 37 Phase L3 Phase L3 active power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
active kW
power
879 Analog2Object 0x384 38 Phase L1 Phase L1 reactive power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
reactive kVAR
power
880 Analog2Object 0x384 39 Phase L2 Phase L2 reactive power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
reactive kVAR
power
881 Analog2Object 0x384 40 Phase L3 Phase L3 reactive power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
reactive kVAR
power
882 Analog2Object 0x384 41 Phase L1 Phase L1 apparent power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
apparent kVA
power
883 Analog2Object 0x384 42 Phase L2 Phase L2 apparent power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
apparent kVA
power
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
884 Analog2Object 0x384 43 Phase L3 Phase L3 apparent power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
apparent kVA
power
885 Analog2Object 0x384 44 RMS active RMS active power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
power kW
886 Analog2Object 0x384 45 RMS RMS reactive power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
reactive kVAR
power
887 Analog2Object 0x384 46 RMS RMS apparent power DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
apparent kVA
power
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

888 Analog2Object 0x384 47 Active Active power demand DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
power kW
demand
889 Analog2Object 0x384 48 Reactive Reactive power demand DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
power kVAR
demand
890 Analog2Object 0x384 49 Apparent Apparent power demand DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
power kVA
demand
891 Analog2Object 0x384 50 Power Demand Power factor DINT 4 1 = 0.01 -100 +100 0 Get
factor Range -1 to +1
demand (Internal range to 65000)
892 Analog2Object 0x384 51 RMS active RMS active power demand DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
power kW
demand
893 Analog2Object 0x384 52 RMS RMS reactive power demand DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
reactive kVAR
power
demand
894 Analog2Object 0x384 53 RMS RMS apparent power demand DINT 4 1=1 0 999999.999 0 Get
apparent kVA
power

Parameter List
demand
895 Analog2Object 0x384 54 T> T> Estimated time to trip UDINT 4 1 0 4294967296 0 Get
Estimated
time to trip

Appendix A
896 Analog2Object 0x385 170 Virtual Virtual output 1 BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
output 1 1=On
447
448

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
897 Analog2Object 0x385 171 Virtual Virtual output 2 BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
output 2

Parameter List
1=On
898 Analog2Object 0x385 172 Virtual Virtual output 3 BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
output 3 1=On
899 Analog2Object 0x385 173 Virtual Virtual output 4 BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
output 4 1=On
900 Analog2Object 0x385 174 Virtual Virtual output 5 BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
output 5 1=On
901 Analog2Object 0x385 175 Virtual Virtual output 6 BOOL 1 1 0=Off 0 Get/Set
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

output 6 1=On
902 Analog2Object 0x384 55 Phase Phase current IL1 UDINT 4 1=1A 0 2000 0 Get
current IL1
903 Analog2Object 0x384 56 Phase Phase current IL2 UDINT 4 1=1A 0 2000 0 Get
current IL2
904 Analog2Object 0x384 57 Phase Phase current IL3 UDINT 4 1=1A 0 2000 0 Get
current IL3
905 Analog2Object 0x384 58 Pos. Positive Sequence I1 UDINT 4 1=1A 0 2000 0 Get
sequence I1
906 Analog2Object 0x384 59 Neg. Negative Sequence I2 UDINT 4 1=1A 0 2000 0 Get
sequence I2
907 Analog2Object 0x384 60 Current - Current -seq./+seq. UDINT 4 1= 0 1000 0 Get
seq./+seq. 0.1%
908 Analog2Object 0x384 61 Voltage - Voltage -seq./+seq. DINT 4 1= 0 1000 0 Get
seq./+seq. 0.1%
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
909 Analog2Object 0x384 62 AI_AlarmSt AI Alarm State Miscellaneous UDINT 4 1 Bit 0: Sensor 1 Short Circuited 0 Get
ateMisc Bit 1: Sensor 2 Short Circuited
Bit 2: Sensor 3 Short Circuited
Bit 3: Sensor 4 Short Circuited
Bit 4: Sensor 5 Short Circuited
Bit 5: Sensor 6 Short Circuited
Bit 6: Sensor 7 Short Circuited
Bit 7: Sensor 8 Short Circuited
Bit 8: Sensor 9 Short Circuited
Bit 9: Sensor 10 Short Circuited
Bit 10: Sensor 11 Short Circuited
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

Bit 11: Sensor 12 Short Circuited


Bit 12: Sensor 13 Short Circuited
Bit 13: Sensor 14 Short Circuited
Bit 14: Sensor 15 Short Circuited
Bit 15: Sensor 16 Short Circuited
Bit 16: Sensor 1 Open Circuit
Bit 17: Sensor 2 Open Circuit
Bit 18: Sensor 3 Open Circuit
Bit 19: Sensor 4 Open Circuit
Bit 20: Sensor 5 Open Circuit
Bit 21: Sensor 6 Open Circuit
Bit 22: Sensor 7 Open Circuit
Bit 23: Sensor 8 Open Circuit
Bit 24: Sensor 9 Open Circuit
Bit 25: Sensor 10 Open Circuit
Bit 26: Sensor 11 Open Circuit
Bit 27: Sensor 12 Open Circuit
Bit 28: Sensor 13 Open Circuit
Bit 29: Sensor 14 Open Circuit
Bit 30: Sensor 15 Open Circuit
Bit 31: Sensor 16 Open Circuit

0=Off

Parameter List
1=On
910 Analog2Object 0x384 63 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 2nd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 2
911 Analog2Object 0x384 64 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 3rd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get

Appendix A
of IL1, 3
449
450

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
912 Analog2Object 0x384 65 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 4th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 4

Parameter List
913 Analog2Object 0x384 66 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 5th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 5
914 Analog2Object 0x384 67 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 6th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 6
915 Analog2Object 0x384 68 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 7th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 7
916 Analog2Object 0x384 69 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 8th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 8
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

917 Analog2Object 0x384 70 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 9th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 9
918 Analog2Object 0x384 71 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 10th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 10
919 Analog2Object 0x384 72 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 11th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 11
920 Analog2Object 0x384 73 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 12th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 12
921 Analog2Object 0x384 74 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 13th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 13
922 Analog2Object 0x384 75 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 14th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 14
923 Analog2Object 0x384 76 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL1, 15th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL1, 15
924 Analog2Object 0x384 77 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 2nd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 2
925 Analog2Object 0x384 78 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 3rd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 3
926 Analog2Object 0x384 79 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 4th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 4
927 Analog2Object 0x384 80 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 5th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 5
928 Analog2Object 0x384 81 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 6th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 6
929 Analog2Object 0x384 82 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 7th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 7
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
930 Analog2Object 0x384 83 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 8th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 8
931 Analog2Object 0x384 84 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 9th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 9
932 Analog2Object 0x384 85 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 10th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 10
933 Analog2Object 0x384 86 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 11th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 11
934 Analog2Object 0x384 87 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 12th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 12
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

935 Analog2Object 0x384 88 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 13th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 13
936 Analog2Object 0x384 89 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 14th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 14
937 Analog2Object 0x384 90 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL2, 15th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL2, 15
938 Analog2Object 0x384 91 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 2nd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 2
939 Analog2Object 0x384 92 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 3rd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 3
940 Analog2Object 0x384 93 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 4th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 4
941 Analog2Object 0x384 94 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 5th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 5
942 Analog2Object 0x384 95 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 6th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 6
943 Analog2Object 0x384 96 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 7th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 7
944 Analog2Object 0x384 97 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 8th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 8

Parameter List
945 Analog2Object 0x384 98 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 9th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 9
946 Analog2Object 0x384 99 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 10th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 10

Appendix A
947 Analog2Object 0x384 100 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 11th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 11
451
452

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
948 Analog2Object 0x384 101 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 12th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 12

Parameter List
949 Analog2Object 0x384 102 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 13th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 13
950 Analog2Object 0x384 103 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 14th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 14
951 Analog2Object 0x384 104 Harmonics Harmonic content of IL3, 15th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of IL3, 15
952 Analog2Object 0x384 105 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 2nd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 2
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

953 Analog2Object 0x384 106 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 3rd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 3
954 Analog2Object 0x384 107 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 4th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 4
955 Analog2Object 0x384 108 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 5th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 5
956 Analog2Object 0x384 109 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 6th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 6
957 Analog2Object 0x384 110 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 7th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 7
958 Analog2Object 0x384 111 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 8th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 8
959 Analog2Object 0x384 112 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 9th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 9
960 Analog2Object 0x384 113 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 10th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 10
961 Analog2Object 0x384 114 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 11th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 11
962 Analog2Object 0x384 115 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 12th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 12
963 Analog2Object 0x384 116 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 13th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 13
964 Analog2Object 0x384 117 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 14th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 14
965 Analog2Object 0x384 118 Harmonics Harmonic content of U12, 15th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U12, 15
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
966 Analog2Object 0x384 119 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 2nd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 2
967 Analog2Object 0x384 120 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 3rd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 3
968 Analog2Object 0x384 121 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 4th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 4
969 Analog2Object 0x384 122 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 5th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 5
970 Analog2Object 0x384 123 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 6th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 6
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

971 Analog2Object 0x384 124 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 7th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 7
972 Analog2Object 0x384 125 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 8th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 8
973 Analog2Object 0x384 126 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 9th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 9
974 Analog2Object 0x384 127 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 10th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 10
975 Analog2Object 0x384 128 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 11th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 11
976 Analog2Object 0x384 129 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 12th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 12
977 Analog2Object 0x384 130 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 13th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 13
978 Analog2Object 0x384 131 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 14th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 14
979 Analog2Object 0x384 132 Harmonics Harmonic content of U23, 15th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of U23, 15
980 Analog2Object 0x384 133 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 2nd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 2

Parameter List
981 Analog2Object 0x384 134 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 3rd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 3
982 Analog2Object 0x384 135 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 4th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 4

Appendix A
983 Analog2Object 0x384 136 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 5th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 5
453
454

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
984 Analog2Object 0x384 137 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 6th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 6

Parameter List
985 Analog2Object 0x384 138 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 7th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 7
986 Analog2Object 0x384 139 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 8th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 8
987 Analog2Object 0x384 140 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 9th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 9
988 Analog2Object 0x384 141 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 10th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 10
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

989 Analog2Object 0x384 142 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 11th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 11
990 Analog2Object 0x384 143 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 12th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 12
991 Analog2Object 0x384 144 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 13th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 13
992 Analog2Object 0x384 145 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 14th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 14
993 Analog2Object 0x384 146 Harmonics Harmonic content of Uo, 15th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of Uo, 15
994 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 147 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 2nd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 2
995 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 148 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 3rd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 3
996 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 149 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 4th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 4
997 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 150 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 5th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 5
998 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 151 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 6th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 6
999 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 152 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 7th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 7
1000 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 153 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 8th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 8
1001 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 154 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 9th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 9
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
1002 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 155 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 10th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 10
1003 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 156 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 11th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 11
1004 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 157 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 12th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 12
1005 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 158 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 13th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 13
1006 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 159 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 14th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 14
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

1007 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 160 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L1, 15th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L1, 15
1008 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 161 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 2nd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 2
1009 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 162 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 3rd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 3
1010 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 163 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 4th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 4
1011 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 164 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 5th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 5
1012 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 165 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 6th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 6
1013 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 166 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 7th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 7
1014 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 167 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 8th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 8
1015 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 168 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 9th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 9
1016 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 169 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 10th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 10

Parameter List
1017 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 170 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 11th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 11
1018 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 171 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 12th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 12

Appendix A
1019 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 172 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 13th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 13
455
456

Appendix A
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
1020 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 173 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 14th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 14

Parameter List
1021 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 174 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L2, 15th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L2, 15
1022 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 175 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 2nd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 2
1023 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 176 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 3rd harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 3
1024 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 177 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 4th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 4
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

1025 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 178 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 5th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 5
1026 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 179 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 6th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 6
1027 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 180 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 7th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 7
1028 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 181 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 8th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 8
1029 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 182 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 9th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 9
1030 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 183 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 10th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 10
1031 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 184 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 11th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 11
1032 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 185 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 12th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 12
1033 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 186 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 13th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 13
1034 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 187 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 14th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 14
1035 Analog2Object(2) 0x384 188 Harmonics Harmonic content of I'L3, 15th harmonic UDINT 4 1%=1 0 500 0 Get
of I'L3, 15
1100 Ethernet(3) NA NA Requested Requested packet interval time UDINT 4 1 50000 5000000 100000 Get/Set
packet
interval
time
Param Group CIP Attribute Parameter Description Type Data Scale Min Max Default Mode
No. Class ID Number Name Size Factor
Code (bytes)
1101 Ethernet (3) NA NA Controller Controller Output Image 100 Size UDINT 4 1=1 Get
Output bytes
Image 100
Size
1102 Ethernet (3) NA NA Controller Controller Input Image 150 Size UDINT 4 1=1 Get
Input bytes
Image 150
Size
1003 DeviceNet (4) NA NA Controller Controller Output Image 100 Size UDINT 4 1=1 Get
Output bytes
Image 100
Size
Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018

1004 DeviceNet (4) NA NA Controller Controller Input Image 150 Size UINT 2 1=1 Get
Input bytes
Image 150
Size
(1) Only available with Arc flash option.
(2) Only used on Bulletin 856.
(3) DeviceNet not available.
(4) Not used with EtherNet.
(5) Indexed values, Bit 0 = DC component, Bit 1 = Fundamental wave, Bits 2…15 = Harmonic component active.
(6) Range and 1 = 0.01 < scaling vary by linked parameter that is selected. See publication 857-UM002.

Parameter List
Appendix A
457
Appendix A Parameter List

Notes:

458 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Appendix B

Modbus Parameter List

Overview This appendix lists all Modbus parameters that are associated with the Bulletin
857 protection system. The parameters are listed in the numerical order of the
holding register. This table includes all holding registers. Depending on the
model and options enabled, some registers are not be available in the device.
Table 220 - Modbus Parameters
Name Scaling Setting for Scaling Read Write The Holding Register Note
Reread event 1=1 — 1 0 401991…401995 Mirror of registers
402490…402494
Events 1=1 — 1 0 401996…402000 Mirror of registers
402101…4021
05
Alive indicator (0…255 increments once 1=1 — 1 0 402001
per second)
Digital Inputs 1=1 — 1 0 402007
Dis after DI16 for Modbus 1=1 — 1 0 402008
Phase current IL1 1 A= 1 — 1 0 402009
Phase current IL2 1 A= 1 — 1 0 402010
Phase current IL3 1A=1 — 1 0 402011
lo1 residual current 1.00 A = 100 — 1 0 402012
lo2 residual current 1.000 A = 100 — 1 0 402013
Line-to-line voltage U12 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 402014
Line-to-line voltage U23 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 402015
Line-to-line voltage U31 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 402016
Phase-to-earth voltage UL1 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 402017
Phase-to-earth voltage UL2 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 402018
Phase-to-earth voltage UL3 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 402019
Zero sequence voltage 1.0% = 10 — 1 0 402020
Frequency 50.000 Hz= 5000 Frequency Scaling 1 0 402021
Active power 1 000 Kw = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 402022
Reactive power 1 000 kVAR = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 402023
Apparent power 1000 kVA = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 402024
Power factor 1.00 = 100 PF and cosine Scaling 1 0 402025
Energy Eexp 1=1 — 1 0 402026
Eexp/1 O^4 10^4 = 1 — 1 0 402027
Eexp/1 O^8 10^8 = 1 — 1 0 402028

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 459


Appendix B Modbus Parameter List

Table 220 - Modbus Parameters (Continued)


Name Scaling Setting for Scaling Read Write The Holding Register Note
Energy EqExp 1=1 — 1 0 402029
EqExp/10^4 10^4 = 1 — 1 0 402030
EqExp/10^8 10^8 = 1 — 1 0 402031
Energy Eimp 1=1 — 1 0 402032
Eimp/10^4 10^4 = 1 — 1 0 402033
Eimp/10^8 10^8 = 1 — 1 0 402034
Energy EqImp 1=1 — 1 0 402035
EqImp/10^4 10^4 = 1 — 1 0 402036
EqImp/10^8 10^8 = 1 — 1 0 402037
Tan phi 1.000 = 1000 Tan phi Scaling 1 0 402038
Phase current IL 1A=1 — 1 0 402039
Average line voltage 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 402040
Average phase voltage 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 402041
Obj1 state Open = 0, Close = 1, — 1 0 402042
Undef = 2
Obj2 state Open = 0, Close = 1, — 1 0 402043
Undef = 2
Obj3 state Open = 0, Close = 1, — 1 0 402044
Undef = 2
Obj4 state Open = 0, Close = 1, — 1 0 402045
Undef = 2
Obj5 state Open = 0, Close = 1, — 1 0 402046
Undef = 2
Obj6 state Open = 0, Close = 1, — 1 0 402047
Undef = 2
Remote/Local State Remote = 0 Local = 1 — 1 1 402048
Output relays 1=1 — 1 0 402049
Obj7 state Open = 0, Close = 1, — 1 0 402050
Undef = 2
Obj8 state Open = 0, Close = 1, — 1 0 402051
Undef = 2
Digital inputs 21…32 1=1 1 0 402052
Run hours/10^0 to Modbus 1=1 — 1 0 402057
Run hours/10^4 to Modbus 1=1 — 1 0 402058
Engine running seconds 1s=1 — 1 1 402059
Start counter 1=1 — 1 1 402060
Phase current I'L1 1A=1 — 1 0 402061
Phase current I'L2 1A=1 — 1 0 402062
Phase current I'L3 1A=1 — 1 0 402063
IL1 difference 1.00 x In = 100 — 1 0 402064
IL2 difference 1.00 x In = 100 — 1 0 402065
IL3 difference 1.00 x In = 100 — 1 0 402066
Events 1=1 — 1 0 402101…402105

460 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Modbus Parameter List Appendix B

Table 220 - Modbus Parameters (Continued)


Name Scaling Setting for Scaling Read Write The Holding Register Note
Event code — 402101
Event Time Stamp: — 402102
bits 15…6 = milliseconds,
bits 5…0 = seconds
Event Time Stamp: — 402103
upper byte = minutes, lower byte =
hours
Event Time Stamp: — 402104
upper byte = days, lower byte = month
Event Time Stamp — 402105
Last fault current 1.00 x In = 100 — 1 1 402110
Fault current 1.00 x In = 100 — 1 0 402111
Fault current 1.00 x In = 100 — 1 0 402112
Fault current 1.00 x In = 100 — 1 0 402113
Fault reactance 1.00 ohm = 100 — 1 0 402115
Algorithm condition OK = 0, NegX = 1 — 1 0 402116
BigX = 2, LongFlt =3
NoDI = 4, NoPreFlt = 5
NoPostFlt = 6, ShrtFlt = 7
Alarm L1…L3: 1=1 — 1 0 402121
bit 0 = L1
bit 1 = L2
bit 2 = L3
Fault L1…L3: 1=1 — 1 0 402122
bit 0 = L1
bit 1 = L2
bit 2 = L3
Last fault Io current 1.00 pu = 100 — 1 0 402130
Fault current 1.00 pu = 100 — 1 0 402131
Fault current 1.00 pu = 100 — 1 0 402132
Fault current 1.00 pu = 100 — 1 0 402133
Fault current 1.00 pu = 100 — 1 0 402134
Diagnostic register 1 1=1 — 1 0 402191
Diagnostic register 2 1=1 — 1 0 402192
Diagnostic register 3 1=1 — 1 0 402193
Diagnostic register 4 1=1 — 1 0 402194
HARMONICS of IL1: 1% = 1 — 1 0 402201…402216
402201 = DC component,
402202 = 1. Harmonic,

402216 = 15. Harmonic
HARMONICS of IL2 1% = 1 — 1 0 402221…402236 Format same as
402201…402216
HARMONICS of IL3 1% = 1 — 1 0 402241…402256 Format same as
402201…402216

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 461


Appendix B Modbus Parameter List

Table 220 - Modbus Parameters (Continued)


Name Scaling Setting for Scaling Read Write The Holding Register Note
HARMONICS of Ua 1% = 1 — 1 0 402301…402316 Format same as
402201…402216
HARMONICS of Ub 1% = 1 — 1 0 402321…402336 Format same as
402201…402216
HARMONICS of Uc 1% = 1 — 1 0 402341…402356 Format same as
402201…402216
HARMONICS of I'L1 1% = 1 — 1 0 402401…402416 Format same as
402201…402216
HARMONICS of I'L2 1% = 1 — 1 0 402421…402436 Format same as
402201…402216
6
HARMONICS of I'L3 1% = 1 — 1 0 402441…402456 Format same as
402201…402216
Reread event 1=1 — 1 0 402490…402494
Release latches Release = 1 — 1 1 402501
Synchronize minutes 1=1 — 1 1 402502
Grp. 2 remote Scaling 1% = 1 — 1 1 402503
Set RTC: 1=1 — 0 1 402504…402507
402504 = seconds,
402505 upper byte =minutes
402505 lower byte = hours
402506 upper byte = day
402506 lower byte = month
402507 = year
Open select Obj1 1=1 — 1 1 402508
Close select Obj1 1=1 — 1 1 402509
Execute operation Obj1 1=1 — 0 1 402510
Max ctrl pulse length of Obj1 1.00 s = 100 — 1 1 402511
Open select Obj2 1=1 — 1 1 402512
Close select Obj2 1=1 — 1 1 402513
Execute operation Obj2 1=1 — 0 1 402514
Max ctrl pulse length of Obj2 1.00 s = 100 — 1 1 402515
Cancel selected operation 1=1 — 0 1 402516
Open select Obj3 1=1 — 1 1 402517
Close select Obj3 1=1 — 1 1 402518
Execute operation Obj3 1=1 — 0 1 402519
Max ctrl pulse length of Obj3 1.00 s = 100 — 1 1 402520
Open select Obj4 1=1 — 1 1 402521
Close select Obj4 1=1 — 1 1 402522
Execute operation Obj4 1=1 — 0 1 402523
Max ctrl pulse length of Obj4 1.00 s = 100 — 1 1 402524
Ambient temperature 1 °C (33.8 °F)= 100 — 1 1 402525
SetGrp common change 1 = 0, 2 = 1 — 1 1 402526

462 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Modbus Parameter List Appendix B

Table 220 - Modbus Parameters (Continued)


Name Scaling Setting for Scaling Read Write The Holding Register Note
Open select Obj5 1=1 — 1 1 402527
Close select Obj5 1=1 — 1 1 402528
Execute operation Obj5 1=1 — 0 1 402529
Max ctrl pulse length of Obj5 1.00 s = 100 — 1 1 402530
Open select Obj6 1=1 — 1 1 402531
Close select Obj6 1=1 — 1 1 402532
Execute operation Obj6 1=1 — 0 1 402533
Max ctrl pulse length of Obj6 1.00 s = 100 — 1 1 402534
Reset diagnostics Reset = 1 — 1 1 402535
Clear min and max Clear = 1 — 1 1 402536
Pos. sequence I1 1A=1 — 1 0 403001
Neg. sequence I2 1A=1 — 1 0 403002
Current -seq./+seq. 1.0% = 10 — 1 0 403003
Current phase seq. ?? = 0, OK = 1, Reverse = 2 — 1 0 403004
Phase current THD 1.0% = 10 — 1 0 403005
IL1 THD 1.0% = 10 — 1 0 403006
IL2 THD 1.0% = 10 — 1 0 403007
IL3 THD 1.0% = 10 — 1 0 403008
Phase current IL 1A=1 — 1 0 403009
Min. of IL1 IL2 IL3 1A=1 — 1 0 403010
Max. of IL1 IL2 IL3 1A=1 — 1 0 403011
Phase current ILRMS 1 A rms = 1 — 1 0 403012
Phase current IL1RMS 1 A rms = 1 — 1 0 403015
Phase current IL2RMS 1 A rms = 1 — 1 0 403016
Phase current IL3RMS 1 A rms = 1 — 1 0 403017
Temperature rise 1.0% = 10 — 1 1 403018
Ambient temperature 1 °C = 100 — 1 1 403019
IL1da demand 1A=1 — 1 0 403020
IL2da demand 1A=1 — 1 0 403021
IL3da demand 1A=1 — 1 0 403022
IoCalc demand 1.00 pu = 100 — 1 0 403023
Io1 demand 1.000 pu = 1000 — 1 0 403024
Io2 demand 1.000 pu = 1000 — 1 0 403025
Pos. sequence U1 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403031
Neg. sequence U2 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403032
Voltage -seq./+seq. 1.0% = 10 — 1 0 403033
Voltage phase seq. ?? = 0, OK = 1, Reverse = 2 — 1 0 403034
Voltage THD 1.0% = 10 — 1 0 403035
Ua THD 1.0% = 10 — 1 0 403036

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 463


Appendix B Modbus Parameter List

Table 220 - Modbus Parameters (Continued)


Name Scaling Setting for Scaling Read Write The Holding Register Note
Ub THD 1.0% = 10 — 1 0 403037
Uc THD 1.0% = 10 — 1 0 403038
Average line voltage 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403039
Min of line voltages 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403040
Max of line voltages 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403041
Average phase voltage 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403042
Min. of phase voltages 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403043
Max. of phase voltages 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403044
Voltage mean 1000V rms = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403045
Input voltage Ua 1000V rms = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403048
Input voltage Ub 1000V rms = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403049
Input voltage Uc 1000V rms = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403050
U12 demand 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403051
U23 demand 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403052
U31 demand 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403053
UL1 demand 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403054
UL2 demand 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403055
UL3 demand 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403056
Cosine phi 1.00 = 100 PF and cos Scaling 1 0 403058
Tan phii 1.000 = 1000 Tan phi Scaling 1 0 403059
Power angle 1° = 1 — 1 0 403060
RMS active power 1000 kW = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 403061
RMS reactive power 1000 kVAR = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 403062
RMS apparent power 1000 kVA = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 403063
Active power demand 1000 kW = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 403066
Reactive power demand 1000 kVAR = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 403067
Apparent power demand 1000 kVA = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 403068
Power factor demand 1.00 = 100 PF and cos Scaling 1 0 403069
RMS active power demand 1000 kW = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 403071
RMS reactive power demand 1000 kVAR = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 403072
RMS apparent power demand 1000 kVA = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 403073
Phase L1 active power 1000 kW = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 403081
Phase L2 active power 1000 kW = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 403082
Phase L3 active power 1000 kW = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 403083
Phase L1 reactive power 1000 kVAR = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 403084
Phase L2 reactive power 1000 kVAR = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 403085
Phase L3 reactive power 1000 kVAR = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 403086
Phase L1 apparent power 1000 kVA = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 403087
Phase L2 apparent power 1000 kVA = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 403088

464 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Modbus Parameter List Appendix B

Table 220 - Modbus Parameters (Continued)


Name Scaling Setting for Scaling Read Write The Holding Register Note
Phase L3 apparent power 1000 kVA = 1000 Power Scaling 1 0 403089
Cosine of phase L1 1.00 = 100 PF and cos Scaling 1 0 403090
Cosine of phase L2 1.00 = 100 PF and cos Scaling 1 0 403091
Cosine of phase L3 1.00 = 100 PF and cos Scaling 1 0 403092
Frequency fy 50.000 Hz = 5000 Frequency Scaling 1 0 403101 Synchrocheck
Line-to-line voltage U12y 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403102 Synchrocheck
Synchrocheck 1-Phase angle difference 1° = 1 — 1 0 403103 Synchrocheck
Frequency fz 50.000 Hz = 5000 Frequency Scaling 1 0 403111 Synchrocheck
Line-to-line voltage U12z 1000V = 1000 Voltage Scaling 1 0 403112 Synchrocheck
Synchrocheck 2-Phase angle difference 1° = 1 — 1 0 403113 Synchrocheck
Positive sequence I'1 1A=1 — 1 0 403151
Negative sequence I'1 1A=1 — 1 0 403152
Current I' -seq./+seq. 1.0% = 10 — 1 0 403153
Current I' phase sequence ?? = 0, OK = 1, Reverse = 2 — 1 0 403154
Phase current I'THD 1.0% = 10 — 1 0 403155
I'L1 THD 1.0% = 10 — 1 0 403156
I'L2 THD 1.0% = 10 — 1 0 403157
I'L3 THD 1.0% = 10 — 1 0 403158
Phase current I'L 1A=1 — 1 0 403159
Min. of I'L1, I'L2, I'L3 1A=1 — 1 0 403160
Max. of I'L1, I'L2, I'L3 1A=1 — 1 0 403161
Phase current I'Lrms 1 A rms = 1 — 1 0 403162
Phase current I'L1rms 1 A rms = 1 — 1 0 403165
Phase current I'L2rms 1 A rms = 1 — 1 0 403166
Phase current I'L3rms 1 A rms = 1 — 1 0 403167
DI1 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403301
DI2 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403302
DI3 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403303
DI4 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403304
DI5 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403305
DI6 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403306
DI7 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403307
DI8 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403308
DI9 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403309
DI10 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403310
DI11 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403311
DI12 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403312
DI13 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403313
DI14 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403314

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 465


Appendix B Modbus Parameter List

Table 220 - Modbus Parameters (Continued)


Name Scaling Setting for Scaling Read Write The Holding Register Note
DI15 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403315
DI16 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403316
DI17 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403317
DI18 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403318
DI19 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403319 Optional DI19/
DI20 card
DI20 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403320 Optional DI19/
DI20 card
DI21 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403350
DI22 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403351
DI23 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403352
DI24 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403353
DI25 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403354
DI26 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403355
DI27 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403356
DI28 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403357
DI29 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403358
DI30 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403359
DI31 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403360
DI32 counter 1=1 — 1 1 403361
Shot1 start counter 1=1 — 1 1 403331
Shot2 start counter 1=1 — 1 1 403332
Shot3 start counter 1=1 — 1 1 403333
Shot4 start counter 1=1 — 1 1 403334
Shot5 start counter 1=1 — 1 1 403335
AR start counter 1=1 — 1 1 403336
AR fail counter 1=1 — 1 1 403337
AR shot number 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, END = 6 — 1 0 403402
Critical AR req. 1=1 — 1 0 403403
Reclose locked 1=1 — 1 0 403404
Reclose running 1=1 — 1 0 403405
Final trip 1=1 — 1 0 403406
Autoreclose on 1=1 — 1 0 403407
Motor Starting 1=1 1 0 403411
Motor Running 1=1 1 0 403412
Voltage interrupt LOW = 0, OK = 1 — 1 0 403413
Voltage status OK = 0, LOW = 1, — 1 0 403414
HIGH = 3, (OK) = 4
(LOW) = 5 (HIGH) = 6
(LOW)/(HIGH) = 7
Timer 1 status 0 = 1, 1 = 2 — 1 1 403415

466 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Modbus Parameter List Appendix B

Table 220 - Modbus Parameters (Continued)


Name Scaling Setting for Scaling Read Write The Holding Register Note
Timer 2 status 0 = 1, 1 = 2 — 1 1 403416
Timer 3 status 0 = 1, 1 = 2 — 1 1 403417
Timer 4 status 0 = 1, 1 = 2 — 1 1 403418
Logic output states 1…10 1=1 — 1 0 403419
CBWAlarm 1 1=1 — 1 0 403420
CBWAlarm 2 1=1 — 1 0 403421
Logic output states 9…16 1=1 — 1 0 403422
Logic output states 17…20 1=1 — 1 0 403423
Virtual outputs 0, 1 — 1 0 403426
Virtual input 1 0, 1 — 1 1 403427
Virtual input 2 0, 1 — 1 1 403428
Virtual input 3 0, 1 — 1 1 403429
Virtual input 4 0, 1 — 1 1 403430
Synchrocheck 1 request 1=1 — 1 0 403431
Synchrocheck 1 OK 1=1 — 1 0 403432
Synchrocheck 1 bypass 1=1 — 1 1 403433
Synchrocheck 1 fail 1=1 — 1 0 403434
Synchrocheck 2 request 1=1 — 1 0 403441
Synchrocheck 2 OK 1=1 — 1 0 403442
Synchrocheck 2 bypass 1=1 — 1 1 403443
Synchrocheck 2 fail 1=1 — 1 0 403444
Logic Cntr1 1=1 — 1 0 403451
Logic Cntr2 1=1 — 1 0 403452
Logic Cntr3 1=1 — 1 0 403453
Logic Cntr4 1=1 — 1 0 403454
Logic Cntr5 1=1 — 1 0 403455
Logic Cntr6 1=1 — 1 0 403456
External AI1 1.00 °C (33.8 °F) = 100 — 1 0 403500 External I/O must
be active
External AI2 1.00 °C (33.8 °F) = 100 — 1 0 403501 External I/O must
be active
External AI3 1.00 °C (33.8 °F) = 100 — 1 0 403502 External I/O must
be active
External AI4 1.00 °C (33.8 °F) = 100 — 1 0 403503 External I/O must
be active
External AI5 1.00 °C (33.8 °F) = 100 — 1 0 403504 External I/O must
be active
External AI6 1.00 °C (33.8 °F) = 100 — 1 0 403505 External I/O must
be active
External AI7 1.00 °C (33.8 °F) = 100 — 1 0 403506 External I/O must
be active
External AI8 1.00 °C (33.8 °F) = 100 — 1 0 403507 External I/O must
be active

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 467


Appendix B Modbus Parameter List

Table 220 - Modbus Parameters (Continued)


Name Scaling Setting for Scaling Read Write The Holding Register Note
External AI9 1.00 °C (33.8 °F) = 100 — 1 0 403508 External I/O must
be active
External AI10 1.00 °C (33.8 °F) = 100 — 1 0 403509 External I/O must
be active
External AI11 1.00 °C (33.8 °F) = 100 — 1 0 403510 External I/O must
be active
External AI12 1.00 °C (33.8 °F) = 100 — 1 0 403511 External I/O must
be active
External AI13 1.00 °C (33.8 °F) = 100 — 1 0 403512 External I/O must
be active
External AI14 1.00 °C (33.8 °F) = 100 — 1 0 403513 External I/O must
be active
External AI15 1.00 °C (33.8 °F) = 100 — 1 0 403514 External I/O must
be active
External AI16 1.00 °C (33.8 °F) = 100 — 1 0 403515 External I/O must
be active
External DI1 1=1 — 1 0 403600
External DI2 1=1 — 1 0 403601
External DI3 1=1 — 1 0 403602
External DI4 1=1 — 1 0 403603
External DI5 1=1 — 1 0 403604
External DI6 1=1 — 1 0 403605
External DI7 1=1 — 1 0 403606
External DI8 1=1 — 1 0 403607
External DI9 1=1 — 1 0 403608
External DI10 1=1 — 1 0 403609
External DI11 1=1 — 1 0 403610
External DI12 1=1 — 1 0 403611
External DI13 1=1 — 1 0 403612
External DI14 1=1 — 1 0 403613
External DI15 1=1 — 1 0 403614
External DI16 1=1 — 1 0 403615
External DI17 1=1 — 1 0 403616
External DI18 1=1 — 1 0 403617
Minimum frequency 50.000 Hz = 50000 — 1 1 404001
Minimum active power 1 kW = 1 — 1 1 404002
Minimum react. power 1 kVAR = 1 — 1 1 404003
Minimum apparent power 1 kVA = 1 — 1 1 404004
Min power factor 1.000 = 1000 — 1 1 404005
Minimum of Io 1.0% = 10 — 1 1 404006
Minimum of Io2 1.0% = 10 — 1 1 404007
Minimum active power 1 kW = 1 — 1 1 404008
Minimum react. power 1 kVAR = 1 — 1 1 404009

468 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Modbus Parameter List Appendix B

Table 220 - Modbus Parameters (Continued)


Name Scaling Setting for Scaling Read Write The Holding Register Note
Minimum apparent power 1 kVA = 1 — 1 1 404010
15 min minimum power factor 1.000 = 1000 — 1 1 404011
Minimum active power 1 kW = 1 — 1 1 404012
Minimum react. power 1 kVAR = 1 — 1 1 404013
Minimum apparent power 1 kVA = 1 — 1 1 404014
Minimum of IL1 1A=1 — 1 1 404015
Minimum of IL2 1A=1 — 1 1 404016
Minimum of IL3 1A=1 — 1 1 404017
RMS minimum of IL1 1 A rms = 1 — 1 1 404018
RMS minimum of IL2 1 A rms = 1 — 1 1 404019
RMS minimum of IL3 1 A rms = 1 — 1 1 404020
Minimum of IL1 1A=1 — 1 1 404021
Minimum of IL2 1A=1 — 1 1 404022
Minimum of IL3 1A=1 — 1 1 404023
RMS minimum of IL1 1 A rms = 1 — 1 1 404024
RMS minimum of IL2 1 A rms = 1 — 1 1 404025
RMS minimum of IL3 1 A rms = 1 — 1 1 404026
Minimum of U12 1V = 1 — 1 1 404030
Minimum of U23 1V = 1 — 1 1 404031
Minimum of U31 1V = 1 — 1 1 404032
Maximum frequency 50.000 Hz = 50000 — 1 1 404101
Maximum active power 1 kW = 1 — 1 1 404102
Maximum react. power 1 kVAR = 1 — 1 1 404103
Maximum apparent power 1 kVA = 1 — 1 1 404104
Max power factor 1.000 = 1000 — 1 1 404105
Maximum of Io 1.0% = 10 — 1 1 404106
Maximum of Io2 1.0% = 10 — 1 1 404107
Maximum active power 1 kW = 1 — 1 1 404108
Maximum react. power 1 kVAR = 1 — 1 1 404109
Maximum apparent power 1 kVA = 1 — 1 1 404110
15 min Maximum power factor 1.000 = 1000 — 1 1 404111
Maximum active power 1 kW = 1 — 1 1 404112
Maximum react. power 1 kVAR = 1 — 1 1 404113
Maximum apparent power 1 kVA = 1 — 1 1 404114
Maximum of IL1 1A=1 — 1 1 404115
Maximum of IL2 1A=1 — 1 1 404116
Maximum of IL3 1A=1 — 1 1 404117
RMS Maximum of IL1 1 A rms = 1 — 1 1 404118
RMS Maximum of IL2 1 A rms = 1 — 1 1 404119

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 469


Appendix B Modbus Parameter List

Table 220 - Modbus Parameters (Continued)


Name Scaling Setting for Scaling Read Write The Holding Register Note
RMS Maximum of IL3 1 A rms = 1 — 1 1 404120
Maximum of IL1 1A=1 — 1 1 404121
Maximum of IL2 1A=1 — 1 1 404122
Maximum of IL3 1A=1 — 1 1 404123
RMS Maximum of IL1 1 A rms = 1 — 1 1 404124
RMS Maximum of IL2 1 A rms = 1 — 1 1 404125
RMS Maximum of IL3 1 A rms = 1 — 1 1 404126
Maximum of U12 1V = 1 — 1 1 404130
Maximum of U23 1V = 1 — 1 1 404131
(Maximum of U31 1V = 1 — 1 1 404132
Z12 primary impedance 1.00 Ω = 100 — 1 0 404201
Z23 primary impedance 1.00 Ω = 100 — 1 0 404202
Z31 primary impedance 1.00 Ω = 100 — 1 0 404203
Z12 secondary impedance 1.00 Ω = 100 — 1 0 404204
Z23 secondary impedance 1.00 Ω = 100 — 1 0 404205
Z31 secondary impedance 1.00 Ω = 100 — 1 0 404206
Z12 angle 1° = 1 — 1 0 404207
Z23 angle 1° = 1 — 1 0 404208
Z31 angle 1° = 1 — 1 0 404209
Diagnostics Registers 1=1 1 0 404372…404379

470 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Appendix C

Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000

There are two primary ways to connect to the relay using EtherNet I/P in
combination with a ControlLogix™ or CompactLogix™ platform using
Studio5000™ software.

1. Use a predefined static assembly in the 857 relay and apply an EDS AOP
within Studio 5000.
2. Create a custom input output assembly within the 857 in combination
with the use of a generic Ethernet module within Studio 5000.

Typical Hardware A basic hardware setup is shown in Figure .


Configuration

ControlLogix
Platform with
Ethernet Interface

Ethernet Switch

Ethernet
Serial (used for initial configuration)

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 471


Appendix C Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000

Configuring an I/O Profile Starting with version 13.01 firmware for the 857, an EDS AOP has been
defined to streamline the integration of the 857 within your EtherNet/IP
Using an EDS AOP network using Studio 5000 software. The use of an EDS AOP approach
provides a level of automation regarding the automatic configuration of the
input and output assembly in the 857 relay and the automatic configuration of
the tag information in the Logix environment.

To use the added functionality of an EDS AOP for the 857 relay, you must
determine which of the predefined static assemblies works best for your
specific application of the 857. The selection of the predefined static assembly
relates to the three basic criteria:
• What configuration are the devices providing three phase voltage
configured
• Is an 857-RAA RTD Scanner being used and,
• Is the protection mode either Motor Protection or Feeder Protection.

Table 146 provides information to determine which predefined static assembly


to use.

Select a Static Assembly

Follow these steps to select a predefined static assembly.

1. From the SetPointPS main screen, press the Communication button.

2. In the left pane, select EtherNet/IP main configuration.

3. Click the value next to I/O assembly instances in use.


4. From the pulldown menu, choose your desired static assembly.

472 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000 Appendix C

5. Press the button to write changes to the device.

Download the EDS File from the 857 Relay

Follow these steps to download the EDS file using SetPointPS.

1. In the SetPointPS toolbar, click Communication.

2. Select Get EtherNetIP EDS....

SetPointPS will read the EDS file from the device.


3. Save the EDS file to a desired location on your computer.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 473


Appendix C Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000

Register the EDS-based Device into Studio 5000

Follow these steps to install the EDS file into the Studio 5000 software.

1. In Studio 5000, click the Tool menu and select EDS Hardware
Installation Tool.
The Rockwell Automation® EDS Wizard opens.

Tools Menu

EDS Hardware
Installation Tool

2. In the Rockwell Automation EDS Wizard home screen, click Next.

474 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000 Appendix C

3. Select the Register an EDS file(s) radio button, and click Next.

4. Select Register a single file.


5. Click Browse and locate and select the EDS file you created in
Download the EDS File from the 857 Relay on page 473.

6. Click Next.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 475


Appendix C Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000

7. Verify a green check is next to your EDS file, and click Next.

8. In the Change Graphic Image dialog, click Next.

9. In the Final Task Summary Dialog, click Next.

10. Click Finish to complete the EDS Wizard.

476 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000 Appendix C

Configure Device Properties in Studio 5000

After the EDS device is registered per the procedure in Register the EDS-based
Device into Studio 5000 on page 474, you must configure the device
properties to match the static assembly selected in the 857 relay.

Follow these steps to configure the device properties.

1. In the RSLogix 5000 window, right-click the EtherNet/IP bridge.


2. Select New Module from the pop-up menu.
The New Module dialog opens.

Ethernet Bridge

New Module

3. In the Select Module Type dialog, select 857 in the Catalog Number
column.
4. Click Create.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 477


Appendix C Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000

5. In the New Module dialog:


a. Verify the module name is 857 Protection Relay
b. Verify the IP address is correct
c. Click Change in the Module Definition section.

6. In the Module Definition dialog, click the pulldown menu and choose
Static Advanced 2.

7. In the Logix Designer dialog, select Yes.

8. Click OK to create the module and complete the procedure.

478 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000 Appendix C

Configuring the 857 I/O No Custom AOP exists for the 857 protection relay when using RSLogix
5000®. If the 857 has firmware version13 or higher, an EDS AOP is available.
Profile Using the Ethernet /IP See Electronic Data Sheet (EDS) File on page 294 for more details.
Bridge
If used in a dynamic assembly (fully configurable), use the following steps. A
basic RSLogix 5000 Generic Profile is required.

There are four main tasks to configure the 857 relay using the EtherNet/IP
bridge.

Section Page
Set Connection Parameters in RSLogix 5000 479
Configuring the 857 for EtherNet/IP Using the Front Panel 482
Configuring the 857 for Ethernet/IP Using SetpointPS 484
Configure Produced/Consumed (CIP I/O) Image 487
Produced and Consuming Assemblies (CIP I/O) Data Table 488
Alignment

Set Connection Parameters in RSLogix 5000

1. In the RSLogix 5000 window, right-click the EtherNet/IP bridge.


2. Select New Module from the pop-up menu.
The New Module dialog opens.

Ethernet Bridge

New Module

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 479


Appendix C Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000

3. Expand the New Module tree and select ETHERNET-MODULE


(Generic Ethernet Module).

4. If 857 relay firmware less than release 10.96 is used, set connection
parameters as they appear in this graphic.

480 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000 Appendix C

5. If 857 relay firmware release 10.96 or greater is used, set connection


parameters as they appear in this graphic. Note the Assembly Instance
(high lighted in red) for the configuration parameter changes to 199.

Use SetpointPS programming software to determine input and output sizes as


defined by the CIP I/O configuration set. They can be set only when offline
with the processor. See Configuring the 857 for Ethernet/IP Using SetpointPS
on page 484.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 481


Appendix C Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000

Connection (RPI) time in the sample program is 200 ms. An I/O connection
with any 857 relay must be no less than 50 ms. To change the RPI value, click
the Connection tab in the Module Properties: EthernetIPBridge dialog.

Configuring the 857 for EtherNet/IP Using the Front Panel


The 857 relay is delivered without the EtherNet/IP protocol enabled. To
become familiar with the front panel and its operation see 857 Protection
System Front Panel on page 27. To enable the EtherNet/IP port, use the front
panel.

1. Press the info Key and enter key on the front panel
2. Enter the Relay password.

3. Navigate by using the up/down arrows to the COMM. OPTIONS level

482 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000 Appendix C

4. Navigate (use right/left arrows) to the ETHERNET PORT screen and


select Protocol (use the enter key).

5. Change Protocol to EtherNet/IP (bottom of list). Restart the relay


(shown by RESTART and progress bar at the top right corner). The
alternative to the RESTART function is to cycle power on the unit.

6. Set the desired IP address, subnet mask, and any other required Ethernet
attributes (specific to site network). Restart the relay.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 483


Appendix C Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000

7. Navigate (use right/left arrows) to the ETHERNET/IP screen to view


protocol-specific settings. The produced/consumed image sizes (in
bytes) can be viewed from this screen.

Configuring the 857 for Ethernet/IP Using SetpointPS

If SetpointPS programming software is the selected configuration method, it is


recommended to use the front serial port to connect to a computer. When
produced/consumed messaging is running between the 857 and controller, it is
not possible to establish a connection from the 857 to a computer through
EtherNet/IP.

For more information on how to use SetpointPS programming software see


Rockwell Publication 857-PM001.

To enable the EtherNet/IP port using SetpointPS:

1. Connect to the relay. Use the icon


2. Enter the password (default configuration is 2) and click OK to allow
access to the SetPointPS window.

484 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000 Appendix C

3. Scroll down the list and select PROTOCOL CONFIGURATION.


Change the Ethernet port protocol to EtherNet/IP, and change other
network values as required.

IMPORTANT When a parameter is shown as red in SetpointPS, it means that the offline
(project file) value is set but online it is not.

4. To (download) set new values in the relay, use the icon. A restart of
the relay can be required, depending on the values that are changed. If it
is, the following dialog appears.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 485


Appendix C Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000

The other method to restart is to cycle control power to the unit.


5. Scroll down to Ethernet/IP MAIN CONFIGURATION and view
protocol-specific parameters.

6. Select I/O assembly instances in use to 100+150. The relay will ask to be
rebooted again, (unless the assembly was already set to 100+150).
After the relay re-boots, the size (byte count) for each assembly is show
in this location.

IMPORTANT The producing and consuming instance sizes are shown in grey font,
indicating that they cannot be configured from this screen. The size for each
instance is dictated by the selections made in the input/output assembly.
You can configure the content of these assemblies.
It is also recommended that the Run/Idle Header selections remain with
their default values (Producing Assembly, de-selected, Consuming
Assembly, Selected).

486 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000 Appendix C

Configure Produced/Consumed (CIP I/O) Image

Use the SetpointPS programming software to configure the CIP I/O image.
Scroll to CIP I/O configuration to view the image parameters. The factory
default only shows one parameter in each assembly. You must add or remove
items that you want packaged in either assembly.

The valid parameters within each assembly are selectable by clicking in the area
below the Name area and by using a pull-down menu as shown below. The
parameters can be single word, double word, or 4 word elements (8, 16, or
32 bits).

Single and double byte pad words are available as required to allow for correct
word or double-word alignment in the image.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 487


Appendix C Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000

Produced and Consuming Assemblies (CIP I/O) Data Table


Alignment
Once the 100+150 CIP I/O image is configured in the 857 the Logix/Studio
5000 program, it is necessary to align the data words from the relay with the
data table in the controller. The offset value provides the byte count offset
value for that parameter.

The example below shows how the CIP I/O configuration Offset value aligns
with the single integer (SINT) array element in the controller data table.

488 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000 Appendix C

Once the data is transferred into the Logix controller, it is recommended that
you move the data into controller defined tags for further use, such that tag
naming can identify the purpose of the data. This image uses the following tag
names to identify their purposes, and Logix 5000 instructions to transfer the
data to them.

Figure 192 - Controller Tags

Figure 193 - Logix 5000 Ladder Logic Instructions

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 489


Appendix C Configuring the 857 Relay in Studio 5000

Notes:

490 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Glossary

The following terms and abbreviations are used throughout this manual. For
definitions of terms that are not listed here, see the Allen-Bradley® Industrial
Automation Glossary, publication AG-7.1.

AC contactor An alternating current (AC) contactor establishes or interrupts an AC power


circuit.

Altitude The atmospheric altitude (height above sea level) at which the motor is
operating; NEMA standards call for an altitude not to exceed1000 m (3300
ft). As the altitude increases above 1000 m (3300 ft) and the air density
decreases, the ability for the air to cool the motor decreases. For higher
altitudes, higher grades of insulation or motor derating are required. DC
motors require special brushes for operation at high altitudes.

Ambient temperature The temperature of the surrounding cooling medium, such as gas or liquid,
which comes into contact with the heated parts of the motor. The cooling
medium is usually the air that surrounds the motor. The standard NEMA
rating for ambient temperature is not to exceed 40 °C (104 °F).

American National Standards American National Standards Institute.  An organization that develops and
Institute (ANSI) publishes voluntary industry standards in the United States.

American Wire Gauge (AWG) A standard system that is used for designating the size of electrical conductors.
Gauge numbers have an inverse relationship to size; larger numbers have a
smaller cross-sectional area.  However, a single-strand conductor has a larger
cross-sectional area than a multi-strand conductor of the same gauge, so that
they have the same current-carrying specification.

ANSI American National Standards Institute. A standardization organization.

Approved Use of this term indicated that the device has been found acceptable by the
authority having jurisdiction.

Architecture Specific configuration of hardware and software elements in a system.

Authority Having Jurisdiction The entity that has authority to enforce the requirements of a code or standard,
or to approve equipment, materials, installations, or procedures.

Branch circuit The conductors and components following the last overcurrent protective
device protecting a load (as defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).

Branch circuit protection Overcurrent protection with an ampere rating that is selected to help protect
the branch circuit. For a motor branch circuit, the overcurrent protection is
required for overcurrents due to short circuits and faults to ground only (as
defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).

Branch circuit protective device A fuse or circuit breaker that has been evaluated to a safety standard for
providing overcurrent protection (as defined in UL 508A, December 28,
2007).

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 491


Glossary

CBFP Circuit breaker failure protection.

Circuit Breaker (CB) A device that is designed to open and close a circuit by non-automatic means.
And to open the circuit automatically on a pre-determined overcurrent,
without damage to itself when properly applied within its rating.

Class 1 circuit A control circuit on the load side of overcurrent protective device where the
voltage does not exceed 600 volts. Where the power available is not limited, or
control circuit on the load side of power is limiting the supply. Such as a
transformer (as defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).

Class 1 wiring Conductors of a Class 1 Circuit (as defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).

Class 2 circuit A control circuit that is supplied from a source having limited voltage (30V rms
or less0. And current capacity, such as from the secondary of a Class 2
transformer, and rated for use with Class 2 remote-control or signaling circuits
(as defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).

Coil 1. The electrical conductors wound into the core slot of a motor, electrically
insulated from the iron core. A group of coils is connected into circuits, or
windings, which carry independent current. These coils carry and produce a
magnetic field when a current pass through them.

2. A ladder diagram symbol that represents an output instruction.

Combination motor controller One or more devices that are assembled to provide a means to disconnect, the
branch circuit protection, motor control, and motor overload protection for a
motor circuit. As defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007.

Compensation Adjustment or alteration of a control system to improve performance.  A


compensator can be an electrical, mechanical, hydraulic, or pneumatic device.

Conductor A material, such as copper or aluminum, which offers low resistance or


opposition to the flow of electric current.

Conduit box The metal container usually on the side of the motor, where the stator (the
winding) leads are attached to leads that go to the power supply.

Control circuit A circuit that carries the electric signals that direct the performance of a
controller, and which does not carry the main power circuit. A control circuit
is, in most cases, limited to 15 amperes (as defined in UL 508A, December 28,
2007).

Control circuit transformer A transformer whose secondary supplies power to control circuit devices only
(excluding loads). As defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007.

Controller A device or group of devices that serves to govern, in some predetermined


manner, the electric power that is delivered to the apparatus to which it is
connected. As defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).

492 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Glossary

cosϕ Active power that is divided by apparent power = P/S. (See Chapter 5).
Negative sign indicates reverse power.

CT Current transformer.

CTPRI Nom primary value of current transformer.

CTSEC Nom secondary value of current transformer.

DC contactor A contactor that is designed to establish or interrupt a direct current (DC)


power circuit.

DC motor A motor that uses generated or rectified DC power. A DC motor is often used
when variable-speed operation is required.

Dead band See Hysteresis.

DI Digital input.

Disconnecting means A device that disconnects all ungrounded conductors of a circuit from their
electrical supply (as defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).

DO Digital output, output relay.

DSR Data set ready. An RS-232 signal. Input in front panel port of Allen-Bradley
relays to disable rear-panel local port.

Dry Potential free.

DST Daylight Savings Time. Adjusting the official local time forward by 1 hour for
summer time.

DT Definite Time.

DTR Data terminal ready. An RS232 signal. Output and always true (8 V DC) in
front panel port of Allen-Bradley relays.

FFT Fast Fourier transform. Algorithm to convert time domain signals to frequency
domain or to phasors.

Feeder circuit The conductors and circuitry on the supply side of the branch-circuit
overcurrent protective device (as defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).

Field installed equipment Devices to be installed after an industrial control panel is built/ labeled (as
defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).

Field wiring terminal A terminal that is provided in an industrial control panel to terminate field
wiring (as defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 493


Glossary

Frame 1. The supporting structure for the stator parts of an AC motor. In a DC


motor, the frame usually forms a part of the magnetic coil. The frame also
determines mounting dimensions.

2. The unit that is exchanged at the data link layer of a communication


network.

Frame size Refers to a set of physical dimensions of motors as established by NEMA.


These dimensions include critical mounting dimensions. NEMA 48 and 56
frame motors are considered fractional horsepower sizes even though they can
exceed 1 horsepower. NEMA 143T to 449T is considered integral horsepower
AC motors and 5000 series and above are called large motors. (For definition
of letters following frame number, see “Suffixes to NEMA frames” on
page 501.

Frequency The rate at which the alternating current makes a complete cycle of reversals. It
is expressed in cycles per second. In the U.S., 60 cycles (Hz) are the standard
while in other countries 50 Hz (cycles) is common. The frequency of the AC
current affects the speed of a motor.

Full-load current (FLC); Full-load The current flowing through the line when the motor is operating at full-load
Amperage (FLA) torque and full-load speed with rated frequency and voltage that is applied to
the motor terminals.

Full load torque The torque necessary to produce the rated horsepower at full-load speed.

General-purpose motor A general-purpose motor is any motor having a NEMA “B” design, which is
listed and offered in standard ratings, with standard operating characteristics
and mechanical construction for use under usual service conditions without
restriction to a particular application or type of application (NEMA).

General-use rating A rating, expressed in volts and amperes, which are assigned to a device that is
intended to control the following:
a. A load with a continuous or inrush ampere rating that does not
exceed the ampere rating of the device.
b. When AC rated, a load that has a power factor of 0.75…0.80
(inductive).
c. When DC rated, a load that is resistive (noninductive) (as defined in
UL 508A, December 28, 2007).

Hardware 1. Any mechanical, electrical, and electronic components and assemblies.

2. All physical components of a control system – including the controller,


peripherals, and the interconnecting wiring – as opposed to the software
components that control its operation. Compare with software
(programming).

494 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Glossary

Horsepower (Hp) 1. Unit of power that represents the amount of work done per unit of time. 1
horsepower (Hp) is equivalent to the lifting of 33,000 pounds to a height of 1
foot in 1 minute. It is equal to 746 watts.

2. The horsepower of a motor is expressed as a function of torque and speed.


Where torque is measured in units of ft•lbs and speed is measured in units of
RPM. Calculated as (torque x speed) / 5252.

Hysteresis Used to avoid oscillation when comparing two near by values.

I01N Nominal current of the I01 input of the device.

I02N Nominal current of the I02 input of the device.

I0N Nominal current of I0 input in general.

IMODE Nominal current of the selected mode. In feeder mode,


Imode = CTprimary. In motor mode, Imode = IMOT.

IMOT Nominal motor current, in motor protective mode.

IN Nominal current. Rating of CT primary or secondary.

ISET Another name for pick up setting value I>

IoSET Another name for pick up setting value IO>

ION Nominal current of I0 input in general

IO1N Nominal current of I01 input in general

IO2N Nominal current of I02 input in general

IEC-101 Abbreviation for communication protocol that is defined in standard


IEC 60870-5-101.

IEC-103 Abbreviation for communication protocol that is defined in standard


IEC 60870-5-103.

IED Intelligent Electronic Device.

IEEE Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers.

Induction motor AC motor that has no electrical connection to the rotor. The current that is
supplied to the primary winding on the stator produces a rotating magnetic
field in the stator. This rotating magnetic field induces current in the rotor
windings. The induced current in the rotor windings creates a magnetic field in
the rotor. The interaction of the magnetic field of the stator and the magnetic
field of the rotor causes motion. It runs close to synchronous speed.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 495


Glossary

Instantaneous trip circuit breaker A circuit breaker in which no delay is introduced into the tripping action of the
circuit breaker. These circuit breakers are able to provide motor branch circuit
protection when evaluated as a part of a combination motor controller as in
31.1.1 (as defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).

Insulation 1. Material that tends to resist the flow of electric current and reduce heat loss.

2. In a motor, insulation allows high voltage in the system for current flow and
for motor torque production.

International Electrotechnical Global organization that prepares and publishes international standards for all
Commission (IEC) electrical, electronic, and related technologies. These standards serve as a basis
for national standardization and as references when drafting international
tenders and contracts. The IEC promotes international cooperation on all
questions of electrotechnical standardization and related matters. Such as the
assessment of conformity to standards, in the fields of electricity, electronics,
and related technologies.

Interrupting Rating The highest current, at rated voltage, which a device is intended to interrupt
under standard test conditions.

Inverse-time circuit breaker A circuit breaker in which a delay is introduced into the tripping action of the
circuit breaker. The delay decreases as the magnitude of the current increases.
These circuit breakers are able to provide branch circuit protection (as defined
in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).

Isolated secondary circuit A circuit that is derived from an isolating source and having no direct
connection back to the primary circuit, other than through the grounding
means. Such as a transformer, optical isolator, a limiting impedance, or
electromechanical relay. A secondary circuit that has a direct connection back
to the primary circuit is evaluated as part of the primary circuit (as defined in
UL 508A, December 28, 2007).

LAN Local area network. based network for computers and relays.

Latching Output relays and status indicators can be latched, which means that they are
not released when the control signal is releasing. The releasing of latched
devices is done with a separate action.

Listed Equipment, materials, or services included in a list that is acceptable to the


authority having jurisdiction.

496 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Glossary

Load 1. Burden that is imposed on a motor by the driven machine. It is often stated
as the torque required to overcome the resistance of the machine it drives.
Sometimes synonymous with “required power.”

2. Share of work that is demanded of a machine or system. It is the external


force that is applied to a machine or system. Or the sum of the external forces
and the weight of the structure moved by the machine or system.

3. Amount of power or current required to start or maintain motion in a


power-driven machine or apparatus.

4. External mechanical resistance against which a machine acts.

5. Machine characteristics that are moved from one place to another.

6. Robot supported function of mass, moment of inertia, static and dynamic


forces. It is expressed as the force and torque at the mechanical interface, which
can be exerted along the various axes of motion under specified conditions of
velocity and acceleration.

Locked-rotor current Amount of current drawn at the instant a motor is energized. It is the steady-
state current that is taken from a line with a rotor that is at standstill with rated
voltage and frequency. In most cases, it is much higher than the current
required for running a motor. It is also known as starting current.

Local HMI IED front panel with display and push buttons

Low-voltage limited energy circuit A control circuit that involves a peak open-circuit potential of not more than
42.4 volts (DC or peak) supplied by a primary battery or by an isolated
secondary circuit. Where the current capacity is limited by an overcurrent
device, such as a fuse. Or by the inherent capacity of the secondary transformer
or power supply, or a combination of a secondary winding and an impedance.
A low-voltage limited energy circuit is not derived from a line-voltage circuit
by connecting a resistance in series with the supply circuit to limit the voltage
and current. As defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007.

Motor A device that takes electrical energy and converts it into mechanical energy to
turn a shaft.

Motor overload Electrical overload, a situation where an electrical machine or system is


subjected to a greater load its design.

Motor rating The operational capabilities of a motor. They are specifications or performance
limits that are measured at defined temperatures.

Nameplate The plate on the outside of the motor that describes the motor horsepower,
voltage, speed efficiency, design, enclosure, and so forth.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 497


Glossary

National Electrical Code® (NEC®) National Fire Protection Association, regulations that govern the construction
and installation of electrical wiring and apparatus. The regulations are suitable
for mandatory application by governing bodies that exercise legal jurisdiction.
It is widely used by state and local authorities within the United States.

National Electrical Manufacturers A non-profit association of manufacturers of electric equipment and supplies.
Association (NEMA) NEMA has set standards for the following: horsepower ratings, speeds, frame
sizes and dimensions, standard voltages and frequencies with allowable
variations, service factors, torque, the starting current and KVA, enclosures.

NTP Network time protocol for LAN and WWW.

Original Equipment Manufacturer The maker of a piece of equipment. For example, a machine tool manufacturer
(OEM) buys programmable controller components, sensors, and actuators. Then
integrates them with their machine tool to produce the complete system for
sale to the end user.

Overcurrent protection A device that is designed to open a circuit when the current through it exceeds
a predetermined value. The ampere rating of the device is selected for a circuit
to terminate a condition. When the current exceeds the rating of conductors
and equipment due to overloads, short circuits, and faults to ground. As
defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).

Overload An electrical load that exceeds the available electrical power.

Overload protection Protection that is required for motor circuits that will operate to prohibit
excessive heat due to running overloads and failure to start (as defined in
UL 508A, December 28, 2007).

P Active power. Units =[W].

PF Power factor. The absolute value is equal to cos φ, but the sign is “+” for
inductive, which is lagging current and “-” for capacitive, that is leading current.

Phase 1. Indicates the space relationships of windings and the changing values of the
recurring cycles of AC voltages and currents. Due to the positioning (or the
phase relationship) of the windings, the various voltages and currents are not
similar in all aspects at any given instant. Each winding leads or lags another in
position. Each voltage leads or lags another voltage in time. Each current leads
or lags another current in time. The most common power supplies are single-
or three-phase (with 120 electrical degrees between the three-phases).

2. The separation in electrical degrees between any specified transitions of any


two channels in an encoder.

PM Nominal current of prime mover (used by reverse/under power protection


elements).

Power The work done per unit of time.  Measured in horsepower or watts:
1 Hp= 33,000 ft•lb/min. = 746 W.

498 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Glossary

Power factor The ratio of the active power (W) to the apparent power (VA) expressed as a
percentage. It is numerically equal to the cosine of the angle of lag of the input
current regarding its voltage, which is multiplied by 100.

Power transformer A transformer whose secondary winding supplies power to loads or a


combination of loads and control circuit devices operating at the secondary
voltage (as defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).

PT See VT.

pu Per unit. Depending on the context, the per unit refers to any nom value. For
example, for overcurrent setting 1 pu = 1 x IMODE.

Q Reactive power. Units = [var] acc. IEC.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 499


Glossary

Qualified person A person who has the skills, knowledge, and training that is related to the
construction, installation, and operation of electrical equipment. With safety
training to recognize and avoid the hazards that are involved.

Rated horsepower The maximum or allowable power output of a motor or other prime mover
under normal, continuous operating conditions.

RMS Root mean square.

S Apparent Power. Unit = [VA].

Safe working procedure A method of work that reduces risk.

Service Factor (SF) 1. When used on a motor nameplate, a number that indicates how much above
the nameplate rating a motor can be loaded without causing serious
degradation. For example, a 1.15 SF can produce 15% greater torque than the
1.0 SF rating of the same motor).

2. When used in the applying motors or gearmotors, a figure of merit, which is


used to “adjust”, measured loads to compensate for conditions, which are
difficult to measure or define. Typically, measured loads are multiplied by
service factors (experience factors) and the result in an “equivalent required
torque” rating of a motor or gearmotor.

Shall Indicates a mandatory requirement in regulatory standards.

Short-circuit current An overcurrent that results from a short circuit due to a fault or an incorrect
connection.

Short-circuit current rating (SCCR) The prospective symmetrical fault current at a nom voltage to which an
apparatus or system can be connected without damage that exceeds the defined
acceptance criteria. As defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007.

SNTP Simple Network Time Protocol for LAN and WWW.

500 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Glossary

Suffixes to NEMA frames Letter suffixes sometimes follow the NEMA frame size designations. Some of
these suffixes, according to NEMA standards, have these meanings:

Fractional Horsepower Motors.

C - Face mounting.
G - Gasoline pump motor.
H - Indicates a frame having a larger “F” dimension.
J - Jet pump motor.
Y - Special mounting dimensions (see manufacturer).
Z - All mounting dimensions are standard except the shaft extension.

Integral Horsepower Motors.

A - DC motor or generator.
C - Face mounting on drive end.
D - Flange mounting on drive end.
P - Vertical hollow and solid shaft motors with P-Base flange.
HP - Vertical solid shaft motors with P-Base flange (normal thrust).
JM - Close-coupled pump motor with C-Face mounting and special
shaft extensions.
JP - Close-coupled pump motor with C-Face mounting and special long
shaft extension.
LP - Vertical solid shaft motors with P-Base flange (medium thrust).
S - Standard short shaft for direct connection.
T - Standardized shaft -“T” frame.
V - Vertical mounting.
Y - Special mounting dimensions.
Z - All mounting dimensions standard except shaft extension.

Supplementary protection A device that is intended to provide additional protection subsequent to


branch circuit protection. They have not been evaluated for providing branch
circuit protection (as defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).

Supplementary protector A manually resettable device that is designed to open the circuit automatically
on a predetermined value of time versus current or voltage within an appliance
or other electrical equipment. It can be provided with manual means to open or
close the circuit. These devices provide supplementary protection only (as
defined in UL 508A, December 28, 2007).

TCS Trip circuit supervision.

THD Total harmonic distortion.

U0SEC Voltage for input Uc at zero-ohm earth-fault (in mode 2LL +U0).

UA Voltage at input U12 or U1, depending on voltage measurement mode.

UB Voltage at input U23 or U2, depending on voltage measurement mode.

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 501


Glossary

UC Voltage at input U31 or U3, depending on voltage measurement mode.

UN Normal voltage. Rating of VT9PT) primary or secondary.

UL (Underwriter’s Laboratory) An independent testing organization, which examines and tests devices,
systems and materials with particular reference to life, fire, and casualty
hazards. It develops standards for motors and controls that are used in
hazardous locations through cooperation with manufacturers. UL has
standards and tests for explosion-proof and dust ignition-proof motors, which
must be met and passed before application of the UL label.

UTC Coordinated Universal Time (used to be called GMT = Greenwich Mean


Time).

VT Voltage or primary transformer.

VTpri Nom primary value of VT or PT.

VTsec Nom secondary value of VT or PT.

Voltage, Nom A Nom value that is assigned to a circuit or system for conveniently designating
its voltage class.

Watt The amount of power that is required to maintain a current of 1 ampere at a


pressure of 1 volt. Most motors are rated in kW equal to 1000 watts. 1
horsepower is equal to 746 watts.

Webset Http base configuration tool.

502 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Index

Numerics Arc protection stage ArcI02> 363


1LL+U0/LLy 218 Arc Sensor Inputs 349
1LL+Uo/LLy 143, 173 Auto Adjust 194
2L/LLy 144 Auto-Lag/Lead 198
2LL/LLy 173, 218 Auto-reclose 238
2LL+Uo 173, 217, 218, 221, 222, 227, 228, 229 Blocking shots 241
Burning Time 238
3LN 173, 217, 227, 228, 229 Critical Request 241
857-3C6 Discrimination Time 238
Block Diagram 336 Final Trip Matrix Signals 242
Rear Connection Panel 319 Manual Closing 240
857-3C7 Manual Opening 240
Block Diagram 337, 338 Matrix 239
Rear Connection Panel 320 Measured and Recorded Values 244
Terminal X8 325 Overview 238
857-3C8 Parameters 242
Reclaim Time Setting 240
Rear Connection 321 Reclose Shots 238
Terminal X8 326
857-VX003-03 252 Running Matrix Signal 242
Shot Active Matrix Signals 241
857-VX003-3 52, 251 Start at Shot 2...5 241
Local Port 52 Start Sequence 241
Terminology 238
Two Circuit Breaker Support 240
A Auto-reset Display 46
Alarm 234 Auxiliary Voltage 327, 346
Contacts 348 Serial Communication Connection 327
Alarm Points Available Data (Profibus DP) 275
Set 185
Ambient Temperature 122
Correction 122 B
ANSI Backlight Control 27
Inverse Time Operation 161 Switch on 27
Long Time Extremely Inverse Delay 163 Bi-directional operation 77
Long Time Inverse Delay 162 Binary Input 152
Long Time Very Inverse Delay 162
Moderately Inverse Delay 163 Binary Output 153
Short Time Extremely Inverse Delay 163 Signals 65
Short Time Inverse Delay 163 Block
Application Modes Configuration 56
Feeder Protection 69 Block Diagram
Motor Protection 69 857-3C6 336
Application Service Data Unit 277 857-3C7 337, 338
Application Techniques 21 Optional Arc Protection Module 339
Block Matrix 235
Arc Fault Protection 152
Cold Load Pick-up 178
Arc Fault Stages 152 Motor status 88
Binary Input 152
Bootcode version 51
Binary Output 153
Delayed Light 153 Breaker Curve 184
Fault History 155 Breaking capacity, DC 346
Light Channel Selection 152 Burden 345
Recorded values 155 Burning Time 238
Arc fault protection (50ARC/50NARC)
Parameter list 154
Pick-up Scaling 153 C
Arc Fault Stages
Capacitor bank protection
ArcI> 152
ArcI>01 152 Application 115
ArcI>02 152 Capacitor Bank Unbalance Protection 114
Arc Protection Interface 349 Parameters 117
Arc protection stage ArcI> 363

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 503


Index

Caption View Clock


Auto-Refresh 60 Daylight Savings Time 194
Logout 60 Synchronization 193
Refresh Content 60 Synchronize with Digital Inputs 196
Refresh Menu 60 Time Zone Offsets 193
Restart Device 60 Cold Load Pick-up Detection 178
Casing 351 Application 178
Catalog Number Explanation 22 Functionality 180
Channel 173 Parameters 180
CosPhi 174 Cold Load/Inrush Current Detection 364
DI 174 Color code 351
DI_2 174 Combined Overcurrent Status 201
DO 174 Line Fault Parameters 201
f 173 Communication Module
fy 174 18 mm 329
fz 174 31 mm 329
I1 174 Internal Connection 329
I2 174 Communication Options
I2/I1 174
I2/Imode 174 Pin Assignments 330
IL 174 Communication Ports
IL, IL2, IL3 173 Port 255
IL1RMS 174 Extension Port 255
IL2RMS 174 Extension Port X4 Parameters 255
IL3RMS 174 Local Port 252
Io1, Io2 173 Local Port Protocol 252
IoCalc 174 Remote Port X9 253
P, Q, S 173 Remote Port X9 Parameters 254
P.F. 174 Communication Protocols 258
Prms 174 Modbus RTU 259
Qrms 174 Modbus TCP 259
Srms 174 PC Communication 259
TanPhi 174 Compensation 116
THDIL1 174 COMTRADE Files
THDIL2 174 Run 177
THDIL3 174 SetPointPS 177
THDUa 174 Configurable Release Delay 125
THDUb 174
THDUc 174 Configuration
U1 174 Current Scaling 50
U12 173 Device Setup 50
U12y 174 Frequency Adaptation 51
U12z 174 Language 50
U2 174 Configuration Level 38
U2/U1 174 Configurator Access
U23 173 Display areas 59
U31 173 Configure
UL1, UL2, UL3 173 Digital Inputs 49
Uline 174 Digital Outputs 49
Uo 173 Contact material 347, 348
Uphase 174
Circuit Breaker Condition Monitoring 183, Continuous carry 346, 348
184 Continuous Mode (Profibus DP) 275
Sample Characteristic Graph 184 Continuous Voltage Withstand 345
Set Alarm Points 185 Contrast
Circuit Breaker Failure Protection 147, 361 Adjust 30
Breaking Current 183 Control Functions 40
Fault History 148 Local/Remote Control 40
Parameters 147 Object Control 40
Clear Operations Left Counters 185 Control Supervisor 282

504 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Index

Controllable Objects 236 Digital Inputs 232


Digital Input 237 Block AR Setting 242
Local/Remote Selection 238 Configure 49
Object States 236 Internal operating voltage 346
Output Signals 237 Parameters 232
Read-only Objects 237 Specifications 346
Settings 236 Threshold Voltages 233
Counters Digital Outputs
Reset 49 Configure 49
Critical Auto-reclose Request 241 Dimensions 351
Current Drain (when active) 346 Dip Switch
Current Protection Function Dependencies 857-VCM Fiber 332
69 857-VCM485-2 332
Current Scaling 225 857-VCM485-4 332
TTL 331
Current Transformer Supervision 182 Direction Algorithm 109
Measured and Recorded Values 182 Direction of Power and Current
Setting Parameters 182
Current Unbalance 82 Power Quadrants 220
Directional Current Protection
Current unbalance I2>
Specifications 356
Specifications 354 Directional Earth Fault Protection 93
Current unbalance protection I2>
Polarization 93
Inverse Delay 83 Directional Earth Fault Stages
Motor Protection 82
Current unbalance stage I2> Block diagram 96
Fault history 99
Fault history 85 Parameter list 97
Feeder Protection Mode 81 Directional Intermittent Earth Fault Stages
Inverse operation delay 84
Parameter List 82 Specifications 357
Parameter list 84 Directional Intermittent Transient Earth
Set Parameters 82 Fault Stage
Fault history 114
Parameter list 113
D Specifications 356
D9S Connector 333 Directional Overcurrent Function
Data Transfer Rate 348 Base Angle 76
Directional mode 76
Day Registers Non-directional mode 76
Parameters 217 Protection area 76
Daylight Savings Time 194 Directional Overcurrent Protection 75
Dead Band 68 Directional Overcurrent Stages
Definite Delay 155 Iφ> and Iφ>> Specifications 356
Definite Operation Time Characteristics 135 Discrimination Time 238
Definite Time Display
Delay 95 Adjust Contrast 30
Function 352 Backlight Control 27
Degree of protection (IEC 60529) 351 Definition of On-screen sections 26
Delay Type Inverse Keypad Overview 27
GE-IAC51 168 Menu Navigation 28, 30
Delayed Light Indication Signal 153 Operation Status Indicators 28
Overview 25
Demand Values 216 Distribution Management System 204, 208,
Parameters 216 210
Deviation 198
Disturbance Recorder 48, 173
DeviceLogix 246
Channels 173
df/dt Operation Time 134 Output Matrix 234
Diagnostic Tests Parameters 175
Error Registers 202 Read Recordings 173
Fatal Errors 202 Signal Links 48
Runtime Errors 202 Trigger the Recorder 173
Digital I/O Card Disturbance Recordings
Card Connections 334 IEC 103 54
Disturbance Tests 349

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 505


Index

DNP 3.0 55, 279 Feeder Protection 69


Parameters 279 Current Dependent Protection Functions 69
Current unbalance stage I2> 81
Imode 69
E Motor Protection 69
Earth Fault Fifth Harmonic O/C Stage 147
Location 210 Fifth harmonic O/C stage If5> 147
Measured and Recorded Values 212 Setting Parameters 147
Protection 104 File Transfer Protocol (FTP) Server 283
Setting Parameters 211 Firmware
Specifications 354 Version 12.001 57
Earth Fault Stages Firmware Compliance 19
I0>> Specifications 355 Flt 36
I0>>> Specifications 355 Force 35
II0>>>> Specifications 355
EDly 36 Force flag 65
Start Condition 65
Electrical Safety Test 351 Trip Condition 65
Energy Pulse Output 190 Force Flag 65
Parameters 190 Reset 65
Environmental Conditions 349 Force Function 44
Relative Humidity 351 Free Parameter Settings 168
Error Frequency Adaptation 51
Fatal 202 Frequency Over/understages 135
Inverse Time Setting 168, 169
Registers 202 Frequency Protection
Port 53, 255 Specifications 359
EtherNet/IP 282, 287 Frequent Start Protection 90
Network Design 287 Application 90
Event Buffer Overflow 172 Breaker Control 90
Parameter list 92
Setting Parameters 172 Specifications 358
Event Enabling/Masking 172 Frequent Start Protection N>
Event Log 171, 172 Contactor Control 91
Enabling 172 Front Panel
Event Buffer Overflow 172 Components 25
Event Register 43 Front Panel Connector 333
Read 43 FTP Server 285
Extension Port 255
Via WIndows Explorer 286
Extension Port X4 FTP Server Selections 284
Parameters 255 Function Dependencies 69
External I/O 54, 280
Application Modes 69
Modbus 54
RTD Input 54
External Operating Voltage 346 G
Extremely Inverse Delay 160, 165
GE-IAC51 Delay Type Inverse 168
GOOSE 281
F Groups
Fault Locator 204 Select Separately 37
Setting 37
Fault Log 38
Example 38
Menu H
Fault Log 36
Voltage Sags and Swells 181 Harmonic Bar Display 43
Features 17 Heat Capacitance 122
Feeder Fault Locator 208 HTTP Server
Measured and Recorded Values 209 Configure 857 Relay 59
Setting Parameters 209 Enable 57
Webset 57
Hysteresis 68

506 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Index

I Inrush Current Detection 178


I>> 35 Application 179
Functionality 180
I0 pick-up sensitivity 109 Parameters 180
IAC Interlock
IEEE2 Inverse Time Operation 163 Configuration 56
IDMT function 352 Intermittent Earth Fault Detection 95, 105
IEC Intermittent Time 111
Extremely Inverse Delay 160 Coordination 111
Free Parameter Settings 168 Internal Operating Voltage 346
Long Time Inverse Delay 160 Internal Parallel Digital Inputs 309
Nomal Inverse Delay 160
Inverse Delay 155
Very Inverse Delay 160
IEC 103 Disturbance Recordings 54 Minimum Time 155
Inverse df/dt Operation Time
IEC 60870-5-101 55, 280
Characteristics 137
Parameters 280
Example 137
IEC 60870-5-103 54, 277
Setting Parameters 138
Parameters 278 Inverse Operation Time 70, 77, 95
IEC 61850 281
(I0> stage only) 105
Parameters 281 Characteristics 136
IEC Inverse Delay Equation Inverse Time Limitation 70, 78, 95, 106
Constants 159 Inverse Time Operation 155
IEC Inverse Time Operation 159
ANSI 161
IEC61850 284 Delay 95
IEEE IEC Inverse Time Operations 159
Free Parameter Settings 168 IEEE 161
Inverse Time Operation 161 IEEE2 163
Long Time Extremely Inverse Delay 163 Inverse Time Setting Error Signal 156
Long Time Inverse Delay 162 Limitation examples 157
Long Time Very Inverse Delay 162 Limitations 156, 169
Moderately Inverse Delay 163, 165 Local Panel Graph 156
Short Time Extremely Inverse Delay 163 Operation Modes 155
Short Time Inverse Delay 163 Stage Specific Inverse Delay 155
IEEE/ANSI Inverse Time Operation 161 Standard Delay Families 158
IEEE2 Standard Inverse Delays 158
Inverse Time Setting Error Signal 156, 158,
Extremely Inverse Delay 165
Free Parameter Settings 168 168, 169
Normal Inverse Delay 165
Very Inverse Delay 165
IEEE2 Inverse Time Operation 163 K
Constants 164 Keypad 27
Illegal Value 47 Overview 27
Ilmax 35
Imode 69
Incomer Short Circuit Fault Locator 204 L
Algorithmic Functions 204 Latched Indicators
Measured and Recorded Values 205 Reset 29
Setting Parameters 205 Latched Relay 234
Incorrect phase sequence I2>> Light Channel Selection 152
Specifications 353 BI 152
Incorrect phase sequence protection I2>> S1 152
85 S1/BI 152
Parameters 85 S1/S2 152
Independent Frequency Stages 132 S1/S2/BI 152
Industrial Feeder Protection 306 S2 152
S2/BI 152
Initial Temperature Rise 123
Limitations 156, 169
Input Modules
Line Fault Parameters 201
External 335
Input Signal Selection 94, 105 Line-to-Line Voltages 218
Line-to-Neutral Voltages 219
LL/LLy/LLz 145, 173, 218

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 507


Index

Load 36 Menu
Load Switching 134 EDly 36
Local Fault Log 38
Control 40 Flt 36
Panel Graph 156 Force 35
Selection 238 I>> 35
Serial Communication Port 348 Ilmax 35
Local Port 252 Load 36
Navigation 30
Parameters 253 Protection Function Structure 34
Protocol 252 SCntr 34
Logarithmic Interpolation 186 SetGrp 35, 36
Logic Functions 246 SGrpDI 35
SetPointPS 246 Stage Setting Group 35
Long Time Extremely Inverse Delay 163 Status 34, 35
Long Time Inverse Delay 160, 162 t>> 35
Long Time Very Inverse Delay 162 TCntr 34
Type 36
Looped network 75 Menu Navigation 28
Minimum Definite Time Delay Start 158, 169
M Modbus
Change Scaling Factor 74
Magnetizing Inrush If2 > Simple Tester 270
Specifications 361 Modbus RTU
Magnetizing Inrush Second Harmonic O/C Bit rate 260
Stage If2> 146 Clock Synchronization 264
Manual Configuration 261
Closing 240 Initiate Transactions 260
Opening 240 Overview 260
Masking 172 Parameters 259
MasterICD 283 Simple Tester 270
Modbus TCP 268
Material 351
Configure 268
Matrix Parameters 259
Auto-reclose 239 ModbusSlv 263
Auto-reclose Running Signal 242 Moderately Inverse Delay 163, 165
Block 235
Final Trip Signals 242 Month Registers
Output 234 Parameters 217
Shot Active Signals 241 Motor Current
Measure residual voltage Frequent Start Protection 90
Line + U0 119 Motor Protection 69
Phase 119 Current Dependent Protection Functions 69
Measured Data 41 Current unbalance protection I2> 82
Values 41 Imode 69
Measuring Circuitry 345 Imot 69
Mechanical Tests 351 Motor Status 87
Run 87
Start 87
Stop 87
Mounting Instructions 367
MSTAT 88

N
Negative Zero Sequence Voltage
Polarization 93
Network Design 287
Non-directional Current Protection
Specifications 352
Non-dry Digital Inputs DI1…DI6 313
Normal Inverse Delay 160, 165
Normal Starting Sequence 89

508 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Index

Number of contacts 346 Overcurrent stages Iφ>


Fault history 81
Overcurrent stages Iφ>>
O Fault history 81
Object Control 40 Overcurrent stages Iφ>>>
Object States 236 Fault history 81
Operating Levels 38 Parameters 80
Overcurrent stages Iφ>>>>
Configuration Level 38
Login 39 Fault history 81
Operating Levels Parameters 80
User Level 38 Overfrequency and underfrequency
Operator Level 38 Protection f><> 131
User Level 38 Overfrequency Protection 131, 132
Operating Measures 40 Fault history 133
Event Register 43 Parameter List 132
Local/Remote Protection Mode 132
Control 40 Setting Groups 132
Measured Data 41 Overload Supervisor 282
Object Control 40 Overvoltage protection U> 125
Signal Forcing Control 44 Adjustable stages 125
Virtual Inputs 40 Configurable Hysteresis 126
Operating Safety 19 Configurable release delay 125
Operating temperature 351 Fault History 127
Operation Modes 155 Set Groups 126
Inverse delay characteristics 155 Overvoltage stages U>
Standard delay formula 155 Parameter list 126
Operation Status Indicators 28 Overvoltage stages U>, U>> and U>>>
Definition 29 Specifications 358
Operations Left
Clear Counters 185
Operator Level 38 P
Optional Arc Protection Module Parallel Line Protection 307
Block Diagram 339 Parameter
Optional Digital I/O Card 334 Change 61
Oscillation 68 Set 45
Output Channels Set value screen 47
Active Exported Energy 190 SetPointPS 45
Active Imported Energy 190 Parameters
Reactive Exported Energy 190 Day 217
Reactive Imported Energy 190 Line Fault 201
Output Matrix 66, 234 Local Port 253
Cold Load Pick-up 178 Month 217
Distrubance Recorder 234 Refresh 62
Motor status 88 Password
Setting Error 156 Change 39
Typical 235 Login 39
Output Modules Protection 38
External 335 Restore 39
Output Relays 231 PC (Local/Spa-bus) 53
Parameters 231 PC Communication 259
Reset 29 Peak Amount Counter 111
Output Sequence Per Unit Scaling 224
Timer 199 Line-to-Line Voltages 228
Output Signals Petersen coil 94
Controllable Objects 237 Phase Current Inputs IL1, IL2, IL3 213
Overcurrent Stage 70 Pick-up current 352
Adjustable overcurrent stage 70 Pick-up Scaling 153
Overcurrent Stage I> ArcI> 153
Parameters 71 ArcI01> 153
Overcurrent Stage Iφ> ArcI02> 153
Parameters 78 Pin Assignments 330

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 509


Index

Polarization 93 Q
Power and Current Direction 220 Quadrants
Power Calculation 218
Power Plane 220
Line-to-Line Voltages 218 Voltage/Current Phasor Plane 220
Line-to-Neutral Voltages 219
Power Consumption 346
Power Protection 360 R
Primary Scaling 224 Range Limits 47
Profibus 55 Display 47
Profibus DP 275 Illegal Value 47
Available Data 275 Set 47
Continuous Mode 275 View allowed limits 47
Parameters 276 Rate of Change of Frequency Protection df/
Request mode 275 dt
Programmable Curves 155 Definite Operation Time 134
Programmable Stages 148 Definite Operation Time Characteristics 135
Available Signals 149 Frequency Over/understages 135
Compare Condition 149 Inverse Operation Time Characteristics 136
Coupling A 148 Load Switching 134
Coupling B 148 ROCOF implementation 135
Fault History 151 Setting Groups 134
Hysteresis 149 Rated
Independent Stages 150 CT Secondary 50
Link 148 frequency fn 345
No Compare Limit 149 Phase Current 345
Operation Delay 149 Residual Current 345
Parameter list 150 Voltage 346
Pick-up 149 Voltage Un 345
Priority 148 Read-only Objects
Recorded Values 151 Settings 237
Setting Groups 150 Rear Connection
Protection
857-3C6 319
Industrial Feeder 306 857-3C7 320
Parallel Line 307 857-3C8 321
Ring Network 308 Rear Panel
Substation Feeder 305
Overview 319
Protection Functions 19, 34
Reclaim Time Setting 240
Block 66 Reclose Shots 238
Enable/disable 49
Fault Logs 38 Recorder
List 63 Trigger 173
Protection Menu 49 Relative Humidity 351
Reset Counters 49 Relay
Protection mode for f>> 132 Applications 21
Protection Stage Auto-reset Display 46
Blocked 64, 65 Catalog Number Explanation 22
Features 64 Communication Protocols 17
OK 64 Configuration 45
Setting Groups 64 Connecto to Web Browser 58
Start 64 Enable HTTP Server 57
Trip 64 Features 17
Protocol Menu 52 Firmware Compliance 19
Front Panel Overview 25
External I/O protocol 54
Information 51
Protocol Port
Operating Levels 38
Port 53 Operating Safety 19
PC (Local/Spa-bus) 53 Protection Functions 19
Profibus 55 Restart 62
Spabus 54 Retardation time 66
PT Fuse Failure 128 Set Parameters 45
Set Range Limits 47
User Interface 18
Release Time 67

510 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Index

Remote Selection
Control Connection Specifications 348 Local/Remote 238
Scaling 75 Self Blocking 128
Selection 238 Self Supervision 202
Remote Control 40 Serial Communication Connection 327
Remote Port X9 253 RJ-45 327
Parameters 254 ST Fiber Optic 327
Request Mode (Profibus DP) 275 Serial Number 51
ResCap 94 Service Factor 122
Directional Earth Fault Protection 96 Set Alarm Points 185
Reset Current 185
Counters 49 Operations Left 185
Latched Indicators 29 SetGrp 35, 36
Output Relays 29 SetPointPS
Time 67
Residual overvoltage stages U0>, U0>> Auto-restart 45
Blocking 56
Fault history 120 Change application mode 69
Parameter list 120 Configure FTP Server 283
Retardation Time 66 Define interlocking 49
Reverse Power 130, 131 Documentation 56
Setting Parameters 131 Download 259
Values 131 download 18
Reverse power and underpower protection P Download software 56
130 Enable HTTP Server 57
Reverse power and under-power stages P Event Buffer Size 172
Event Log 171
360 Fault Logs 38
RI Input selection 234
Inverse Delay 167 Interlocking 56
RI Inverse Time Operation 166 Logic 246
Ring Network Protection 308 Logic Functions 246
RJ-45 327, 330 LOGIC groups 57
MIMIC groups 57
RMS Values 215 Modbus Data Mappings 261
Currents 215 Motor Status 88
Voltages 215 Overview 18
ROCOF 134, 135 Read the Recordings 173
Implementation 135 RS-232 Serial Port 45
RS-232 251, 252, 259, 260, 279, 328 Run Virtual COMTRADE Files 177
RS-485 255, 259, 260, 279, 328 Set Parameters 46
Running Hour Counter 198 Single Line Diagrams 56
Virtual Input 234
Parameters 198 Setting Error 156
Runtime Errors 202
Setting Groups 37, 64
RXIDG
Example 37
Equation 166 Select 37
Inverse Delay 167 SGrpDI 35
RXIDG Inverse Time Operation 166
Shock (IEC 60255-21-1) 351
Short Time Extremely Inverse Delay 163
S Short Time Inverse Delay 163
Sags 181 Shot Active Matrix Signals 241
Scaling Examples 191 Signal Forcing Control 44
SCntr 34 Simple Tester 270
Second harmonic blocking If2> Modbus RTU 270
Modbus TCP
Measured and recorded values 146 Modbus TCP
Parameter Setting 146
Secondary Simple Tester 271
Current 78 Read Data 273
Scaling 224 Write Data 273
Sector 94 Single Line Diagram 56
Edit 56
Skipping shots 241

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 511


Index

Softstarting 88 System Clock


Profile 88 Daylight Savings Time 194
Software Parameters 196
Options 52 Synchronization 193
Version 51 Time Zone Offsets 193
SPA-Bus 276
Parameters 277
Squelch Limit 213 T
Stage Setting Group 35 t>> 35
Stage Specific Inverse Delay 155 TCntr 34
Stall Protection Ist> 85 Temperature
Block diagram 87 Storage 351
Operation time delay 86 Terminal Block 348
Parameter list 87 Terminal block 345
Standard Delay Families 158 Terminal X1
Standard Inverse Delays Left Side 322
IEC 158 Right Side 322
IEEE 158 Terminal X2 323
IEEE2 158 Terminal X3 323
Limitations 158 Terminal X6 326
RI 158
Start DI19/DI20 Option 327
Terminal X7 324
Force Flag 65
Force Start Condition 65 Terminal X8
Start Condition 65 857-3C7 325
Start Detection 857-3C8 326
Test
Default value 89
Start Up Peak 346 Force flag 65
Force Start/Trip Condition 65
Stator Windings 90 Thermal Model 121
Status 34, 35 Thermal model
Status Indicator Alarm 121
A, B, C 29 Diagram 124
Alarm 29 Release time 121
Com 29 Start release 121
Error 29 Trip 121
Power 29 Trip release 121
Trip 29 Trip Time 121
Storage Temperature 351 Thermal Overload Protection T> 121
Submenu Alarm 123
Select 37 Ambient Temperature 122
Substation Feeder Protection 305 Ambient Temperature Correction 122
Supporting Functions 364 Diagram 124
Swells 181 Heat Capacitance 122
Initial Temperature Rise 123
Sychrocheck Protection Service Factor 122
2L/LLy 144 Thermal Model 121
Symmetric Components 221 Thermal Model Behavior 123
Sync Source 197 Thermal Overload Stage T>
Synchrocheck Function Parameter list 124
Specifications 361 Specifications 353
Synchrocheck Protection 138 Three-phase overvoltage stages U>
1LL+Uo/LLy 143 Block Diagram 126
Block Diagram 141 Time Constant for Cooling Situation 122
LL/LLy/LLz 145 Time Drift Correction 195
Measured and Recorded Values 140 Time Stamps
Principle 141 Absolute Accuracy 172
Setting Parameters 139 Time Zone Offsets 193
Voltage Measurement Modes 142
Synchronization Correction 197 Timer 199
Output Sequence 199
Timer Output Sequence 199

512 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Index

Timers Virtual COMTRADE


Setting Parameters 200 Run 177
Total Harmonic Distortion 215 SetPointPS 177
Transient over-reach 352 Virtual Inputs 40
Trip 234 Virtual Inputs and Outputs 234
Condition 65 Parameters 234
Contacts 346 Voltage
Force Flag 65 Inputs UA, UB, UC 214
Force Trip Condition 65 Measurement Mode 173, 217
Trip Circuit Supervision 308 Measuring Range 345
Internal Parallel Digital Inputs 309 Scaling 227
One Digital Input 309 Voltage Interruptions 365
Two Digital Inputs 316 Voltage Protection
Two-Channel Arc Protection Card 333 Specifications 358
Two-way Feeder 75 Voltage Sags and Swells 181
Type 36 Recorded Values 181
Typical Overvoltage Trip Event 171 Setting Parameters 181
Typical Relay Application 21 Voltage Transformer Supervision 183, 364
Measured and Recorded Values 183
Setting Parameters 183
U VT Fuse Failure 128
U0> back up protection 110
Unbalance stage I2> W
Specifications 353 Web browser
Under voltage stages U 129
Connect 857 Relay 58
Undercurrent Protection I 92 Webset 57
Undercurrent Protection I<> 92 Caption View 60
Undercurrent protection stage I 354 Restart 62
Underfrequency Protection 131, 132 Weight 351
Fault history 133
Independent Frequency Stages 132
Parameter List 132 Z
Protection Mode 132 Zero sequence voltage protection U0>,
Setting Groups 132
Underfrequency stages U0>> 118
Self blocking 132 Measure residual voltage 119
Self-blocking 132 Zero sequence voltage stages U0> and
Underfrequency stages f 360 U0>>
Underpower Protection 130, 131 Block Diagram 119
Setting Parameters 131 Specifications 359
Values 131
Undervoltage protection
U<> 127
Undervoltage protection U 128, 129, 129, 130
Undervoltage stages U 130, 358
Undir 94
Undirectional Earth Fault Stage I0>
Fault history 108
Parameter list 106
Unselective trip 66
User Interface
Control 18
User Level 38

V
Very Inverse Delay 160, 165
Vibration (IEC 60255-21-1) 351

Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018 513


Index

Notes:

514 Rockwell Automation Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


.

Rockwell Automation Support


Use the following resources to access support information.

Technical Support Center Knowledgebase Articles, How-to Videos, FAQs, Chat, User https://rockwellautomation.custhelp.com/
Forums, and Product Notification Updates.
Local Technical Support Phone Numbers Locate the phone number for your country. http://www.rockwellautomation.com/global/support/get-support-now.page
Find the Direct Dial Code for your product. Use the code to
Direct Dial Codes route your call directly to a technical support engineer. http://www.rockwellautomation.com/global/support/direct-dial.page

Installation Instructions, Manuals, Brochures, and


Literature Library http://www.rockwellautomation.com/global/literature-library/overview.page
Technical Data.
Product Compatibility and Download Get help determining how products interact, check
http://www.rockwellautomation.com/global/support/pcdc.page
Center (PCDC) features and capabilities, and find associated firmware.

Documentation Feedback
Your comments will help us serve your documentation needs better. If you have any suggestions on how to improve this document, complete the
How Are We Doing? form at http://literature.rockwellautomation.com/idc/groups/literature/documents/du/ra-du002_-en-e.pdf.

Rockwell Automation maintains current product environmental information on its website at http://www.rockwellautomation.com/rockwellautomation/about-us/sustainability-ethics/product-environmental-compliance.page.

Allen-Bradley, CompactLogix, ControlLogix, DeviceLogix, RS Logix 5000, Rockwell Automation, Rockwell Software, RSLinx, RSNetWorx, Stratix. and Studio 5000 are trademarks of Rockwell Automation, Inc.
Trademarks not belonging to Rockwell Automation are property of their respective companies.

Rockwell Otomasyon Ticaret A.Ş., Kar Plaza İş Merkezi E Blok Kat:6 34752 İçerenköy, İstanbul, Tel: +90 (216) 5698400

Publication 857-UM001B-EN-P - March 2018


Supersedes Publication 857-UM001A-EN-P - July 2009 Copyright © 2018 Rockwell Automation, Inc. All rights reserved. Printed in Canada.

You might also like

pFad - Phonifier reborn

Pfad - The Proxy pFad of © 2024 Garber Painting. All rights reserved.

Note: This service is not intended for secure transactions such as banking, social media, email, or purchasing. Use at your own risk. We assume no liability whatsoever for broken pages.


Alternative Proxies:

Alternative Proxy

pFad Proxy

pFad v3 Proxy

pFad v4 Proxy